Docs: more indexing of affix-related bits
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
... / ...
CommitLineData
1. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2. This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3. converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
4. formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5. The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
6.
7. WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8. adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9. unwanted vertical space.
10. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12.include stdflags
13.include stdmacs
14
15. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16. This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18
19.docbook
20
21. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22. These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23. Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24. PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
25. processors.
26. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27
28.literal xml
29<?sdop
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
34?>
35.literal off
36
37. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38. This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
39. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40
41.book
42
43. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44. These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45. Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
47
48.set previousversion "4.91"
49.include ./local_params
50
51.set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52.set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
53
54.macro copyyear
552018
56.endmacro
57
58. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59. Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60. provided in the xfpt library.
61. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62
63. --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
64
65.flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66
67. --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68. --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
69
70.flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
71.flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
72
73. --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74. --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75. --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
76. --- index entry.
77
78.macro option
79.arg 5
80.oindex "&%$5%&"
81.endarg
82.arg -5
83.oindex "&%$1%&"
84.endarg
85.itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86.row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
87.endtable
88.endmacro
89
90. --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91. --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92. --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93
94.macro table2 196pt 254pt
95.itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
96.endmacro
97
98. --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99. --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100. --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
101
102.macro irow
103.arg 4
104.row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
105.endarg
106.arg -4
107.arg 3
108.row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
109.endarg
110.arg -3
111.row "&I;$1" "$2"
112.endarg
113.endarg
114.endmacro
115
116. --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117. --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118. --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119. --- ID that ties them together.
120
121.macro cindex
122&<indexterm role="concept">&
123&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124.arg 2
125&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
126.endarg
127&</indexterm>&
128.endmacro
129
130.macro scindex
131&<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132&<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133.arg 3
134&<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
135.endarg
136&</indexterm>&
137.endmacro
138
139.macro ecindex
140&<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
141.endmacro
142
143.macro oindex
144&<indexterm role="option">&
145&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146.arg 2
147&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
148.endarg
149&</indexterm>&
150.endmacro
151
152.macro vindex
153&<indexterm role="variable">&
154&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155.arg 2
156&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
157.endarg
158&</indexterm>&
159.endmacro
160
161.macro index
162.echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163.endmacro
164. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165
166
167. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168. The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
169. output formats.
170. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
171
172.literal xml
173<bookinfo>
174<title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175<titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
176<date>
177.fulldate
178</date>
179<author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180<authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181<revhistory><revision>
182.versiondatexml
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184</revision></revhistory>
185<copyright><year>
186.copyyear
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
188</bookinfo>
189.literal off
190
191
192. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193. This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194. "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195. at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
197
198.chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
199.literal xml
200
201<indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
204</indexterm>
205<indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
209</indexterm>
210<indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
213</indexterm>
214<indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
217</indexterm>
218<indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
221</indexterm>
222<indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
225</indexterm>
226<indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
230</indexterm>
231<indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
234</indexterm>
235<indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
238</indexterm>
239<indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
242</indexterm>
243<indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
246</indexterm>
247<indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
251</indexterm>
252<indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
255</indexterm>
256<indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
259</indexterm>
260<indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
263</indexterm>
264<indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
267</indexterm>
268<indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
271</indexterm>
272<indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
275</indexterm>
276<indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
279</indexterm>
280<indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
283</indexterm>
284<indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
287</indexterm>
288<indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
291</indexterm>
292<indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
295</indexterm>
296<indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
299</indexterm>
300<indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
303</indexterm>
304<indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
308</indexterm>
309<indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
312</indexterm>
313<indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
316</indexterm>
317<indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
320</indexterm>
321
322.literal off
323
324
325. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326. This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327. we can't have the .chapter line here.
328. chapter "Introduction"
329. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
330
331Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
335
336Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
341Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
343
344There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
347
348The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
351
352The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
354which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
357
358Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
363
364Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367&_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
368contributors.
369
370
371.section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372. Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
373
374.new
375.cindex "documentation"
376This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
377Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
378renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
379capable of showing a change indicator.
380.wen
381
382This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
383is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
384with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
385and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
386it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
387Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
388a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
389very wide interest.
390
391.cindex "books about Exim"
392An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
393introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
394SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
395(&url(https://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
396
397This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
398Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
399with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
400published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
401
402.cindex "Debian" "information sources"
403If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
404Debian-specific features in the file
405&_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
406The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
407information.
408
409.cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
410.cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
411.cindex "change log"
412As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
413yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
414digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
415new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
416&_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
417
418Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
419incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
420they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
421can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
422
423All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
424change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
425
426.cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
427This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
428that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
429directory are:
430
431.table2 100pt
432.row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
433.row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
434.row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
435.row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
436.row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
437.row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
438.row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
439.row &_openssl.txt_& "installing a current OpenSSL release"
440.endtable
441
442The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
443available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
444&<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
445
446
447
448.section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
449.cindex "web site"
450.cindex "FTP site"
451The primary site for Exim source distributions is the &%exim.org%& FTP site,
452available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP. These services, and the &%exim.org%&
453website, are hosted at the University of Cambridge.
454
455.cindex "wiki"
456.cindex "FAQ"
457As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
458differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
459online information is the Exim wiki (&url(https://wiki.exim.org)),
460which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
461examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
462The wiki site should always redirect to the correct place, which is currently
463provided by GitHub, and is open to editing by anyone with a GitHub account.
464
465.cindex Bugzilla
466An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(https://bugs.exim.org). You can use
467this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
468first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
469Please do not ask for configuration help in the bug-tracker.
470
471
472.section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
473.cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
474The following Exim mailing lists exist:
475
476.table2 140pt
477.row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
478.row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
479.row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
480.row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
481.endtable
482
483You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
484or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
485.cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
486If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
487the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
488via this web page:
489.display
490&url(https://alioth-lists.debian.net/cgi-bin/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
491.endd
492Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
493lists.
494
495.section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
496.cindex "bug reports"
497.cindex "reporting bugs"
498Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
499via the Bugzilla (&url(https://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
500whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
501message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
502
503
504
505.section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
506.cindex "FTP site"
507.cindex "HTTPS download site"
508.cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
509.cindex "distribution" "https site"
510The master distribution site for the Exim distribution is
511.display
512.url(https://downloads.exim.org/)
513.endd
514The service is available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP.
515We encourage people to migrate to HTTPS.
516
517The content served at &url(https://downloads.exim.org/) is identical to the
518content served at &url(https://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim) and
519&url(ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim).
520
521If accessing via a hostname containing &'ftp'&, then the file references that
522follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at these sites.
523If accessing via the hostname &'downloads'& then the subdirectories described
524here are top-level directories.
525
526There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
527the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
528
529Within the top exim directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
530previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
531distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
532subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
533.display
534&_exim-n.nn.tar.xz_&
535&_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
536&_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
537.endd
538where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The three
539files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
540The &_.xz_& file is usually the smallest, while the &_.gz_& file is the
541most portable to old systems.
542
543.cindex "distribution" "signing details"
544.cindex "distribution" "public key"
545.cindex "public key for signed distribution"
546The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
547Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
548&'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
549other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
550PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from Nigel Metheringham's
551PGP key, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
552&_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
553such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
554
555At time of last update, releases were being made by Jeremy Harris and signed
556with key &'0xBCE58C8CE41F32DF'&. Other recent keys used for signing are those
557of Heiko Schlittermann, &'0x26101B62F69376CE'&,
558and of Phil Pennock, &'0x4D1E900E14C1CC04'&.
559
560The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
561.display
562&_exim-n.nn.tar.xz.asc_&
563&_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
564&_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
565.endd
566For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
567separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
568find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
569
570.cindex "documentation" "available formats"
571The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
572documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
573inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
574.display
575&_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576&_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
577&_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
578&_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
579.endd
580These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
581distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& and &_.xz_& forms.
582
583
584.section "Limitations" "SECID6"
585.ilist
586.cindex "limitations of Exim"
587.cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
588Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
589RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
590simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
591configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
592UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
593.next
594.cindex "domainless addresses"
595.cindex "address" "without domain"
596Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
597local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
598configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
599systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
600arrival.
601.next
602.cindex "transport" "external"
603.cindex "external transports"
604The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
605and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
606transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
607and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
608to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
609handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
610.next
611Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
612such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
613(that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
614other means.
615.next
616Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
617are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
618are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
619compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
620a number of common scanners are provided.
621.endlist
622
623
624.section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
625Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
626into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
627values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
628file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
629distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
630
631
632.section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
633.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
634Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
635can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
636&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
637about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
638Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
639example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
640format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
6413, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
642documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
643made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
644
645Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
646line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
647which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
648interface to Exim's command line administration options.
649
650
651
652.section "Terminology" "SECID9"
653.cindex "terminology definitions"
654.cindex "body of message" "definition of"
655The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
656It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
657below) by a blank line.
658
659.cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
660When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
661delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
662&'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
663called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
664failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
665message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
666rise to further bounce messages.
667
668The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
669value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
670also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
671otherwise.
672
673The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
674destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
675down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
676until a later time.
677
678The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
679host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
680the part of an email address following the @ sign.
681
682.cindex "envelope, definition of"
683.cindex "sender" "definition of"
684A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
685body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
686be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
687sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
688envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
689messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
690
691.cindex "message" "header, definition of"
692.cindex "header section" "definition of"
693The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
694of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
695&'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
696indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
697line.
698
699.cindex "local part" "definition of"
700.cindex "domain" "definition of"
701The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
702part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
703@ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
704
705.cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
706.cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
707The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
708delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
709TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
710host it is running on are &'remote'&.
711
712.cindex "return path" "definition of"
713&'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
714message's envelope.
715
716.cindex "queue" "definition of"
717The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
718because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
719Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
720normally no ordering of waiting messages.
721
722.cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
723The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
724and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
725is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
726the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
727
728.cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
729The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
730messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
731delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
732mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
733the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
734
735
736
737
738
739
740. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
741. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
742
743.chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
744.cindex "incorporated code"
745.cindex "regular expressions" "library"
746.cindex "PCRE"
747.cindex "OpenDMARC"
748A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
749
750.ilist
751Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
752Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
753&copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
754Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
755or obtain and install the full version of the library from
756&url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
757.next
758.cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
759Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
760contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
761Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
762It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
763following statements:
764
765.blockquote
766Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
767
768This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
769the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
770Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
771version.
772This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
773the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
774&url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
775some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
776restrictions applied to it).
777.endblockquote
778.next
779.cindex "SPA authentication"
780.cindex "Samba project"
781.cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
782Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
783by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
784Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
785under the Gnu GPL.
786.next
787.cindex "Cyrus"
788.cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
789.cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
790Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
791by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
792Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
793conditions expressed therein.
794
795.blockquote
796Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
797
798Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
799modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
800are met:
801
802.olist
803Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
804notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
805.next
806Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
807notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
808the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
809distribution.
810.next
811The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
812endorse or promote products derived from this software without
813prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
814details, please contact
815.display
816 Office of Technology Transfer
817 Carnegie Mellon University
818 5000 Forbes Avenue
819 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
820 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
821 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
822.endd
823.next
824Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
825acknowledgment:
826
827&"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
828at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(https://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
829
830CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
831THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
832AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
833FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
834WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
835AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
836OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
837.endlist
838.endblockquote
839
840.next
841.cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
842.cindex "X-windows"
843.cindex "Athena"
844The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
845modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
846This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
847below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
848
849.blockquote
850Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
851and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
852
853All Rights Reserved
854
855Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
856documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
857provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
858both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
859supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
860used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
861software without specific, written prior permission.
862
863DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
864ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
865DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
866ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
867WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
868ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
869SOFTWARE.
870.endblockquote
871
872.next
873.cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
874The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
875The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
876derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
877license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
878source code.
879
880.next
881Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
882not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
883contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
884.endlist
885
886
887
888
889
890. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
891. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
892
893.chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
894 "Receiving and delivering mail"
895
896
897.section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
898.cindex "design philosophy"
899Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
900to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
901most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
902maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
903it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
904has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
905
906
907.section "Policy control" "SECID11"
908.cindex "policy control" "overview"
909Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
910Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
911&"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
912unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
913facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
914
915.ilist
916.cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
917Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
918incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
919series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
920several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
921host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
922very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
923rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
924two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
925error code.
926.next
927An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
928case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
929.next
930When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
931provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
932spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
933which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
934.next
935When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
936host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
937function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
938whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
939is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
940.next
941Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
942software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
943Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
944.next
945After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
946the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
947runs at the start of every delivery process.
948.endlist
949
950
951
952.section "User filters" "SECID12"
953.cindex "filter" "introduction"
954.cindex "Sieve filter"
955In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
956setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
957chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
958configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
959&'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
960of filtering are available:
961
962.ilist
963Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
964by RFC 3028.
965.next
966Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
967powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
968.endlist
969
970User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
971
972
973
974.section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
975.cindex "message ids" "details of format"
976.cindex "format" "of message id"
977.cindex "id of message"
978.cindex "base62"
979.cindex "base36"
980.cindex "Darwin"
981.cindex "Cygwin"
982Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
983characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
984example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
985normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
986system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
987(avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
988id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
989not always case-sensitive.
990
991.cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
992The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
993Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
994within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
995be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
996the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
997somewhat eccentric:
998
999.ilist
1000The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
1001started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1002contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1003way of representing the date and time of day).
1004.next
1005After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1006received the message.
1007.next
1008There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1009.olist
1010.oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1011If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1012time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1013that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1014systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1015.next
1016If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1017the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1018(1/100) of a second.
1019.endlist
1020.endlist
1021
1022After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1023appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1024received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1025pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1026will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1027
1028
1029.section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1030.cindex "receiving mail"
1031.cindex "message" "reception"
1032The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1033TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1034SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1035there are several possibilities:
1036
1037.ilist
1038If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1039non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1040command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1041.next
1042If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1043non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1044the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1045command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1046but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1047envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1048.next
1049If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1050interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1051passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1052This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1053example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1054.next
1055A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1056(127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1057does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1058in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1059.endlist
1060
1061
1062.cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1063.cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1064In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1065constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1066qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1067option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1068SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1069certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1070unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1071address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1072different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1073users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1074users to change sender addresses.
1075
1076Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1077checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1078(either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1079number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1080individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1081requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1082&<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1083
1084Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1085received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1086connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1087queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1088configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1089message is received.
1090
1091
1092
1093
1094
1095.section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1096.cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1097.cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1098When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1099first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1100the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1101the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1102file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1103
1104.cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1105By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1106&_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1107not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1108improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1109used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1110whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1111processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1112overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1113affect file system performance.
1114
1115The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1116the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1117any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1118a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1119first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1120
1121.cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1122Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1123(see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1124both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1125If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1126example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1127generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1128rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1129different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1130addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1131delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1132&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1133
1134
1135
1136.section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1137.cindex "message" "life of"
1138.cindex "message" "frozen"
1139A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1140its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1141administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1142cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1143recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1144spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1145
1146.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1147.cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1148An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1149corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1150addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1151to be sent.
1152
1153.oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1154.oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1155There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1156&%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1157The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1158
1159.cindex "message" "log file for"
1160.cindex "log" "file for each message"
1161While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1162attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1163delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1164lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1165These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1166deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1167The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1168&%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1169systems.
1170
1171.cindex "journal file"
1172.cindex "file" "journal"
1173All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1174spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1175address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1176message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1177addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1178is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1179Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1180minimize the possibility of data loss.
1181
1182Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1183the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1184time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1185updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1186deliveries caused by crashes.
1187
1188
1189
1190.section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1191.cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1192.cindex "router" "definition of"
1193.cindex "transport" "definition of"
1194The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1195&'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1196number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1197specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1198ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1199
1200.cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1201Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1202of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1203you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1204option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1205instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1206instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1207configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1208the driver's features in general.
1209
1210A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1211its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1212converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1213alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1214to be bounced.
1215
1216A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1217spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1218transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1219&'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1220to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1221several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1222
1223.cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1224An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1225turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1226specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1227detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1228address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1229
1230To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1231routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1232routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1233configuration.
1234
1235The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1236addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1237are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1238is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1239its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1240match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1241find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1242assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1243configured to fail the address.
1244
1245The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1246&"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1247aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1248original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1249router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1250address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1251
1252The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1253address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1254see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1255local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1256the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1257the address is bounced.
1258
1259
1260
1261.section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1262.cindex "router" "for verification"
1263.cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1264As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1265are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1266one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1267sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1268&%-bvs%& command line options.
1269
1270When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1271does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1272detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1273when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1274sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1275previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1276checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1277would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1278
1279
1280
1281
1282.section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1283.cindex "router" "running details"
1284.cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1285.cindex "router" "result of running"
1286As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1287running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1288passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1289the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1290the following:
1291
1292.ilist
1293&'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1294transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1295original address ceases,
1296.oindex "&%unseen%&"
1297unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1298can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1299for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1300passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1301end of routing.
1302
1303Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1304starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1305setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1306child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1307&%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1308.next
1309&'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1310requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1311is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1312&%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1313must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1314.next
1315&'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1316recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1317this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1318set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1319&'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1320.next
1321&'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1322the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1323original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1324.next
1325&'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1326database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1327processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1328next time the message is considered for delivery.
1329.next
1330&'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1331its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1332.endlist
1333
1334If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1335any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1336situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1337making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1338router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1339
1340Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1341met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1342You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1343when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1344facility for this purpose.
1345
1346
1347.section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1348.cindex "case of local parts"
1349.cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1350.cindex "duplicate addresses"
1351Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1352and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1353check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1354actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1355routed addresses are shown.
1356
1357
1358
1359.section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1360.cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1361.cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1362The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1363order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1364described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1365
1366.ilist
1367.cindex affix "router precondition"
1368The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1369the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1370suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1371skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1372removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1373of any other conditions.
1374.next
1375Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1376only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1377&%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1378address.
1379Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1380&%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1381sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1382you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1383Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1384.next
1385If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1386run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1387when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1388makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1389having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1390.next
1391Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1392opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1393Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1394.next
1395Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1396check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1397.next
1398If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1399of domains that it defines.
1400.next
1401.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1402.vindex "&$local_part$&"
1403.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1404.cindex affix "router precondition"
1405If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1406the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1407&%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1408part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1409that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1410that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1411&$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1412.next
1413.vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1414.vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1415.vindex "&$home$&"
1416If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1417an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1418local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1419user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1420remaining preconditions.
1421.next
1422If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1423because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1424later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1425subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1426could lead to confusion.
1427.next
1428If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1429set of addresses that it defines.
1430.next
1431If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1432specified files is tested.
1433.next
1434.cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1435If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1436uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1437Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1438.endlist
1439
1440
1441Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1442it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1443part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1444&%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1445&%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1446going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1447example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1448
1449
1450
1451.section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1452.cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1453When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1454
1455.ilist
1456If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1457filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1458message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1459fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1460files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1461filtering'&.
1462.cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1463(&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1464
1465Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1466&<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1467filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1468if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1469be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1470condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1471filter.
1472.next
1473Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1474its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1475address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1476can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1477processed entirely independently of each other.
1478.next
1479.cindex "routing" "loops in"
1480.cindex "loop" "while routing"
1481A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1482transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1483is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1484Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1485from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1486process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1487which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1488.next
1489When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1490handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1491doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1492local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1493collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1494addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1495address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1496addresses to the same domain.
1497.next
1498Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1499non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1500deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1501to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1502run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1503one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1504The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1505deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1506.next
1507.cindex "queue runner"
1508When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1509database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1510address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1511Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1512reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1513queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1514follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1515better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1516causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1517.next
1518.cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1519Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1520deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1521retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1522reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1523not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1524.next
1525If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1526appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1527for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1528messages to other addresses.
1529.next
1530.cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1531If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1532the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1533&'deferred'&.
1534.next
1535When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1536handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1537deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1538.endlist
1539
1540
1541
1542
1543.section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1544.cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1545.cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1546.cindex "queue runner"
1547Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1548attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1549uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1550intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1551not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1552first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1553its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1554passed its retry time.
1555You can run several queue runners at once.
1556
1557Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1558address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1559should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1560bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1561error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1562as permanent.
1563
1564
1565
1566.section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1567.cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1568There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1569particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1570connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1571detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1572Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1573is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1574impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1575also apply.
1576
1577If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1578waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1579connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1580deferred,
1581.cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1582Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1583SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1584for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1585connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1586one connection.
1587
1588
1589
1590.section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1591.cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1592.cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1593When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1594bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1595errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1596delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1597many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1598attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1599message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1600See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1601
1602.cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1603Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1604failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1605automatically.
1606
1607.cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1608A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1609obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1610address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1611forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1612failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1613&<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1614of the list.
1615
1616
1617
1618.section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1619.cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1620If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1621itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1622but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1623that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1624for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1625&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1626
1627
1628
1629
1630
1631. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1632. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1633
1634.chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1635.scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1636
1637.section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1638Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1639creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1640&_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1641
1642.table2 140pt
1643.irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1644.irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1645 documented"
1646.irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1647.irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1648.irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1649.irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1650 instructions"
1651.endtable
1652
1653Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1654following subdirectories are created:
1655
1656.table2 140pt
1657.irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1658.irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1659.irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1660.irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1661.irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1662.irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1663.irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1664.endtable
1665
1666The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1667with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1668that may be useful to some sites.
1669
1670
1671.section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1672.cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1673The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1674a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1675source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1676Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1677system.
1678.cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1679Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1680the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1681architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1682overridden if necessary.
1683.cindex compiler requirements
1684.cindex compiler version
1685A C99-capable compiler will be required for the build.
1686
1687
1688.section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1689.cindex "PCRE library"
1690Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1691modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1692to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1693system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1694process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1695headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1696and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1697or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1698If your operating system has no
1699PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1700from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1701More information on PCRE is available at &url(https://www.pcre.org/).
1702
1703.section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1704.cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1705.cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1706Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1707DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1708databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1709different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1710
1711.cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1712.cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1713.cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1714.cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1715If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1716Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1717may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1718you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1719
1720.cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1721Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1722via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1723versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1724some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1725distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1726versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1727Berkeley DB library.
1728
1729Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1730use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1731possibilities:
1732
1733.olist
1734A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1735Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1736.next
1737.cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1738The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1739compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1740&_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1741file name is used unmodified.
1742.next
1743.cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1744The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1745operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1746programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1747.next
1748If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1749file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1750the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1751.next
1752To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1753Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
17542.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions when Exim last revamped support were numbered 4.&'x'&.
1755Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All versions of
1756Berkeley DB could be obtained from
1757&url(http://www.sleepycat.com/), which is now a redirect to their new owner's
1758page with far newer versions listed.
1759It is probably wise to plan to move your storage configurations away from
1760Berkeley DB format, as today there are smaller and simpler alternatives more
1761suited to Exim's usage model.
1762.next
1763.cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1764Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1765&url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/tdb/files/). It has its own interface, and also
1766operates on a single file.
1767.endlist
1768
1769.cindex "USE_DB"
1770.cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1771Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1772to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1773USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1774&_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1775.code
1776USE_DB=yes
1777.endd
1778Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1779error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1780
1781At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1782thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1783configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1784Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1785configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1786&_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1787
1788As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1789necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1790in one of these lines:
1791.code
1792DBMLIB = -ldb
1793DBMLIB = -ltdb
1794.endd
1795Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1796place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1797the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1798file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1799this example:
1800.code
1801INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1802DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1803.endd
1804There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1805file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1806
1807
1808
1809.section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1810.cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1811.cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1812.cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1813.cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1814Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1815independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1816&_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1817&_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1818therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1819building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1820&_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1821
1822There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1823without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1824(CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1825(BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1826maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1827a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1828
1829There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1830at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1831machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1832directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1833you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1834detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1835be logged.
1836
1837.cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1838Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1839access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1840facilities, you need to set
1841.code
1842WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1843.endd
1844in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1845chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1846
1847
1848.cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1849.cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1850If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1851required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1852your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1853happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1854&_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1855
1856This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1857operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1858to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1859configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1860defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1861do this.
1862
1863
1864
1865.section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1866.cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1867.cindex "RFC 2047"
1868The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1869described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1870in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1871character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1872mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1873(default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1874supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1875
1876However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1877very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1878&url(https://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1879systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1880&[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1881.code
1882HAVE_ICONV=yes
1883.endd
1884to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1885
1886
1887
1888.section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1889.cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1890.cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1891.cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1892.cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1893.cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1894Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1895command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1896start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1897&%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1898line option).
1899
1900If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1901OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1902implementing SSL.
1903
1904If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1905.code
1906SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1907TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1908.endd
1909in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1910OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1911.code
1912SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1913TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1914TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1915.endd
1916.cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1917If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1918.code
1919SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1920USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1921.endd
1922.cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1923If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1924.code
1925SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1926USE_GNUTLS=yes
1927TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1928.endd
1929in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1930library and include files. For example:
1931.code
1932SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1933USE_GNUTLS=yes
1934TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1935TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1936.endd
1937.cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1938If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1939.code
1940SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1941USE_GNUTLS=yes
1942USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1943.endd
1944
1945You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1946specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1947given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1948
1949
1950
1951
1952.section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1953
1954.cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1955.cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1956.cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1957.cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1958Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1959SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1960alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1961already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1962should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1963&_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1964&_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1965EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1966you might have
1967.code
1968USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1969CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1970EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1971.endd
1972in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1973files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1974.code
1975exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1976.endd
1977in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1978the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1979All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1980can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1981&_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1982configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1983further details.
1984
1985
1986.section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1987.cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1988Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1989&`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1990it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1991where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1992library files.
1993
1994Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1995defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1996currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1997as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1998over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
1999Exim used to
2000have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
2001withdrawn.
2002
2003
2004
2005.section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
2006.cindex "lookup modules"
2007.cindex "dynamic modules"
2008.cindex ".so building"
2009On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2010the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2011on demand.
2012This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2013library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2014dependencies.
2015Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2016
2017Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2018installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2019measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2020for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2021Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2022see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2023
2024Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2025&`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2026For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2027on demand:
2028.code
2029LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
2030LOOKUP_SQLITE=2
2031LOOKUP_MYSQL=2
2032.endd
2033
2034
2035.section "The building process" "SECID29"
2036.cindex "build directory"
2037Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2038created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2039operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2040For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2041&_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2042.cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2043Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2044
2045If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2046a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2047&_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2048&'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2049then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2050number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2051makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2052directory, should this ever be necessary.
2053
2054If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2055&_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2056FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2057
2058
2059
2060.section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2061The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2062unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2063output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2064appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2065each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2066get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2067.code
2068FULLECHO='' make -e
2069.endd
2070The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2071command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2072given in addition to the short output.
2073
2074
2075
2076.section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2077.cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2078The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2079consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2080values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2081more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2082convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2083order:
2084.display
2085&_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2086&_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2087&_Local/Makefile_&
2088&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2089&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2090&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2091&_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2092.endd
2093.cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2094.cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2095.cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2096where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2097architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2098process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2099and are often not needed.
2100
2101The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2102called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2103the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2104values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2105Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2106fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2107of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2108that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2109to find out what values are being used on your system.
2110
2111
2112&_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2113therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2114needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2115file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2116default values are.
2117
2118
2119.cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2120If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2121or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2122need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2123putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2124.cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2125when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2126formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2127compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2128called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2129Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2130default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2131containing the lines
2132.code
2133CC=cc
2134CFLAGS=-std1
2135.endd
2136If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2137these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2138
2139Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2140files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2141the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2142
2143
2144.cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2145.cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2146.cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2147.cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2148Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2149lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2150not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2151and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2152which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2153case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2154.code
2155LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2156LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2157LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2158.endd
2159and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2160&_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2161libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2162.cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2163However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2164the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2165files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2166binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2167errors.
2168
2169.cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2170.cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2171Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2172about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2173being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2174makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2175variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2176name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2177&'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2178with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2179syntax. For instance:
2180.code
2181LOOKUP_SQLITE=yes
2182LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2183AUTH_GSASL=yes
2184AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2185AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2186AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2187.endd
2188
2189.cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2190Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2191subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2192.code
2193EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2194.endd
2195must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2196chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2197
2198.cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2199The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2200operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2201with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2202monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2203The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2204.code
2205X11=/usr/X11R6
2206XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2207XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2208.endd
2209These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2210example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2211.code
2212X11=/usr/openwin
2213XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2214XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2215.endd
2216If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2217definition of all three of these variables into your
2218&_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2219
2220.cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2221If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2222variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2223default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2224command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2225
2226.cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2227There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2228use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2229EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2230binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2231libraries.
2232
2233.cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2234The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2235files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2236necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2237&_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2238
2239
2240.section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2241.cindex "&_os.h_&"
2242.cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2243The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2244&_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2245normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2246recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2247are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2248
2249
2250
2251.section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2252.cindex "building Eximon"
2253A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2254where the files that are involved are
2255.display
2256&_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2257&_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2258&_Local/eximon.conf_&
2259&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2260&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2261&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2262.endd
2263.cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2264As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2265&_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2266&_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2267variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2268EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2269LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2270.ecindex IIDbuex
2271
2272
2273.section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2274.cindex "installing Exim"
2275.cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2276The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2277arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2278whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2279.cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2280The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2281going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2282&'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2283install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2284some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2285it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2286chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2287
2288.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2289Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2290in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2291exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2292by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2293is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2294alternative files, no default is installed.
2295
2296.cindex "system aliases file"
2297.cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2298One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2299default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2300The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2301SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2302If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2303and outputs a comment to the user.
2304
2305The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2306aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2307kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2308&_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2309Exim's configuration if necessary.
2310
2311The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2312and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2313running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2314directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2315other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2316over SMTP.
2317
2318It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2319distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2320command such as
2321.code
2322make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2323.endd
2324This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2325paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2326configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2327For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2328but this usage is deprecated.
2329
2330.cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2331Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2332&'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2333upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2334directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2335INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2336
2337For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2338to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2339installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2340for example &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2341called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2342of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2343from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2344
2345.cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2346If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2347real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2348command:
2349.code
2350make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2351.endd
2352The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2353script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2354the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2355directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2356command:
2357.code
2358(cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2359.endd
2360.cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2361There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2362
2363.ilist
2364&%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2365to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2366.next
2367&%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2368installed binary.
2369.endlist
2370
2371INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2372.code
2373make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2374.endd
2375The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2376to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2377without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2378.code
2379make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2380.endd
2381
2382
2383
2384.section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2385.cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2386Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2387reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2388distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2389&<<SECTavail>>&).
2390
2391If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2392source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2393install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2394
2395
2396
2397.section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2398.cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2399When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2400exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2401directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2402necessary.
2403
2404
2405
2406
2407.section "Testing" "SECID34"
2408.cindex "testing" "installation"
2409Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2410syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2411Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2412.code
2413exim -bV
2414.endd
2415If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2416Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2417the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2418other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2419Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2420example,
2421.display
2422&`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2423.endd
2424should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2425.display
2426&`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2427.endd
2428a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2429This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2430user agent. For example:
2431.code
2432exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2433From: user@your.domain.example
2434To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2435Subject: Testing Exim
2436
2437This is a test message.
2438^D
2439.endd
2440The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2441In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2442arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2443
2444.cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2445If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2446&'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2447of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2448&%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2449with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2450.display
2451&`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2452.endd
2453You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2454produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2455For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2456relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2457&<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2458
2459.cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2460.cindex "lock files"
2461One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2462local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2463&"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2464writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2465is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2466directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2467that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2468&(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2469approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2470&[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2471agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2472see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2473
2474One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2475the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2476&%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2477port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2478&'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2479incoming SMTP mail.
2480
2481Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2482be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2483within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2484that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2485production version.
2486
2487
2488.section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2489.cindex "replacing another MTA"
2490Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2491general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2492is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2493operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2494binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2495normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2496or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2497.cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2498a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2499privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2500and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2501
2502.cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2503.cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2504Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2505example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2506&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2507described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2508as follows:
2509.code
2510sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2511send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2512mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2513newaliases /usr/bin/true
2514.endd
2515Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2516your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2517favourite user agent.
2518
2519You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2520have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2521various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2522command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2523use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2524&'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2525
2526
2527
2528.section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2529.cindex "upgrading Exim"
2530If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2531version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2532call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2533to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2534new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2535version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2536configuration file.
2537
2538
2539
2540
2541.section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2542.cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2543The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2544.code
2545/etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2546.endd
2547If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2548fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2549for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2550(that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2551solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2552.code
2553pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2554.endd
2555to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2556
2557Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2558still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2559(the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2560
2561
2562
2563
2564. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2565. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2566
2567.chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2568.scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2569.scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2570Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2571each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2572options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2573some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2574combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2575The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2576
2577
2578.section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2579.cindex "&'mailq'&"
2580If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2581were present before any other options.
2582The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2583standard output.
2584This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2585that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2586&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2587
2588.cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2589If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2590were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2591&%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2592format.
2593
2594.cindex "&'rmail'&"
2595If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2596&%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2597Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2598
2599.cindex "&'runq'&"
2600.cindex "queue runner"
2601If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2602were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2603option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2604
2605.cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2606.cindex "alias file" "building"
2607.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2608If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2609&%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2610This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2611the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2612command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2613
2614
2615.section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2616Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2617available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2618user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2619EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2620&%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2621
2622.ilist
2623.cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2624.cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2625The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2626&%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2627supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2628configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2629
2630.cindex '&"From"& line'
2631.cindex "envelope sender"
2632Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2633&"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2634Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2635See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2636users to set envelope senders.
2637
2638.cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2639.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2640.cindex "header lines" "From:"
2641.cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
2642For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2643header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2644&'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2645
2646Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2647protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2648locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2649have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2650users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2651that are available to trusted users.
2652.next
2653.cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2654.cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2655The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2656Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2657The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2658
2659Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2660operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2661necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2662the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2663
2664By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2665Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2666However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2667option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2668
2669Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2670is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2671false.
2672.endlist
2673
2674
2675&*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2676edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2677getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2678&<<CHAPconf>>&.
2679
2680
2681
2682
2683.section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2684Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2685of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2686a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2687format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2688on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2689with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2690outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2691
2692. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2693. Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2694. options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2695. creates a man page for the options.
2696. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2697
2698.literal xml
2699<!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2700.literal off
2701
2702
2703.vlist
2704.vitem &%--%&
2705.oindex "--"
2706.cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2707This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2708therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2709rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2710
2711.vitem &%--help%&
2712.oindex "&%--help%&"
2713This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2714The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2715no arguments.
2716
2717.vitem &%--version%&
2718.oindex "&%--version%&"
2719This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2720displayed.
2721
2722.vitem &%-Ac%& &&&
2723 &%-Am%&
2724.oindex "&%-Ac%&"
2725.oindex "&%-Am%&"
2726These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2727ignored by Exim.
2728
2729.vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2730.oindex "&%-B%&"
2731.cindex "8-bit characters"
2732.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2733This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2734clean; it ignores this option.
2735
2736.vitem &%-bd%&
2737.oindex "&%-bd%&"
2738.cindex "daemon"
2739.cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2740.cindex "queue runner"
2741This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2742the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2743that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2744
2745The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2746(debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2747disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2748stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2749
2750By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2751all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2752ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2753&<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2754
2755When a listening daemon
2756.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2757.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2758is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2759configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2760in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2761PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2762running as root.
2763
2764When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2765process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2766used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2767
2768The SIGHUP signal
2769.cindex "SIGHUP"
2770.cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2771can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2772whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2773means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2774of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2775referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2776because these are reread each time they are used.
2777
2778.vitem &%-bdf%&
2779.oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2780This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2781from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2782
2783.vitem &%-be%&
2784.oindex "&%-be%&"
2785.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2786.cindex "expansion" "testing"
2787Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2788prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2789files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2790of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2791
2792If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2793to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2794used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2795function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2796test data. A line history is supported.
2797
2798Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2799continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2800continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2801string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2802configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2803message-specific values (such as &$message_exim_id$&) are set, because no message
2804is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2805
2806&*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2807files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2808the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2809of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2810
2811Macro processing is done on lines before string-expansion: new macros can be
2812defined and macros will be expanded.
2813Because macros in the config file are often used for secrets, those are only
2814available to admin users.
2815
2816.vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2817.oindex "&%-bem%&"
2818.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2819.cindex "expansion" "testing"
2820This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2821of a file. For example:
2822.code
2823exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2824.endd
2825The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2826message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2827variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2828no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2829recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2830&$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2831line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2832&%-be%&).
2833
2834.vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2835.oindex "&%-bF%&"
2836.cindex "system filter" "testing"
2837.cindex "testing" "system filter"
2838This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2839tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2840system filters are recognized.
2841
2842.vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2843.oindex "&%-bf%&"
2844.cindex "filter" "testing"
2845.cindex "testing" "filter file"
2846.cindex "forward file" "testing"
2847.cindex "testing" "forward file"
2848.cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2849This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2850to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2851there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2852supplied.
2853
2854If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2855can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2856filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2857.code
2858exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2859.endd
2860This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2861variables that are used by the user filter.
2862
2863If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2864.code
2865# Exim filter
2866# Sieve filter
2867.endd
2868it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2869that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2870&<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2871redirection lists.
2872
2873The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2874detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2875with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2876separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2877
2878When testing a filter file,
2879.cindex "&""From""& line"
2880.cindex "envelope sender"
2881.oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2882the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2883or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2884that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2885can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2886options).
2887
2888.vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2889.oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2890.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2891This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2892tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2893&$qualify_domain$&.
2894
2895.vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2896.oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2897This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2898tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2899process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2900suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2901actually being delivered.
2902
2903.vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2904.oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2905.cindex affix "filter testing"
2906This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2907file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2908prefix.
2909
2910.vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2911.oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2912.cindex affix "filter testing"
2913This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2914file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2915suffix.
2916
2917.vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2918.oindex "&%-bh%&"
2919.cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2920.cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2921.cindex "testing" "relay control"
2922.cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2923.cindex "policy control" "testing"
2924.cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2925This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2926standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2927after a full stop. For example:
2928.code
2929exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2930exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2931.endd
2932When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2933of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2934conversion to the canonical form is
2935&`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2936
2937Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2938include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2939This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2940messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2941test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2942
2943&*Warning 1*&:
2944.cindex "RFC 1413"
2945You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2946information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2947an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2948connection.
2949
2950&*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2951are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2952occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2953
2954Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2955written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2956lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2957can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2958and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2959session were authenticated.
2960
2961The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2962output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2963acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2964
2965Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2966plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2967specialized SMTP test program such as
2968&url(https://www.jetmore.org/john/code/swaks/,swaks).
2969
2970.vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2971.oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2972This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2973verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2974updating the callout cache database.
2975
2976.vitem &%-bi%&
2977.oindex "&%-bi%&"
2978.cindex "alias file" "building"
2979.cindex "building alias file"
2980.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2981Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2982Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2983this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2984tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2985recognized.
2986
2987If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2988configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2989the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2990The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2991use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2992if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2993&%-bi%& is a no-op.
2994
2995. // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2996.vitem &%-bI:help%&
2997.oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2998.cindex "querying exim information"
2999We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
3000information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
3001consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
3002synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
3003options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
3004
3005.vitem &%-bI:dscp%&
3006.oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
3007.cindex "DSCP" "values"
3008This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
3009recognised DSCP names.
3010
3011.vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
3012.oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
3013.cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
3014This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
3015Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
3016useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
3017&`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3018compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3019way to guarantee a correct response.
3020
3021.vitem &%-bm%&
3022.oindex "&%-bm%&"
3023.cindex "local message reception"
3024This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3025locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3026command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3027argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3028default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3029if no other conflicting option is present.
3030
3031If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3032qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3033options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3034suppressing this for special cases.
3035
3036Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3037the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3038
3039.cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3040The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3041action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3042
3043The format
3044.cindex "message" "format"
3045.cindex "format" "message"
3046.cindex "&""From""& line"
3047.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3048.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3049of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3050compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3051.code
3052From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3053From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3054.endd
3055(with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3056is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3057authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3058matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3059option, which can be changed if necessary.
3060
3061.oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3062The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3063&%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3064preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3065trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3066
3067.vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3068.oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3069.cindex "testing", "malware"
3070.cindex "malware scan test"
3071This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file or directory
3072(depending on the used scanner interface),
3073using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3074this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3075the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3076not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3077will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3078
3079Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3080using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3081user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3082This option requires admin privileges.
3083
3084The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3085there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3086administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3087
3088.vitem &%-bnq%&
3089.oindex "&%-bnq%&"
3090.cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3091By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3092without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3093is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3094envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3095&%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3096defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3097
3098Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3099being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3100content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3101header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3102syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3103
3104The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3105messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3106addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3107unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3108
3109
3110.vitem &%-bP%&
3111.oindex "&%-bP%&"
3112.cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3113.cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3114If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3115main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3116of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3117arguments, for example:
3118.code
3119exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3120.endd
3121.cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3122.cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3123.cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3124However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3125configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3126users, the output is as in this example:
3127.code
3128mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3129.endd
3130If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3131output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3132
3133If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
3134configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3135backward compatibility.)
3136If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3137is the name of the file that was actually used.
3138
3139.cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3140If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3141name will not be output.
3142
3143.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3144.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3145If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3146directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3147respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3148sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3149written directly into the spool directory.
3150
3151If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3152.code
3153exim -bP +local_domains
3154.endd
3155it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3156local part) and outputs what it finds.
3157
3158.cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3159.cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3160.cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3161If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3162followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3163that driver are output. For example:
3164.code
3165exim -bP transport local_delivery
3166.endd
3167The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3168options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3169using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3170&%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3171settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3172&%authenticators%&.
3173
3174.cindex "environment"
3175If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3176variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag suppresses the value of the
3177variables.
3178
3179.cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3180If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3181are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3182for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3183The output format is one item per line.
3184For the "-bP macro <name>" form, if no such macro is found
3185the exit status will be nonzero.
3186
3187.vitem &%-bp%&
3188.oindex "&%-bp%&"
3189.cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
3190.cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
3191This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3192standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3193just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3194admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3195to allow any user to see the queue.
3196
3197Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3198.code
319925m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3200 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3201 <other addresses>
3202.endd
3203.cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3204.cindex "size" "of message"
3205The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3206(in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3207identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3208envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3209&"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3210the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3211before the sender address.
3212
3213.cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3214If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3215&"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3216
3217The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3218displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3219been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3220expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3221displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3222complete.
3223
3224
3225.vitem &%-bpa%&
3226.oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3227This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3228that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3229alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3230of just &"D"&.
3231
3232
3233.vitem &%-bpc%&
3234.oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3235.cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3236This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3237to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3238&%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3239
3240
3241.vitem &%-bpr%&
3242.oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3243This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3244chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3245lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3246going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3247
3248.vitem &%-bpra%&
3249.oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3250This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3251
3252.vitem &%-bpru%&
3253.oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3254This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3255
3256
3257.vitem &%-bpu%&
3258.oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3259This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3260addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3261forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3262router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3263
3264
3265.vitem &%-brt%&
3266.oindex "&%-brt%&"
3267.cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3268.cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3269This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3270arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3271and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3272.code
3273exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3274Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3275.endd
3276See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3277argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3278&'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3279contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3280retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3281with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3282rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3283sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3284used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3285.code
3286exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3287Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3288.endd
3289
3290.vitem &%-brw%&
3291.oindex "&%-brw%&"
3292.cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3293.cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3294This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3295a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3296complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3297would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3298&<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3299
3300.vitem &%-bS%&
3301.oindex "&%-bS%&"
3302.cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3303.cindex "batched SMTP input"
3304This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3305for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3306submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3307input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3308input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3309&%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3310believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3311
3312The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3313dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3314provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3315
3316As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3317messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3318Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3319&%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3320
3321Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3322as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3323QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3324
3325.cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3326If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3327error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3328was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3329was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3330
3331More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3332&<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3333
3334.vitem &%-bs%&
3335.oindex "&%-bs%&"
3336.cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3337.cindex "local SMTP input"
3338This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3339on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3340policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3341Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3342messages to the MTA.
3343
3344In
3345.cindex "sender" "source of"
3346this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3347set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3348Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3349the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3350&%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3351&%-bnq%& option is used.
3352
3353.cindex "inetd"
3354The
3355&%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3356using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3357whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3358&'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3359above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3360Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3361the listening daemon.
3362
3363.vitem &%-bt%&
3364.oindex "&%-bt%&"
3365.cindex "testing" "addresses"
3366.cindex "address" "testing"
3367This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3368as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3369written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3370user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3371sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3372
3373If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3374right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3375
3376Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3377&[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3378security issues.
3379
3380Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3381(compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3382written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3383&%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3384genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3385program.
3386
3387.cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3388The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3389failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3390code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3391
3392.cindex "duplicate addresses"
3393&*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3394addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3395This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3396always shown.
3397
3398&*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3399routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3400message,
3401.oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3402you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3403&%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3404default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3405whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3406those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3407doing such tests.
3408
3409.vitem &%-bV%&
3410.oindex "&%-bV%&"
3411.cindex "version number of Exim"
3412This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3413number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3414It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3415specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3416name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3417
3418As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3419configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3420values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3421detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3422alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3423realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3424dynamic testing facilities.
3425
3426.vitem &%-bv%&
3427.oindex "&%-bv%&"
3428.cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3429.cindex "address" "verification"
3430This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3431taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3432not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3433happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3434(see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3435including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3436
3437If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3438failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3439usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3440
3441If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3442right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3443
3444Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3445&[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3446security issues.
3447
3448Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3449that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3450router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3451verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3452address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3453
3454If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3455address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3456latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3457causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3458addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3459and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3460to succeed.
3461
3462When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3463and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3464considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3465
3466The
3467.cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3468return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3469failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3470code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3471
3472If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3473address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3474sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3475calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3476
3477.vitem &%-bvs%&
3478.oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3479This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3480than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3481might happen.
3482
3483.vitem &%-bw%&
3484.oindex "&%-bw%&"
3485.cindex "daemon"
3486.cindex "inetd"
3487.cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3488This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3489similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3490and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3491
3492In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3493listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3494inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3495each port only when the first connection is received.
3496
3497If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3498which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3499
3500.vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3501.oindex "&%-C%&"
3502.cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3503.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3504.cindex "alternate configuration file"
3505This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3506list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3507compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3508name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3509file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3510proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3511
3512When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3513from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3514runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3515However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3516file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3517which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3518listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3519CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3520not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3521
3522Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3523configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3524even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3525running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3526delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3527test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3528on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3529
3530If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3531prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3532must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3533However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3534CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3535usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3536unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3537
3538ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3539to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3540broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3541configuration file.
3542
3543The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3544syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3545caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3546require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3547specified by this option.
3548
3549
3550.vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3551.oindex "&%-D%&"
3552.cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3553This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3554(see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3555unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3556If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3557completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3558
3559If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3560colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3561supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3562not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3563the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3564to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3565regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3566
3567The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3568command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3569string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3570synonymous:
3571.code
3572exim -DABC ...
3573exim -DABC= ...
3574.endd
3575To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3576quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3577example:
3578.code
3579exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3580.endd
3581&%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3582Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3583
3584
3585.vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3586.oindex "&%-d%&"
3587.cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3588.cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3589This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3590error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3591database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3592filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3593writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3594return code.
3595
3596When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3597standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3598some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3599made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3600of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3601debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3602no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3603are:
3604.display
3605&`acl `& ACL interpretation
3606&`auth `& authenticators
3607&`deliver `& general delivery logic
3608&`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3609&`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3610&`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3611&`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3612&`filter `& filter handling
3613&`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3614&`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3615&`ident `& ident lookup
3616&`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3617&`lists `& matching things in lists
3618&`load `& system load checks
3619&`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3620 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3621&`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3622&`memory `& memory handling
3623&`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3624&`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3625&`queue_run `& queue runs
3626&`receive `& general message reception logic
3627&`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3628&`retry `& retry handling
3629&`rewrite `& address rewriting
3630&`route `& address routing
3631&`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3632&`tls `& TLS logic
3633&`transport `& transports
3634&`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3635&`verify `& address verification logic
3636&`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3637.endd
3638The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3639for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3640tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3641is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3642generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3643turn everything off.
3644
3645.cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3646.cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3647The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3648with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3649unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3650rather than stderr.
3651
3652The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3653&`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3654However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3655daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3656automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3657run in parallel.
3658
3659The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3660of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3661in processing.
3662
3663If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3664any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3665
3666.vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3667.oindex "&%-dd%&"
3668This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3669starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3670subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3671behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3672
3673.vitem &%-dropcr%&
3674.oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3675This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3676handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3677described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3678
3679.vitem &%-E%&
3680.oindex "&%-E%&"
3681.cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3682This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3683failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3684and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3685generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3686could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3687follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3688new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3689
3690.vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3691.oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3692There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3693called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3694example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3695form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3696
3697.vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3698.oindex "&%-F%&"
3699.cindex "sender" "name"
3700.cindex "name" "of sender"
3701This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3702message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3703entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3704their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3705between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3706
3707.vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3708.oindex "&%-f%&"
3709.cindex "sender" "address"
3710.cindex "address" "sender"
3711.cindex "trusted users"
3712.cindex "envelope sender"
3713.cindex "user" "trusted"
3714This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3715message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3716by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3717users to use it.
3718
3719Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3720trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3721options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3722of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3723domain.
3724
3725There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3726can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3727never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3728string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3729examples of shell commands:
3730.code
3731exim -f '<>' user@domain
3732exim -f "" user@domain
3733.endd
3734In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3735with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3736&%-bv%& options.
3737
3738Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3739it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3740refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3741though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3742
3743White
3744.cindex "&""From""& line"
3745space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3746given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3747locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3748&"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3749if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3750
3751.vitem &%-G%&
3752.oindex "&%-G%&"
3753.cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3754This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3755.code
3756control = suppress_local_fixups
3757.endd
3758for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3759bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3760in future.
3761
3762As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3763this option.
3764
3765.vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3766.oindex "&%-h%&"
3767.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3768This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3769Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3770headers.)
3771
3772.vitem &%-i%&
3773.oindex "&%-i%&"
3774.cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3775.cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3776This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3777line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3778no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3779command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3780
3781.vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3782.oindex "&%-L%&"
3783.cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3784This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3785file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3786Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3787read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3788effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3789
3790The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3791
3792.vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3793.oindex "&%-M%&"
3794.cindex "forcing delivery"
3795.cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3796.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3797This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3798any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3799delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3800and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3801
3802Retry
3803.cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3804hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3805the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3806to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3807which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3808for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3809
3810The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3811not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3812produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3813use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3814
3815.vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3816.oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3817.cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3818.cindex "recipient" "adding"
3819This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3820message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3821id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3822active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3823can be used only by an admin user.
3824
3825.vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3826 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3827.oindex "&%-MC%&"
3828.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3829.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3830.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3831This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3832by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3833an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3834given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3835must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3836
3837.vitem &%-MCA%&
3838.oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3839This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3840by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3841connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3842
3843.vitem &%-MCD%&
3844.oindex "&%-MCD%&"
3845This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3846by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3847remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3848
3849.vitem &%-MCG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&>
3850.oindex "&%-MCG%&"
3851This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3852by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3853alternate queue is used, named by the following argument.
3854
3855.vitem &%-MCK%&
3856.oindex "&%-MCK%&"
3857This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3858by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that a
3859remote host supports the ESMTP &_CHUNKING_& extension.
3860
3861.vitem &%-MCP%&
3862.oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3863This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3864by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3865which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3866
3867.vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3868.oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3869This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3870by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3871started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3872together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3873signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3874messages through the same SMTP connection.
3875
3876.vitem &%-MCS%&
3877.oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3878This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3879by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3880SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3881connection.
3882
3883.vitem &%-MCT%&
3884.oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3885This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3886by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3887host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3888
3889.vitem &%-MCt%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>&~<&'port'&>&~<&'cipher'&>
3890.oindex "&%-MCt%&"
3891This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3892by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3893connection is being proxied by a parent process for handling TLS encryption.
3894The arguments give the local address and port being proxied, and the TLS cipher.
3895
3896.vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3897.oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3898.cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3899.cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3900This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3901but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3902that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3903provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3904order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3905However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3906respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3907overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3908If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3909&%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3910and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3911
3912.vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3913.oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3914.cindex "message" "changing sender"
3915.cindex "sender" "changing"
3916This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3917given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3918&"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3919be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3920is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3921This option can be used only by an admin user.
3922
3923.vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3924.oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3925.cindex "freezing messages"
3926.cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3927This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3928prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3929either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3930However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3931attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3932user.
3933
3934.vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3935.oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3936.cindex "giving up on messages"
3937.cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3938.cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3939This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3940including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3941their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3942is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3943Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3944user.
3945
3946.vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3947.oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3948.cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3949This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3950as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3951message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3952altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3953
3954.vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3955.oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3956.cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3957.cindex "recipient" "removing"
3958.cindex "removing recipients"
3959This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3960(&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3961the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3962addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3963(in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3964can be used only by an admin user.
3965
3966.vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3967.oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
3968.cindex "removing messages"
3969.cindex "abandoning mail"
3970.cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3971This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3972bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3973the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3974only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3975placed on the queue.
3976
3977. .new
3978. .vitem &%-MS%&
3979. .oindex "&%-MS%&"
3980. .cindex REQUIRETLS
3981. This option is used to request REQUIRETLS processing on the message.
3982. It is used internally by Exim in conjunction with -E when generating
3983. a bounce message.
3984. .wen
3985
3986.vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3987.oindex "&%-Mset%&"
3988.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3989.cindex "expansion" "testing"
3990This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3991string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3992the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3993&$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3994available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3995make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3996user. See also &%-bem%&.
3997
3998.vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3999.oindex "&%-Mt%&"
4000.cindex "thawing messages"
4001.cindex "unfreezing messages"
4002.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
4003.cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
4004This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
4005&"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
4006messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
4007by an admin user.
4008
4009.vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4010.oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
4011.cindex "listing" "message body"
4012.cindex "message" "listing body of"
4013This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
4014written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4015
4016.vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4017.oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
4018.cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
4019.cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
4020This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
4021be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
4022only by an admin user.
4023
4024.vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4025.oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
4026.cindex "listing" "message headers"
4027.cindex "header lines" "listing"
4028.cindex "message" "listing header lines"
4029This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
4030written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4031
4032.vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4033.oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
4034.cindex "listing" "message log"
4035.cindex "message" "listing message log"
4036This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
4037the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4038
4039.vitem &%-m%&
4040.oindex "&%-m%&"
4041This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
4042treats it that way too.
4043
4044.vitem &%-N%&
4045.oindex "&%-N%&"
4046.cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
4047.cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4048This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4049level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4050it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4051had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4052database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4053than &"=>"&.
4054
4055Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4056user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4057words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4058which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4059address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4060routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4061the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4062for that message.
4063
4064.vitem &%-n%&
4065.oindex "&%-n%&"
4066This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4067For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4068When combined with &%-bP%& it makes the output more terse (suppresses
4069option names, environment values and config pretty printing).
4070
4071.vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4072.oindex "&%-O%&"
4073This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4074Exim.
4075
4076.vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4077.oindex "&%-oA%&"
4078.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4079This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4080alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4081description above.
4082
4083.vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4084.oindex "&%-oB%&"
4085.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4086.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4087.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4088This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4089be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4090transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4091
4092.vitem &%-odb%&
4093.oindex "&%-odb%&"
4094.cindex "background delivery"
4095.cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4096This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4097including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4098messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4099delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4100processes to finish.
4101
4102When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4103leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4104and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4105This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4106
4107If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4108(&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4109overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4110setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4111
4112.vitem &%-odf%&
4113.oindex "&%-odf%&"
4114.cindex "foreground delivery"
4115.cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4116This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4117accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4118&%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4119and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4120
4121The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4122process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4123during deliveries.
4124
4125However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4126false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4127
4128If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4129message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4130process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4131restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4132
4133
4134.vitem &%-odi%&
4135.oindex "&%-odi%&"
4136This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4137Sendmail.
4138
4139.vitem &%-odq%&
4140.oindex "&%-odq%&"
4141.cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4142.cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4143.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4144This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4145including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4146not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4147are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4148process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4149&%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4150conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4151forces queueing.
4152
4153.vitem &%-odqs%&
4154.oindex "&%-odqs%&"
4155.cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4156This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4157However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4158&%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4159configuration file is in effect.
4160
4161When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4162message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4163also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4164in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4165done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
4166runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4167messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4168host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4169configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4170&%-qq%& option.
4171
4172.vitem &%-oee%&
4173.oindex "&%-oee%&"
4174.cindex "error" "reporting"
4175If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4176example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4177message.
4178
4179.cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4180Provided
4181this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4182exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4183is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4184This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4185
4186.vitem &%-oem%&
4187.oindex "&%-oem%&"
4188.cindex "error" "reporting"
4189.cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4190This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4191return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4192This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4193
4194.vitem &%-oep%&
4195.oindex "&%-oep%&"
4196.cindex "error" "reporting"
4197If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4198error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4199.cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4200The return code is 1 for all errors.
4201
4202.vitem &%-oeq%&
4203.oindex "&%-oeq%&"
4204.cindex "error" "reporting"
4205This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4206effect as &%-oep%&.
4207
4208.vitem &%-oew%&
4209.oindex "&%-oew%&"
4210.cindex "error" "reporting"
4211This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4212effect as &%-oem%&.
4213
4214.vitem &%-oi%&
4215.oindex "&%-oi%&"
4216.cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4217This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4218line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4219single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4220lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4221&'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4222
4223.vitem &%-oitrue%&
4224.oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4225This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4226
4227.vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4228.oindex "&%-oMa%&"
4229.cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4230A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4231with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4232over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4233&%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4234other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4235
4236The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4237number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4238.code
4239exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4240.endd
4241An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4242followed by a colon and the port number:
4243.code
4244exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4245.endd
4246The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4247port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4248are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4249whichever one is last.
4250
4251.vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4252.oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4253.cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4254See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4255option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4256name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4257This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4258authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4259
4260.vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4261.oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4262.cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4263See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4264option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4265This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4266where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4267&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4268
4269.vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4270.oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4271.cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4272See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4273option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4274overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4275messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4276default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4277specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4278&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4279
4280.vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4281.oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4282.cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4283See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4284option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4285using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4286&$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4287
4288.vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4289.oindex "&%-oMm%&"
4290.cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4291See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4292option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4293delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4294messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4295abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4296running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4297
4298The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4299The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4300is sending the bounce.
4301
4302.vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4303.oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4304.cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4305.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4306See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4307option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4308&$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4309or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4310SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4311&<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4312one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4313be set by &%-oMr%&. Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4314
4315.vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4316.oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4317.cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4318See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4319option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4320present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4321uses the name it is given.
4322
4323.vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4324.oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4325.cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4326See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4327option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4328local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4329used, when there is no default.
4330
4331.vitem &%-om%&
4332.oindex "&%-om%&"
4333.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4334In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4335message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4336expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4337
4338.vitem &%-oo%&
4339.oindex "&%-oo%&"
4340.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4341This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4342whatever that means.
4343
4344.vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4345.oindex "&%-oP%&"
4346.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4347.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4348This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4349value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4350written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4351without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4352because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4353
4354.vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4355.oindex "&%-or%&"
4356.cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4357This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4358set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4359by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4360described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4361
4362.vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4363.oindex "&%-os%&"
4364.cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4365.cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4366This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4367applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4368the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4369for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4370
4371.vitem &%-ov%&
4372.oindex "&%-ov%&"
4373This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4374
4375.vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4376.oindex "&%-oX%&"
4377.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4378.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4379.cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4380This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4381is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4382of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4383in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4384file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4385
4386.vitem &%-pd%&
4387.oindex "&%-pd%&"
4388.cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4389This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4390chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4391option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4392needed.
4393
4394.vitem &%-ps%&
4395.oindex "&%-ps%&"
4396.cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4397This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4398chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4399option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4400started.
4401
4402.vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4403.oindex "&%-p%&"
4404For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4405.display
4406&`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4407.endd
4408It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4409host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4410Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4411to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4412or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4413Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4414
4415.vitem &%-q%&
4416.oindex "&%-q%&"
4417.cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4418This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4419configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4420relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4421and &%-S%& options).
4422
4423.cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4424If other commandline options do not specify an action,
4425the &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4426waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4427for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4428process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4429have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4430
4431If
4432.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4433.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4434.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4435the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4436passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4437proceeding.
4438
4439When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4440process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4441mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4442this to be repeated periodically.
4443
4444Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4445random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4446If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4447MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4448
4449It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4450order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4451&%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4452
4453.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4454The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4455behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4456appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4457
4458.vitem &%-qq...%&
4459.oindex "&%-qq%&"
4460.cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4461.cindex "queue" "routing"
4462.cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4463An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4464stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4465every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4466transports are run.
4467
4468.cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4469The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4470is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4471complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4472place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4473delivered down a single SMTP
4474.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4475.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4476.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4477connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4478This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4479intermittently.
4480
4481.vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4482.oindex "&%-qi%&"
4483.cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4484If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4485those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4486delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4487&%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4488
4489.vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4490.oindex "&%-qf%&"
4491.cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4492.cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4493If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4494message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4495their retry times are tried.
4496
4497.vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4498.oindex "&%-qff%&"
4499.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4500If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4501frozen or not.
4502
4503.vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4504.oindex "&%-ql%&"
4505.cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4506The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4507be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4508for later delivery.
4509
4510.vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]][l][G<name>[/<time>]]]%&
4511.oindex "&%-qG%&"
4512.cindex queue named
4513.cindex "named queues"
4514.cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4515If the &'G'& flag and a name is present, the queue runner operates on the
4516queue with the given name rather than the default queue.
4517The name should not contain a &'/'& character.
4518For a periodic queue run (see below)
4519append to the name a slash and a time value.
4520
4521If other commandline options specify an action, a &'-qG<name>'& option
4522will specify a queue to operate on.
4523For example:
4524.code
4525exim -bp -qGquarantine
4526mailq -qGquarantine
4527exim -qGoffpeak -Rf @special.domain.example
4528.endd
4529
4530.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4531When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4532lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4533starting message id. For example:
4534.code
4535exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4536.endd
4537Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4538second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4539are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4540.code
4541exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4542.endd
4543just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4544&%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4545that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4546mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4547are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4548queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4549
4550.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4551.cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4552.cindex "periodic queue running"
4553When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4554starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4555(whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4556&%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4557single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4558combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4559.code
4560/usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4561.endd
4562Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4563process every 30 minutes.
4564
4565When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4566pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4567
4568.vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4569.oindex "&%-qR%&"
4570This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4571compatibility.
4572
4573.vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4574.oindex "&%-qS%&"
4575This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4576
4577.vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4578.oindex "&%-R%&"
4579.cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4580.cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4581.cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4582The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4583is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4584which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4585<&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4586
4587This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4588perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4589queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4590address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4591way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4592regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4593
4594If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4595you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4596.code
4597exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4598.endd
4599This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4600every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4601applied to each queue run.
4602
4603Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4604are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4605information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4606means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4607existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4608address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4609will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4610information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4611address will be skipped.
4612
4613.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4614If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4615all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4616&'ff'& is present.
4617
4618The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4619to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4620command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4621effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4622an arbitrary command instead.
4623
4624.vitem &%-r%&
4625.oindex "&%-r%&"
4626This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4627
4628.vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4629.oindex "&%-S%&"
4630.cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4631.cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4632This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4633message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4634conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4635has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4636
4637.vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4638.oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4639This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4640recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4641&"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4642
4643.vitem &%-t%&
4644.oindex "&%-t%&"
4645.cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4646.cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4647.cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4648.cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4649When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4650input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4651from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4652from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4653takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4654
4655.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4656If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4657is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4658the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4659and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4660Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4661Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4662argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4663Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4664instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4665&%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4666
4667.cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4668If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4669recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4670lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4671with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4672&%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4673
4674RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4675message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4676added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4677not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4678nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4679In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4680are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4681once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4682&%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4683
4684.vitem &%-ti%&
4685.oindex "&%-ti%&"
4686This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4687compatibility with Sendmail.
4688
4689.vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4690.oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4691.cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4692.cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4693This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4694incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4695&%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4696&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4697
4698
4699.vitem &%-U%&
4700.oindex "&%-U%&"
4701.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4702Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4703documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4704syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4705set. Exim ignores this option.
4706
4707.vitem &%-v%&
4708.oindex "&%-v%&"
4709This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4710describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4711receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4712dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4713the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4714selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4715unconditional.
4716
4717.vitem &%-x%&
4718.oindex "&%-x%&"
4719AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4720National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4721It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4722this option.
4723
4724.vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4725.oindex "&%-X%&"
4726This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4727to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4728
4729.vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4730.oindex "&%-z%&"
4731This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4732Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4733Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4734under most shells.
4735.endlist
4736
4737.ecindex IIDclo1
4738.ecindex IIDclo2
4739
4740
4741. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4742. Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4743. line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4744. creates a man page for the options.
4745. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4746
4747.literal xml
4748<!-- === End of command line options === -->
4749.literal off
4750
4751
4752
4753
4754
4755. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4756. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4757
4758
4759.chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4760 "The runtime configuration file"
4761
4762.cindex "run time configuration"
4763.cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4764.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4765.cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4766.cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4767.cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4768Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4769binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4770because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4771control.
4772
4773If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4774writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4775The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4776errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4777not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4778actually alter the string.
4779
4780The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4781reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4782most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4783give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4784existing file in the list.
4785
4786.cindex "EXIM_USER"
4787.cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4788.cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4789.cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4790.cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4791.cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4792The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4793specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4794configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4795group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4796CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4797
4798&*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4799to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4800easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4801CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4802who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4803
4804Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
4805be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4806since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4807compromise the Exim user account.
4808
4809A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4810is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4811defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4812configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4813CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4814&<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4815configuration.
4816
4817
4818
4819.section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4820.cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4821A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4822option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4823&%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4824unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4825CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4826is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4827is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4828installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4829specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4830
4831Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4832with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4833listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4834testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4835delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4836Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4837the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4838can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4839message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4840&%-M%&).
4841
4842If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4843prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4844start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4845There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4846name can be used with &%-C%&.
4847
4848One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4849option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4850configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4851non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4852If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4853completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4854
4855The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4856to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4857necessarily be discarded.
4858WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4859considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4860values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4861is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4862transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4863values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4864
4865Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4866share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4867If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4868looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4869and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4870file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4871each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4872
4873In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4874different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4875help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4876
4877
4878
4879.section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4880.cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4881.cindex "format" "configuration file"
4882Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4883option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4884are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4885is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4886space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4887
4888.ilist
4889&'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4890&<<CHAPACL>>&).
4891.next
4892.cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4893&'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4894are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4895.next
4896&'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4897addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4898&<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4899.next
4900&'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4901define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4902&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4903.next
4904&'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4905If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4906defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4907are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4908&<<CHAPretry>>&.
4909.next
4910&'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4911when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4912chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4913.next
4914&'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4915want to use this feature, you must set
4916.code
4917LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4918.endd
4919in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4920facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4921.endlist
4922
4923.cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4924.cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4925.cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4926Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4927
4928Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4929leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4930# character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4931and does not introduce a comment.
4932
4933Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4934the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4935backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4936lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4937appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4938
4939A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4940default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4941change settings as required.
4942
4943The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4944described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4945respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4946items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4947onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4948described.
4949
4950
4951
4952.section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4953.cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4954.cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4955.cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4956.cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4957You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4958using this syntax:
4959.display
4960&`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4961&`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4962.endd
4963on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4964the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4965second form does nothing for non-existent files.
4966The first form allows a relative name. It is resolved relative to
4967the directory of the including file. For the second form an absolute file
4968name is required.
4969
4970Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4971configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4972If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4973because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4974
4975The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4976comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4977for example:
4978.code
4979hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4980 .include /some/file
4981.endd
4982Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4983process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4984inclusion appears.
4985
4986
4987
4988.section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4989.cindex "macro" "description of"
4990.cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4991If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4992&"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4993definition, and must be of the form
4994.display
4995<&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4996.endd
4997The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4998in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4999continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
5000space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
5001a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
5002
5003Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
5004definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
5005ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
5006
5007.section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
5008Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
5009files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
5010scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
5011replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
5012for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
5013the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
5014define
5015.display
5016&`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
5017&`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
5018.endd
5019but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
5020error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
5021before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
5022consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
5023line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
5024comment line or a &`.include`& line.
5025
5026
5027.section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
5028Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
5029(or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
5030&'='&. For example:
5031.code
5032MAC = initial value
5033...
5034MAC == updated value
5035.endd
5036Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
5037subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
5038the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
5039Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
5040.code
5041MAC = initial value
5042...
5043MAC == MAC and something added
5044.endd
5045This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
5046from a number of other files.
5047
5048.section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
5049The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
5050&%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
5051used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
5052using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
5053file to be ignored.
5054
5055
5056
5057.section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
5058As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
5059up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
5060strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
5061.code
5062ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
5063 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
5064.endd
5065This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
5066.code
5067data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
5068.endd
5069In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
5070address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
5071section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5072
5073
5074.section "Builtin macros" "SECTbuiltinmacros"
5075Exim defines some macros depending on facilities available, which may
5076differ due to build-time definitions and from one release to another.
5077All of these macros start with an underscore.
5078They can be used to conditionally include parts of a configuration
5079(see below).
5080
5081The following classes of macros are defined:
5082.display
5083&` _HAVE_* `& build-time defines
5084&` _DRIVER_ROUTER_* `& router drivers
5085&` _DRIVER_TRANSPORT_* `& transport drivers
5086&` _DRIVER_AUTHENTICATOR_* `& authenticator drivers
5087&` _LOG_* `& log_selector values
5088&` _OPT_MAIN_* `& main config options
5089&` _OPT_ROUTERS_* `& generic router options
5090&` _OPT_TRANSPORTS_* `& generic transport options
5091&` _OPT_AUTHENTICATORS_* `& generic authenticator options
5092&` _OPT_ROUTER_*_* `& private router options
5093&` _OPT_TRANSPORT_*_* `& private transport options
5094&` _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_*_* `& private authenticator options
5095.endd
5096
5097Use an &"exim -bP macros"& command to get the list of macros.
5098
5099
5100.section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5101.cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5102.cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5103You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5104&`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5105portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5106read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5107
5108The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5109be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5110that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5111line. Thus:
5112.code
5113.ifdef AAA
5114message_size_limit = 50M
5115.else
5116message_size_limit = 100M
5117.endif
5118.endd
5119sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5120(or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5121otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5122is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5123obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5124
5125Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5126it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5127in this line"& will always be true.
5128
5129Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5130to clarify complicated nestings.
5131
5132
5133
5134.section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5135.cindex "common option syntax"
5136.cindex "syntax of common options"
5137.cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5138For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5139each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5140lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5141these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5142space) and then the value. For example:
5143.code
5144qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5145.endd
5146.cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5147.cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5148.cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5149Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5150accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5151line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5152word &"hide"&. For example:
5153.code
5154hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5155.endd
5156For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5157.code
5158mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5159.endd
5160If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5161all instances of the same driver.
5162
5163The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5164that are found in option settings.
5165
5166
5167.section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5168.cindex "format" "boolean"
5169.cindex "boolean configuration values"
5170.oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5171.oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5172Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5173different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5174the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5175if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5176boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5177&"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5178the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5179.code
5180queue_only
5181queue_only = true
5182.endd
5183The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5184.code
5185no_queue_only
5186queue_only = false
5187.endd
5188You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5189
5190
5191
5192
5193.section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5194.cindex "integer configuration values"
5195.cindex "format" "integer"
5196If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5197hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5198number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5199with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5200hexadecimal number.
5201
5202If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5203it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024;
5204if by the letter G, 1024x1024x1024.
5205When the values
5206of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
52071024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5208and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5209used.
5210
5211
5212.section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5213.cindex "integer format"
5214.cindex "format" "octal integer"
5215If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5216interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5217Such options are always output in octal.
5218
5219
5220.section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5221.cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5222.cindex "format" "fixed point"
5223If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5224integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5225
5226
5227
5228.section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5229.cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5230.cindex "format" "time interval"
5231A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5232the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5233
5234.table2 30pt
5235.irow &%s%& seconds
5236.irow &%m%& minutes
5237.irow &%h%& hours
5238.irow &%d%& days
5239.irow &%w%& weeks
5240.endtable
5241
5242For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5243intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5244is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5245
5246
5247
5248.section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5249.cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5250.cindex "format" "string"
5251If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5252or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5253consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5254the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5255removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5256Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5257appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5258therefore equivalent:
5259.code
5260trusted_users = uucp:mail
5261trusted_users = uucp:\
5262 # This comment line is ignored
5263 mail
5264.endd
5265.cindex "string" "quoted"
5266.cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5267If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5268double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5269continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5270
5271.table2 100pt
5272.irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5273.irow &`\n`& "newline"
5274.irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5275.irow &`\t`& "tab"
5276.irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5277.irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5278 character"
5279.endtable
5280
5281If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5282character, that character replaces the pair.
5283
5284Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5285insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5286trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5287current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5288in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5289and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5290
5291
5292.section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5293.cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5294Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5295by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5296circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5297is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5298strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5299However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5300backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5301within a quoted configuration string.
5302
5303
5304.section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5305.cindex "user name" "format of"
5306.cindex "format" "user name"
5307.cindex "groups" "name format"
5308.cindex "format" "group name"
5309User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5310above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5311either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5312&[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5313
5314
5315.section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5316.cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5317.cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5318.cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5319The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5320default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5321the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5322&"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5323are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5324particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5325&<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5326
5327In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5328input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5329&<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5330in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5331on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5332start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5333example, the list
5334.code
5335local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5336.endd
5337contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5338
5339&*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5340list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5341colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5342be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5343
5344.section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5345.cindex "list separator" "changing"
5346.cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5347Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5348introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5349with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5350character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5351above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5352.code
5353local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5354.endd
5355This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5356&%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5357confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5358
5359.cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5360.cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5361It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5362code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5363must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5364are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5365sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5366interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5367generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5368.code
5369domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5370.endd
5371This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5372to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5373expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5374the value in quotes. For example:
5375.code
5376local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5377.endd
5378Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5379doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5380set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5381enclosing an empty list item.
5382
5383
5384
5385.section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5386.cindex "list" "empty item in"
5387An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5388separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5389.code
5390senders = user@domain :
5391.endd
5392contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5393in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5394items, the second of which is empty:
5395.code
5396senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5397.endd
5398&*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5399are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5400would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5401just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5402.code
5403senders = :
5404.endd
5405In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5406is at the end of the list.
5407
5408
5409
5410
5411.section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5412.cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5413There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5414and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5415instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5416a sequence of lines like this:
5417.display
5418<&'instance name'&>:
5419 <&'option'&>
5420 ...
5421 <&'option'&>
5422.endd
5423In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5424followed by three options settings:
5425.code
5426localuser:
5427 driver = accept
5428 check_local_user
5429 transport = local_delivery
5430.endd
5431For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5432setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5433settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5434deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5435a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5436described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5437
5438You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5439the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5440
5441The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5442passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5443transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5444authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5445them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5446server.
5447
5448.cindex "generic options"
5449.cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5450Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5451and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5452same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5453&%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5454.cindex "private options"
5455The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5456they all have default values.
5457
5458The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5459precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5460this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5461
5462Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5463elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5464with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5465a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5466instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5467confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5468configuration lines:
5469.code
5470remote_smtp:
5471 driver = smtp
5472.endd
5473create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5474&(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5475different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5476instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5477thus:
5478.code
5479special_smtp:
5480 driver = smtp
5481 port = 1234
5482 command_timeout = 10s
5483.endd
5484The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5485these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5486lines.
5487
5488Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5489list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5490defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5491option.
5492
5493
5494
5495
5496
5497
5498. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5499. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5500
5501.chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5502.scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5503.cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5504The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5505is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5506the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5507configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5508of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5509itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5510initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5511mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5512
5513
5514
5515.section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5516The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5517file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5518the line
5519.code
5520# primary_hostname =
5521.endd
5522This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5523to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5524can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5525it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5526
5527The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5528.code
5529domainlist local_domains = @
5530domainlist relay_to_domains =
5531hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5532.endd
5533These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5534domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5535domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5536configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5537
5538The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5539later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5540on the local host.
5541
5542.cindex "@ in a domain list"
5543There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5544of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5545called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5546be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5547the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5548
5549The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5550list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5551controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5552domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5553domain is permitted.
5554
5555The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5556used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5557that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5558loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5559submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5560hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5561
5562Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5563we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5564and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5565
5566The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5567.code
5568acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5569acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5570.endd
5571These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5572during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5573command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5574respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5575&'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5576section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5577accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5578to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5579contents of a message to be checked.
5580
5581Two commented-out option settings are next:
5582.code
5583# av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5584# spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5585.endd
5586These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5587content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5588scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5589details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5590
5591Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5592.code
5593# tls_advertise_hosts = *
5594# tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5595# tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5596.endd
5597These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5598support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5599first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5600connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5601other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5602key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5603More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5604
5605Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5606.code
5607# daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5608# tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5609.endd
5610.cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5611.cindex "port" "for message submission"
5612.cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5613.cindex "submissions protocol"
5614.cindex "smtps protocol"
5615.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5616.cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
5617.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5618.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5619These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5620server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5621TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5622more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&).
5623Mail submission from mail clients (MUAs) should be separate from inbound mail
5624to your domain (MX delivery) for various good reasons (eg, ability to impose
5625much saner TLS protocol and ciphersuite requirements without unintended
5626consequences).
5627RFC 6409 (previously 4409) specifies use of port 587 for SMTP Submission,
5628which uses STARTTLS, so this is the &"submission"& port.
5629RFC 8314 specifies use of port 465 as the &"submissions"& protocol,
5630which should be used in preference to 587.
5631You should also consider deploying SRV records to help clients find
5632these ports.
5633Older names for &"submissions"& are &"smtps"& and &"ssmtp"&.
5634
5635Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5636.code
5637# qualify_domain =
5638# qualify_recipient =
5639.endd
5640The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5641complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5642receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5643the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5644you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5645addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5646
5647.cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5648The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5649addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5650(an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5651.code
5652# allow_domain_literals
5653.endd
5654The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5655Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5656quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5657try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5658people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5659&'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5660
5661The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5662.code
5663never_users = root
5664.endd
5665It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5666convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5667setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5668The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5669list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5670FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5671contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5672FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5673
5674When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5675Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5676line,
5677.code
5678host_lookup = *
5679.endd
5680specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5681in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5682information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5683or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5684Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5685because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5686unreachable.
5687
5688The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
56891413 (hence their names):
5690.code
5691rfc1413_hosts = *
5692rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5693.endd
5694These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5695Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5696terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5697of an incoming SMTP connection.
5698If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5699information, you can change this.
5700
5701This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5702and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5703.code
5704prdr_enable = true
5705.endd
5706
5707When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5708be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5709if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5710find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5711.code
5712# sender_unqualified_hosts =
5713# recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5714.endd
5715show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5716and recipient addresses, respectively.
5717
5718The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5719over the default:
5720.code
5721log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5722 +tls_certificate_verified
5723.endd
5724
5725The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5726.code
5727# percent_hack_domains =
5728.endd
5729It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5730This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5731anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5732
5733The next two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5734concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5735message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5736occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5737address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5738bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5739are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5740always bounce messages.
5741.code
5742ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5743timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5744.endd
5745The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5746discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5747message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5748after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5749bounce message ever lasts a week.
5750
5751Exim queues it's messages in a spool directory. If you expect to have
5752large queues, you may consider using this option. It splits the spool
5753directory into subdirectories to avoid file system degradation from
5754many files in a single directory, resulting in better performance.
5755Manual manipulation of queued messages becomes more complex (though fortunately
5756not often needed).
5757.code
5758# split_spool_directory = true
5759.endd
5760
5761In an ideal world everybody follows the standards. For non-ASCII
5762messages RFC 2047 is a standard, allowing a maximum line length of 76
5763characters. Exim adheres that standard and won't process messages which
5764violate this standard. (Even ${rfc2047:...} expansions will fail.)
5765In particular, the Exim maintainers have had multiple reports of
5766problems from Russian administrators of issues until they disable this
5767check, because of some popular, yet buggy, mail composition software.
5768.code
5769# check_rfc2047_length = false
5770.endd
5771
5772If you need to be strictly RFC compliant you may wish to disable the
57738BITMIME advertisement. Use this, if you exchange mails with systems
5774that are not 8-bit clean.
5775.code
5776# accept_8bitmime = false
5777.endd
5778
5779Libraries you use may depend on specific environment settings. This
5780imposes a security risk (e.g. PATH). There are two lists:
5781&%keep_environment%& for the variables to import as they are, and
5782&%add_environment%& for variables we want to set to a fixed value.
5783Note that TZ is handled separately, by the $%timezone%$ runtime
5784option and by the TIMEZONE_DEFAULT buildtime option.
5785.code
5786# keep_environment = ^LDAP
5787# add_environment = PATH=/usr/bin::/bin
5788.endd
5789
5790
5791.section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5792.cindex "default" "ACLs"
5793.cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5794In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5795It starts with the line
5796.code
5797begin acl
5798.endd
5799and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5800&'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5801and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5802
5803.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5804The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5805RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5806are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5807rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5808result of the ACL processing.
5809.code
5810acl_check_rcpt:
5811.endd
5812This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5813ACL, and names it.
5814.code
5815accept hosts = :
5816.endd
5817This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5818But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5819names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5820list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5821host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5822important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5823
5824What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5825messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5826input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5827manner.
5828.code
5829deny message = Restricted characters in address
5830 domains = +local_domains
5831 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5832
5833deny message = Restricted characters in address
5834 domains = !+local_domains
5835 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5836.endd
5837These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5838characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5839Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5840&"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5841in Internet mail addresses.
5842
5843The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5844addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5845option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5846in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5847programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5848at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5849characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5850policy of being as safe as possible.
5851
5852The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5853to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5854first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5855&'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5856reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5857&'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5858
5859The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5860block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5861or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5862have to modify this rule.
5863
5864Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5865allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5866common convention of local parts constructed as
5867&"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5868the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5869with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5870file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5871that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5872is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5873
5874The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5875allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5876and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5877with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5878local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5879and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5880(or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5881.code
5882accept local_parts = postmaster
5883 domains = +local_domains
5884.endd
5885This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5886local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5887&'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5888reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5889&'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5890
5891The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5892by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5893in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5894.code
5895require verify = sender
5896.endd
5897This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5898ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5899address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5900see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5901addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5902used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5903discusses the details of address verification.
5904.code
5905accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5906 control = submission
5907.endd
5908This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5909hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5910verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5911that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5912second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5913is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5914messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5915&'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5916probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5917.code
5918accept authenticated = *
5919 control = submission
5920.endd
5921This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5922Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5923likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5924authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5925examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5926fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5927.code
5928require message = relay not permitted
5929 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5930.endd
5931This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5932one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5933.code
5934require verify = recipient
5935.endd
5936This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5937fails, the address is rejected.
5938.code
5939# deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5940# is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5941# $dnslist_text
5942# dnslists = black.list.example
5943#
5944# warn dnslists = black.list.example
5945# add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5946# a black list at $dnslist_domain
5947# log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5948.endd
5949These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5950sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5951from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5952line.
5953.code
5954# require verify = csa
5955.endd
5956This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5957authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5958records.
5959.code
5960accept
5961.endd
5962The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5963address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5964.code
5965acl_check_data:
5966.endd
5967This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5968of this ACL are commented out:
5969.code
5970# deny malware = *
5971# message = This message contains a virus \
5972# ($malware_name).
5973.endd
5974These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5975viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5976suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5977virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5978.code
5979# warn spam = nobody
5980# message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5981# X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5982# X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5983# X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5984.endd
5985These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5986SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5987and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5988&`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5989series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5990whatever the spam score.
5991.code
5992accept
5993.endd
5994This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5995
5996
5997.section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5998.cindex "default" "routers"
5999.cindex "routers" "default"
6000The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
6001by the line
6002.code
6003begin routers
6004.endd
6005Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
6006messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
6007accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
6008matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
6009manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
6010.code
6011# domain_literal:
6012# driver = ipliteral
6013# domains = !+local_domains
6014# transport = remote_smtp
6015.endd
6016.cindex "domain literal" "default router"
6017This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
6018support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
6019you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
6020&%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
6021.code
6022dnslookup:
6023 driver = dnslookup
6024 domains = ! +local_domains
6025 transport = remote_smtp
6026 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
6027 no_more
6028.endd
6029The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
6030domains. This is specified by the line
6031.code
6032domains = ! +local_domains
6033.endd
6034The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
6035exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
6036that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
6037the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
6038indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
6039passed on to the following routers.
6040
6041The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
6042and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
6043the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
6044instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
6045one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6046
6047The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
6048DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
6049router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
6050specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
6051in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
6052the address fails and is bounced.
6053
6054The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
6055be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
6056encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
6057whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
6058Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
6059email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
6060continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
6061out.
6062.code
6063system_aliases:
6064 driver = redirect
6065 allow_fail
6066 allow_defer
6067 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
6068# user = exim
6069 file_transport = address_file
6070 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6071.endd
6072Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
6073domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
6074alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
6075data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
6076the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
6077the next router.
6078
6079&_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
6080often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
6081file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
6082&_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
6083.code
6084userforward:
6085 driver = redirect
6086 check_local_user
6087# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6088# local_part_suffix_optional
6089 file = $home/.forward
6090# allow_filter
6091 no_verify
6092 no_expn
6093 check_ancestor
6094 file_transport = address_file
6095 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6096 reply_transport = address_reply
6097.endd
6098This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
6099redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
6100individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
6101local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
6102router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
6103namely:
6104.code
6105# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6106# local_part_suffix_optional
6107.endd
6108.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
6109show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
6110is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
6111by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
6112variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
6113presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
6114the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
6115
6116When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
6117home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
6118declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
6119redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
6120
6121.cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
6122Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
6123files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
6124is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
6125of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
6126filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
6127separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
6128
6129The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
6130verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
6131There are two reasons for doing this:
6132
6133.olist
6134Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
6135checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
6136unnecessary work.
6137.next
6138More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
6139command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
6140The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
6141It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
6142this time.
6143.endlist
6144
6145The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6146address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6147works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6148forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6149
6150The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6151forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6152auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6153.code
6154a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6155.endd
6156the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6157transport.
6158.code
6159localuser:
6160 driver = accept
6161 check_local_user
6162# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6163# local_part_suffix_optional
6164 transport = local_delivery
6165.endd
6166The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6167part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6168the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6169routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6170same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6171
6172
6173.section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6174.cindex "default" "transports"
6175.cindex "transports" "default"
6176Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6177only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6178not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6179.code
6180begin transports
6181.endd
6182One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
6183.code
6184remote_smtp:
6185 driver = smtp
6186 hosts_try_prdr = *
6187.endd
6188This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6189The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6190The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option.
6191It is negotiated between client and server
6192and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
6193All other options are defaulted.
6194.code
6195local_delivery:
6196 driver = appendfile
6197 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6198 delivery_date_add
6199 envelope_to_add
6200 return_path_add
6201# group = mail
6202# mode = 0660
6203.endd
6204This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6205traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6206local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6207directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6208under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6209show how this can be done.
6210
6211Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6212&'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6213similarly-named options above.
6214.code
6215address_pipe:
6216 driver = pipe
6217 return_output
6218.endd
6219This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6220redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6221option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6222be returned to the sender.
6223.code
6224address_file:
6225 driver = appendfile
6226 delivery_date_add
6227 envelope_to_add
6228 return_path_add
6229.endd
6230This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6231redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6232&(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6233.code
6234address_reply:
6235 driver = autoreply
6236.endd
6237This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6238filter files.
6239
6240
6241
6242.section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6243.cindex "retry" "default rule"
6244.cindex "default" "retry rule"
6245The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6246Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6247introduced by the line
6248.code
6249begin retry
6250.endd
6251In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6252errors:
6253.code
6254* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6255.endd
6256This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
62572 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
62581.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6259is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced. The time is
6260measured from first failure, not from the time the message was received.
6261
6262If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6263if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6264temporary errors into permanent errors.
6265
6266
6267.section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6268The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6269.code
6270begin rewrite
6271.endd
6272contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6273rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6274
6275
6276
6277.section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6278.cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6279The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6280.code
6281begin authenticators
6282.endd
6283defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6284configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6285which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6286standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6287mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6288to support most MUA software.
6289
6290The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6291.code
6292#PLAIN:
6293# driver = plaintext
6294# server_set_id = $auth2
6295# server_prompts = :
6296# server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6297# server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6298.endd
6299And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6300.code
6301#LOGIN:
6302# driver = plaintext
6303# server_set_id = $auth1
6304# server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6305# server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6306# server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6307.endd
6308
6309The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6310in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6311&%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6312that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6313i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6314when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6315when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6316need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6317
6318The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6319password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6320To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6321expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6322
6323Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6324usercode and password are in different positions.
6325Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6326
6327.ecindex IIDconfiwal
6328
6329
6330
6331. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6332. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6333
6334.chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6335
6336.cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6337.cindex "PCRE"
6338Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6339uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6340matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6341regular expressions is discussed in
6342online Perl manpages, in
6343many Perl reference books, and also in
6344Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6345O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6346. --- the http: URL here redirects to another page with the ISBN in the URL
6347. --- where trying to use https: just redirects back to http:, so sticking
6348. --- to the old URL for now. 2018-09-07.
6349
6350The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6351are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6352description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6353the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6354the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6355case-insensitive.
6356
6357In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6358it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6359or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6360second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6361.code
6362domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6363.endd
6364The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6365precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6366of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6367regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6368backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6369normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6370matched.
6371
6372There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6373recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6374string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6375these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6376it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6377match anywhere in the subject string.
6378
6379In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6380you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6381.code
6382domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6383.endd
6384matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6385You need to use:
6386.code
6387domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6388.endd
6389if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6390$ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6391
6392
6393
6394. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6395. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6396
6397.chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6398.scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6399.scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6400.cindex "lookup" "description of"
6401Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6402messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6403
6404.olist
6405A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6406cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6407lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6408can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6409&<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6410The key for the lookup is specified as part of the string expansion.
6411.next
6412Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6413way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6414returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6415succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6416chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6417The key for the lookup is given by the context in which the list is expanded.
6418.endlist
6419
6420String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6421that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6422involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6423if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6424time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6425chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6426
6427.section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6428It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6429lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6430processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6431Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6432.code
6433domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6434domains = lsearch;/some/file
6435.endd
6436The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6437No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6438defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6439The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6440file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6441.code
6442192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6443192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6444.endd
6445When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6446possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6447
6448In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6449Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6450in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6451.code
6452domain1:
6453domain2:
6454.endd
6455Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6456matches the list item.
6457
6458It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6459Consider a file containing lines like this:
6460.code
6461192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6462.endd
6463If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6464first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6465causes a second lookup to occur.
6466
6467The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6468available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6469lookup is permitted.
6470
6471
6472.section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6473.cindex "lookup" "types of"
6474.cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6475Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6476
6477.ilist
6478The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6479and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6480lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6481.next
6482.cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6483The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6484key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6485Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6486.endlist
6487
6488The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6489the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6490default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6491.code
6492LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6493LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6494.endd
6495which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6496For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6497libraries and header files before building Exim.
6498
6499
6500
6501
6502.section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6503.cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6504.cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6505The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6506
6507.ilist
6508.cindex "cdb" "description of"
6509.cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6510.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6511&(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6512string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6513indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6514re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6515aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb and
6516tools for building the files can be found in several places:
6517.display
6518&url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html)
6519&url(http://www.corpit.ru/mjt/tinycdb.html)
6520&url(https://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb)
6521&url(https://github.com/philpennock/cdbtools) (in Go)
6522.endd
6523. --- 2018-09-07: corpit.ru http:-only
6524A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6525because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6526However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6527you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6528.next
6529.cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6530.cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6531.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6532&(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6533DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6534zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6535&<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6536
6537.cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6538For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6539when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6540using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6541the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6542that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6543other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6544.next
6545.cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6546.cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6547.cindex "sasldb2"
6548.cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6549&(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6550interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6551ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6552authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6553&_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6554&(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6555.next
6556.cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6557.cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6558.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6559.cindex "Courier"
6560.cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6561.cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6562&(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6563is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6564if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6565other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6566use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6567calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6568utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6569by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6570.next
6571.cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6572.cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6573&(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6574whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6575contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6576the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6577symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6578lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6579&<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6580.next
6581.cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6582.cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6583&(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6584terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6585file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6586IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6587being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6588.code
65891.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6590192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6591"abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6592"abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6593.endd
6594The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6595file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6596key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6597&"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6598&(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6599
6600&*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6601&(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6602lookup types support only literal keys.
6603
6604&*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6605the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6606&<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6607.next
6608.cindex "linear search"
6609.cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6610.cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6611.cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6612&(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6613line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6614end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6615letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6616in the file is used.
6617
6618White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6619line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6620continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6621space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6622junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6623colon, for example:
6624.code
6625baduser: :fail:
6626.endd
6627Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6628middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6629that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6630wildcarding of any kind.
6631
6632.cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6633.cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6634In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6635characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6636If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6637matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6638contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6639quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6640quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6641
6642.next
6643.cindex "NIS lookup type"
6644.cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6645.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6646&(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6647the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6648&(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6649reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6650aliases; the full map names must be used.
6651
6652.next
6653.cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6654.cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6655.cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6656.cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6657&(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6658&(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6659the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6660that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6661used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6662
6663.cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6664Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6665file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6666&`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6667
6668. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6669. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6670
6671.olist
6672The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6673.code
6674 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6675 *fish data for anythingfish
6676.endd
6677.next
6678The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6679example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6680.code
6681 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6682.endd
6683Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6684expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6685string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6686.code
6687 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6688.endd
6689The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6690expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6691For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6692.code
6693 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6694.endd
6695
6696If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6697either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6698ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6699colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6700escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6701
6702&*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6703match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6704is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6705takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6706&((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6707
6708.next
6709Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6710is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6711lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6712example:
6713.code
6714 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6715.endd
6716The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6717.endlist olist
6718
6719Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6720continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6721be followed by optional colons.
6722
6723&*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6724&((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6725lookup types support only literal keys.
6726.endlist ilist
6727
6728
6729.section "Query-style lookup types" "SECTquerystylelookups"
6730.cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6731.cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6732The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6733many of them are given in later sections.
6734
6735.ilist
6736.cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6737.cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6738&(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6739are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6740records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6741.next
6742.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6743.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6744&(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6745.next
6746.cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6747.cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6748&(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6749returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6750that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6751called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6752any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6753.next
6754.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6755.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6756&(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6757MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6758.next
6759.cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6760.cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6761&(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6762the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6763.next
6764.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6765.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6766&(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6767Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6768.next
6769.cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6770.cindex "passwd lookup type"
6771.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6772&(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6773lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6774success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6775lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6776password value. For example:
6777.code
6778*:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6779.endd
6780.next
6781.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6782.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6783&(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6784PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6785
6786.next
6787.cindex "Redis lookup type"
6788.cindex lookup Redis
6789&(redis)&: The format of the query is either a simple get or simple set,
6790passed to a Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6791
6792.next
6793.cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6794.cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6795&(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6796that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6797
6798.next
6799&(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6800not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6801.next
6802.cindex "whoson lookup type"
6803.cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6804. --- still http:-only, 2018-09-07
6805&(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6806allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6807address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6808obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6809at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6810superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6811&"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6812.code
6813require condition = \
6814 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6815.endd
6816The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6817the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6818this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6819one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6820.endlist
6821
6822
6823
6824.section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6825.cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6826Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6827completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6828reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6829options such as a list of local domains.
6830
6831When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6832of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6833temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6834or may give up altogether.
6835
6836
6837
6838.section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6839.cindex "wildcard lookups"
6840.cindex "lookup" "default values"
6841.cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6842.cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6843.cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6844In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6845that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6846
6847&*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6848lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6849specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6850
6851If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6852and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6853provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6854
6855.cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6856.cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6857.cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6858Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6859&%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6860character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6861by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6862that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6863take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6864For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6865.code
6866data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6867.endd
6868Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6869looks up these keys, in this order:
6870.code
6871jane@eyre.example
6872*@eyre.example
6873*
6874.endd
6875The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6876&(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6877complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6878Exim move on to try the next key.
6879
6880
6881
6882.section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6883.cindex "partial matching"
6884.cindex "wildcard lookups"
6885.cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6886.cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6887.cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6888The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6889match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6890being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6891information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6892domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6893a key in a DBM file is
6894.code
6895*.dates.fict.example
6896.endd
6897then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6898&'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6899by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6900file.
6901
6902&*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6903also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6904&<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6905
6906Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6907keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6908be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6909partial matching keys
6910beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6911Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6912unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6913
6914Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6915the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6916is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6917is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6918fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6919start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6920remains.
6921
6922A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6923by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6924&%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6925modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6926subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6927up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6928.code
69292250.dates.fict.example
6930*.2250.dates.fict.example
6931*.dates.fict.example
6932*.fict.example
6933.endd
6934As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6935finishes.
6936
6937.cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6938.cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6939The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6940changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6941formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6942parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6943.code
6944domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6945.endd
6946In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6947&`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6948components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6949other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6950.code
6951domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6952.endd
6953For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6954&`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6955
6956If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6957just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6958down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6959
6960.ilist
6961If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6962.next
6963If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6964example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6965.next
6966Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6967remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6968for &"*"& on its own.
6969.next
6970Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6971.endlist
6972
6973
6974If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6975&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6976this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6977specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6978prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6979lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6980&"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6981
6982The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6983in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6984dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6985in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6986subject key is always followed by a dot.
6987
6988
6989
6990
6991.section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6992.cindex "lookup" "caching"
6993.cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6994Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6995lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6996of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6997single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6998
6999For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
7000another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
7001many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
7002the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
7003closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
7004own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
7005
7006The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
7007strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
7008complete.
7009
7010
7011
7012
7013.section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
7014.cindex "lookup" "quoting"
7015.cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
7016When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
7017is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
7018the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
7019.code
7020[name=$local_part]
7021.endd
7022will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
7023For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
7024.code
7025[name="$local_part"]
7026.endd
7027but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
7028NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
7029rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
7030of the following form is provided:
7031.code
7032${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
7033.endd
7034For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
7035.code
7036[name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
7037.endd
7038See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
7039operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
7040lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
7041
7042
7043
7044
7045.section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
7046.cindex "dnsdb lookup"
7047.cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
7048.cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7049The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
7050of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
7051an expansion string could contain:
7052.code
7053${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
7054.endd
7055If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
7056is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
7057&`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
7058&<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
7059
7060The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
7061and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
7062If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
7063
7064For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
7065concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
7066depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
7067between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
7068by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
7069.code
7070${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
7071.endd
7072It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7073white space is ignored.
7074For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
7075an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
7076separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
7077
7078.cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7079When the type is PTR,
7080the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
7081&%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
7082.code
7083${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
7084.endd
7085If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
7086altered and nothing is added.
7087
7088.cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7089.cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7090For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7091each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
7092port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
7093The field separator can be modified as above.
7094
7095.cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7096.cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7097For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
7098unless a field separator is specified.
7099To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
7100For SPF records the
7101default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
7102.code
7103${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
7104${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
7105${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
7106.endd
7107It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7108white space is ignored.
7109
7110.cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7111For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
7112successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
7113Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
7114specified.
7115.code
7116${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
7117.endd
7118
7119.section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
7120.cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
7121.cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
7122.cindex "options" "dnsdb"
7123Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
7124each followed by a comma,
7125that may appear before the record type.
7126
7127The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
7128temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
7129a defer-option modifier.
7130The possible keywords are
7131&"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
7132With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7133whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7134ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7135With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7136error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7137succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7138.code
7139${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7140${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7141.endd
7142Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7143yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7144
7145.cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7146Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7147The possible keywords are
7148&"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7149With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7150with the lookup.
7151With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7152is not labelled as authenticated data
7153is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7154The default is &"never"&.
7155
7156See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7157
7158.cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7159.cindex "DNS" timeout
7160Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7161The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7162(e.g. &"5s"&).
7163The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7164
7165Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7166The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7167The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7168
7169.cindex caching "of dns lookup"
7170.cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7171.cindex DNS TTL
7172Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7173The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7174value of the set of returned DNS records.
7175
7176
7177.section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7178.cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7179By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7180each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7181the pseudo-type MXH:
7182.code
7183${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7184.endd
7185In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7186returned.
7187
7188.cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7189Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7190records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7191component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7192records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7193error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7194but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7195top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7196.code
7197${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7198${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7199.endd
7200Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7201the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7202the name servers for &%edu%&.
7203
7204You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7205top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7206sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7207given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7208for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7209such a list.
7210
7211.cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7212A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7213records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7214&<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7215not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7216result of a successful lookup such as:
7217.code
7218${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7219.endd
7220has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7221The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7222authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7223
7224.cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7225The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7226and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7227(see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7228.code
7229${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7230.endd
7231
7232
7233.section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7234In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7235However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7236&(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7237the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7238.code
7239${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7240${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7241${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7242.endd
7243In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7244the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7245to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7246case, it does not treat it as a list.
7247
7248The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7249in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7250different separator can be specified, as described above.
7251
7252
7253
7254
7255.section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7256.cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7257.cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7258.cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7259The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7260become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7261implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7262contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7263the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7264it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7265indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7266your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7267.code
7268LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7269LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7270LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7271LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7272LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7273.endd
7274If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7275same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7276
7277There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7278the way they handle the results of a query:
7279
7280.ilist
7281&(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7282gives an error.
7283.next
7284&(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7285Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7286.next
7287&(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7288from all of them are returned.
7289.endlist
7290
7291
7292For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7293Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7294the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7295First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7296
7297
7298.section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7299.cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7300An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7301the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7302.code
7303data = ${lookup ldap \
7304 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7305 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7306.endd
7307.cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7308The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7309secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7310encrypted TLS connection is used.
7311
7312With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7313LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7314See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7315
7316Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7317controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7318&_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7319your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7320&_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7321certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7322running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7323methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7324&_exim.conf_&.
7325
7326
7327.section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7328.cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7329Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7330and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7331within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7332reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7333
7334The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7335filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7336the string:
7337.code
7338* => \2A
7339( => \28
7340) => \29
7341\ => \5C
7342.endd
7343in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7344to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7345.code
7346! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
7347.endd
7348are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7349.code
7350${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7351.endd
7352yields
7353.code
7354%20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7355.endd
7356Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7357.code
7358a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7359.endd
7360The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7361base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7362by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7363.code
7364, + " \ < > ;
7365.endd
7366It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7367before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7368is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7369.code
7370${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7371.endd
7372yields
7373.code
7374%5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7375.endd
7376Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7377.code
7378\ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7379.endd
7380There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7381authentication below.
7382
7383
7384.section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7385.cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7386The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7387is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7388an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7389by starting it with
7390.code
7391ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7392.endd
7393If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7394used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7395taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7396colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7397handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7398returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7399are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7400Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7401failures, and timeouts.
7402
7403For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7404of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7405&%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7406doubled. For example
7407.code
7408ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7409.endd
7410If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7411to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7412the local host) is used.
7413
7414If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7415a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7416&`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7417to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7418not available.
7419
7420For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7421for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7422can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7423the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7424.code
7425ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7426.endd
7427When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7428&`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7429.code
7430${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7431.endd
7432When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7433a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7434specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7435socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7436&%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7437or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7438the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7439backup host.
7440
7441If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7442specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7443&%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7444
7445.ilist
7446Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7447interface.
7448.next
7449Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7450.endlist
7451
7452
7453Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7454&%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7455
7456
7457
7458.section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7459.cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7460The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7461information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7462be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7463spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7464when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7465them. The following names are recognized:
7466.display
7467&`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7468&`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7469&`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7470&`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7471&`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7472&`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7473&`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7474&`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7475.endd
7476The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7477&"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7478must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7479library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7480
7481.cindex LDAP timeout
7482.cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7483The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7484backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7485enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7486network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7487&'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7488LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7489if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7490SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7491Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7492
7493The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7494set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7495
7496The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7497to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7498default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7499server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7500different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7501different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7502alternate list (colon-separated).
7503
7504Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7505values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7506.code
7507${lookup ldap
7508 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7509 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7510 {$value}fail}
7511.endd
7512The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7513any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7514which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7515non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7516
7517The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7518connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7519on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7520
7521When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7522removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7523some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7524quoting has two advantages:
7525
7526.ilist
7527It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7528DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7529.next
7530It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7531.endlist
7532
7533For example, a setting such as
7534.code
7535USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7536.endd
7537should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7538
7539Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7540expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7541field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7542does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7543.code
7544PASS=${quote:$3}
7545.endd
7546The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7547SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7548&<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7549
7550
7551
7552.section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7553.cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7554The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7555as a sequence of values, for example
7556.code
7557cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
7558.endd
7559The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7560search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7561the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7562values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7563you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7564directory.
7565
7566In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7567result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7568has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
7569part of an attribute's value is doubled.
7570
7571If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7572strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7573quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7574backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7575Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7576(permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7577Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7578output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7579same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7580
7581Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7582LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7583&%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7584&%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
7585(they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
7586
7587.code
7588ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7589value1.1,value1,,2
7590
7591ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7592value two
7593
7594ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
7595value1.1,value1,,2,value two
7596
7597ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7598attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7599
7600ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7601objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7602.endd
7603You can
7604make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7605results of LDAP lookups.
7606The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7607individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7608The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7609of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7610The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7611comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7612
7613
7614
7615
7616.section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7617.cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7618.cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7619NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7620and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7621contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7622of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7623values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7624.code
7625[name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7626.endd
7627might return the string
7628.code
7629name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7630home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7631.endd
7632(split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7633.code
7634[name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7635.endd
7636would just return
7637.code
7638Martin Guerre
7639.endd
7640with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7641for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7642operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7643
7644
7645
7646.section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7647.cindex "SQL lookup types"
7648.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7649.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7650.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7651.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7652.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7653.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7654.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7655.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7656.cindex "Redis lookup type"
7657.cindex lookup Redis
7658Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
7659and SQLite
7660databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7661might be
7662.code
7663${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7664 {$value}fail}
7665.endd
7666If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7667field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7668.code
7669${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7670 {$value}}
7671.endd
7672might be
7673.code
7674home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7675.endd
7676Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7677quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7678field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7679.code
7680Mister X
7681.endd
7682If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7683with a newline between the data for each row.
7684
7685
7686.section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" "SECID72"
7687.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7688.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7689.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7690.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7691.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7692.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7693.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7694.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7695.cindex "Redis lookup type"
7696.cindex lookup Redis
7697If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
7698&%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
7699or &%redis_servers%&
7700option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7701information.
7702(For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
7703queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7704&<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
7705For all but Redis
7706each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7707items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7708Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7709name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7710.code
7711hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7712.endd
7713Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7714&"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7715option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7716.code
7717hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7718 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7719.endd
7720For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7721because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7722query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7723a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7724found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7725servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7726
7727For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
7728own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
7729If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7730information.
7731Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
7732host, database number, and password.
7733.olist
7734The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
7735port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
7736higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
7737.next
7738The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
7739.next
7740The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
7741.endlist
7742
7743The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7744convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7745respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7746itself are escaped with backslashes.
7747
7748The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
7749escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
7750
7751.section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7752For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7753it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7754done by starting the query with
7755.display
7756&`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7757.endd
7758Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7759.olist
7760If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7761global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7762of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7763taken from there.
7764.next
7765If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7766.endlist
7767The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7768Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7769successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7770
7771This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7772are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7773master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7774like this:
7775.code
7776mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7777 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7778 master/db/name/pw
7779.endd
7780In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7781.code
7782${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7783.endd
7784That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7785the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7786option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7787.code
7788${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7789.endd
7790
7791
7792.section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7793For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7794causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7795socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
7796An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
7797the default value is &"exim"&.
7798The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7799.display
7800<&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
7801 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7802.endd
7803Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7804the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7805
7806No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7807the queries.
7808
7809If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7810or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7811
7812&*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7813anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7814is zero because no rows are affected.
7815
7816
7817.section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7818PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7819This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7820However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7821database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7822looks like this:
7823.code
7824hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7825.endd
7826In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7827given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7828visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7829
7830If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7831update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7832affected.
7833
7834.section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7835.cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7836.cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7837SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7838addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7839daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7840of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7841separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7842contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7843.code
7844${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7845 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7846.endd
7847In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7848.code
7849domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7850 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7851.endd
7852The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7853quote, which it doubles.
7854
7855.cindex timeout SQLite
7856.cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
7857The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7858internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7859update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7860are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7861waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7862to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7863option.
7864
7865.section "More about Redis" "SECTredis"
7866.cindex "lookup" "Redis"
7867.cindex "redis lookup type"
7868Redis is a non-SQL database. Commands are simple get and set.
7869Examples:
7870.code
7871${lookup redis{set keyname ${quote_redis:objvalue plus}}}
7872${lookup redis{get keyname}}
7873.endd
7874
7875As of release 4.91, "lightweight" support for Redis Cluster is available.
7876Requires &%redis_servers%& list to contain all the servers in the cluster, all
7877of which must be reachable from the running exim instance. If the cluster has
7878master/slave replication, the list must contain all the master and slave
7879servers.
7880
7881When the Redis Cluster returns a "MOVED" response to a query, Exim does not
7882immediately follow the redirection but treats the response as a DEFER, moving on
7883to the next server in the &%redis_servers%& list until the correct server is
7884reached.
7885
7886.ecindex IIDfidalo1
7887.ecindex IIDfidalo2
7888
7889
7890. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7891. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7892
7893.chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7894 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7895 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7896.scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7897A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7898email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7899contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7900are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7901arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7902
7903Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7904host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7905different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7906general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7907
7908Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
7909support all the complexity available in
7910domain, host, address and local part lists.
7911
7912
7913
7914.section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
7915.cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7916Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used.
7917
7918&'Exception: the router headers_remove option, where list-item
7919splitting is done before string-expansion.'&
7920
7921The result of
7922expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7923into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7924but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7925&<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7926discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7927
7928
7929If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7930testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7931expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7932
7933If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7934other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7935misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7936the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7937expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7938.code
7939deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7940 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7941.endd
7942The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7943&`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7944senders based on the receiving domain.
7945
7946
7947
7948
7949.section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7950.cindex "list" "negation"
7951.cindex "negation" "in lists"
7952Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7953leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7954defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7955it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7956(respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7957
7958The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7959subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7960subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7961subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7962was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7963.code
7964domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7965.endd
7966matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7967neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7968list is positive. However, if the setting were
7969.code
7970domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
7971.endd
7972then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7973list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7974as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7975
7976Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7977the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7978item.
7979
7980
7981
7982.section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7983.cindex "list" "file name in"
7984If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7985name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7986processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7987file names are not allowed,
7988and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7989Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7990lines:
7991
7992.ilist
7993For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7994file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7995.next
7996Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7997address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7998white space or the start of the line. For example:
7999.code
8000not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
8001.endd
8002.endlist
8003
8004Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
8005file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
8006is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
8007so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
8008
8009If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
8010within the file is inverted. For example, if
8011.code
8012hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
8013.endd
8014and the file contains the lines
8015.code
8016!a.b.c
8017*.b.c
8018.endd
8019then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
8020any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
8021
8022
8023
8024.section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
8025As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
8026to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
8027confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
8028an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
8029sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
8030non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
8031always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
8032
8033If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
8034list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
8035in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
8036&(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
8037
8038
8039
8040
8041.section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
8042.cindex "named lists"
8043.cindex "list" "named"
8044A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
8045which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
8046particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
8047places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
8048the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
8049a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
8050locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
8051.code
8052domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
8053.endd
8054Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
8055for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
8056configured with the line
8057.code
8058domains = +local_domains
8059.endd
8060The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
8061except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
8062.code
8063dnslookup:
8064 driver = dnslookup
8065 domains = ! +local_domains
8066 transport = remote_smtp
8067 no_more
8068.endd
8069The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
8070the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
8071respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
8072equals sign and the list itself. For example:
8073.code
8074hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
8075addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
8076.endd
8077A named list may refer to other named lists:
8078.code
8079domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
8080domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
8081domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
8082.endd
8083&*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
8084effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
8085out to the higher level. For example, consider:
8086.code
8087domainlist dom1 = !a.b
8088domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
8089.endd
8090The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
8091list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
8092means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
8093.code
8094domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
8095.endd
8096where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
8097referenced lists if you can.
8098
8099Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
8100address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
8101lists. So, if you have a setting such as
8102.code
8103domains = +local_domains
8104.endd
8105on several of your routers
8106or in several ACL statements,
8107the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
8108if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
8109references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
8110the same each time they are referenced.
8111
8112By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
8113extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
8114is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
8115hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
8116
8117
8118
8119.section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
8120.cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
8121.cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
8122At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
8123configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
8124write
8125.code
8126ALIST = host1 : host2
8127auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
8128.endd
8129it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
8130.code
8131auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
8132.endd
8133Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
8134list, and write
8135.code
8136hostlist alist = host1 : host2
8137auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
8138.endd
8139the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
8140.code
8141auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
8142.endd
8143
8144
8145.section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
8146.cindex "list" "caching of named"
8147.cindex "caching" "named lists"
8148While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
8149it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
8150the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
8151that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
8152an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
8153message. For example:
8154.code
8155domainlist special_domains = \
8156 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
8157.endd
8158This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
8159address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
8160in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
8161cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
8162same list each time.
8163
8164By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
8165cache the result anyway. For example:
8166.code
8167domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
8168.endd
8169If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
8170the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
8171
8172
8173
8174.section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8175.cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8176.cindex "list" "domain list"
8177Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8178The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8179
8180.ilist
8181.cindex "primary host name"
8182.cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8183.oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8184.cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8185.cindex "@ in a domain list"
8186If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8187as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8188possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8189differ only in their names.
8190.next
8191.cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8192.cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8193.cindex "domain literal"
8194If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8195in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8196only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8197&%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8198control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8199In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
8200.next
8201.cindex "@mx_any"
8202.cindex "@mx_primary"
8203.cindex "@mx_secondary"
8204.cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8205If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8206has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8207.oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8208&%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8209are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8210local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8211but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8212preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8213
8214The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8215performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8216example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8217resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8218options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8219
8220Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8221patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8222list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8223ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8224on a router). For example:
8225.code
8226domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8227.endd
8228This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8229the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8230
8231The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8232host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8233contain negative items.
8234
8235Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8236be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8237list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8238.code
8239domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8240 an.other.domain : ...
8241.endd
8242so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8243involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8244.code
8245domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8246 an.other.domain ? ...
8247.endd
8248.next
8249.cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8250.cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8251.cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8252If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8253are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8254domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8255list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8256matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8257list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8258&'cipher.key.ex'&.
8259
8260.next
8261.cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8262.cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8263If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8264expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8265function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8266Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8267default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8268with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8269are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8270
8271&*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8272must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8273use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8274it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8275expression by expansion, of course).
8276.next
8277.cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8278.cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8279If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8280semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8281must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8282&"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8283.code
8284domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8285.endd
8286The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8287key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8288only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8289is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8290or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8291&$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8292other statements in the same ACL.
8293
8294.next
8295Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8296&`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8297.code
8298domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8299.endd
8300This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8301works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8302
8303.next
8304.cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8305Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8306a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8307original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8308select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8309value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8310expansion variable.
8311.next
8312If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8313semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8314pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8315chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8316.code
8317hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8318 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8319.endd
8320In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8321example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8322whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8323&%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8324variable and can be referred to in other options.
8325.next
8326.cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8327If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8328between the pattern and the domain.
8329.endlist
8330
8331Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8332.code
8333domainlist funny_domains = \
8334 @ : \
8335 lib.unseen.edu : \
8336 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8337 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8338 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8339 nis;domains.byname : \
8340 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8341.endd
8342There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8343an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8344explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8345but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8346patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8347patterns earlier.
8348
8349
8350
8351.section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8352.cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8353.cindex "list" "host list"
8354Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8355example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8356may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8357two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8358pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8359You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8360involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8361
8362
8363.section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8364.cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8365.cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8366If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8367involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8368process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8369not used.
8370
8371.cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8372The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8373the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8374
8375
8376
8377.section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8378.cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8379If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8380the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8381&`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8382list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8383systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8384concerns.)
8385
8386The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8387inspecting its IP address:
8388
8389.ilist
8390If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8391with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8392to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8393&[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8394This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8395with the IP address of the subject host.
8396
8397If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8398lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8399ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8400temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8401what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8402
8403.next
8404.cindex "@ in a host list"
8405If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8406domain name, as just described.
8407
8408.next
8409If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8410subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8411IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8412be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8413separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8414without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8415IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8416that can never match a client host.
8417
8418.next
8419.cindex "@[] in a host list"
8420If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8421the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8422interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8423.code
8424accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8425accept hosts = @[]
8426.endd
8427.next
8428.cindex "CIDR notation"
8429If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8430example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8431host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8432included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8433specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8434significant end of the address.
8435
8436&*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8437of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8438address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8439addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8440.code
8441192.168.23.236/31
8442.endd
8443matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
844432 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8445matches.
8446
8447Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8448.code
8449recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8450 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8451.endd
8452The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8453appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8454For example:
8455.code
8456recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8457.endd
8458could make use of a file containing
8459.code
8460172.16.0.0/12
84613ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8462.endd
8463to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8464addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8465changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8466.code
8467recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8468 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8469.endd
8470The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8471list.
8472.endlist
8473
8474
8475
8476.section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8477 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8478.cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8479When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8480address, the pattern takes this form:
8481.display
8482&`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8483.endd
8484For example:
8485.code
8486hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8487.endd
8488The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8489IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8490letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8491&(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8492quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8493returned by the lookup is not used.
8494
8495.cindex "IP address" "masking"
8496.cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8497Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8498patterns of this form:
8499.display
8500&`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8501.endd
8502For example:
8503.code
8504net24-dbm;/networks.db
8505.endd
8506The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8507length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8508mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8509is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8510&"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8511
8512When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8513of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8514terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8515to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8516recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8517(notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8518For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8519converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8520addresses are always used.
8521
8522Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8523colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8524However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8525configurations.
8526
8527&*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8528IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8529the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8530case the IP address is used on its own.
8531
8532
8533
8534.section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8535.cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8536.cindex "unknown host name"
8537.cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8538There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8539remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8540complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8541address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8542above.)
8543
8544If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8545patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8546Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8547DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8548Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8549effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8550Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8551
8552Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8553against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8554
8555By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8556if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8557&[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8558are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8559security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8560for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8561Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8562discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8563found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8564
8565There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8566found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8567
8568.cindex "host" "alias for"
8569.cindex "alias for host"
8570As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8571of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8572
8573.ilist
8574.cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8575If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8576the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8577&'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8578requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8579expression.
8580.next
8581.cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8582.cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8583If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8584matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8585expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8586case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8587syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8588example,
8589.code
8590^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8591.endd
8592is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8593&'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8594that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8595string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8596part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8597.code
8598sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8599.endd
8600&*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8601&`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8602example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8603required.
8604.endlist
8605
8606
8607
8608
8609.section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8610.cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8611While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8612name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8613from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8614behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8615
8616&*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8617apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8618
8619.cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8620.cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8621Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8622lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8623Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8624does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8625To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8626&`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8627not recognized in an indirected file).
8628
8629.ilist
8630If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8631cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8632.code
8633host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8634.endd
8635rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8636any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8637
8638.next
8639If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8640be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8641example:
8642.code
8643accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8644 192.168.4.5
8645.endd
8646accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8647whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8648name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8649.endlist
8650
8651Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8652list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8653list.
8654
8655.section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8656 "SECTmixwilhos"
8657.cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8658
8659This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8660as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8661wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8662
8663.ilist
8664If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8665IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8666addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8667.code
8668accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8669.endd
8670The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8671left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8672without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8673a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8674pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8675&%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8676if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8677
8678.next
8679If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8680address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8681.code
8682accept hosts = *.friend.example
8683accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8684.endd
8685If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8686&<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8687&`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8688this section.
8689.endlist
8690
8691
8692.section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8693 "SECTtemdnserr"
8694.cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8695.cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8696.cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8697A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8698&%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8699host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
8700&`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8701section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8702host lists such as whitelists.
8703
8704
8705
8706.section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8707 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8708.cindex "unknown host name"
8709.cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8710If a pattern is of the form
8711.display
8712<&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8713.endd
8714for example
8715.code
8716dbm;/host/accept/list
8717.endd
8718a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8719lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8720is not used.
8721
8722&*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8723keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8724addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8725&<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8726two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8727lookup, both using the same file.
8728
8729
8730
8731.section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8732If a pattern is of the form
8733.display
8734<&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8735.endd
8736the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8737data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8738&$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8739.code
8740hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8741 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8742.endd
8743The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8744can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8745use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8746operator.
8747
8748If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8749looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8750&<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8751
8752Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8753host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8754&`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8755still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8756effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8757See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8758
8759
8760
8761
8762
8763.section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8764.cindex "list" "address list"
8765.cindex "address list" "empty item"
8766.cindex "address list" "patterns"
8767Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8768is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8769always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8770list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8771using this option setting:
8772.code
8773senders = :
8774.endd
8775The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8776data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8777detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8778and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8779
8780Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8781example:
8782.code
8783senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8784.endd
8785A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8786character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8787semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8788subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8789with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8790the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8791wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8792.code
8793deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8794 *@+hostile_domains:\
8795 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8796 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8797.endd
8798.cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8799.cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8800If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8801specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8802treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8803
8804If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8805contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8806address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8807domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8808is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8809.code
8810deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8811.endd
8812
8813The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8814address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8815senders:
8816
8817.ilist
8818.cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8819.cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8820If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8821done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8822You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8823as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8824to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8825.code
8826deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8827 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8828.endd
8829The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8830start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8831
8832.next
8833.cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8834Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8835lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8836example:
8837.code
8838deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8839 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8840 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8841.endd
8842Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8843lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8844not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8845always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8846
8847Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8848cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8849panic log.
8850.cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8851However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8852&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8853default. For example, with this lookup:
8854.code
8855accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8856.endd
8857the file could contains lines like this:
8858.code
8859user1@domain1.example
8860*@domain2.example
8861.endd
8862and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8863that are tried is:
8864.code
8865nimrod@jaeger.example
8866*@jaeger.example
8867*
8868.endd
8869&*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8870would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8871
8872&*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8873.code
8874deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8875deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8876.endd
8877The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8878because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8879domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8880.endlist
8881
8882
8883The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8884If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8885always fails.
8886
8887
8888.ilist
8889.cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8890.cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8891.cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8892If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8893(for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8894split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8895it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8896from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8897of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8898
8899.cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8900The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8901keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8902patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8903even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8904with
8905.code
8906deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8907.endd
8908the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8909.code
8910baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8911.endd
8912to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8913
8914.cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8915If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8916has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8917may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8918but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8919surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8920.code
8921aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8922 spammer3 : spammer4
8923.endd
8924As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8925doubling.
8926
8927If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8928of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8929list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8930might have entries like
8931.code
8932aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8933xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8934*: ^\d{8}$
8935.endd
8936in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8937local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8938each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8939chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8940
8941.cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8942It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8943them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8944
8945.next
8946The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8947lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8948can only return a single list of local parts.
8949.endlist
8950
8951&*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8952in these two examples:
8953.code
8954senders = +my_list
8955senders = *@+my_list
8956.endd
8957In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8958example it is a named domain list.
8959
8960
8961
8962
8963.section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8964.cindex "case of local parts"
8965.cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8966.cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8967Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8968case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8969Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8970Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8971blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8972lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8973default.
8974
8975The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8976address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8977comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8978the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8979that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8980keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8981works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8982case-independent.
8983
8984.cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8985To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8986an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8987part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8988longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8989lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8990performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8991become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8992
8993
8994
8995.section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8996.cindex "list" "local part list"
8997.cindex "local part" "list"
8998Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8999lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
9000setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
9001set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
9002case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
9003matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
9004&%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
9005option is case-sensitive from the start.
9006
9007If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
9008comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
9009only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
9010Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
9011that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
9012&`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
9013Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
9014types.
9015.ecindex IIDdohoadli
9016
9017
9018
9019
9020. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9021. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9022
9023.chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
9024.scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
9025Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
9026them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
9027
9028When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
9029when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
9030start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
9031below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
9032escape character, as described in the following section.
9033
9034Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
9035dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
9036options for which string expansion is performed are marked with &dagger; after
9037the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
9038conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
9039reasons.
9040
9041
9042
9043.section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
9044.cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
9045An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
9046backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
9047character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
9048If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
9049required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
9050the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
9051
9052.cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
9053A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
9054two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
9055expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
9056.code
9057deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
9058.endd
9059On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
9060without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
9061string.
9062
9063
9064
9065.section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
9066.cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
9067A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
9068expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
9069carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
9070octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
9071backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
9072encoding.
9073
9074These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
9075in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
9076and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
9077
9078
9079.section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
9080.cindex "expansion" "testing"
9081.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
9082.oindex "&%-be%&"
9083Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
9084takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
9085arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
9086to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
9087since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
9088value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
9089database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
9090and &%nhash%&.
9091
9092Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
9093instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
9094using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
9095
9096.oindex "&%-bem%&"
9097If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
9098from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
9099option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
9100read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
9101.code
9102exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
9103.endd
9104The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
9105Exim message identifier. For example:
9106.code
9107exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
9108.endd
9109This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
9110is therefore restricted to admin users.
9111
9112
9113.section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
9114.cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
9115A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
9116alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
9117(which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
9118used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
9119instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
9120the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
9121that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
9122its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
9123from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
9124taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
9125being expanded.
9126
9127
9128
9129
9130.section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
9131The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
9132between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
9133outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
9134white space is significant.
9135
9136.vlist
9137.vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
9138.cindex "expansion" "variables"
9139Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
9140.code
9141$local_part
9142${domain}
9143.endd
9144The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
9145characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
9146&'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
9147section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
9148given, the expansion fails.
9149
9150.vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9151.cindex "expansion" "operators"
9152The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
9153<&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
9154.code
9155${lc:$local_part}
9156.endd
9157The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
9158leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
9159below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
9160one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
9161string easier to understand.
9162
9163.vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9164This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9165expansion item below.
9166
9167
9168.vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9169.cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
9170.cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
9171The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9172arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9173Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9174arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9175and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9176are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9177a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9178the result of the expansion.
9179If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9180the expansion result is an empty string.
9181If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9182
9183
9184.vitem "&*${authresults{*&<&'authserv-id'&>&*}}*&"
9185.cindex authentication "results header"
9186.cindex headers "authentication-results:"
9187.cindex authentication "expansion item"
9188This item returns a string suitable for insertion as an
9189&'Authentication-Results"'&
9190header line.
9191The given <&'authserv-id'&> is included in the result; typically this
9192will be a domain name identifying the system performing the authentications.
9193Methods that might be present in the result include:
9194.code
9195none
9196iprev
9197auth
9198spf
9199dkim
9200.endd
9201
9202Example use (as an ACL modifier):
9203.code
9204 add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
9205.endd
9206This is safe even if no authentication results are available.
9207
9208
9209.vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9210 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9211.cindex "expansion" "extracting certificate fields"
9212.cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9213.cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9214The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9215The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9216the certificate. Supported fields are:
9217.display
9218&`version `&
9219&`serial_number `&
9220&`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9221&`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9222&`notbefore `& time
9223&`notafter `& time
9224&`sig_algorithm `&
9225&`signature `&
9226&`subj_altname `& tagged list
9227&`ocsp_uri `& list
9228&`crl_uri `& list
9229.endd
9230If the field is found,
9231<&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9232otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9233variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9234is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9235
9236If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9237key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9238extracted is used.
9239
9240Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9241
9242The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9243output a Distinguished Name string which is
9244not quite
9245parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9246(the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9247RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9248a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9249result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9250The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9251a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9252Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9253
9254The field selectors marked as "time" above
9255take an optional modifier of "int"
9256for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9257Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9258in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9259
9260The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9261newline-separated by default,
9262(embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9263The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9264a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9265
9266The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9267prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9268Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9269which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9270if so the element tags are omitted.
9271
9272If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9273
9274.vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9275 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9276.cindex &%dlfunc%&
9277This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9278This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9279.code
9280EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
9281.endd
9282set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9283object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9284(but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9285
9286There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
9287a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
9288included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9289are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9290must have the following type:
9291.code
9292int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9293.endd
9294Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9295function should return one of the following values:
9296
9297&`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9298into the expanded string that is being built.
9299
9300&`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9301from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9302
9303&`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9304taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9305
9306&`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9307
9308When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9309you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9310configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9311
9312
9313.vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9314.cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9315.cindex "environment" "values from"
9316The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9317removed.
9318This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9319If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9320and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9321
9322Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9323appear, for example:
9324.code
9325${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9326.endd
9327This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9328{<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9329
9330If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9331search failure.
9332If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9333search success.
9334
9335The environment is adjusted by the &%keep_environment%& and
9336&%add_environment%& main section options.
9337
9338
9339.vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9340 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9341.cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9342.cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9343The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9344white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9345must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9346The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9347.display
9348<&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9349.endd
9350.vindex "&$value$&"
9351where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9352values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9353values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9354described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9355for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9356the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9357otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9358variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9359is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9360
9361If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9362key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9363extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9364yield &"2001"&:
9365.code
9366${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9367${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9368.endd
9369Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9370appear, for example:
9371.code
9372${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9373.endd
9374This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9375{<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9376
9377
9378.vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9379 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9380.cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9381.cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9382The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9383apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9384This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9385behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9386extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9387argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9388<&'string3'&> as before.
9389
9390The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9391separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9392The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9393counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9394number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9395number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9396expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9397provided. For example:
9398.code
9399${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9400.endd
9401yields &"42"&, and
9402.code
9403${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9404.endd
9405yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9406empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9407
9408
9409.vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9410.cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9411.cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9412.vindex "&$item$&"
9413After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9414default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9415in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9416evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9417item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9418separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9419input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9420.code
9421${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}}
9422.endd
9423yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9424to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9425
9426
9427.vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9428.cindex "hash function" "textual"
9429.cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9430This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9431early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9432(numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9433
9434The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9435<&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9436<&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9437use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9438.code
9439${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9440.endd
9441The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9442or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9443Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9444function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9445first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9446.code
9447abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9448.endd
9449If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9450letters appear. For example:
9451.display
9452&`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9453&`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9454&`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9455.endd
9456
9457.vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9458 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9459 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9460 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9461 "&*$lheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9462 &*$lh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9463 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9464 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9465.cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9466.vindex "&$header_$&"
9467.vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9468.vindex "&$lheader_$&"
9469.vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9470.cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9471.cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9472.cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9473Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9474.code
9475$header_reply-to:
9476.endd
9477The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9478internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9479lines) may be present.
9480
9481The difference between the four pairs of expansions is in the way
9482the data in the header line is interpreted.
9483
9484.ilist
9485.cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9486&%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9487processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9488
9489.next
9490.cindex "list" "of header lines"
9491&%lheader%& gives a colon-separated list, one element per header when there
9492are multiple headers with a given name.
9493Any embedded colon characters within an element are doubled, so normal Exim
9494list-processing facilities can be used.
9495The terminating newline of each element is removed; in other respects
9496the content is &"raw"&.
9497
9498.next
9499.cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9500&%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9501or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9502character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9503&"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9504.cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9505produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9506what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9507
9508.next
9509&%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9510standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9511be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9512returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9513&[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9514a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9515.endlist ilist
9516
9517In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9518command of the following form:
9519.code
9520headers charset "UTF-8"
9521.endd
9522This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9523subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9524character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9525option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9526value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9527ISO-8859-1.
9528
9529Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9530any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9531&'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9532if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9533
9534Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9535this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9536message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9537filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9538router or transport are not accessible.
9539
9540For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in
9541ACLs that are obeyed before the data phase completes,
9542because the header structure is not set up until the message is received.
9543They are visible in DKIM, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
9544Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9545are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9546point they are added.
9547When any of the above ACLs ar
9548running, however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
9549
9550Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9551following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9552this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9553white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
9554expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
9555expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
9556section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
9557header.)
9558
9559If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9560to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9561&%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9562each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9563newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9564newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9565those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9566junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9567
9568
9569.vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9570.cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9571.cindex &%hmac%&
9572This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9573shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9574RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9575&`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9576cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9577or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9578present. For example:
9579.code
9580${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9581.endd
9582For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9583produces:
9584.code
9585dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9586.endd
9587As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9588an Exim configuration:
9589.code
9590SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9591.endd
9592In a router or a transport you could then have:
9593.code
9594headers_add = \
9595 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9596 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9597 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9598.endd
9599Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9600&'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9601this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9602host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9603using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
9604&'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9605
9606
9607.vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9608.cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9609.cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9610If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9611item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9612in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9613.code
9614${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9615.endd
9616The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9617true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9618be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9619case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9620&<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9621
9622If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9623is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9624cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9625.code
9626condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9627.endd
9628you can use
9629.code
9630condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9631.endd
9632
9633
9634
9635.vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
9636.cindex expansion "imap folder"
9637.cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
9638This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
9639folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
9640For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
9641
9642
9643
9644.vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9645.cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9646.cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9647The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9648strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9649you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9650change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9651some of the braces:
9652.code
9653${length_<n>:<string>}
9654.endd
9655The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> bytes or the whole
9656of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9657&%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9658All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
9659
9660
9661.vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9662 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9663.cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9664.cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9665.cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9666The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9667apart from an optional leading minus,
9668and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9669
9670After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9671default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
9672
9673The first field of the list is numbered one.
9674If the number is negative, the fields are
9675counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9676The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9677then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9678
9679If the modulus of the
9680number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9681the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9682
9683For example:
9684.code
9685${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9686.endd
9687yields &"42"&, and
9688.code
9689${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9690.endd
9691yields &"result: 42"&.
9692
9693If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9694If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9695extracted is used.
9696You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9697
9698
9699.vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9700 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9701This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9702described in the next item.
9703
9704.vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9705 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9706.cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9707.cindex "file" "lookups"
9708.cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9709The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9710discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9711lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9712<&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9713
9714If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9715a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9716other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9717in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9718out by the system administrator.
9719
9720.vindex "&$value$&"
9721If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9722During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9723lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9724level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9725the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9726string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9727lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9728original lookup fails.
9729
9730If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9731data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9732expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9733the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9734appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9735to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9736{<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9737successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9738
9739For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9740search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9741type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9742&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9743
9744.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9745If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9746and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9747They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9748
9749This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9750.code
9751${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9752.endd
9753This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9754the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9755.code
9756${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9757 {$value}fail}
9758.endd
9759
9760
9761.vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9762.cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9763.vindex "&$item$&"
9764After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9765default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
9766in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9767expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9768for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9769setting is not included in the output. For example:
9770.code
9771${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9772.endd
9773expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9774value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9775and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9776
9777.vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9778.cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9779.cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9780The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9781<&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9782if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9783can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9784.code
9785${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9786.endd
9787The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
9788the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
9789processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
9790slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
9791example,
9792.code
9793${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
9794.endd
9795returns the string &"6/33"&.
9796
9797
9798
9799.vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
9800.cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9801.cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9802This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9803interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9804expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9805additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9806name of the subroutine, is nine.
9807
9808The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9809the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9810way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9811Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9812return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9813not its contents.
9814
9815If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9816with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9817Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9818
9819The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9820out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9821
9822
9823.vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9824.cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9825The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9826keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9827it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9828to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9829as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9830and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9831
9832.vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9833 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9834.cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9835This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9836checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9837yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9838empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9839prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9840version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9841variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9842
9843These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9844retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9845against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9846which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9847
9848The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9849string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9850result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9851whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9852is the expansion of the third argument.
9853
9854All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9855However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9856For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9857
9858.vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9859.cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9860.cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9861.cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9862The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9863then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9864the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9865newlines are left in the string.
9866String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9867you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9868the string expansion fails.
9869
9870The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9871locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9872
9873
9874
9875.vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9876 {*&<&'options'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9877.cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9878.cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9879.cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9880This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
9881string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9882examples:
9883.code
9884${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9885${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9886.endd
9887For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9888For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9889a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9890number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9891optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9892example:
9893.code
9894${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9895.endd
9896Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9897one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9898both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9899unless it is an empty string; and no terminating NUL is ever sent)
9900and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9901is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9902extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9903.code
9904${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9905.endd
9906
9907The third argument is a list of options, of which the first element is the timeout
9908and must be present if the argument is given.
9909Further elements are options of form &'name=value'&.
9910Two option types is currently recognised: shutdown and tls.
9911The first defines whether (the default)
9912or not a shutdown is done on the connection after sending the request.
9913Example, to not do so (preferred, eg. by some webservers):
9914.code
9915${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:shutdown=no}}
9916.endd
9917.new
9918The second, tls, controls the use of TLS on the connection. Example:
9919.code
9920${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:tls=yes}}
9921.endd
9922The default is to not use TLS.
9923If it is enabled, a shutdown as descripbed above is never done.
9924.wen
9925
9926A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9927that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9928turns them into spaces:
9929.code
9930${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9931.endd
9932As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9933happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9934addition, the following errors can occur:
9935
9936.ilist
9937Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9938.next
9939Failure to connect the socket;
9940.next
9941Failure to write the request string;
9942.next
9943Timeout on reading from the socket.
9944.endlist
9945
9946By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9947you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9948errors occurs. For example:
9949.code
9950${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9951 {socket failure}}
9952.endd
9953You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9954expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9955and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9956if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9957non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9958
9959The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9960locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9961
9962
9963.vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9964.cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9965.cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9966.vindex "&$value$&"
9967.vindex "&$item$&"
9968This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9969<&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9970separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9971assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9972list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9973them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9974iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9975added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9976number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9977.code
9978${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9979.endd
9980The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9981can be found:
9982.code
9983${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9984.endd
9985At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9986restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9987expansion items.
9988
9989.vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9990This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9991expansion item above.
9992
9993.vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9994 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9995.cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9996.cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9997The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
9998split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
9999in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
10000executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
10001a shell, you must explicitly code it.
10002
10003Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
10004which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
10005simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
10006script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
10007variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
10008quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
10009in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
10010around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
10011variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
10012character.
10013
10014The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
10015and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
10016.cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
10017.vindex "&$value$&"
10018If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
10019and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
10020from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
10021<&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
10022expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
10023&$value$&.
10024
10025If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
10026can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
10027command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
10028of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
10029
10030.vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
10031The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
10032In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
10033troubleshoot:
10034.code
10035warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
10036 log_message = Output of id: $value
10037.endd
10038If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
10039shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
10040.code
10041${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
10042.endd
10043
10044.vindex "&$runrc$&"
10045The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
10046remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
10047.code
10048if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
10049 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
10050 ...
10051endif
10052.endd
10053If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
10054the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
10055commands.
10056
10057&*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
10058option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
10059testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
10060by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
10061
10062The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
10063out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10064
10065
10066.vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
10067.cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
10068.cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
10069This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
10070option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
10071modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
10072into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
10073a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
10074.code
10075${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
10076.endd
10077yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
10078if any $, } or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
10079substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
10080.code
10081${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
10082.endd
10083yields &"defabc"&, and
10084.code
10085${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
10086.endd
10087yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
10088the regular expression from string expansion.
10089
10090The regular expression is compiled in 8-bit mode, working against bytes
10091rather than any Unicode-aware character handling.
10092
10093
10094.vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
10095.cindex sorting "a list"
10096.cindex list sorting
10097.cindex expansion "list sorting"
10098After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10099default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way.
10100The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
10101of a two-argument expansion condition.
10102The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
10103The comparison should return true when applied to two values
10104if the first value should sort before the second value.
10105The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
10106the element being placed in &$item$&,
10107to give values for comparison.
10108
10109The item result is a sorted list,
10110with the original list separator,
10111of the list elements (in full) of the original.
10112
10113Examples:
10114.code
10115${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
10116.endd
10117sorts a list of numbers, and
10118.code
10119${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
10120.endd
10121will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
10122
10123
10124.vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10125.cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10126.cindex "substring extraction"
10127.cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
10128The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10129<&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10130if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10131can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10132.code
10133${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10134.endd
10135The second number is optional (in both notations).
10136If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
10137omitted.
10138
10139The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
10140&%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
10141length required. For example
10142.code
10143${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
10144.endd
10145If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
10146null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
10147length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
10148given offset. The first byte (character) in the string has offset zero.
10149
10150The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
10151from the right-hand end of its operand. The last byte (character) is offset -1,
10152the second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
10153.code
10154${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
10155.endd
10156yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
10157length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
10158the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
10159.code
10160${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
10161.endd
10162yields an empty string, but
10163.code
10164${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
10165.endd
10166yields &"1"&.
10167
10168When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
10169is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all bytes (characters) in the
10170string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
10171no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
10172.code
10173${substr_-1:abcde}
10174${substr{-1}{abcde}}
10175.endd
10176yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
10177
10178All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10179
10180
10181
10182.vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
10183 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
10184.cindex "expansion" "character translation"
10185.cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
10186This item does single-character (in bytes) translation on its subject string. The second
10187argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
10188matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
10189replacement list. For example
10190.code
10191${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
10192.endd
10193yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
10194last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
10195last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
10196place.
10197
10198All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10199
10200.endlist
10201
10202
10203
10204.section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
10205.cindex "expansion" "operators"
10206For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
10207the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
10208The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
10209following operations can be performed:
10210
10211.vlist
10212.vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10213.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10214.cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
10215The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
10216header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
10217not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10218
10219The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10220
10221
10222.vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10223.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10224.cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
10225The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
102262822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
10227operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
10228result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
10229doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
10230Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
10231
10232It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
10233separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
10234character. For example:
10235.code
10236${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
10237.endd
10238expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. The string is expanded
10239first, so if the expanded string starts with >, it may change the output
10240separator unintentionally. This can be avoided by setting the output
10241separator explicitly:
10242.code
10243${addresses:>:$h_from:}
10244.endd
10245
10246Compare the &*address*& (singular)
10247expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
10248address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
10249processing lists.
10250
10251To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
10252a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
10253unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
10254email address separator. For the example header line:
10255.code
10256From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
10257.endd
10258The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
10259properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
10260It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
10261example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
10262de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
10263The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
10264quoted. The fourth example shows SMTPUTF8 handling.
10265.code
10266# exim -be '${addresses:From: \
10267=?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
10268user@example.com
10269# exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
10270Last:user@example.com
10271# exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
10272user@example.com
10273# exim -be '${addresses:フィル <フィリップ@example.jp>}'
10274フィリップ@example.jp
10275.endd
10276
10277.vitem &*${base32:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10278.cindex "&%base32%& expansion item"
10279.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10280The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10281base 32 and output as a (empty, for zero) string of characters.
10282Only lowercase letters are used.
10283
10284.vitem &*${base32d:*&<&'base-32&~digits'&>&*}*&
10285.cindex "&%base32d%& expansion item"
10286.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10287The string must consist entirely of base-32 digits.
10288The number is converted to decimal and output as a string.
10289
10290.vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10291.cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
10292.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10293The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10294base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
10295the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
10296its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
10297names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
10298be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
10299
10300.vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
10301.cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
10302.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10303The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
10304environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
10305identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
10306string.
10307
10308.vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10309.cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10310.cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10311.cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
10312.cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
10313This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10314
10315If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10316returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
10317
10318
10319.vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10320.cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
10321.cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
10322.cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
10323This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
10324
10325
10326.vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10327.cindex "domain" "extraction"
10328.cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
10329The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
10330from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10331
10332
10333.vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10334.cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
10335.cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
10336If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
10337escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
10338significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
10339is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
10340
10341.vitem &*${escape8bit:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10342.cindex "expansion" "escaping 8-bit characters"
10343.cindex "&%escape8bit%& expansion item"
10344If the string contains and characters with the most significant bit set,
10345they are converted to escape sequences starting with a backslash.
10346Backslashes and DEL characters are also converted.
10347
10348
10349.vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10350.cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
10351.cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
10352.cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
10353These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
10354expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
10355arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
10356logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
10357integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
10358C programming language):
10359.table2 70pt 300pt
10360.irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
10361.irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
10362.irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
10363.irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
10364.irow "" "and (&&)"
10365.irow "" "xor (^)"
10366.irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10367.endtable
10368Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10369space is permitted before or after operators.
10370
10371For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10372hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10373decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10374permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10375times, which often do have leading zeros.
10376
10377A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10378or 1024*1024*1024,
10379respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10380a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10381
10382.display
10383&`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10384&`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10385&`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10386&`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10387&`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
10388&`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10389&`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10390&`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10391&`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10392&`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
10393&`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10394.endd
10395
10396As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10397.code
10398deny message = Too many bad recipients
10399 condition = \
10400 ${if and { \
10401 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10402 { \
10403 < \
10404 {$recipients_count} \
10405 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10406 } \
10407 }{yes}{no}}
10408.endd
10409The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10410fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10411
10412
10413.vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10414.cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10415The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10416example,
10417.code
10418${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10419.endd
10420first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10421and then re-expands what it has found.
10422
10423
10424.vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10425.cindex "Unicode"
10426.cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10427.cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10428.cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10429The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10430email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10431to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10432UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10433converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10434the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10435
10436Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10437ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10438For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10439way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10440characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10441single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10442translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10443
10444
10445.vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10446.cindex "hash function" "textual"
10447.cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10448The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10449be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10450change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10451.code
10452${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10453.endd
10454See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10455abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10456
10457
10458
10459.vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10460.cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10461.cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10462.cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10463This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10464be useful for processing the output of the various hashing functions.
10465
10466
10467
10468.vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10469.cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10470.cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10471This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10472escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10473as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example a
10474byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10475
10476
10477.vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10478.cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
10479.cindex "IP address" normalisation
10480This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
10481of hex digits including leading zeroes.
10482A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10483Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10484
10485.vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10486.cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
10487.cindex "IP address" normalisation
10488.cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
10489This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
10490Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
10491set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
10492A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10493Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10494
10495
10496.vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10497.cindex "case forcing in strings"
10498.cindex "string" "case forcing"
10499.cindex "lower casing"
10500.cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10501.cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10502This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10503.code
10504${lc:$local_part}
10505.endd
10506Case is defined per the system C locale.
10507
10508.vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10509.cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10510.cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10511The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10512can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10513changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10514.code
10515${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10516.endd
10517See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10518&%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10519when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10520All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10521
10522
10523.vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10524.cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10525.cindex "list" "item count"
10526.cindex "list" "count of items"
10527.cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10528The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10529
10530
10531.vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10532.cindex "expansion" "named list"
10533.cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10534The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10535expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10536If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10537and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10538Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10539matching list is returned.
10540
10541
10542.vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10543.cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10544.cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10545The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10546extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10547empty.
10548The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10549
10550
10551.vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10552.cindex "masked IP address"
10553.cindex "IP address" "masking"
10554.cindex "CIDR notation"
10555.cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10556.cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10557If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10558slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10559expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10560masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10561the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10562.code
10563${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10564.endd
10565returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10566be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10567address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10568terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10569.code
10570${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10571.endd
10572returns the string
10573.code
105743ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10575.endd
10576Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10577
10578
10579.vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10580.cindex "MD5 hash"
10581.cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10582.cindex certificate fingerprint
10583.cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10584The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10585as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10586
10587If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10588returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10589
10590
10591.vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10592.cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10593.cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10594The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10595that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10596strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10597.code
10598${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10599.endd
10600See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10601
10602
10603.vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10604.cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10605.cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10606.cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10607The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10608is an empty string or
10609contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10610Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10611Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10612respectively For example,
10613.code
10614${quote:ab"*"cd}
10615.endd
10616becomes
10617.code
10618"ab\"*\"cd"
10619.endd
10620The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10621variable or a message header.
10622
10623.vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10624.cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10625This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10626required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10627example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10628If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10629(or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10630
10631This quoting determination is not SMTPUTF8-aware, thus quoting non-ASCII data
10632will likely use the quoting form.
10633Thus &'${quote_local_part:フィル}'& will always become &'"フィル"'&.
10634
10635
10636.vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10637.cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10638This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10639query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10640the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10641.code
10642${quote_ldap:two * two}
10643.endd
10644returns
10645.code
10646two%20%5C2A%20two
10647.endd
10648For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10649yields an unchanged string.
10650
10651
10652.vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10653.cindex "random number"
10654This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10655supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10656on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10657If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10658If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10659for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10660Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10661srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10662random().
10663
10664
10665.vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10666.cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10667This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10668dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
10669dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10670for DNS. For example,
10671.code
10672${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10673${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10674.endd
10675returns
10676.code
106774.2.0.192
10678f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10679.endd
10680
10681
10682.vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10683.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10684.cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10685.cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10686This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10687encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10688assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10689&%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
10690contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10691characters
10692.code
10693? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10694.endd
10695it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10696string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10697characters.
10698
10699
10700.vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10701.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10702.cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10703.cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10704This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10705bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10706character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10707not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10708
10709&*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10710access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10711to use this operator as well.
10712
10713
10714
10715.vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10716.cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10717.cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10718.cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10719The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10720characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10721variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10722
10723
10724.vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10725.cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10726.cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10727.cindex certificate fingerprint
10728.cindex "&%sha1%& expansion item"
10729The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10730it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10731
10732If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10733returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10734
10735
10736.vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10737.cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10738.cindex certificate fingerprint
10739.cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10740.cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
10741The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash value of the string
10742and returns
10743it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10744
10745If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10746returns the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10747
10748
10749.vitem &*${sha3:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10750 &*${sha3_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10751.cindex "SHA3 hash"
10752.cindex "expansion" "SHA3 hashing"
10753.cindex "&%sha3%& expansion item"
10754The &%sha3%& operator computes the SHA3-256 hash value of the string
10755and returns
10756it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10757
10758If a number is appended, separated by an underbar, it specifies
10759the output length. Values of 224, 256, 384 and 512 are accepted;
10760with 256 being the default.
10761
10762The &%sha3%& expansion item is only supported if Exim has been
10763compiled with GnuTLS 3.5.0 or later,
10764or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later.
10765The macro "_CRYPTO_HASH_SHA3" will be defined if it is supported.
10766
10767
10768.vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10769.cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
10770.cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
10771.cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
10772The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
10773function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
10774expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
10775series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
10776except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
10777a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
1077810-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
10779&"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
10780can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
10781
10782The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
10783the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
10784systems for files larger than 2GB.
10785
10786.vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10787.cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
10788Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
10789
10790
10791
10792.vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10793.cindex "expansion" "string length"
10794.cindex "string" "length in expansion"
10795.cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
10796The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
10797decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
10798All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10799
10800
10801.vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10802.cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10803.cindex "substring extraction"
10804.cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
10805The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
10806can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
10807that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10808.code
10809${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
10810.endd
10811See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
10812abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
10813All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10814
10815.vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10816.cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
10817.cindex "time interval" "decoding"
10818This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
10819seconds.
10820
10821.vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10822.cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
10823.cindex "time interval" "formatting"
10824The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
10825represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
10826number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
10827&`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
10828
10829.vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10830.cindex "case forcing in strings"
10831.cindex "string" "case forcing"
10832.cindex "upper casing"
10833.cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10834.cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
10835This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
10836Case is defined per the system C locale.
10837
10838.vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10839.cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
10840.cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
10841.cindex "incorrect utf-8"
10842.cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
10843.cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
10844This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
10845.new
10846In versions of Exim before 4.92, this did not correctly do so for a truncated
10847final codepoint's encoding, and the character would be silently dropped.
10848If you must handle detection of this scenario across both sets of Exim behavior,
10849the complexity will depend upon the task.
10850For instance, to detect if the first character is multibyte and a 1-byte
10851extraction can be successfully used as a path component (as is common for
10852dividing up delivery folders), you might use:
10853.code
10854condition = ${if inlist{${utf8clean:${length_1:$local_part}}}{:?}{yes}{no}}
10855.endd
10856(which will false-positive if the first character of the local part is a
10857literal question mark).
10858.wen
10859
10860.vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10861 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10862 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
10863 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
10864.cindex expansion UTF-8
10865.cindex UTF-8 expansion
10866.cindex EAI
10867.cindex internationalisation
10868.cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
10869.cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
10870.cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
10871.cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
10872These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
10873For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
10874.endlist
10875
10876
10877
10878
10879
10880
10881.section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
10882.scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
10883The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
10884while expanding strings:
10885
10886.vlist
10887.vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
10888.cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
10889.cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
10890Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
10891condition.
10892
10893.vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10894.cindex "numeric comparison"
10895.cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
10896There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
10897are:
10898.display
10899&`= `& equal
10900&`== `& equal
10901&`> `& greater
10902&`>= `& greater or equal
10903&`< `& less
10904&`<= `& less or equal
10905.endd
10906For example:
10907.code
10908${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
10909.endd
10910Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
10911two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
10912optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
10913lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
10914As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
10915zero.
10916
10917In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
10918<&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
1091910M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
10920
10921
10922.vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
10923 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
10924.cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
10925.cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
10926The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
10927arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
10928Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
10929arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
10930and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
10931are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
10932a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
10933the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
10934If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
10935If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
10936
10937.vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10938.cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10939.cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
10940This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
10941a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
10942(case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
10943false if zero.
10944An empty string is treated as false.
10945Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
10946thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
10947All other string values will result in expansion failure.
10948
10949When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
10950make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
10951For example:
10952.code
10953${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
10954.endd
10955
10956
10957.vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10958.cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
10959.cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
10960Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
10961where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
10962loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
10963and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
10964true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
10965
10966Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
10967
10968.vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10969.cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
10970.cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
10971.cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
10972This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
10973authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
10974necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
10975included in the binary.
10976
10977The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
10978compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
10979be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
10980encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
10981does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
10982&[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
10983Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
10984string in LDAP form is:
10985.code
10986{md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
10987.endd
10988If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
10989be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
10990.code
10991${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
10992.endd
10993The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
10994supported:
10995
10996.ilist
10997.cindex "MD5 hash"
10998.cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
10999&%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11000printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11001length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
11002(as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
11003hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
11004comparison fails.
11005
11006.next
11007.cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11008&%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11009printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11010length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
11011If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
11012SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
11013
11014.next
11015.cindex "&[crypt()]&"
11016&%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
11017only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
11018systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
11019whatever its length.
11020
11021.next
11022.cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
11023&%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
11024use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
11025modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
11026.endlist
11027Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
11028&[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
11029HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
11030operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
11031the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
11032support &[crypt16()]&.
11033
11034Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
11035it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
11036turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
11037&[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
11038algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
11039
11040However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
11041functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
11042Exim is seen as very low priority.
11043
11044If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
11045comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
11046determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
11047default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
11048function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
11049
11050.vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
11051.cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
11052.cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
11053The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
11054variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
11055variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
11056.code
11057${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
11058.endd
11059Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
11060variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
11061
11062.vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
11063 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
11064.cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
11065This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
11066exists in the message. For example,
11067.code
11068${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
11069.endd
11070&*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
11071the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
11072
11073.vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11074 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11075.cindex "string" "comparison"
11076.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11077.cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
11078.cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
11079The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
11080resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
11081letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent, where
11082case is defined per the system C locale.
11083
11084.vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
11085.cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
11086.cindex "file" "existence test"
11087.cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
11088The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
11089condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
11090is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
11091users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
11092
11093.vitem &*first_delivery*&
11094.cindex "delivery" "first"
11095.cindex "first delivery"
11096.cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
11097.cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
11098This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
11099attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
11100
11101
11102.vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11103 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11104.cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11105.cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
11106.cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
11107.vindex "&$item$&"
11108These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
11109the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
11110the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
11111be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
11112condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
11113.ilist
11114For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
11115the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
11116items in the list, the overall condition is false.
11117.next
11118For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
11119and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
11120all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
11121.endlist
11122Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
11123items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
11124that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
11125list separator is changed to a comma:
11126.code
11127${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
11128.endd
11129The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
11130being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
11131
11132To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
11133
11134
11135.vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11136 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11137.cindex "string" "comparison"
11138.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11139.cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
11140.cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
11141The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11142string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
11143comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
11144case-independent.
11145Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11146
11147.vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11148 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11149.cindex "string" "comparison"
11150.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11151.cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
11152.cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
11153The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11154string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
11155includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
11156case-independent.
11157Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11158
11159.vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11160 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11161.cindex "string" "comparison"
11162.cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11163Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
11164strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
11165is true.
11166For the case-independent &%inlisti%& condition, case is defined per the system C locale.
11167
11168These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
11169Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
11170.code
11171${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
11172 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
11173${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
11174 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
11175.endd
11176
11177.vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11178 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11179 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11180.cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
11181.cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
11182.cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
11183.cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
11184.cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
11185The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
11186an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
11187&%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
11188
11189For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
11190which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
11191colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
11192hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
11193component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
11194
11195&*Note*&: The checks used to be just on the form of the address; actual numerical
11196values were not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passed the IPv4
11197check.
11198This is no longer the case.
11199
11200The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
11201host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
11202.code
11203${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
11204.endd
11205to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
11206
11207.vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
11208.cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
11209.cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
11210.cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
11211This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
11212&<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
11213queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
11214query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
11215password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
11216server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
11217with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
11218will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
11219of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
11220this can be used.
11221
11222
11223.vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11224 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11225.cindex "string" "comparison"
11226.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11227.cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
11228.cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
11229The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11230string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
11231comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
11232case-independent.
11233Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11234
11235.vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11236 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11237.cindex "string" "comparison"
11238.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11239.cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
11240.cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
11241The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11242string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
11243includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
11244case-independent.
11245Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11246
11247
11248.vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11249.cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
11250.cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
11251.cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
11252The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
11253expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
11254regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
11255escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
11256(curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
11257premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
11258&`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
11259For example,
11260.code
11261${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
11262.endd
11263If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
11264backslashes is also required.
11265
11266The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
11267The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
11268metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
11269and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
11270the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
11271metacharacter at an appropriate point.
11272All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware,
11273but we might change this in a future Exim release.
11274
11275.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
11276At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
11277substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
11278succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
11279will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
11280of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
11281combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
11282variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
11283
11284.vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11285.cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
11286See &*match_local_part*&.
11287
11288.vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11289.cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
11290See &*match_local_part*&.
11291
11292.vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11293.cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
11294This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
11295be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
11296address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
11297list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
11298.code
11299${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
11300.endd
11301The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
11302
11303.ilist
11304An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
11305.next
11306A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
11307.next
11308An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
11309useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
11310in a single test such as
11311. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11312. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
11313. ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
11314. ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
11315.code
11316 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
11317.endd
11318where the first item in the list is the empty string.
11319.next
11320The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
11321.next
11322Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
11323even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
11324address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
11325&*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
11326masks. For example:
11327.code
11328 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
11329.endd
11330It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
11331do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
11332address mask, for example:
11333.code
11334 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
11335.endd
11336However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
11337just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
11338.code
11339 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
11340.endd
11341.endlist ilist
11342
11343Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11344Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11345
11346Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
11347
11348.vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11349.cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
11350.cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
11351.cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
11352.cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
11353This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
11354possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
11355condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
11356example is:
11357.code
11358${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
11359.endd
11360In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
11361list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument
11362is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
11363Thus, you can use conditions like this:
11364.code
11365${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
11366.endd
11367.cindex "&`+caseful`&"
11368For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
11369item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
11370have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
11371caselessly.
11372
11373Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11374Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11375
11376&*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
11377hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
11378how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
11379matched using &%match_ip%&.
11380
11381.vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
11382.cindex "PAM authentication"
11383.cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
11384.cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
11385.cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
11386.cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
11387&'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
11388(&url(https://mirrors.edge.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
11389available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
11390distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
11391the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
11392.code
11393SUPPORT_PAM=yes
11394.endd
11395in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
11396in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
11397
11398The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
11399colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
11400The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
11401taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
11402The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
11403from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
11404request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
11405
11406There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
11407characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
11408separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
11409item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
11410of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
11411.code
11412server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
11413.endd
11414For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
11415.code
11416server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
11417.endd
11418In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
11419running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
11420messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
11421. --- 2018-09-07: the pam_exim modified variant has gone, removed claims re using Exim via that
11422
11423
11424.vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11425.cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
11426.cindex "Cyrus"
11427.cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
11428.cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
11429This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
11430This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
11431that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
11432deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
11433
11434The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11435the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11436building Exim. For example:
11437.code
11438CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
11439.endd
11440You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11441the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11442from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
11443access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
11444
11445The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
11446password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
11447configuration, you might have this:
11448.code
11449server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
11450.endd
11451Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
11452.code
11453server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
11454.endd
11455.vitem &*queue_running*&
11456.cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
11457.cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
11458.cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
11459This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
11460initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
11461
11462
11463.vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
11464.cindex "Radius"
11465.cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
11466.cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11467Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11468set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11469the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11470support.
11471
11472With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11473library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11474this library, you need to set
11475.code
11476RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11477.endd
11478in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11479&%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11480.code
11481RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11482.endd
11483in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11484You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11485Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11486
11487The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11488Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11489the authentication is successful. For example:
11490.code
11491server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11492.endd
11493
11494
11495.vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11496 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11497.cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11498.cindex "Cyrus"
11499.cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11500.cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11501This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11502daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11503Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11504by a process that is not running as root.
11505
11506The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11507the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11508building Exim. For example:
11509.code
11510CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11511.endd
11512You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11513the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11514from the Cyrus SASL library.
11515
11516Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11517two are mandatory. For example:
11518.code
11519server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11520.endd
11521The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11522in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11523realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11524.endlist vlist
11525
11526
11527
11528.section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11529.cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11530Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11531and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11532conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11533sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11534the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11535
11536
11537.vlist
11538.vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11539.cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11540.cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11541The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11542any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11543For example,
11544.code
11545${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11546.endd
11547When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11548evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11549numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11550
11551.vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11552.cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11553.cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11554The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11555all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11556sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11557the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11558parsed but not evaluated.
11559.endlist
11560.ecindex IIDexpcond
11561
11562
11563
11564
11565.section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11566.cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11567This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11568of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11569support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11570
11571.vlist
11572.vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11573.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11574When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11575captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11576processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11577In the expansion condition case
11578they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11579values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11580variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11581precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11582Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11583matching condition.
11584
11585.vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11586Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11587any arguments are copied to these variables,
11588any unused variables being made empty.
11589
11590.vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11591Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11592can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11593long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11594example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11595variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11596used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11597same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11598with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11599during subsequent delivery.
11600
11601.vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11602These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11603are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11604received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11605message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11606also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11607message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11608and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11609delivery.
11610
11611.vitem &$acl_narg$&
11612Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11613this variable has the number of arguments.
11614
11615.vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11616.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11617After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11618message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11619be preserved by coding like this:
11620.code
11621warn !verify = sender
11622 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11623.endd
11624You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11625&%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11626failure.
11627
11628.vitem &$address_data$&
11629.vindex "&$address_data$&"
11630This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11631value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11632and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11633the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11634for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11635user filter files.
11636
11637If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11638a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11639conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11640to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11641of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11642from the child's routing.
11643
11644If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11645sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11646&$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11647address.
11648
11649In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11650after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11651these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11652
11653.vitem &$address_file$&
11654.vindex "&$address_file$&"
11655When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11656to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11657is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11658default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11659.code
11660/home/r2d2/savemail
11661.endd
11662then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11663contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11664.cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11665For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11666then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11667to the relevant file.
11668
11669.vitem &$address_pipe$&
11670.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11671When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11672this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11673
11674.vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11675.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11676These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11677&<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11678
11679.vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11680.cindex "authentication" "id"
11681.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11682When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11683preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11684&$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11685user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11686in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11687&$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11688
11689When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11690the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11691process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11692command line option.
11693This second case also sets up inforamtion used by the
11694&$authresults$& expansion item.
11695
11696.vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11697.cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11698.vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11699When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11700will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11701id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11702available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11703A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11704authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11705the ACL's as well.
11706
11707
11708.vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11709.cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11710.cindex "authentication" "sender"
11711.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11712.vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11713When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11714SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11715described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11716&"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
11717available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
11718sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
11719
11720.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11721When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
11722value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
11723name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
11724can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
11725
11726
11727.vitem &$authentication_failed$&
11728.cindex "authentication" "failure"
11729.vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
11730This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
11731command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
11732possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
11733(&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
11734&"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
11735is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
11736negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
11737an undefined mechanism.
11738
11739.vitem &$av_failed$&
11740.cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
11741This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
11742extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
11743problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
11744the ACL malware condition.
11745
11746.vitem &$body_linecount$&
11747.cindex "message body" "line count"
11748.cindex "body of message" "line count"
11749.vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
11750When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11751number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
11752
11753.vitem &$body_zerocount$&
11754.cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
11755.cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
11756.cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11757.vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
11758When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11759number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
11760
11761.vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
11762.vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
11763This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
11764it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
11765chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11766
11767.vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
11768.vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
11769This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
11770up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
11771file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11772
11773.vitem &$caller_gid$&
11774.cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
11775.vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11776The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11777not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
11778&$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11779incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
11780
11781.vitem &$caller_uid$&
11782.cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
11783.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11784The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
11785not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
11786&$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
11787incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
11788
11789.vitem &$callout_address$&
11790.vindex "&$callout_address$&"
11791After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
11792address that was connected to.
11793
11794.vitem &$compile_number$&
11795.vindex "&$compile_number$&"
11796The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
11797of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
11798compilations of the same version of the program.
11799
11800.vitem &$config_dir$&
11801.vindex "&$config_dir$&"
11802The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
11803&$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
11804contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
11805&$config_dir$& is ".".
11806
11807.vitem &$config_file$&
11808.vindex "&$config_file$&"
11809The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
11810
11811.vitem &$dkim_verify_status$&
11812Results of DKIM verification.
11813For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
11814
11815.vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
11816 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
11817 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
11818 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
11819 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
11820 &$dkim_algo$& &&&
11821 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
11822 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
11823 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
11824 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
11825 &$dkim_created$& &&&
11826 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
11827 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
11828 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
11829 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
11830 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
11831 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
11832 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
11833 &$dkim_key_length$&
11834These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
11835For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
11836
11837.vitem &$dkim_signers$&
11838.vindex &$dkim_signers$&
11839When a message has been received this variable contains
11840a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
11841For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
11842
11843.vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
11844 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
11845 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
11846 &$dnslist_value$&
11847.vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
11848.vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
11849.vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
11850.vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
11851.cindex "black list (DNS)"
11852When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
11853the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
11854looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
11855main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
11856
11857.vitem &$domain$&
11858.vindex "&$domain$&"
11859When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
11860contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
11861case for &$domain$&.
11862
11863Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
11864&$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
11865is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
11866message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
11867
11868When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
11869RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
11870have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
11871at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
11872the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
11873which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
11874
11875.oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
11876At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
11877set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
11878
11879The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
11880
11881.ilist
11882When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
11883the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
11884&$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
11885normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
11886is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
11887&$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
11888the &(smtp)& transport.
11889
11890.next
11891When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
11892&$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
11893it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
11894rewrite domains by file lookup.
11895
11896.next
11897With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
11898&$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
11899a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
11900is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
11901that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
11902recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
11903
11904.next
11905.cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
11906.oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
11907When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
11908the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
11909.endlist
11910
11911
11912.vitem &$domain_data$&
11913.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
11914When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
11915means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
11916of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
11917address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
11918transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
11919used.
11920
11921&$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
11922domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
11923the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
11924to nothing.
11925
11926.vitem &$exim_gid$&
11927.vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
11928This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
11929
11930.vitem &$exim_path$&
11931.vindex "&$exim_path$&"
11932This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
11933
11934.vitem &$exim_uid$&
11935.vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
11936This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
11937
11938.vitem &$exim_version$&
11939.vindex "&$exim_version$&"
11940This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
11941The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
11942Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
11943There may be other characters following the minor version.
11944
11945.vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
11946This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
11947inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
11948be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
11949characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
11950
11951.vitem &$headers_added$&
11952.vindex "&$headers_added$&"
11953Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
11954the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
11955The headers are a newline-separated list.
11956
11957.vitem &$home$&
11958.vindex "&$home$&"
11959When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
11960directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
11961means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
11962explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
11963by a setting on the transport itself.
11964
11965When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
11966of the environment variable HOME, which is subject to the
11967&%keep_environment%& and &%add_environment%& main config options.
11968
11969.vitem &$host$&
11970.vindex "&$host$&"
11971If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
11972list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
11973to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
11974to local and remote transports.
11975
11976.cindex "transport" "filter"
11977.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11978For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
11979&$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
11980particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
11981using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
11982&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
11983is connected.
11984
11985When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
11986&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
11987client is connected.
11988
11989
11990.vitem &$host_address$&
11991.vindex "&$host_address$&"
11992This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
11993for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
11994when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
11995
11996.vitem &$host_data$&
11997.vindex "&$host_data$&"
11998If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
11999result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
12000allows you, for example, to do things like this:
12001.code
12002deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
12003message = $host_data
12004.endd
12005.vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12006.cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
12007.vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12008This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
12009message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
12010name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
12011variables is set to &"1"&.
12012
12013.ilist
12014If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
12015succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12016
12017.next
12018If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
12019tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
12020lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
12021.endlist ilist
12022
12023Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
12024single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
12025names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
12026is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
12027&$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
12028IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
12029sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
12030lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
12031the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
12032&"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
12033
12034.cindex authentication "expansion item"
12035Performing these checks sets up information used by the
12036&$authresults$& expansion item.
12037
12038
12039.vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
12040.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12041See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
12042
12043.vitem &$host_port$&
12044.vindex "&$host_port$&"
12045This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
12046for an outbound connection.
12047
12048.vitem &$initial_cwd$&
12049.vindex "&$initial_cwd$&
12050This variable contains the full path name of the initial working
12051directory of the current Exim process. This may differ from the current
12052working directory, as Exim changes this to "/" during early startup, and
12053to &$spool_directory$& later.
12054
12055.vitem &$inode$&
12056.vindex "&$inode$&"
12057The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
12058option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
12059of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
12060a unique name for the file.
12061
12062.vitem &$interface_address$&
12063.vindex "&$interface_address$&"
12064This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
12065
12066.vitem &$interface_port$&
12067.vindex "&$interface_port$&"
12068This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
12069
12070.vitem &$item$&
12071.vindex "&$item$&"
12072This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
12073conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
12074&*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
12075empty.
12076
12077.vitem &$ldap_dn$&
12078.vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
12079This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
12080contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
12081lookup.
12082
12083.vitem &$load_average$&
12084.vindex "&$load_average$&"
12085This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
12086is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
12087variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
12088
12089.vitem &$local_part$&
12090.vindex "&$local_part$&"
12091When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
12092variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
12093delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
12094session), &$local_part$& is not set.
12095
12096Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12097&$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
12098&$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
12099because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
12100once.
12101
12102.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12103.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12104.cindex affix variables
12105If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
12106value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
12107any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
12108&$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
12109
12110When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
12111result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
12112the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
12113&$address_pipe$&).
12114
12115When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
12116local part of the recipient address.
12117
12118When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12119&$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
12120it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
12121
12122In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
12123the addresses
12124.code
12125"abc:xyz"@test.example
12126abc\:xyz@test.example
12127.endd
12128the value of &$local_part$& is
12129.code
12130abc:xyz
12131.endd
12132If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
12133inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
12134have:
12135.code
12136data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
12137.endd
12138&*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
12139to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
12140&%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
12141
12142.vitem &$local_part_data$&
12143.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
12144When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
12145lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
12146router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
12147to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
12148handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
12149
12150&$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
12151matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
12152available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
12153variable expands to nothing.
12154
12155.vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
12156.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12157.cindex affix variables
12158When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12159specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12160variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12161
12162.vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
12163.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12164When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12165specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12166variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12167
12168.vitem &$local_scan_data$&
12169.vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
12170This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
12171a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
12172
12173.vitem &$local_user_gid$&
12174.vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
12175See &$local_user_uid$&.
12176
12177.vitem &$local_user_uid$&
12178.vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
12179This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
12180&%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
12181are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
12182and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
12183router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
12184are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
12185
12186.vitem &$localhost_number$&
12187.vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
12188This contains the expanded value of the
12189&%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
12190been read.
12191
12192.vitem &$log_inodes$&
12193.vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
12194The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
12195log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
12196referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
12197the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
12198
12199.vitem &$log_space$&
12200.vindex "&$log_space$&"
12201The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
12202partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
12203whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
12204ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
12205the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
12206
12207
12208.vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
12209.vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
12210This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
12211a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
12212.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12213It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
12214&"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
12215and &"yes"& if it was.
12216Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
12217the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
12218as authenticated data.
12219
12220.vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
12221.vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
12222This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
12223&(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
12224&%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
12225contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
12226without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
12227variable is empty.
12228
12229.vitem &$malware_name$&
12230.vindex "&$malware_name$&"
12231This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
12232content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
12233when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
12234
12235.vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
12236.vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
12237.cindex "maximum" "line length"
12238.cindex "line length" "maximum"
12239This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
12240received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
12241character(s).
12242It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12243
12244.vitem &$message_age$&
12245.cindex "message" "age of"
12246.vindex "&$message_age$&"
12247This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
12248of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
12249delivery attempt.
12250
12251.vitem &$message_body$&
12252.cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12253.cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12254.cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12255.vindex "&$message_body$&"
12256.oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
12257This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
12258being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
12259number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
12260&%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
12261
12262.oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
12263By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
12264easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
12265this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
12266zeros are always converted into spaces.
12267
12268.vitem &$message_body_end$&
12269.cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12270.cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12271.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
12272This variable contains the final portion of a message's
12273body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
12274&$message_body$&.
12275
12276.vitem &$message_body_size$&
12277.cindex "body of message" "size"
12278.cindex "message body" "size"
12279.vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
12280When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
12281in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
12282separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
12283also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12284
12285If the spool file is wireformat
12286(see the &%spool_files_wireformat%& main option)
12287the CRLF line-terminators are included in the count.
12288
12289.vitem &$message_exim_id$&
12290.vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
12291When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12292unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
12293An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
12294received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
12295line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
12296&`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
12297
12298.vitem &$message_headers$&
12299.vindex &$message_headers$&
12300This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
12301is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
12302lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
12303same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
12304
12305.vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
12306.vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
12307This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
12308contents of header lines is done.
12309
12310.vitem &$message_id$&
12311This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
12312
12313.vitem &$message_linecount$&
12314.vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
12315This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
12316message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
12317During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
12318number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
12319routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
12320&'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
12321lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
12322from the body is not counted.
12323
12324As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
12325appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
12326&$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
12327file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
12328header and the body).
12329
12330Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
12331.code
12332deny message = Too many lines in message header
12333 condition = \
12334 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
12335.endd
12336In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
12337message has not yet been received.
12338
12339This variable is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12340
12341.vitem &$message_size$&
12342.cindex "size" "of message"
12343.cindex "message" "size"
12344.vindex "&$message_size$&"
12345When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
12346most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
12347message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
12348deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
12349expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
12350doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
12351precise size of the file that has been written. See also
12352&$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12353
12354.cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
12355While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
12356contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
12357value may not, of course, be truthful.
12358
12359.vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
12360A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
12361available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
12362details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
12363
12364.vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
12365These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
12366of the &%add%& command in filter files.
12367
12368.vitem &$original_domain$&
12369.vindex "&$domain$&"
12370.vindex "&$original_domain$&"
12371When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12372same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
12373generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
12374variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
12375differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
12376aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
12377single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
12378
12379If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12380filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12381part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12382
12383.vitem &$original_local_part$&
12384.vindex "&$local_part$&"
12385.vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
12386When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12387same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
12388local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
12389part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
12390filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
12391the original address.
12392
12393If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
12394case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
12395This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
12396one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
12397delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
12398
12399If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12400filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12401part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12402
12403.vitem &$originator_gid$&
12404.cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
12405.cindex "sender" "gid"
12406.vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12407.vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
12408This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
12409message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
12410gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
12411normally the gid of the Exim user.
12412
12413.vitem &$originator_uid$&
12414.cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
12415.cindex "sender" "uid"
12416.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12417.vindex "&$originator_uid$&"
12418The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
12419messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
12420For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
12421user.
12422
12423.vitem &$parent_domain$&
12424.vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
12425This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
12426above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12427
12428.vitem &$parent_local_part$&
12429.vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
12430This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
12431(see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12432
12433.vitem &$pid$&
12434.cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
12435.vindex "&$pid$&"
12436This variable contains the current process id.
12437
12438.vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
12439.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12440.cindex "transport" "filter"
12441.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
12442This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
12443&`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
12444&(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
12445(described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
12446It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
12447variable"& error if encountered.
12448
12449.vitem &$primary_hostname$&
12450.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
12451This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
12452configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
12453a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
12454&[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
12455qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
12456
12457
12458.vitem &$proxy_external_address$& &&&
12459 &$proxy_external_port$& &&&
12460 &$proxy_local_address$& &&&
12461 &$proxy_local_port$& &&&
12462 &$proxy_session$&
12463These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
12464or SOCKS5 support.
12465For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
12466
12467.vitem &$prdr_requested$&
12468.cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
12469This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
12470current message, otherwise &"no"&.
12471
12472.vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
12473This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12474which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12475&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12476
12477.vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
12478This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12479which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12480&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12481
12482.vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
12483This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12484which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12485&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12486
12487.vitem &$qualify_domain$&
12488.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12489The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
12490
12491.vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
12492.vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12493The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12494or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12495
12496.vitem &$queue_name$&
12497.vindex &$queue_name$&
12498.cindex "named queues"
12499.cindex queues named
12500The name of the spool queue in use; empty for the default queue.
12501
12502.vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12503.vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12504When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12505RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12506RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12507
12508.vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12509.vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12510.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12511When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12512RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12513temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12514
12515.vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12516.vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12517When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12518RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12519permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12520
12521.vitem &$received_count$&
12522.vindex "&$received_count$&"
12523This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12524including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12525is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12526delivering.
12527
12528.vitem &$received_for$&
12529.vindex "&$received_for$&"
12530If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12531variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12532built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12533the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12534
12535.vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12536.vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12537As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12538variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12539is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12540&$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12541the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12542option.
12543
12544As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12545could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
12546on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12547values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12548messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12549time.
12550For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12551
12552.vitem &$received_port$&
12553.vindex "&$received_port$&"
12554See &$received_ip_address$&.
12555
12556.vitem &$received_protocol$&
12557.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12558When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
12559protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
12560by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
12561&"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
12562(encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
12563is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
12564connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
12565
12566Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
12567automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
12568&%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
12569encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
12570where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
12571STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
12572
12573The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
12574messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
12575identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
12576
12577.vitem &$received_time$&
12578.vindex "&$received_time$&"
12579This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
12580as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12581
12582.vitem &$recipient_data$&
12583.vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12584This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12585condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12586until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12587.display
12588&`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12589&`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12590.endd
12591&*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12592method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12593The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12594expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12595
12596.vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12597.vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12598In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
12599information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
12600
12601.ilist
12602&"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
12603was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
12604
12605.next
12606&"route"&: Routing failed.
12607
12608.next
12609&"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
12610or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12611MAIL).
12612
12613.next
12614&"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12615.next
12616
12617&"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12618.endlist
12619
12620The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12621rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12622
12623.vitem &$recipients$&
12624.vindex "&$recipients$&"
12625This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12626a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12627is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12628unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12629cases:
12630
12631.olist
12632In a system filter file.
12633.next
12634In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12635is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12636&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12637&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12638.next
12639From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12640.endlist
12641
12642
12643.vitem &$recipients_count$&
12644.vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12645When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12646envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12647from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12648increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12649
12650
12651.vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12652.vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12653This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12654&%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12655
12656.vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
12657.cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
12658When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
12659these variables contain the
12660captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
12661
12662
12663.vitem &$reply_address$&
12664.vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12665When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12666&'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12667contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12668white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12669decoding or character code translation takes place.
12670
12671.vitem &$return_path$&
12672.vindex "&$return_path$&"
12673When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12674the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12675in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12676same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12677mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
12678for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
12679address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
12680that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
12681the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
12682envelope sender.
12683
12684.vitem &$return_size_limit$&
12685.vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
12686This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
12687
12688.vitem &$router_name$&
12689.cindex "router" "name"
12690.cindex "name" "of router"
12691.vindex "&$router_name$&"
12692During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
12693
12694.vitem &$runrc$&
12695.cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
12696.vindex "&$runrc$&"
12697This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
12698&%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
12699assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
12700preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
12701reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
12702another.
12703
12704.vitem &$self_hostname$&
12705.oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
12706.vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
12707When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
12708local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
12709One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
12710happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
12711original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
12712
12713.vitem &$sender_address$&
12714.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
12715When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
12716that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
12717is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
12718value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
12719
12720.vitem &$sender_address_data$&
12721.vindex "&$address_data$&"
12722.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
12723If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12724sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
12725distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
12726after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
12727longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
12728
12729.vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
12730.vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
12731The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
12732
12733.vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
12734.vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
12735The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
12736
12737.vitem &$sender_data$&
12738.vindex "&$sender_data$&"
12739This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
12740in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
12741value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
12742this:
12743.display
12744&`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12745&`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
12746.endd
12747&*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12748method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12749The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12750expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12751
12752.vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
12753.vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
12754When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
12755name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
12756brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
12757enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
12758issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
12759looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
12760&%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
12761start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
12762verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
12763the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
12764the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
12765
12766.vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
12767.vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
12768This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
12769.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12770done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
12771
12772.vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
12773.vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
12774When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
12775command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
12776set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
12777the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
12778
12779.vitem &$sender_host_address$&
12780.vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
12781When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
12782this variable contains that
12783host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
12784
12785.vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
12786.vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
12787This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
12788driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
12789received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
12790&$authenticated_id$&.
12791
12792.vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
12793.vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
12794If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
12795(by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
12796otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
12797resolver library states that both
12798the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
12799other times, this variable is false.
12800
12801.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12802It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
12803library, by setting:
12804.code
12805dns_dnssec_ok = 1
12806.endd
12807
12808Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
12809validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
12810
12811If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
12812mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
12813
12814This requires that your system resolver library support EDNS0 (and that
12815DNSSEC flags exist in the system headers). If the resolver silently drops
12816all EDNS0 options, then this will have no effect. OpenBSD's asr resolver
12817is known to currently ignore EDNS0, documented in CAVEATS of asr_run(3).
12818
12819
12820.vitem &$sender_host_name$&
12821.vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
12822When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12823host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
12824other means, this variable is empty.
12825
12826.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12827If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
12828&$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
12829A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
12830via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
12831any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
12832&$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12833
12834.vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12835However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
12836DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
12837&$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
12838
12839Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
12840host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
12841in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12842is set to &"1"&.
12843
12844Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
12845maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
12846these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
12847following are true:
12848
12849.ilist
12850A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
12851.next
12852The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
12853configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
12854to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
12855.next
12856Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
12857that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
12858&<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
12859.next
12860The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
12861In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
12862EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
12863.next
12864The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
12865domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
12866. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
12867. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
12868.code
12869 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
12870.endd
12871which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
12872IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
12873.endlist
12874
12875
12876.vitem &$sender_host_port$&
12877.vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
12878When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
12879number that was used on the remote host.
12880
12881.vitem &$sender_ident$&
12882.vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
12883When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
12884identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
12885been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
12886called Exim.
12887
12888.vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
12889A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
12890&%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
12891&<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
12892
12893.vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
12894.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
12895.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
12896.vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
12897This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
12898either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
12899there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
12900there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
12901the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
12902followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
12903first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
12904the parentheses.
12905
12906There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
12907was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
12908address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
12909all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
12910into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
12911
12912.vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
12913.vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
12914In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
12915about the failure. The details are the same as for
12916&$recipient_verify_failure$&.
12917
12918.vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
12919.vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
12920This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12921been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
12922used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
12923on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
12924connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
12925
12926.vitem &$sending_port$&
12927.vindex "&$sending_port$&"
12928This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
12929been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
12930connections, see &$received_port$&.
12931
12932.vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
12933.vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
12934During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
12935host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
12936&$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
12937value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
12938
12939.vitem &$smtp_command$&
12940.vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
12941During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
12942entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
12943the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
12944.code
12945MAIL FROM:<>
12946MAIL FROM: <>
12947.endd
12948For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
12949command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
12950rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
12951the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
12952
12953.vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
12954.cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
12955.vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
12956While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
12957argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
12958space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
12959somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
12960
12961.vitem &$smtp_command_history$&
12962.cindex SMTP "command history"
12963.vindex "&$smtp_command_history$&"
12964A comma-separated list (with no whitespace) of the most-recent SMTP commands
12965received, in time-order left to right. Only a limited number of commands
12966are remembered.
12967
12968.vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
12969.vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
12970This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
12971daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
12972in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
12973connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
12974the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
12975never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
12976there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
12977single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
12978daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
12979
12980.vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
12981These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
12982that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
12983filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
12984example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
12985message is junk mail.
12986
12987.vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
12988A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
12989is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
12990&<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
12991
12992.vitem &$spf_header_comment$& &&&
12993 &$spf_received$& &&&
12994 &$spf_result$& &&&
12995 &$spf_result_guessed$& &&&
12996 &$spf_smtp_comment$&
12997These variables are only available if Exim is built with SPF support.
12998For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
12999
13000.vitem &$spool_directory$&
13001.vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
13002The name of Exim's spool directory.
13003
13004.vitem &$spool_inodes$&
13005.vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13006The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
13007being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
13008If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
13009is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
13010
13011.vitem &$spool_space$&
13012.vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13013The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
13014Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
13015variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
13016find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
13017value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
13018megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
13019.code
13020condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
13021.endd
13022See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
13023
13024
13025.vitem &$thisaddress$&
13026.vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
13027This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
13028command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
13029command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
13030interfaces to mail filtering'&.
13031
13032.vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
13033.vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
13034Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13035on the inbound connection; the meaning of
13036this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13037If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13038The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
13039when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
13040
13041The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
13042except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13043the outbound.
13044
13045.vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
13046.vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
13047Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13048on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
13049this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13050If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13051
13052.vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
13053.vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
13054.cindex certificate variables
13055This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13056inbound connection when the message was received.
13057It is only useful as the argument of a
13058&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13059or a &%def%& condition.
13060
13061&*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
13062when a list of more than one
13063file is used for &%tls_certificate%&, this variable is not reliable.
13064
13065.vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
13066.vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
13067This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13068inbound connection when the message was received.
13069It is only useful as the argument of a
13070&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13071or a &%def%& condition.
13072If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13073which is not the leaf.
13074
13075.vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
13076.vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
13077This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13078outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13079&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13080or a &%def%& condition.
13081
13082.vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
13083.vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
13084This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13085outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13086&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13087or a &%def%& condition.
13088If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13089which is not the leaf.
13090
13091.vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
13092.vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
13093This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
13094message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
13095
13096The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
13097except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13098the outbound.
13099
13100.vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
13101.vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
13102This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
13103outbound SMTP connection was made,
13104and &"0"& otherwise.
13105
13106.vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
13107.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13108.vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
13109When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13110connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
13111example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
13112received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
13113&$tls_in_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
13114non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
13115
13116The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
13117but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
13118becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
13119
13120.vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
13121.vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
13122This variable is
13123cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
13124and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
13125&<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
13126details of the &(smtp)& transport.
13127
13128.vitem &$tls_out_dane$&
13129.vindex &$tls_out_dane$&
13130DANE active status. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13131
13132.vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
13133.vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
13134When a message is received from a remote client connection
13135the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
13136.code
131370 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
131381 No response to request
131392 Response not verified
131403 Verification failed
131414 Verification succeeded
13142.endd
13143
13144.vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
13145.vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
13146When a message is sent to a remote host connection
13147the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
13148See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
13149
13150.vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
13151.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
13152.vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
13153.cindex certificate "extracting fields"
13154When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13155connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
13156the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13157&$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13158If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13159which is not the leaf.
13160
13161The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
13162except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13163the outbound.
13164
13165.vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
13166.vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
13167When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13168connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
13169the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13170&$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13171If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13172which is not the leaf.
13173
13174.vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
13175.vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
13176.vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
13177.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13178When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
13179Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
13180If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
13181some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
13182will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
13183a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
13184used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
13185
13186The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
13187except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13188the outbound.
13189
13190.vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
13191.vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
13192.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13193During outbound
13194SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
13195the transport.
13196
13197.vitem &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13198.vindex &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13199Bitfield of TLSA record types found. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13200
13201.vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
13202.vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
13203The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
13204files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
13205
13206.vitem &$tod_epoch$&
13207.vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
13208The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13209
13210.vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
13211.vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
13212The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13213
13214.vitem &$tod_full$&
13215.vindex "&$tod_full$&"
13216A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
13217+0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
13218positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
13219values for those that are behind (west).
13220
13221.vitem &$tod_log$&
13222.vindex "&$tod_log$&"
13223The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
132241995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
13225
13226.vitem &$tod_logfile$&
13227.vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
13228This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
13229is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
13230flag.
13231
13232.vitem &$tod_zone$&
13233.vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
13234This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
13235-0500.
13236
13237.vitem &$tod_zulu$&
13238.vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
13239This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
13240by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
13241
13242.vitem &$transport_name$&
13243.cindex "transport" "name"
13244.cindex "name" "of transport"
13245.vindex "&$transport_name$&"
13246During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
13247
13248.vitem &$value$&
13249.vindex "&$value$&"
13250This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
13251or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
13252&*reduce*& expansion.
13253
13254.vitem &$verify_mode$&
13255.vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
13256While a router or transport is being run in verify mode or for cutthrough delivery,
13257contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
13258Otherwise, empty.
13259
13260.vitem &$version_number$&
13261.vindex "&$version_number$&"
13262The version number of Exim.
13263
13264.vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
13265.vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
13266This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13267delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13268
13269.vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
13270.vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
13271This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13272delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13273.endlist
13274.ecindex IIDstrexp
13275
13276
13277
13278. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13279. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13280
13281.chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
13282.scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
13283Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
13284Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
13285use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
13286your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
13287the line
13288.code
13289EXIM_PERL = perl.o
13290.endd
13291in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
13292
13293
13294.section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
13295.oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
13296Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
13297&%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
13298no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
13299interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
13300the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
13301option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
13302a newly created Perl interpreter.
13303
13304The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
13305need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
13306should usually be something like
13307.code
13308perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
13309.endd
13310where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
13311use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
13312soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
13313the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
13314its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
13315fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
13316necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
13317the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
13318two ways:
13319
13320.ilist
13321.oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
13322Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
13323a startup when Exim is entered.
13324.next
13325The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
13326overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
13327.endlist
13328
13329There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
13330initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
13331
13332.ilist
13333.oindex "&%perl_taintmode%&"
13334.cindex "Perl" "taintmode"
13335To provide more security executing Perl code via the embedded Perl
13336interpreter, the &%perl_taintmode%& option can be set. This enables the
13337taint mode of the Perl interpreter. You are encouraged to set this
13338option to a true value. To avoid breaking existing installations, it
13339defaults to false.
13340
13341
13342.section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
13343When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
13344of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
13345by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
13346forms:
13347.code
13348${perl{foo}}
13349${perl{foo}{argument}}
13350${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
13351.endd
13352which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
13353arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
13354with an error message of the form
13355.code
13356Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
13357.endd
13358The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
13359it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
13360return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
13361an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
13362by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
13363that was passed to &%die%&.
13364
13365
13366.section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
13367Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
13368is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
13369the Perl code
13370.code
13371my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
13372.endd
13373makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
13374Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
13375&$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
13376
13377If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
13378&'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
13379expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
13380an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
13381
13382.cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
13383.cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
13384Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
13385&'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
13386debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
13387&'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
13388timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
13389
13390
13391.section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
13392.cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
13393You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
13394Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
13395before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
13396SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
13397is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
13398error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
13399avoided, but the output is lost.
13400
13401.cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
13402The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
13403Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
13404you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
13405output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
13406change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
13407For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
13408.code
13409$SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
13410.endd
13411Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
13412example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
13413include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
13414as the first subroutine argument.
13415.ecindex IIDperl
13416
13417
13418. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13419. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13420
13421.chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
13422 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
13423 "Starting the daemon"
13424.cindex "daemon" "starting"
13425.cindex "interface" "listening"
13426.cindex "network interface"
13427.cindex "interface" "network"
13428.cindex "IP address" "for listening"
13429.cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
13430.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
13431.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13432A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
13433hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
13434or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
13435works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
13436In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
13437IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
13438knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
13439
13440.olist
13441When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
13442and ports to listen on.
13443.next
13444When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
13445are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
13446processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
13447same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
13448when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
13449local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
13450option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
13451as an error situation.
13452.next
13453When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
13454for the outgoing connection.
13455.endlist
13456
13457
13458Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
13459of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
13460addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
13461standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
13462rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
13463
13464In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
13465interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
13466options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
13467chapter describes how they operate.
13468
13469When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
13470actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
13471
13472
13473
13474.section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
13475When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
13476option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
13477following options:
13478
13479.ilist
13480&%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
13481or service names.
13482(For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
13483.next
13484&%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
13485listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
13486.endlist
13487
13488The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
13489described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
13490it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
13491colons. For example:
13492.code
13493local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
13494 192.168.23.65 ; \
13495 ::1 ; \
13496 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
13497.endd
13498There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
13499in &%local_interfaces%&:
13500
13501.olist
13502The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
13503on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
13504.code
13505local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
13506 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
13507.endd
13508.next
13509The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
13510with a colon separator, for example:
13511.code
13512local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
13513 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
13514.endd
13515.endlist
13516
13517When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
13518default setting contains just one port:
13519.code
13520daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13521.endd
13522If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
13523specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
13524&%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
13525&_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
13526IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
13527
13528
13529
13530.section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
13531The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
13532as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
13533case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
13534instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
13535default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13536.code
13537local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13538.endd
13539when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
13540.code
13541local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13542.endd
13543Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
13544
13545
13546
13547.section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
13548The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
13549&%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
13550instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
13551option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
13552the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
13553exim.
13554
13555The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
13556changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
13557contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
13558&%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
13559items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13560replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
13561.code
13562-oX 1225
13563.endd
13564overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
13565whereas
13566.code
13567-oX 192.168.34.5.1125
13568.endd
13569overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
13570(However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
13571value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
13572
13573
13574
13575.section "Support for the submissions (aka SSMTP or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
13576.cindex "submissions protocol"
13577.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
13578.cindex "smtps protocol"
13579.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
13580.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
13581Exim supports the use of TLS-on-connect, used by mail clients in the
13582&"submissions"& protocol, historically also known as SMTPS or SSMTP.
13583For some years, IETF Standards Track documents only blessed the
13584STARTTLS-based Submission service (port 587) while common practice was to support
13585the same feature set on port 465, but using TLS-on-connect.
13586If your installation needs to provide service to mail clients
13587(Mail User Agents, MUAs) then you should provide service on both the 587 and
13588the 465 TCP ports.
13589
13590If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a list of port numbers or
13591service names, connections to those ports must first establish TLS, before
13592proceeding to the application layer use of the SMTP protocol.
13593
13594The common use of this option is expected to be
13595.code
13596tls_on_connect_ports = 465
13597.endd
13598per RFC 8314.
13599There is also a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports
13600to behave in this way when a daemon is started.
13601
13602&*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
13603daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
13604&%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
13605because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
13606connections via the daemon.)
13607
13608
13609
13610
13611.section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
13612.cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
13613IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
13614can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
13615interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
13616address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
13617percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
13618adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
13619.code
13620fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
13621.endd
13622To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
13623allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
13624to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
13625percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
13626address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
13627&[getaddrinfo()]&. If
13628.code
13629IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
13630.endd
13631is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
13632Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
13633instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
13634function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
13635&[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
13636
13637.section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
13638.cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13639Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
13640run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
13641using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
13642connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
13643.oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
13644&%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13645activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13646that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
13647etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13648to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13649
13650On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
13651disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
13652option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
13653and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
13654IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
13655
13656
13657
13658.section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
13659The default case in an IPv6 environment is
13660.code
13661daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13662local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13663.endd
13664This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
13665Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
13666the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
13667read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
13668
13669To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
13670.code
13671daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
13672.endd
13673(leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
13674.code
13675local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
13676 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
13677.endd
13678To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
13679IPv4 loopback address only:
13680.code
13681local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
13682.endd
13683To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
13684.code
13685local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
13686.endd
13687&*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
13688
13689
13690
13691.section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
13692The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
13693whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
13694addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
13695treated as local.
13696
13697For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
13698the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
13699available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
13700(that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
13701
13702Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
13703many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
13704email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
13705interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
13706&%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
13707&"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
13708used for listening. Consider this example:
13709.code
13710local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
13711 192.168.53.235 ; \
13712 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
13713
13714extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13715.endd
13716The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
13717address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
13718Exim is routing.
13719
13720In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
13721address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
13722desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
13723these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
13724This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
13725during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
13726host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
13727addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
13728
13729
13730
13731.section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
13732Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
13733allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
13734there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
13735&%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
13736description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
13737details.
13738
13739
13740
13741
13742. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13743. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13744
13745.chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
13746.scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
13747.scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
13748The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
13749
13750.ilist
13751Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
13752&<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
13753.next
13754Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
13755&"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
13756section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
13757.next
13758Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
13759(with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
13760&"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
13761only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
13762settings.
13763.endlist
13764
13765This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
13766types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
13767in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
13768are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
13769an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
13770listed in more than one group.
13771
13772.section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
13773.table2
13774.row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
13775.row &%debug_store%& "do extra internal checks"
13776.row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
13777.row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
13778.row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
13779.row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
13780.row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
13781.row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
13782.row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
13783.row &%spool_wireformat%& "use wire-format spool data files when possible"
13784.row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
13785.endtable
13786
13787
13788.section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
13789.table2
13790.row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
13791.row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13792.row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
13793.row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
13794.row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
13795.row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
13796.endtable
13797
13798
13799
13800.section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
13801.table2
13802.row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
13803.row &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& "require admin for various checks"
13804.row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
13805.row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
13806.row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13807.row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
13808.row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
13809.row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
13810.row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
13811.row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
13812.row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
13813.row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
13814.endtable
13815
13816
13817
13818.section "Logging" "SECID99"
13819.table2
13820.row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
13821.row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
13822.row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13823.row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
13824.row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
13825.row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
13826.row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
13827.row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
13828.row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
13829.row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
13830.row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
13831.row &%syslog_pid%& "pid in syslog lines"
13832.row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
13833.row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
13834.row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
13835.endtable
13836
13837
13838
13839.section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
13840.table2
13841.row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
13842.row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
13843.row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
13844.row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
13845.endtable
13846
13847
13848
13849.section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
13850.table2
13851.row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
13852.row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13853.row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
13854.row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
13855.row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
13856.row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
13857.row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
13858.row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
13859.row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
13860.row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
13861.row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
13862.row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
13863.row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
13864.row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
13865.row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
13866.endtable
13867
13868
13869
13870.section "Message ids" "SECID102"
13871.table2
13872.row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
13873.row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
13874.endtable
13875
13876
13877
13878.section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
13879.table2
13880.row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
13881.row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
13882.row &%perl_taintmode%& "enable taint mode in Perl"
13883.endtable
13884
13885
13886
13887.section "Daemon" "SECID104"
13888.table2
13889.row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
13890.row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
13891.row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
13892.row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
13893.row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
13894.row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
13895.row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13896.endtable
13897
13898
13899
13900.section "Resource control" "SECID105"
13901.table2
13902.row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13903.row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
13904.row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
13905.row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
13906.row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
13907.row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
13908.row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
13909.row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
13910.row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
13911.row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
13912.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
13913.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
13914.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
13915.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
13916.row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
13917.row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
13918 connection"
13919.row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
13920.row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
13921.row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
13922.row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
13923.row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
13924.endtable
13925
13926
13927
13928.section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
13929.table2
13930.row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
13931.row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
13932.row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
13933.row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
13934.row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
13935.row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
13936.row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
13937.row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
13938.row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
13939.row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
13940.row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
13941.row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
13942.row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
13943.row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
13944.row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
13945.row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
13946.row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
13947.row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
13948.row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
13949.row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
13950.row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
13951.row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
13952 words""&"
13953.row &%dns_cname_loops%& "follow CNAMEs returned by resolver"
13954.row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
13955.row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
13956.row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
13957.row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
13958.row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
13959.row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
13960.row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
13961.row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
13962.row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
13963.row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
13964.row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
13965.row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
13966.row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
13967.row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
13968.row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
13969.row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
13970.row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
13971.row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
13972.row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
13973.endtable
13974
13975
13976
13977.section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
13978.table2
13979.row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
13980 item"
13981.row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
13982 item"
13983.row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
13984.row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
13985.row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
13986.endtable
13987
13988
13989
13990.section "TLS" "SECID108"
13991.table2
13992.row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
13993.row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
13994.row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
13995.row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
13996.row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
13997.row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
13998.row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
13999.row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
14000.row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
14001.row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
14002.row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
14003.row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
14004.row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
14005.row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
14006.row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
14007.row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
14008.row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
14009.endtable
14010
14011
14012
14013.section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
14014.table2
14015.row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
14016.row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
14017.row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
14018.row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
14019.row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
14020.row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
14021.row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
14022.row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
14023.endtable
14024
14025
14026
14027.section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
14028.table2
14029.row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14030.row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14031.row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
14032.row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14033.row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
14034.row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
14035.row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
14036.row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
14037.endtable
14038
14039
14040
14041
14042.section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
14043.table2
14044.row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
14045.endtable
14046
14047
14048
14049
14050
14051.section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
14052See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
14053
14054.table2
14055.row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domain for which DKIM ACL is run"
14056.row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14057.row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14058.row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
14059.row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
14060.row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
14061.row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
14062.row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
14063.row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14064.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14065.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14066.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14067.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14068.row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14069.row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14070 connection"
14071.row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14072.row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
14073.row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
14074.row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14075.row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14076.row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
14077.row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
14078.row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
14079.row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
14080.row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
14081.row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
14082.row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
14083.row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
14084.row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
14085.row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14086.row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14087.endtable
14088
14089
14090
14091.section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
14092.table2
14093.row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
14094.row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
14095.row &%chunking_advertise_hosts%& "advertise CHUNKING to these hosts"
14096.row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
14097.row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
14098.row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
14099.row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14100.row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
14101.row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
14102.row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14103.endtable
14104
14105
14106
14107.section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
14108.table2
14109.row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
14110.row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
14111.row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
14112.row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14113 words""&"
14114.row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14115.row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14116.row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
14117.row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
14118.row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
14119.row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
14120.row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14121.row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
14122.row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
14123.row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
14124.endtable
14125
14126
14127
14128.section "System filter" "SECID115"
14129.table2
14130.row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
14131.row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
14132 directory"
14133.row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
14134.row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
14135.row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
14136.row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
14137.row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
14138.endtable
14139
14140
14141
14142.section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
14143.table2
14144.row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14145.row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
14146.row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
14147.row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
14148.row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
14149.row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
14150.row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
14151.row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
14152.row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
14153.row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
14154.row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
14155.row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
14156.row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
14157.row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
14158.row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
14159.row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14160.row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
14161.row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
14162.row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
14163.row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
14164.row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14165.row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
14166.row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
14167.row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
14168.endtable
14169
14170
14171
14172.section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
14173.table2
14174.row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
14175.row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
14176.row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
14177.row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
14178.row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
14179.row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
14180.row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
14181.row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
14182.row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
14183.row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
14184.row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
14185.row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
14186.row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
14187.row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14188.row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
14189.endtable
14190
14191
14192
14193.section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
14194Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
14195&dagger;.
14196
14197.option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
14198.cindex "8BITMIME"
14199.cindex "8-bit characters"
14200.cindex "log" "selectors"
14201.cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
14202This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
14203EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
14204However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
14205takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
14206
14207Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
14208feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
14209It now defaults to true.
14210A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
14211.display
14212&url(https://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
14213.endd
14214
14215To log received 8BITMIME status use
14216.code
14217log_selector = +8bitmime
14218.endd
14219
14220.option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
14221.cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
14222.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14223This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
14224read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14225further details.
14226
14227.option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14228This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
14229messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
14230SMTP messages.
14231
14232.option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
14233.cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
14234.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14235This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
14236non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14237
14238.option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
14239.cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
14240.cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
14241This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
14242received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14243
14244.option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
14245.cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
14246This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
14247See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14248
14249.option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
14250.cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
14251This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
14252processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
14253acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14254
14255.option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
14256.cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
14257.cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
14258.cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
14259.cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
14260This option defines the ACL that,
14261if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
14262is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
14263processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
14264acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14265
14266.option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
14267.cindex DKIM "ACL for"
14268This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
14269(by default, or as specified in the dkim_verify_signers option)
14270of a received message.
14271See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>& for further details.
14272
14273.option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
14274.cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
14275This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
14276received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14277
14278.option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
14279.cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
14280This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
14281received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14282
14283.option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
14284.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
14285.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
14286This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
14287command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14288
14289
14290.option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
14291.cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
14292This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
14293received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14294
14295.option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
14296.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
14297This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
14298a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
14299&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
14300
14301.option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14302.cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
14303This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
14304extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
14305section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
14306
14307.option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
14308.cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
14309This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
14310ends without a QUIT command being received.
14311See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14312
14313.option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
14314This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
14315received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14316further details.
14317
14318.option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
14319.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
14320This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
14321received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14322
14323.option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
14324.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
14325This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
14326received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14327
14328.option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
14329.cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
14330This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
14331received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14332
14333.option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
14334.cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
14335This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
14336received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14337
14338.option add_environment main "string list" empty
14339.cindex "environment" "set values"
14340This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
14341currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use.
14342See &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the environment of &(pipe)& transports.
14343
14344.option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
14345.cindex "admin user"
14346This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
14347current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
14348colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
14349programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
14350admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
14351not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
14352To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
14353
14354.option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
14355.cindex "domain literal"
14356If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
14357email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
14358format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
14359has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
14360
14361Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
14362format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
14363addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
14364&%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
14365domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
14366configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
14367the local host's IP addresses.
14368
14369
14370.option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
14371.cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
14372It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
14373and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
14374MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
14375that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
14376practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
14377&%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
14378recommended, except when you have no other choice.
14379
14380.option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
14381.cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
14382.cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
14383Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
14384camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
14385that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
14386experiment if they wish.
14387
14388If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
14389UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
14390letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
14391enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
14392adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
14393suitable setting is:
14394.code
14395dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
14396 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
14397.endd
14398Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
14399.code
14400dns_check_names_pattern =
14401.endd
14402That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
14403
14404
14405.option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14406.cindex "authentication" "advertising"
14407.cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
14408If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
14409response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
14410Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
14411Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
14412advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
14413authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
14414&%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
14415authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
14416
14417Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
14418and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
14419not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
14420authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
14421to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
14422which Exim advertises AUTH.
14423
14424.cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
14425If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
14426is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
14427option is expanded, with a setting like this:
14428.code
14429auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
14430.endd
14431.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
14432If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
14433the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
14434expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
14435
14436
14437.option auto_thaw main time 0s
14438.cindex "thawing messages"
14439.cindex "unfreezing messages"
14440If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
14441new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
14442this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
14443being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
14444saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
14445
14446&*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
14447&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
14448thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
14449
14450
14451.option av_scanner main string "see below"
14452This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
14453It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
14454.code
14455sophie:/var/run/sophie
14456.endd
14457If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
14458before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
14459
14460
14461.option bi_command main string unset
14462.oindex "&%-bi%&"
14463This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
14464the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
14465just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
14466required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
14467
14468
14469.option bounce_message_file main string unset
14470.cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
14471.cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
14472This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
14473for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
14474chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
14475
14476
14477.option bounce_message_text main string unset
14478When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
14479message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
14480delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
14481
14482.option bounce_return_body main boolean true
14483.cindex "bounce message" "including body"
14484This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
14485bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
14486causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
14487value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
14488message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
14489error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
14490point at which the error was detected are returned.
14491.cindex "bounce message" "including original"
14492
14493.option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
14494.cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
14495.cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
14496.cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
14497This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
14498that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
14499when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
14500The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
14501If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
14502treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
14503
14504The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
14505during reception of a message.
14506In this case lines from the original are truncated.
14507
14508The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
14509
14510
14511.option bounce_return_message main boolean true
14512If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
14513bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
14514&%bounce_return_body%&.
14515
14516
14517.option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
14518.cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
14519.cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
14520.cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
14521This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
14522senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
14523limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
14524any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
14525that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
14526
14527When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
14528greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
14529added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
14530to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
14531size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
14532messages.
14533
14534.option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
14535.cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
14536.cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
14537.cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
14538This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
14539bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
14540connection. A typical setting might be:
14541.code
14542bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14543.endd
14544which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
14545.code
14546MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14547.endd
14548The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
14549address.
14550
14551.option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
14552.cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
14553.cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
14554This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
14555domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14556section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14557
14558
14559.option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
14560This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
14561domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14562section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14563
14564
14565.option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
14566This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
14567address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14568section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14569
14570
14571.option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
14572This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
14573address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14574section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14575
14576
14577.option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
14578This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
14579callout verification. The default value is
14580.code
14581$primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
14582.endd
14583See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
14584
14585
14586.option check_log_inodes main integer 100
14587See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14588
14589
14590.option check_log_space main integer 10M
14591See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14592
14593.oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
14594.cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
14595.option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
14596RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
14597system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
14598word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
14599multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
14600exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
14601of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
14602set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
14603
14604
14605.option check_spool_inodes main integer 100
14606See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14607
14608
14609.option check_spool_space main integer 10M
14610.cindex "checking disk space"
14611.cindex "disk space, checking"
14612.cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14613The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
14614message is accepted.
14615
14616.vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
14617.vindex "&$log_space$&"
14618.vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14619.vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14620When any of these options are nonzero, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
14621want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
14622testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
14623&$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
14624
14625
14626&%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
14627either value is greater than zero, for example:
14628.code
14629check_spool_space = 100M
14630check_spool_inodes = 100
14631.endd
14632The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
14633SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
14634transit.
14635
14636&%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
14637files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
14638&%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
14639
14640If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
14641incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
14642error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
14643SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
14644&%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
14645&%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
14646
14647The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
14648number of kilobytes (though specified in bytes).
14649If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
14650
14651For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
14652failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
14653it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
14654
14655There is a slight performance penalty for these checks.
14656Versions of Exim preceding 4.88 had these disabled by default;
14657high-rate installations confident they will never run out of resources
14658may wish to deliberately disable them.
14659
14660.option chunking_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14661.cindex CHUNKING advertisement
14662.cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
14663The CHUNKING extension (RFC3030) will be advertised in the EHLO message to
14664these hosts.
14665Hosts may use the BDAT command as an alternate to DATA.
14666
14667.option commandline_checks_require_admin main boolean &`false`&
14668.cindex "restricting access to features"
14669This option restricts various basic checking features to require an
14670administrative user.
14671This affects most of the &%-b*%& options, such as &%-be%&.
14672
14673.option debug_store main boolean &`false`&
14674.cindex debugging "memory corruption"
14675.cindex memory debugging
14676This option, when true, enables extra checking in Exim's internal memory
14677management. For use when a memory corruption issue is being investigated,
14678it should normally be left as default.
14679
14680.option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
14681.cindex "port" "for daemon"
14682.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14683This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
14684listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
14685backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
14686
14687.option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
14688.cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
14689This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
14690the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
14691(typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
14692defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
14693&%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
14694
14695.option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
14696See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
14697
14698.option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
14699.cindex "warning of delay"
14700.cindex "delay warning, specifying"
14701.cindex "queue" "delay warning"
14702When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
14703intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
14704after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
14705string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
14706message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
14707between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
14708with
14709.code
14710delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
14711.endd
14712the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
14713the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
14714because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
14715just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
14716.code
14717delay_warning = 6h
14718.endd
14719messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
14720a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
14721.code
14722delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
14723.endd
14724Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
14725which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
14726Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
14727
14728.option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
14729.vindex "&$domain$&"
14730The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
14731deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
14732expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
14733forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
14734&"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
14735not sent. The default is:
14736.code
14737delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
14738 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
14739 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
14740 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
14741 } {no}{yes}}
14742.endd
14743This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
14744&'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
14745&"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
14746&"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
14747
14748.option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
14749.cindex "unprivileged delivery"
14750.cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
14751If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
14752delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
14753the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
14754of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
14755chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
14756
14757.option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
14758.cindex "load average"
14759.cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
14760When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
14761becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
14762ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
14763See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14764
14765
14766.option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
14767.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
14768Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
14769message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14770handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
14771should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
14772removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
14773occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14774
14775.option disable_fsync main boolean false
14776.cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
14777This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
14778ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
14779a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
14780build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
14781really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
14782distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
14783
14784When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
14785updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
14786such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
14787Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
14788
14789
14790.option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
14791.cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14792If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14793activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14794that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
14795etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14796to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14797
14798
14799.option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
14800.cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
14801This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
14802It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
14803the ACL once for each signature in the message.
14804See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
14805
14806
14807.option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
14808.cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
14809DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
14810&"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
14811keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
14812incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
14813may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
14814anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
14815This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
14816by a setting such as this:
14817.code
14818dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
14819.endd
14820This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
14821&[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
14822since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
14823&(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
14824when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
14825options are applied after this global option.
14826
14827.option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
14828.cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
14829When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
14830names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
14831the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
14832contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
14833a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
14834done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
14835value of this option. The default pattern is
14836.code
14837dns_check_names_pattern = \
14838 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
14839.endd
14840which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
14841they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
14842permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
14843accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
14844&%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
14845empty string.
14846
14847.option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
14848This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
14849DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14850
14851.option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
14852This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
14853reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
14854section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
14855
14856.new
14857.option dns_cname_loops main integer 1
14858.cindex DNS "CNAME following"
14859This option controls the following of CNAME chains, needed if the resolver does
14860not do it internally.
14861As of 2018 most should, and the default can be left.
14862If you have an ancient one, a value of 10 is likely needed.
14863
14864The default value of one CNAME-follow is needed
14865thanks to the observed return for an MX request,
14866given no MX presence but a CNAME to an A, of the CNAME.
14867.wen
14868
14869
14870.option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
14871.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14872.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14873If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14874DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
14875default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
14876
14877If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
14878
14879
14880.option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
14881.cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
14882.cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
14883.cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
14884When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
14885looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
14886(A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
14887domain matches this list.
14888
14889This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
14890not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
14891servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
14892
14893
14894.option dns_retrans main time 0s
14895.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14896.cindex timeout "dns lookup"
14897.cindex "DNS" timeout
14898The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
14899retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
14900defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
14901time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
14902totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
14903take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
14904parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
14905but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
14906to set in them.
14907See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
14908
14909
14910.option dns_retry main integer 0
14911See &%dns_retrans%& above.
14912
14913
14914.option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
14915.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14916.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
14917If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
14918(Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
14919DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
14920match with this expanded domain list.
14921
14922Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
14923authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
14924bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
14925mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
14926Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
14927a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
14928
14929Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
14930to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
14931zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
14932
14933If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
14934in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
14935authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
14936authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
14937record in the authoritative section is used instead.
14938
14939.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14940.option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
14941.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
14942.cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
14943.cindex "DNS" "OpenBSD
14944If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
14945DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
14946the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
14947on.
14948
14949If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
14950
14951OpenBSD's asr resolver routines are known to ignore the EDNS0 option; this
14952means that DNSSEC will not work with Exim on that platform either, unless Exim
14953is linked against an alternative DNS client library.
14954
14955
14956.option drop_cr main boolean false
14957This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
14958handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
14959described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
14960
14961.option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14962.cindex "bounce messages" "success"
14963.cindex "DSN" "success"
14964.cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
14965DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
14966and accepted from, these hosts.
14967Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
14968and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
14969A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
14970A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
14971are sent.
14972
14973.option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
14974.cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
14975.cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
14976This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
14977bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
14978Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
14979.code
14980dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
14981.endd
14982The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
14983panic is logged, and the default value is used.
14984
14985.option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
14986.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
14987Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
14988message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
14989handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
14990message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
14991be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
14992the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
14993delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
14994
14995
14996.option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
14997.cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
14998.cindex "copy of bounce message"
14999Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
15000generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
15001coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
15002items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
15003a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
15004must be enclosed in double quotes.
15005
15006Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
15007(see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
15008the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
15009items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
15010are examined. For example:
15011.code
15012errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
15013 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
15014 postmaster@mydomain.example
15015.endd
15016.vindex "&$domain$&"
15017.vindex "&$local_part$&"
15018The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
15019and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
15020there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
15021.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
15022variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
15023
15024
15025.option errors_reply_to main string unset
15026.cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
15027By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
15028.display
15029&`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
15030.endd
15031.oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
15032where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
15033A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
15034&(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
15035overrides the default.
15036
15037Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
15038&%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
15039and warning messages. For example:
15040.code
15041errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
15042.endd
15043The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
15044address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
15045&%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
15046own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
15047not used.
15048
15049
15050.option event_action main string&!! unset
15051.cindex events
15052This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
15053For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
15054
15055
15056.option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
15057.cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
15058.cindex "Exim group"
15059This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15060privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
15061option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
15062of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
15063configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
15064security issues.
15065
15066
15067.option exim_path main string "see below"
15068.cindex "Exim binary, path name"
15069This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
15070needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
15071the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
15072is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
15073other place.
15074&*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
15075you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
15076where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
15077settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
15078
15079
15080.option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
15081.cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
15082.cindex "Exim user"
15083This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15084privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
15085time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
15086options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
15087
15088Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
15089&[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
15090not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
15091used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
15092
15093
15094.option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
15095This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
15096routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
15097&<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
15098
15099
15100. Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15101. for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15102
15103.option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
15104 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
15105.oindex "&%-t%&"
15106.cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
15107.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
15108According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
15109are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
15110envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
15111line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
15112behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
15113command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
15114&%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
15115argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
15116addresses.
15117
15118
15119.option finduser_retries main integer 0
15120.cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
15121On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
15122distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
15123related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
15124Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
15125errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
15126many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
15127retries.
15128
15129.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
15130You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
15131a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
15132search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
15133
15134
15135
15136.option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
15137.cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
15138On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
15139ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
15140delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
15141&%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
15142feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
15143warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
15144freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
15145is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
15146supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
15147message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
15148freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
15149log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
15150logging that you require.
15151
15152
15153.option gecos_name main string&!! unset
15154.cindex "HP-UX"
15155.cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
15156Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
15157password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
15158looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
15159headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
15160of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
15161it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
15162upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
15163
15164When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
15165expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
15166login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
15167user's name.
15168
15169.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
15170Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
15171pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
15172name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
15173.code
15174gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
15175gecos_name = $1
15176.endd
15177
15178.option gecos_pattern main string unset
15179See &%gecos_name%& above.
15180
15181
15182.option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
15183This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
15184server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
15185implementations of TLS.
15186
15187
15188.option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
15189This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
15190the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
15191
15192See
15193&url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
15194for documentation.
15195
15196
15197
15198.option headers_charset main string "see below"
15199This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
15200&"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
15201default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
15202ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
15203insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
15204
15205
15206
15207.option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
15208.cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
15209.cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
15210This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
15211section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
15212&_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
15213sections are rejected.
15214
15215
15216.option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
15217.cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
15218.cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
15219This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
15220all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
15221header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
15222zero means &"no limit"&.
15223
15224
15225
15226
15227.option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15228.cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
15229.cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
15230Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
15231mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
15232some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
15233this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
15234if you want to do semantic checking.
15235See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
15236set.
15237
15238
15239.option helo_allow_chars main string unset
15240.cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
15241.cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
15242.cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
15243This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
15244all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
15245hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
15246.code
15247helo_allow_chars = _
15248.endd
15249Note that the value is one string, not a list.
15250
15251
15252.option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
15253.cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15254.cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15255If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
15256list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
15257default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
15258its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
15259do.
15260
15261
15262.option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15263.cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
15264.cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
15265By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
15266&%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
15267to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
15268condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
15269Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
15270to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
15271necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
15272encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
15273Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
15274
15275When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
15276&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
15277EHLO command either:
15278
15279.ilist
15280is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
15281.next
15282.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
15283.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
15284matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
15285calling host address, or
15286.next
15287when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
15288.endlist
15289
15290However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
15291fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
15292be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
15293
15294If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
15295.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15296&$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
15297
15298.option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15299.cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
15300.cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
15301Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
15302backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
15303name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
15304&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
15305rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
15306If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
15307error.
15308
15309.option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15310.cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
15311.cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
15312This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
15313manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
15314&%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
15315verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
15316item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
15317it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
15318
15319This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
15320delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
15321configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
15322domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
15323&%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
15324
15325A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
15326messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
15327time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
15328retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
15329
15330
15331.option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
15332.cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
15333Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
15334is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
15335&%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
15336option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
15337default configuration file contains
15338.code
15339host_lookup = *
15340.endd
15341which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
15342is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
15343
15344After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
15345has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
15346this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
15347
15348.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
15349.vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
15350After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
15351unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
15352&%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
15353&`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
15354
15355
15356.option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
15357This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
15358to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
15359first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
15360if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
15361if you want.
15362
15363&*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
15364multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
15365&_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
15366case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
15367
15368
15369
15370.option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
15371.cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
15372If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
15373as soon as the connection is made.
15374This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
15375nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
15376connections immediately.
15377
15378The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
15379ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
15380sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
15381incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
15382chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
15383
15384
15385.option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
15386.cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
15387This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
15388happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
15389you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
15390127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
15391the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
15392list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
15393local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
15394.code
15395hosts_connection_nolog = :
15396.endd
15397If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
15398
15399
15400
15401.option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
15402.cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
15403This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
15404connections. For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
15405
15406
15407.option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
15408.cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
15409.cindex "host" "treated as local"
15410If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
15411if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
15412records
15413or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
15414host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
15415
15416This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
15417&`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
15418section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
15419&(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
15420that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
15421chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
15422interfaces and recognizing the local host.
15423
15424
15425.option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
15426.cindex "InterBase" "server list"
15427This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
15428to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15429The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
15430
15431
15432
15433.option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
15434.cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
15435.cindex "discarding bounce message"
15436This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
15437that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
15438suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
15439
15440After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
15441because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
15442message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
15443the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
15444again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
15445bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
15446for frozen messages. For example,
15447.code
15448ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
15449.endd
15450retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
15451failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
15452failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
15453value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
15454dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
15455&%timeout_frozen_after%&.
15456
15457
15458.option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15459.cindex "&""From""& line"
15460.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15461Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
15462the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
15463message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
15464such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
15465match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
15466process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
15467&%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
15468
15469
15470.option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
15471See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
15472
15473.option keep_environment main "string list" unset
15474.cindex "environment" "values from"
15475This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
15476You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
15477these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
15478during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
15479installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
15480environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
15481external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
15482
15483Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
15484(&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
15485
15486WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
15487FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
15488unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
15489that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
15490
15491Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startup if you do not mention
15492&%keep_environment%& in your runtime configuration file and if your
15493current environment is not empty. Future versions may not issue that warning
15494anymore.
15495
15496See the &%add_environment%& main config option for a way to set
15497environment variables to a fixed value. The environment for &(pipe)&
15498transports is handled separately, see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for
15499details.
15500
15501
15502.option keep_malformed main time 4d
15503This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
15504have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
15505next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
15506logged.
15507
15508
15509.option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
15510.cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
15511.cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
15512This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
15513a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15514While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15515Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15516and constrained to be a directory.
15517
15518
15519.option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
15520.cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
15521.cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15522This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
15523a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15524While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15525Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15526and constrained to be a file.
15527
15528
15529.option ldap_cert_file main string unset
15530.cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
15531.cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15532This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
15533Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15534Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
15535
15536
15537.option ldap_cert_key main string unset
15538.cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
15539.cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
15540This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
15541to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15542Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
15543identity to be proven.
15544
15545
15546.option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
15547.cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
15548This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
15549the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
15550cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
15551
15552
15553.option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
15554.cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
15555This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
15556LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
15557details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
15558with LDAP support.
15559
15560
15561.option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
15562.cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
15563This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
15564A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
15565See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
15566Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
15567to hard/demand.
15568
15569
15570.option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
15571.cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
15572If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
15573connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
15574"STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
15575of SSL-on-connect.
15576In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
15577by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
15578This option is ignored for &`ldapi`& connections.
15579
15580
15581.option ldap_version main integer unset
15582.cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
15583This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
15584LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
15585-1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
15586the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
15587has been built with LDAP support.
15588
15589
15590
15591.option local_from_check main boolean true
15592.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
15593.cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
15594When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15595an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
15596checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
15597the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
15598
15599&*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
15600locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
15601&%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15602
15603You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
15604on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
15605&'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
15606and the default qualify domain.
15607
15608If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
15609and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
15610&'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
15611&%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
15612
15613.cindex "envelope sender"
15614These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
15615is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
15616&%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
15617
15618For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
15619request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
15620has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15621
15622
15623
15624
15625.option local_from_prefix main string unset
15626When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
15627matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
15628ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
15629done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
15630appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
15631&%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
15632example, if
15633.code
15634local_from_prefix = *-
15635.endd
15636is set, a &'From:'& line containing
15637.code
15638From: anything-user@your.domain.example
15639.endd
15640will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
15641matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
15642qualify domain.
15643
15644
15645.option local_from_suffix main string unset
15646See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
15647
15648
15649.option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
15650This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
15651listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
15652&<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
15653options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
15654&%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
15655&%local_interfaces%& is
15656.code
15657local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
15658.endd
15659when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
15660.code
15661local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
15662.endd
15663
15664.option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
15665.cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
15666.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
15667This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
15668&<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
15669the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
15670message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
15671non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
15672
15673
15674
15675.option local_sender_retain main boolean false
15676.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
15677When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15678an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
15679do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
15680also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
15681See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
15682&<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15683
15684
15685
15686
15687.option localhost_number main string&!! unset
15688.cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
15689.cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
15690.vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
15691Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
15692uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
15693value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
15694after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
15695host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
15696range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
15697systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
15698&$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
15699characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
15700time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
15701section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
15702
15703
15704
15705.option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
15706.cindex "log" "file path for"
15707This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
15708files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
15709when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
15710name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time,
15711or if the option is unset at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
15712they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
15713Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
15714section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
15715used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
15716variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
15717configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
15718&_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
15719early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
15720
15721
15722.option log_selector main string unset
15723.cindex "log" "selectors"
15724This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
15725writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
15726minus characters. For example:
15727.code
15728log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
15729.endd
15730A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
15731logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
15732
15733
15734.option log_timezone main boolean false
15735.cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
15736.vindex "&$tod_log$&"
15737.vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
15738By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
15739timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
15740in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
15741avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
15742&%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
15743timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
15744of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
15745&$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
15746another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
15747
15748
15749.option lookup_open_max main integer 25
15750.cindex "too many open files"
15751.cindex "open files, too many"
15752.cindex "file" "too many open"
15753.cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
15754.cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
15755This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
15756lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
15757Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
15758file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
15759recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
15760actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
15761as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
15762open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
15763&%lookup_open_max%&.
15764
15765
15766.option max_username_length main integer 0
15767.cindex "length of login name"
15768.cindex "user name" "maximum length"
15769.cindex "limit" "user name length"
15770Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
15771&[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
15772this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
15773an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
15774
15775
15776.option message_body_newlines main bool false
15777.cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
15778.cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
15779.vindex "&$message_body$&"
15780.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15781By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
15782the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
15783option is set true, this no longer happens.
15784
15785
15786.option message_body_visible main integer 500
15787.cindex "body of message" "visible size"
15788.cindex "message body" "visible size"
15789.vindex "&$message_body$&"
15790.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
15791This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
15792&$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
15793
15794
15795.option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
15796.cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
15797If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
15798(domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
15799locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
15800means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
15801Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
15802Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
15803replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
15804empty string, the option is ignored.
15805
15806
15807.option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
15808If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
15809the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
15810message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
15811take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
15812the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
15813it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
15814yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
15815before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
15816that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
15817means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
15818colons will become hyphens.
15819
15820
15821.option message_logs main boolean true
15822.cindex "message logs" "disabling"
15823.cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
15824If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
15825&_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
15826Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
15827minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
15828per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
15829which is not affected by this option.
15830
15831
15832.option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
15833.cindex "message" "size limit"
15834.cindex "limit" "message size"
15835.cindex "size" "of message, limit"
15836This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
15837value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
15838to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
15839TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
15840optionally followed by K or M.
15841
15842&*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
15843other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
15844the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
15845error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
15846&%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
15847
15848Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
15849exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
15850failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
15851an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
15852the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
15853message that an individual transport can process.
15854
15855If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
15856maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
15857failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
15858virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
15859probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
15860default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
15861some problems may result.
15862
15863A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
15864SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
15865SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
15866
15867
15868.option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
15869.cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
15870This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
15871.code
15872SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
15873.endd
15874in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
15875moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
15876and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
15877standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
15878lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
15879
15880
15881.option mua_wrapper main boolean false
15882Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
15883it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
15884contains a full description of this facility.
15885
15886
15887
15888.option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
15889.cindex "MySQL" "server list"
15890This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
15891be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
15892option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
15893
15894
15895.option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
15896This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
15897message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
15898recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
15899It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
15900safety precaution.
15901
15902When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
15903list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
15904the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
15905contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
15906can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
15907
15908If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
15909&%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
15910example is
15911.code
15912never_users = root:daemon:bin
15913.endd
15914Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
15915harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
15916transport driver.
15917
15918
15919.option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +single_dh_use +no_ticket"
15920.cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
15921This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
15922by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
15923each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
15924
15925This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
15926available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
15927The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
15928the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
15929list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
15930&"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
15931names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
15932
15933Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
15934SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
15935yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
15936adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
15937invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
15938
15939The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
15940
15941Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
15942"+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
15943with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
15944some now infamous attacks.
15945
15946Examples:
15947.code
15948# Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
15949openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
15950 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
15951
15952# Disable older protocol versions:
15953openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
15954.endd
15955
15956Possible options may include:
15957.ilist
15958&`all`&
15959.next
15960&`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
15961.next
15962&`cipher_server_preference`&
15963.next
15964&`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
15965.next
15966&`ephemeral_rsa`&
15967.next
15968&`legacy_server_connect`&
15969.next
15970&`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
15971.next
15972&`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
15973.next
15974&`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
15975.next
15976&`netscape_challenge_bug`&
15977.next
15978&`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
15979.next
15980&`no_compression`&
15981.next
15982&`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
15983.next
15984&`no_sslv2`&
15985.next
15986&`no_sslv3`&
15987.next
15988&`no_ticket`&
15989.next
15990&`no_tlsv1`&
15991.next
15992&`no_tlsv1_1`&
15993.next
15994&`no_tlsv1_2`&
15995.next
15996&`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
15997.next
15998&`single_dh_use`&
15999.next
16000&`single_ecdh_use`&
16001.next
16002&`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
16003.next
16004&`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
16005.next
16006&`tls_block_padding_bug`&
16007.next
16008&`tls_d5_bug`&
16009.next
16010&`tls_rollback_bug`&
16011.endlist
16012
16013As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
16014all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
16015to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
16016to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
16017release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
16018where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
16019
16020
16021.option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
16022.cindex "Oracle" "server list"
16023This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
16024to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
16025The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
16026
16027
16028.option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16029.cindex "&""percent hack""&"
16030.cindex "source routing" "in email address"
16031.cindex "address" "source-routed"
16032The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
16033percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
16034replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
16035also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
16036option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
16037but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
16038an ACL.
16039
16040&*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
16041trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
16042if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
16043implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
16044routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
16045a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
16046local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
16047
16048
16049.option perl_at_start main boolean false
16050.cindex "Perl"
16051This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16052interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16053
16054
16055.option perl_startup main string unset
16056.cindex "Perl"
16057This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16058interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16059
16060.option perl_startup main boolean false
16061.cindex "Perl"
16062This Option enables the taint mode of the embedded Perl interpreter.
16063
16064
16065.option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
16066.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
16067This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
16068data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
16069&<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
16070PostgreSQL support.
16071
16072
16073.option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
16074.cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
16075.cindex "pid file, path for"
16076This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
16077process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
16078to the host name:
16079.code
16080pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
16081.endd
16082If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
16083spool directory.
16084The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
16085option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
16086of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
16087
16088
16089.option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16090.cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
16091This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
16092PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
16093control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
16094&%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
16095for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
16096that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
16097not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
16098
16099
16100.option prdr_enable main boolean false
16101.cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
16102This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
16103to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
16104If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
16105If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
16106an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
16107is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
16108
16109.option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
16110.cindex "message logs" "preserving"
16111If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
16112completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
16113called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
16114purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
16115volume of mail. Use with care!
16116
16117
16118.option primary_hostname main string "see below"
16119.cindex "name" "of local host"
16120.cindex "host" "name of local"
16121.cindex "local host" "name of"
16122.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16123This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
16124HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
16125option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
16126The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
16127server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
16128
16129If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
16130name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
16131contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
16132&[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
16133version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
16134explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
16135
16136
16137.option print_topbitchars main boolean false
16138.cindex "printing characters"
16139.cindex "8-bit characters"
16140By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
1614132&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
16142when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
16143sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
16144is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
16145characters.
16146
16147This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
16148&(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
16149the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
16150described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
16151Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
16152standards.
16153
16154
16155.option process_log_path main string unset
16156.cindex "process log path"
16157.cindex "log" "process log"
16158.cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
16159This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
16160&"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
16161utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
16162in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
16163can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
16164different spool directories.
16165
16166
16167.option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
16168.cindex "restricting access to features"
16169.oindex "&%-M%&"
16170.oindex "&%-R%&"
16171.oindex "&%-q%&"
16172The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
16173admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
16174&%queue_list_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16175
16176
16177.option qualify_domain main string "see below"
16178.cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
16179.cindex "address" "qualification"
16180This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
16181addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
16182recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
16183are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
16184also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
16185locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
16186
16187Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
16188unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
16189&%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
16190addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
16191necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
16192addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
16193&%primary_hostname%& value.
16194
16195
16196.option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
16197This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
16198addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
16199
16200
16201
16202.option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16203.cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
16204.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16205.cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
16206This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
16207A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
16208domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
16209next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
16210
16211
16212.option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
16213.cindex "restricting access to features"
16214.oindex "&%-bp%&"
16215The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
16216queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
16217&%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
16218See also &%prod_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16219
16220
16221.option queue_only main boolean false
16222.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16223.cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
16224If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
16225whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
16226next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
16227delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
16228
16229The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
16230and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
16231&%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
16232&%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
16233
16234
16235.option queue_only_file main string unset
16236.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16237.cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
16238This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
16239one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
16240it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
16241each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
16242For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
16243&"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
16244.code
16245queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
16246.endd
16247causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
16248&_/some/file_& exists.
16249
16250
16251.option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
16252.cindex "load average"
16253.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16254.cindex "message" "queueing by load"
16255If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
16256all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
16257happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
16258the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
16259the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16260false.
16261
16262Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
16263option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
16264determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
16265&%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16266
16267
16268.option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
16269.cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
16270When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
16271because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
16272all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
16273This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
16274threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
16275connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
16276circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
16277where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16278should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
16279re-evaluated for each message.
16280
16281
16282.option queue_only_override main boolean true
16283.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16284When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
16285setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
16286&%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
16287to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
16288
16289
16290.option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
16291.cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
16292If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
16293in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
16294must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
16295single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
16296and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
16297single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
16298the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
16299avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
16300&%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
16301when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
16302large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
16303
16304
16305
16306.option queue_run_max main integer&!! 5
16307.cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
16308This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
16309can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
16310but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
16311start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
16312very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
16313however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
16314started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
16315
16316Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
16317the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
16318run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
16319the daemon's command line.
16320
16321.cindex queues named
16322.cindex "named queues"
16323To set limits for different named queues use
16324an expansion depending on the &$queue_name$& variable.
16325
16326.option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16327.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16328.cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
16329When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
16330received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
16331However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
16332&%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
16333message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
16334has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
16335when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
16336over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
16337SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
16338&%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
16339&%queue_domains%&.
16340
16341
16342.option receive_timeout main time 0s
16343.cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
16344This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
16345maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
16346the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
16347&%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
16348controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
16349
16350.option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
16351.cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
16352.cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
16353This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
16354added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
16355on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
16356used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
16357added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
16358&"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
16359header lines. The default setting is:
16360
16361.code
16362received_header_text = Received: \
16363 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
16364 {${if def:sender_ident \
16365 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
16366 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
16367 by $primary_hostname \
16368 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
16369 ${if def:tls_in_cipher {($tls_in_cipher)\n\t}}\
16370 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
16371 ${if def:sender_address \
16372 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
16373 id $message_exim_id\
16374 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
16375.endd
16376
16377The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
16378support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
16379locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
16380header lines such as the following:
16381.code
16382Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
16383by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
16384(envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
16385id 16IOWa-00019l-00
16386for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
16387Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
16388id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
16389.endd
16390Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
16391the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
16392checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
16393message was accepted.
16394
16395
16396.option received_headers_max main integer 30
16397.cindex "loop" "prevention"
16398.cindex "mail loop prevention"
16399.cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
16400When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
16401counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
16402have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
16403This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
16404
16405
16406.option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16407.cindex "unqualified addresses"
16408.cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16409This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16410recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
16411qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
16412affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
16413addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
16414host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
16415or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
16416option was not set.
16417
16418
16419.option recipients_max main integer 0
16420.cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
16421.cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
16422If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
16423original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
16424by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
16425all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
16426Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
16427done.
16428
16429.cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
16430&*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
16431RCPT commands in a single message.
16432
16433
16434.option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
16435If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
16436recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
16437error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
16438error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
16439initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
16440for the remaining recipients at a later time.
16441
16442
16443.option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
16444.cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
16445This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
16446hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
16447does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
16448message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
16449have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
16450deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
16451deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
16452each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
16453same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
16454&%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
16455with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
16456tagged with its process id.
16457
16458This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
16459message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
16460manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
16461deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
16462is received.
16463
16464.cindex "number of deliveries"
16465.cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
16466If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
16467need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
16468are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
16469daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
16470fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
16471runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
16472delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
16473then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
16474&%remote_max_parallel%&.
16475
16476If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
16477&%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
16478doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
16479host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
16480
16481
16482.option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16483.cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
16484.cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
16485When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
16486domain into the order given by this list. For example,
16487.code
16488remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
16489.endd
16490would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
16491then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
16492
16493
16494.option retry_data_expire main time 7d
16495.cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
16496This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
16497database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
16498host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
16499past failures.
16500
16501
16502.option retry_interval_max main time 24h
16503.cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
16504.cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
16505Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
16506intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
16507straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
16508retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
16509the default value.
16510
16511
16512.option return_path_remove main boolean true
16513.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
16514RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
16515&'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
16516The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
16517MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
16518in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
16519&'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
16520received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
16521the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
16522
16523
16524.option return_size_limit main integer 100K
16525This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16526
16527
16528.option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
16529.cindex "RFC 1413"
16530.cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
16531RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
16532an item in the list.
16533The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
16534for the system.
16535
16536.option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
16537.cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
16538.cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
16539This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
16540no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
16541
16542
16543.option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16544.cindex "unqualified addresses"
16545.cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16546This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16547sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
16548&%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
16549not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
16550it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
16551&%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
16552using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
16553
16554.option set_environment main "string list" empty
16555.cindex "environment"
16556This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
16557currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use. The
16558default list is empty,
16559
16560
16561.option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
16562.cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
16563.cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
16564This option controls logging of slow lookups.
16565If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
16566and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
16567Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
16568
16569
16570
16571.option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
16572.cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
16573This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
16574TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
16575connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
16576other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
16577still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
16578this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
16579connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
16580tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
16581hours to detect unreachable hosts.
16582
16583
16584
16585.option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
16586.cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
16587.cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16588.cindex "inetd"
16589This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
16590that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
16591control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
16592value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
16593non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
16594set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16595
16596A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
16597has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
16598that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
16599and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
16600
16601
16602.option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
16603.cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
16604.cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
16605Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
16606the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
16607check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
16608client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
16609client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
16610
16611When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
16612allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
16613but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
16614or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
16615starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
16616counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
16617following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
16618MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
16619
16620
16621.option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16622You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
16623check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
16624changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
16625live with.
16626
16627
16628. Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
16629. for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
16630. We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
16631. non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
16632. zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
16633. html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
16634. inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
16635. searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
16636. the option name to split.
16637
16638.option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
16639 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16640.cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
16641.cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
16642The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
16643prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
16644results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
16645response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
16646precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
16647seen).
16648
16649
16650.option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
16651.cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
16652.cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
16653This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
16654host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
16655expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
16656reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
16657connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
16658is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
16659of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
16660required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
16661
16662&*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
16663constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
16664happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
16665without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
16666could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
16667doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
16668
16669
16670
16671.option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
16672.cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16673.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16674.cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
16675If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
16676listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
16677on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
16678fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
16679subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
16680to all messages received in the same connection.
16681
16682A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
16683if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
16684also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
16685various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
16686
16687
16688. See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16689
16690.option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
16691 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
16692.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16693.cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
16694This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
16695automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
16696the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
16697and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
16698number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
16699are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
16700restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
16701systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
16702dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
16703
16704
16705.option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
16706.cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
16707.cindex "host" "reserved"
16708When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
16709number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
16710that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
16711&%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
16712restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
16713of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
16714of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
16715the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
16716individual host.
16717
16718For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
16719set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
16720connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
16721provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
16722
16723
16724.option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
16725.cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
16726.cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
16727.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16728This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
16729several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
16730is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
16731responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
16732incoming HELO or EHLO command.
16733
16734.vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
16735The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
16736is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
16737in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
16738
16739If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
16740expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
16741used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
16742panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
16743value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
16744For example:
16745.code
16746smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
16747 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
16748.endd
16749
16750Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
16751messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
16752verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
16753&%helo_data%& value.
16754
16755.option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
16756.cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
16757.cindex "banner for SMTP"
16758.cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
16759.cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
16760This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
16761positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
16762.code
16763smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
16764 $version_number $tod_full
16765.endd
16766Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
16767multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
16768appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
16769in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
16770multiline response).
16771
16772
16773.option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
16774.cindex "checking disk space"
16775.cindex "disk space, checking"
16776.cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
16777When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
16778option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
16779spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
16780leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
16781is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
16782
16783
16784.option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
16785.cindex "connection backlog"
16786.cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
16787.cindex "backlog of connections"
16788This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
16789this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
16790of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
16791attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
16792say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
16793out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
16794value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
16795attacks by SYN flooding.
16796
16797
16798.option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
16799.cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
16800.cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
16801The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
16802the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
16803synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
16804fewer, but they still exist.
16805
16806Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
16807for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
16808client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
16809SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
16810for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
16811input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
16812does detect many instances.
16813
16814The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
16815If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
16816hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
16817(see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
16818
16819
16820
16821.option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
16822.cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
16823.vindex "&$domain$&"
16824If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
16825command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
16826chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
16827are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
16828argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
16829example:
16830.code
16831smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
16832 $sender_host_address
16833.endd
16834A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
16835complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
16836run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
16837a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
16838receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
16839the command.
16840
16841
16842.option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
16843.cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
16844When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
16845one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
16846section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
16847
16848
16849.option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
16850.cindex "load average"
16851If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
16852accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
16853If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
16854the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
16855systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
16856&%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
16857
16858
16859
16860.option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
16861.cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
16862.cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
16863Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
16864particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
16865.code
16866RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
16867.endd
16868causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
16869(The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
16870example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
16871too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
16872dropped. The limit is set by this option.
16873
16874.cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
16875When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
16876&"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
16877Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
16878&%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
16879not count towards the limit.
16880
16881
16882
16883.option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
16884.cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
16885.cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
16886If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
16887Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
16888that subvert web
16889clients
16890into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
16891non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
16892
16893
16894
16895.option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16896.cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
16897.cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
16898.cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
16899Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
16900can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
16901recipients.
16902
16903Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
16904facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
16905&%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
16906&<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
16907
16908When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
16909&%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
16910rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
16911respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
16912values:
16913
16914.ilist
16915A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
16916.next
16917An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
16918fractional parts are allowed here.
16919.next
16920A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
16921.next
16922A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
16923because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
16924.endlist
16925
16926For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
16927first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
16928.code
16929smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
16930smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
16931.endd
16932The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
16933two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
16934seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
16935delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
16936
16937
16938.option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
16939See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16940
16941
16942.option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
16943See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
16944
16945
16946.option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
16947.cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
16948.cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
16949This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
16950input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
16951data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
16952the message is abandoned.
16953A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
16954.code
16955SMTP command timeout on connection from...
16956SMTP data timeout on connection from...
16957.endd
16958The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
16959means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
16960
16961If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
16962expanded before use and may depend on
16963&$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
16964
16965
16966.oindex "&%-os%&"
16967The value set by this option can be overridden by the
16968&%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
16969this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
16970of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
16971timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
16972
16973
16974.option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16975This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
16976&%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
16977
16978
16979.option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
16980.cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
16981.cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
16982In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
16983&"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
16984reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
16985to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
16986policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
16987&%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
16988example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
16989.code
16990550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
16991550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
16992.endd
16993
16994
16995.option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16996.cindex "SMTPUTF8" "advertising"
16997When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
16998the availability thereof is advertised in
16999response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17000chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
17001
17002
17003.option spamd_address main string "127.0.0.1 783"
17004This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
17005extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
17006See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
17007
17008
17009
17010.option spf_guess main string "v=spf1 a/24 mx/24 ptr ?all"
17011This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support.
17012See section &<<SECSPF>>& for more details.
17013
17014
17015
17016.option split_spool_directory main boolean false
17017.cindex "multiple spool directories"
17018.cindex "spool directory" "split"
17019.cindex "directories, multiple"
17020If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
17021subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
17022sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
17023subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
17024arrival of the message.
17025
17026Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
17027where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
17028directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
17029directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
17030are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
17031
17032It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
17033changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
17034&"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
17035after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
17036automatically deleted.
17037
17038When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
17039changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
17040trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
17041sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
17042sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
17043spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
17044particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
17045if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
17046entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
17047
17048
17049.option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
17050.cindex "spool directory" "path to"
17051This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
17052it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
17053configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
17054string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
17055&$primary_hostname$&.
17056
17057If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
17058that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
17059log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
17060Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
17061as failures in the configuration file.
17062
17063By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
17064tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
17065
17066.option spool_wireformat main boolean false
17067.cindex "spool directory" "file formats"
17068If this option is set, Exim may for some messages use an alternative format
17069for data-files in the spool which matches the wire format.
17070Doing this permits more efficient message reception and transmission.
17071Currently it is only done for messages received using the ESMTP CHUNKING
17072option.
17073
17074The following variables will not have useful values:
17075.code
17076$max_received_linelength
17077$body_linecount
17078$body_zerocount
17079.endd
17080
17081Users of the local_scan() API (see &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&),
17082and any external programs which are passed a reference to a message data file
17083(except via the &"regex"&, &"malware"& or &"spam"&) ACL conditions)
17084will need to be aware of the different formats potentially available.
17085
17086Using any of the ACL conditions noted will negate the reception benefit
17087(as a Unix-mbox-format file is constructed for them).
17088The transmission benefit is maintained.
17089
17090.option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
17091.cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
17092This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
17093access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
17094
17095.option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
17096.cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
17097This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
17098variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
17099is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
17100&<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
17101
17102.option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
17103.cindex "angle brackets, excess"
17104If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
17105items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
17106treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
17107passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
17108option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
17109
17110
17111.option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
17112.cindex "trailing dot on domain"
17113.cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
17114If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
17115ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
17116MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
17117domain causes a syntax error.
17118However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
17119syntax checking.
17120
17121
17122.option syslog_duplication main boolean true
17123.cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
17124When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
17125separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
17126be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
17127separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
17128nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
17129particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
17130both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
17131containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
17132Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
17133the LOG_ALERT priority.
17134
17135
17136.option syslog_facility main string unset
17137.cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
17138This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17139syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
17140&"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
17141If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17142details of Exim's logging.
17143
17144
17145.option syslog_pid main boolean true
17146.cindex "syslog" "pid"
17147If &%syslog_pid%& is set false, the PID on Exim's log lines are
17148omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. (Syslog normally prefixes
17149the log lines with the PID of the logging process automatically.) You need
17150to enable the &`+pid`& log selector item, if you want Exim to write it's PID
17151into the logs.) See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17152
17153
17154
17155.option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
17156.cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
17157This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17158syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
17159&<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17160
17161
17162
17163.option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
17164.cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
17165If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
17166omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17167details of Exim's logging.
17168
17169
17170.option system_filter main string&!! unset
17171.cindex "filter" "system filter"
17172.cindex "system filter" "specifying"
17173.cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
17174This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
17175the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
17176must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
17177generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
17178appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
17179which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
17180&<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
17181A forced expansion failure results in no filter operation.
17182
17183
17184.option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
17185.vindex "&$address_file$&"
17186This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
17187&%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
17188implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
17189During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17190
17191
17192.option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
17193.cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
17194This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
17195command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
17196the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17197
17198.option system_filter_group main string unset
17199.cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
17200This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
17201gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
17202with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
17203
17204.option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
17205.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
17206.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
17207This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
17208is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
17209contains the pipe command.
17210
17211
17212.option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
17213.cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
17214This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
17215is used in a system filter.
17216
17217
17218.option system_filter_user main string unset
17219.cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
17220If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
17221delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
17222process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
17223Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
17224is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
17225configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
17226specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
17227&%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
17228
17229If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
17230under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
17231transport option overrides.
17232
17233
17234.option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
17235.cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
17236.cindex "Nagle algorithm"
17237.cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
17238If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
17239TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
17240turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
17241performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
17242should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
17243However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
17244this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
17245daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
17246TCP_NODELAY.
17247
17248
17249.option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
17250.cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
17251.cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
17252If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
17253message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
17254is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
17255bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
17256sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
17257If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
17258frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
17259
17260&*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
17261frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
17262messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
17263
17264
17265.option timezone main string unset
17266.cindex "timezone, setting"
17267.cindex "environment" "values from"
17268The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
17269running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
17270created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
17271to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
17272.code
17273timezone = UTC
17274.endd
17275The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
17276or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
17277is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
17278time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
17279runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
17280unfortunately not all, operating systems.
17281
17282
17283.option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17284.cindex "TLS" "advertising"
17285.cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
17286.cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
17287When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
17288of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
17289response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17290chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
17291Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
17292using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If TLS support for incoming connections
17293is not required the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
17294
17295
17296.option tls_certificate main string list&!! unset
17297.cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
17298.cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
17299The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17300files which contains the server's certificates. Commonly only one file is
17301needed.
17302The server's private key is also
17303assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
17304&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17305
17306&*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
17307receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
17308use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
17309option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
17310
17311&*Note*&: If you use filenames based on IP addresses, change the list
17312separator in the usual way to avoid confusion under IPv6.
17313
17314&*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
17315when a list of more than one
17316file is used, the &$tls_in_ourcert$& variable is unreliable.
17317
17318&*Note*&: OCSP stapling is not usable under OpenSSL
17319when a list of more than one file is used.
17320
17321If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
17322if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
17323Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
17324&<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
17325
17326If this option is unset or empty a fresh self-signed certificate will be
17327generated for every connection.
17328
17329.option tls_crl main string&!! unset
17330.cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
17331.cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
17332This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
17333be the name of a file that contains CRLs in PEM format.
17334
17335Under OpenSSL the option can specify a directory with CRL files.
17336
17337&*Note:*& Under OpenSSL the option must, if given, supply a CRL
17338for each signing element of the certificate chain (i.e. all but the leaf).
17339For the file variant this can be multiple PEM blocks in the one file.
17340
17341See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17342
17343
17344.option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
17345.cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
17346The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
17347the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
17348interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
17349suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
17350
17351The value must be at least 1024.
17352
17353The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
17354hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
17355by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
17356
17357If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
17358number.
17359
17360Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
17361little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
17362larger prime than requested.
17363
17364
17365.option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
17366.cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
17367The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
17368to be used by Exim.
17369
17370&*Note: The Exim Maintainers strongly recommend using a filename with site-generated
17371local DH parameters*&, which has been supported across all versions of Exim. The
17372other specific constants available are a fallback so that even when
17373"unconfigured", Exim can offer Perfect Forward Secrecy in older ciphersuites in TLS.
17374
17375If &%tls_dhparam%& is a filename starting with a &`/`&,
17376then it names a file from which DH
17377parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
17378PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
17379OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
17380fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
17381loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
17382and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
17383
17384If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
17385loaded by Exim.
17386
17387If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
17388Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
17389does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
17390See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
17391
17392If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
17393a default DH prime; the default is Exim-specific but lacks verifiable provenance.
17394
17395In older versions of Exim the default was the 2048 bit prime described in section
173962.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
17397in IKE is assigned number 23.
17398
17399Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
17400of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526, RFC 5114, RFC 7919, or from other
17401sources. As names, Exim uses a standard specified name, else "ike" followed by
17402the number used by IKE, or "default" which corresponds to
17403&`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17404
17405The available standard primes are:
17406&`ffdhe2048`&, &`ffdhe3072`&, &`ffdhe4096`&, &`ffdhe6144`&, &`ffdhe8192`&,
17407&`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
17408&`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
17409&`ike22`&, &`ike23`& and &`ike24`&.
17410
17411The available additional primes are:
17412&`exim.dev.20160529.1`&, &`exim.dev.20160529.2`& and &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17413
17414Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
17415Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
17416The open cryptographic community has suspicions about the integrity of some
17417of the later IKE values, which led into RFC7919 providing new fixed constants
17418(the "ffdhe" identifiers).
17419
17420At this point, all of the "ike" values should be considered obsolete;
17421they're still in Exim to avoid breaking unusual configurations, but are
17422candidates for removal the next time we have backwards-incompatible changes.
17423
17424The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
17425to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
17426whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
17427tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
17428need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
17429userbase.
17430
17431Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
17432is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
17433applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
17434used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
17435mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
17436prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
17437acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
17438
17439
17440.option tls_eccurve main string&!! &`auto`&
17441.cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
17442This option selects a EC curve for use by Exim when used with OpenSSL.
17443It has no effect when Exim is used with GnuTLS.
17444
17445After expansion it must contain a valid EC curve parameter, such as
17446&`prime256v1`&, &`secp384r1`&, or &`P-512`&. Consult your OpenSSL manual
17447for valid selections.
17448
17449For OpenSSL versions before (and not including) 1.0.2, the string
17450&`auto`& selects &`prime256v1`&. For more recent OpenSSL versions
17451&`auto`& tells the library to choose.
17452
17453If the option expands to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
17454
17455
17456.option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
17457.cindex TLS "certificate status"
17458.cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
17459This option
17460must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
17461status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
17462Certificate Authority.
17463
17464Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
17465
17466For GnuTLS 3.5.6 or later the expanded value of this option can be a list
17467of files, to match a list given for the &%tls_certificate%& option.
17468The ordering of the two lists must match.
17469
17470
17471.option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
17472.cindex SSMTP
17473.cindex SMTPS
17474This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
17475operate the SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
17476set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
17477further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
17478
17479
17480
17481.option tls_privatekey main string list&!! unset
17482.cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
17483The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17484files which contains the server's private keys.
17485If this option is unset, or if
17486the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
17487key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
17488&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17489
17490See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17491
17492
17493.option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
17494.cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
17495.cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
17496If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
17497&"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
17498support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
17499TLS session.
17500
17501
17502.option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
17503.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
17504.cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
17505This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
17506The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
17507connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
17508different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
17509permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
17510in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
17511preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
17512&<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
17513
17514
17515.option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17516.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17517.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17518See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
17519
17520
17521.option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
17522.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17523.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17524The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
17525word "system"
17526or the absolute path to
17527a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
17528match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
17529
17530The "system" value for the option will use a
17531system default location compiled into the SSL library.
17532This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
17533and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
17534must be specified.
17535
17536The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
17537preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
17538
17539With OpenSSL the certificates specified
17540explicitly
17541either by file or directory
17542are added to those given by the system default location.
17543
17544These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
17545than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
17546the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
17547connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
17548Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
17549use the explicit directory version.
17550
17551See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17552
17553A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
17554being unset.
17555
17556
17557.option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17558.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17559.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17560This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
17561certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
17562&%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
17563either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
17564&%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
17565
17566Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
17567&%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
17568present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
17569aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
17570the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
17571connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
17572ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
17573
17574A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
17575matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
17576certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
17577abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
17578state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
17579such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
17580but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
17581certificate"&.
17582
17583Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
17584certificates.
17585
17586
17587.option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
17588.cindex "trusted groups"
17589.cindex "groups" "trusted"
17590This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17591option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
17592which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
17593specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
17594details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
17595&%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
17596are trusted.
17597
17598.option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
17599.cindex "trusted users"
17600.cindex "user" "trusted"
17601This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17602option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
17603trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
17604&<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
17605If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
17606Exim user are trusted.
17607
17608.option unknown_login main string&!! unset
17609.cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
17610.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
17611This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
17612the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
17613gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
17614used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
17615can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
17616is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
17617&%-F%& option.
17618
17619.option unknown_username main string unset
17620See &%unknown_login%&.
17621
17622.option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
17623.cindex "trusted users"
17624.cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
17625.cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
17626.cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
17627.cindex "envelope sender"
17628When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
17629normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
17630default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
17631senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
17632is used) is ignored.
17633
17634However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
17635to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
17636.code
17637exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
17638.endd
17639.vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
17640The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
17641other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
17642users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
17643patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
17644identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
17645users to setting senders that start with their login ids
17646followed by a hyphen
17647by a setting like this:
17648.code
17649untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
17650.endd
17651If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
17652restriction, you can use
17653.code
17654untrusted_set_sender = *
17655.endd
17656The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
17657only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
17658to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
17659parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
17660&'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
17661necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
17662overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
17663described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
17664
17665The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
17666&"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
17667&%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
17668envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
17669sender address.
17670
17671
17672.option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
17673.cindex "&""From""& line"
17674.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
17675Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
17676an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
17677particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
17678of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
17679matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
17680&%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
17681default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
17682.code
17683From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
17684From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
17685.endd
17686The pattern can be seen by running
17687.code
17688exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
17689.endd
17690It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
17691year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
17692regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
17693&%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
17694(&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
17695&%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
17696
17697
17698.option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
17699See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
17700
17701
17702.option warn_message_file main string unset
17703.cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
17704.cindex "customizing" "warning message"
17705This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
17706for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
17707been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
17708&%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
17709&<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
17710
17711
17712.option write_rejectlog main boolean true
17713.cindex "reject log" "disabling"
17714If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
17715See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
17716.ecindex IIDconfima
17717.ecindex IIDmaiconf
17718
17719
17720
17721
17722. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17723. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17724
17725.chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
17726.scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
17727.scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
17728This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
17729Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
17730
17731For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
17732&<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
17733which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
17734provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
17735&%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
17736
17737
17738
17739.option address_data routers string&!! unset
17740.cindex "router" "data attached to address"
17741The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
17742precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
17743router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
17744&%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
17745delivery of the address to be deferred.
17746
17747.vindex "&$address_data$&"
17748When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
17749accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
17750routers, and the eventual transport.
17751
17752&*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
17753that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
17754in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
17755either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
17756put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
17757
17758Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
17759with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
17760on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
17761&$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
17762&"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
17763
17764The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
17765for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
17766you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
17767.code
17768uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
17769.endd
17770In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
17771.code
17772file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
17773.endd
17774This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
17775lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
17776
17777.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
17778.vindex "&$address_data$&"
17779The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
17780from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
17781&$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
17782ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
17783verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
17784
17785
17786
17787.option address_test routers&!? boolean true
17788.oindex "&%-bt%&"
17789.cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
17790If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
17791by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
17792your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
17793having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
17794routing.
17795
17796
17797
17798.option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
17799.cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
17800.cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
17801This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
17802routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
17803&"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
17804&%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
17805value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
17806includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
17807well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
17808you could put:
17809.code
17810cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
17811.endd
17812on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
17813and
17814.code
17815cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
17816.endd
17817on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
17818this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
17819explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
17820logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
17821
17822
17823.option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
17824.cindex "case of local parts"
17825.cindex "router" "case of local parts"
17826By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
17827manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
17828If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
17829this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
17830part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
17831turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
17832more details.
17833
17834.vindex "&$local_part$&"
17835.vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
17836.vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
17837The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
17838router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
17839an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
17840is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
17841addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
17842and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
17843
17844This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
17845recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
17846modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
17847(see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
17848
17849
17850
17851.option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
17852.cindex "local user, checking in router"
17853.cindex "router" "checking for local user"
17854.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
17855.vindex "&$home$&"
17856When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
17857address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
17858local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
17859than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
17860holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
17861user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
17862preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
17863given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
17864overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
17865the router is skipped.
17866
17867If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
17868or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
17869setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
17870two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
17871setting to achieve this. For example:
17872.code
17873local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
17874.endd
17875Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
17876up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
17877&%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
17878
17879
17880
17881.option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
17882.cindex "router" "customized precondition"
17883This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
17884router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
17885evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
17886result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
17887&"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
17888router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
17889
17890If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
17891precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
17892
17893This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
17894All &%condition%& options must succeed.
17895
17896The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
17897running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
17898the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
17899.code
17900condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17901.endd
17902Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
17903.code
17904condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
17905.endd
17906
17907A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
17908.code
17909condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
17910condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
17911condition = foobar
17912.endd
17913
17914If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
17915of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
17916be specified using &%condition%&.
17917
17918Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
17919are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
17920they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
17921parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17922ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
17923Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
17924Router rules processing behavior.
17925
17926This is best illustrated in an example:
17927.code
17928# If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
17929# in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
17930
17931$ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17932true {yes} {no}}
17933
17934$ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
17935 {yes} {no}}
17936.endd
17937In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
17938&"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
17939default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
17940(which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
17941string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
17942with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
17943resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
17944&" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
17945
17946In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
17947&%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
17948mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
17949conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
17950string characters.
17951
17952Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
17953true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
17954match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
17955contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
17956expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
17957
17958
17959.option debug_print routers string&!! unset
17960.cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
17961If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
17962option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
17963the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
17964If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
17965output, and Exim carries on processing.
17966This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
17967so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
17968option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
17969variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
17970&%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
17971are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
17972The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
17973
17974
17975
17976.option disable_logging routers boolean false
17977If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
17978or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
17979unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
17980transport option of the same name.
17981
17982.option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17983.cindex "MX record" "security"
17984.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17985.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17986.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17987DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
17988the dnssec request bit set.
17989This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
17990
17991.option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
17992.cindex "MX record" "security"
17993.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
17994.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
17995.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
17996DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
17997the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
17998(AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
17999This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
18000
18001
18002.option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
18003.cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
18004.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
18005If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
18006the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
18007lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
18008expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
18009a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
18010
18011
18012
18013.option driver routers string unset
18014This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
18015to be used.
18016
18017
18018.option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
18019.cindex "DSN" "success"
18020.cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
18021If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
18022Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
18023instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
18024Not effective on redirect routers.
18025
18026
18027
18028.option errors_to routers string&!! unset
18029.cindex "envelope sender"
18030.cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
18031If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
18032transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
18033there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
18034message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
18035provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
18036expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
18037
18038The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
18039subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
18040settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
18041setting.
18042
18043If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
18044the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
18045address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
18046expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
18047
18048If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
18049SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
18050any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
18051sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
18052settings:
18053.code
18054errors_to =
18055errors_to = ""
18056.endd
18057An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
18058this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
18059no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
18060address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
18061overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
18062
18063.vindex "&$address_data$&"
18064If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
18065MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
18066path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
18067setting &%return_path%&.
18068
18069The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
18070manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
18071implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
18072
18073
18074
18075.option expn routers&!? boolean true
18076.cindex "address" "testing"
18077.cindex "testing" "addresses"
18078.cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
18079.cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
18080If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
18081as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
18082want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
18083on for the system alias file.
18084See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18085are evaluated.
18086
18087The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
18088&<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
18089an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
18090
18091
18092
18093.option fail_verify routers boolean false
18094.cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
18095Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
18096&%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18097
18098
18099
18100.option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
18101If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18102verifying a recipient, verification fails.
18103
18104
18105
18106.option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
18107If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18108verifying a sender, verification fails.
18109
18110
18111
18112.option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
18113.cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
18114.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
18115String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
18116colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
18117changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
18118each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
18119defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
18120&<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
18121
18122If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
18123associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
18124list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
18125randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
18126transport for further details.
18127
18128
18129.option group routers string&!! "see below"
18130.cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
18131.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18132.cindex "transport" "local"
18133.cindex "router" "setting group"
18134When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18135specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
18136process.
18137The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18138error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18139The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
18140is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
18141and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18142
18143
18144
18145.option headers_add routers list&!! unset
18146.cindex "header lines" "adding"
18147.cindex "router" "adding header lines"
18148This option specifies a list of text headers,
18149newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
18150that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18151Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18152option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18153the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
18154&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
18155message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
18156header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
18157&"see"& the added header lines.
18158
18159The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
18160&%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
18161an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
18162failures are treated as configuration errors.
18163
18164Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
18165for a router; all listed headers are added.
18166
18167&*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18168router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18169
18170.cindex "duplicate addresses"
18171.oindex "&%unseen%&"
18172&*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18173additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
18174For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
18175address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
18176modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
18177circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
18178which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
18179avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18180
18181
18182
18183.option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
18184.cindex "header lines" "removing"
18185.cindex "router" "removing header lines"
18186This option specifies a list of text headers,
18187colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
18188that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18189Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18190option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18191the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
18192section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
18193the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
18194to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
18195&"see"& the original header lines.
18196
18197The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
18198&%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
18199the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
18200errors.
18201
18202Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
18203for a router; all listed headers are removed.
18204
18205&*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18206router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18207
18208&*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18209removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
18210routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
18211warning for &%headers_add%& above.
18212
18213&*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
18214items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
18215To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
18216
18217
18218
18219.option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
18220.cindex "IP address" "discarding"
18221.cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
18222Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
18223entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
18224IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
18225address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
18226like
18227.code
18228remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
18229.endd
18230by setting
18231.code
18232ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
18233.endd
18234on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
18235discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
18236attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
18237domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
18238Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
18239router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
18240
18241You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
18242means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
18243.code
18244ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
18245ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
18246.endd
18247The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
18248in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
18249
18250This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
18251addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18252is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
18253domain that is being routed.
18254
18255.vindex "&$host_address$&"
18256During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
18257checked.
18258
18259.option initgroups routers boolean false
18260.cindex "additional groups"
18261.cindex "groups" "additional"
18262.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18263.cindex "transport" "local"
18264If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
18265the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
18266&[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
18267any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
18268and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18269
18270
18271
18272.option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
18273.cindex affix "router precondition"
18274.cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
18275.cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
18276If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
18277one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
18278section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
18279evaluated.
18280
18281The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
18282used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
18283asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
18284the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
18285some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
18286.cindex "multiple mailboxes"
18287.cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
18288Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
18289section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
18290
18291.vindex "&$local_part$&"
18292.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
18293During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
18294running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
18295expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
18296the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
18297a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
18298command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
18299This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
18300the relevant transport.
18301
18302When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
18303behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
18304means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
18305callout.
18306
18307The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
18308&%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
18309&%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
18310to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
18311immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
18312.code
18313real_localuser:
18314 driver = accept
18315 local_part_prefix = real-
18316 check_local_user
18317 transport = local_delivery
18318.endd
18319For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
18320router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
18321.code
18322 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
18323 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
18324.endd
18325
18326If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
18327both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
18328are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
18329separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
18330
18331
18332.option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
18333See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
18334
18335
18336
18337.option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
18338.cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
18339.cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
18340This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
18341local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
18342&%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
18343mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
18344character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
18345parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
18346&%username-foo%&.
18347
18348
18349.option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
18350See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
18351
18352
18353
18354.option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
18355.cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
18356.cindex "local part" "checking in router"
18357The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
18358See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18359are evaluated, and
18360section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
18361string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
18362example:
18363.code
18364local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
18365.endd
18366.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
18367If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
18368for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
18369expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
18370example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
18371send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
18372each virtual domain:
18373.code
18374postmaster:
18375 driver = redirect
18376 local_parts = postmaster
18377 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
18378.endd
18379
18380
18381.option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
18382.cindex "log" "delivery line"
18383.cindex "delivery" "log line format"
18384Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
18385deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
18386recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
18387this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
18388router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
18389router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
18390redirect addresses.
18391
18392
18393
18394.option more routers boolean&!! true
18395The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18396that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18397result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18398fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
18399delivery to be deferred.
18400
18401If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
18402further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
18403.oindex "&%self%&"
18404However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
18405means of the setting
18406.code
18407self = pass
18408.endd
18409or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
18410does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
18411case, the address is always passed to the next router.
18412
18413Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
18414expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
18415controls what happens next.
18416
18417
18418.option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
18419.cindex "timeout" "of router"
18420.cindex "router" "timeout"
18421If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
18422address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
18423router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
18424intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
18425host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
18426
18427There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
18428lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
18429applies to all of them.
18430
18431
18432
18433.option pass_router routers string unset
18434.cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
18435Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
18436&(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
18437routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
18438these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
18439router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
18440of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
18441be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
18442to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
18443&"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
18444
18445
18446
18447.option redirect_router routers string unset
18448.cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
18449Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
18450generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
18451example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
18452point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
18453
18454The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
18455It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
18456instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
18457which it is set does not generate new addresses.
18458
18459
18460
18461.option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
18462.cindex "file" "requiring for router"
18463.cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
18464This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
18465router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
18466Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
18467through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
18468
18469Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
18470be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
18471If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
18472failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
18473
18474If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
18475below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
18476&"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
18477existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
18478preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
18479
18480.cindex "NFS"
18481If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
18482the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
18483unavailable.
18484
18485This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
18486options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
18487look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
18488full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
18489these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
18490to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
18491that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
18492transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
18493
18494During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
18495facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
18496This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
18497operates as follows:
18498
18499If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
18500characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
18501comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
18502but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
18503used. For example:
18504.code
18505require_files = mail:/some/file
18506require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
18507.endd
18508If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
18509&%require_files%& condition fails.
18510
18511Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
18512checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
18513directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
18514access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
18515
18516&*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
18517incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
18518may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
18519may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
18520user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
18521
18522&*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
18523&[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
18524without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
18525is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
18526check again in that process.
18527
18528The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
18529be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
18530existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
18531circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
18532not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
18533name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
18534as if the file did not exist. For example:
18535.code
18536require_files = +/some/file
18537.endd
18538If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
18539handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
18540option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
18541
18542
18543
18544.option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
18545.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
18546.cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
18547When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
18548in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
18549domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
18550other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
18551Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
18552latter kind.
18553
18554This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
18555hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
18556router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
18557set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
18558for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
18559same name.
18560
18561The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
18562appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
18563independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
18564
18565
18566
18567.option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
18568.cindex "router" "home directory for"
18569.cindex "home directory" "for router"
18570.vindex "&$home$&"
18571This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
18572&%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
18573transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
18574sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
18575forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
18576cause the router to defer.
18577
18578Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
18579&%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
18580place.
18581(See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18582are evaluated.)
18583While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
18584&$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
18585
18586When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
18587the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
18588delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
18589of these values that is set:
18590
18591.ilist
18592The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
18593.next
18594The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
18595.next
18596The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
18597.next
18598The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
18599.endlist
18600
18601In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
18602router, but not for the transport.
18603
18604
18605
18606.option self routers string freeze
18607.cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18608.cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18609This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
18610list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
18611and &(manualroute)& routers.
18612Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
18613of remote hosts.
18614Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
18615&(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
18616host on the list turns out to be the local host.
18617The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
18618&<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18619
18620Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
18621example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
18622error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
18623reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
18624freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
18625cases:
18626
18627.vlist
18628.vitem &%defer%&
18629Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
18630
18631.vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
18632The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
18633be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
18634behaviour is essentially a redirection.
18635
18636.vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
18637The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
18638reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
18639rewritten.
18640
18641.vitem &%pass%&
18642.oindex "&%more%&"
18643.vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
18644The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
18645&%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
18646subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
18647name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
18648distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
18649combination
18650.code
18651self = pass
18652no_more
18653.endd
18654ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
18655Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
18656be passed to the next router.
18657
18658.vitem &%fail%&
18659Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
18660
18661.vitem &%send%&
18662.cindex "local host" "sending to"
18663The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
18664setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
18665makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
18666is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
18667different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
18668.endlist
18669
18670
18671
18672.option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
18673.cindex "router" "checking senders"
18674If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
18675address matches something on the list.
18676See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18677are evaluated.
18678
18679There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
18680dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
18681setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
18682to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
18683set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
18684verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
18685SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
18686matters.
18687
18688
18689.option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
18690.cindex "IP address" "translating"
18691.cindex "packet radio"
18692.cindex "router" "IP address translation"
18693There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
18694it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
18695mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
18696routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
18697is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
18698code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
18699SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
18700
18701.vindex "&$host_address$&"
18702The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
18703by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
18704expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
18705For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
18706If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
18707address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
18708up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
18709produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
18710addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
18711.code
18712translate_ip_address = \
18713 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
18714 {$value}fail}}
18715.endd
18716The file would contain lines like
18717.code
1871810.2.3.128/26 some.host
1871910.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
18720.endd
18721You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
18722are doing.
18723
18724
18725
18726.option transport routers string&!! unset
18727This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
18728and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
18729only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
18730after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
18731and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
18732delivery is deferred.
18733
18734The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
18735have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
18736(see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
18737
18738
18739
18740.option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
18741.cindex "current directory for local transport"
18742This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
18743to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
18744explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
18745file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
18746option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
18747overridden by a setting on the transport.
18748If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18749logged, and delivery is deferred.
18750See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
18751environment.
18752
18753
18754
18755
18756.option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
18757.cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
18758This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
18759local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
18760configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
18761pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
18762string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
18763setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
18764If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18765logged, and delivery is deferred.
18766
18767If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
18768&%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
18769the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
18770the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
18771is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
18772
18773See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
18774environment.
18775
18776
18777
18778
18779.option unseen routers boolean&!! false
18780.cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
18781The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18782that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18783result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18784fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
18785delivery to be deferred.
18786
18787When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
18788address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
18789overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
18790&%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
18791the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
18792sometimes true and sometimes false).
18793
18794.cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
18795Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
18796qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
18797delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
18798In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
18799&-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
18800to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
18801&%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
18802
18803&*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
18804this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
18805only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
18806no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
18807a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
18808duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
18809duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
18810&<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
18811so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
18812&%redirect%& router may be of help.
18813
18814Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
18815&%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
18816subsequent routers.
18817
18818
18819.option user routers string&!! "see below"
18820.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
18821.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18822.cindex "transport" "local"
18823.cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
18824.cindex "filter" "user for processing"
18825When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18826specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
18827The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18828error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18829This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
18830The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
18831the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
18832a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
18833See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
18834&<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18835
18836
18837
18838.option verify routers&!? boolean true
18839Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
18840&%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18841
18842
18843.option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
18844.cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
18845.oindex "&%-bv%&"
18846.cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
18847If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
18848delivering in cutthrough mode or
18849testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
18850with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
18851restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
18852&%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
18853
18854&*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
18855SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
18856accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
18857user or group.
18858
18859
18860.option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
18861If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
18862addresses,
18863delivering in cutthrough mode
18864or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
18865See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18866are evaluated.
18867See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18868
18869
18870.option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
18871If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
18872or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
18873See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18874are evaluated.
18875See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
18876.ecindex IIDgenoprou1
18877.ecindex IIDgenoprou2
18878
18879
18880
18881
18882
18883
18884. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18885. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18886
18887.chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
18888.cindex "&(accept)& router"
18889.cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
18890The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
18891used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
18892be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
18893specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
18894it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
18895up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
18896.code
18897localusers:
18898 driver = accept
18899 domains = mydomain.example
18900 check_local_user
18901 transport = local_delivery
18902.endd
18903The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
18904&%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
18905When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
18906address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
18907
18908
18909
18910
18911
18912
18913. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18914. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18915
18916.chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
18917.scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
18918.scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
18919The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
18920recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
18921unless &%verify_only%& is set.
18922
18923If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
18924SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
18925MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
18926However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
18927records.
18928
18929MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
18930looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
18931When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
18932except that IPv6 addresses are sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
18933IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18934generic option, the router declines.
18935
18936Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
18937to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
18938are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
18939
18940.cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18941.cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18942.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
18943If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
18944address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
18945happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
18946
18947
18948.section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
18949There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
18950Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
18951SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
18952MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
18953problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
18954
18955For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
18956&%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
18957&(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
18958an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
18959domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
18960such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
18961proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
18962look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
18963case routing fails.
18964
18965
18966.section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
18967.cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
18968There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
18969an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
18970domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
18971
18972The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
18973is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
18974
18975Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
18976.ilist
18977The domain does not exist in DNS
18978.next
18979The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
18980convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
18981for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
18982.next
18983Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
18984.next
18985MX record points to a non-existent host.
18986.next
18987MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
18988&%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
18989.next
18990MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
18991addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
18992.next
18993The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
18994&%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
18995.next
18996&%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
18997not be found in the MX records (see below)
18998.endlist
18999
19000
19001
19002
19003.section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
19004.cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
19005The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
19006
19007.option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
19008.cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
19009If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
19010(and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
19011process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
19012differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
19013the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
19014
19015
19016.option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
19017.cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
19018The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
19019addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
19020enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
19021required. For example,
19022.code
19023check_srv = smtp
19024.endd
19025looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
19026expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
19027to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
19028submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
19029option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
19030normal way.
19031
19032When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
19033the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
19034host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
19035this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
19036SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
19037according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
19038
19039When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
19040the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
19041records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
19042this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
19043defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
19044and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
19045have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
19046trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
19047
19048See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
19049when there is a DNS lookup error.
19050
19051
19052
19053
19054.option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19055.cindex "MX record" "not found"
19056DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
19057which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
19058rather than the default behaviour of decline.
19059This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
19060domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
19061However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
19062also being queued.
19063
19064
19065.option ipv4_only "string&!!" unset
19066.cindex IPv6 disabling
19067.cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
19068The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
19069or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
19070(checked without regard to the case of the letters),
19071only A records are used.
19072
19073.option ipv4_prefer "string&!!" unset
19074.cindex IPv4 preference
19075.cindex DNS "IPv4 preference"
19076The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
19077or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
19078(checked without regard to the case of the letters),
19079A records are sorted before AAAA records (inverting the default).
19080
19081.option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19082.cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
19083.cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
19084A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
19085record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
19086For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
19087records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
19088setting:
19089.code
19090mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
19091.endd
19092This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
19093has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
19094the address record.
19095
19096
19097.option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19098If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19099DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
19100&<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19101
19102
19103
19104
19105.option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
19106.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19107.cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
19108When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
19109lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
19110single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
19111called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
19112&'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
19113resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
19114&'resolv.conf'&.
19115
19116
19117
19118.option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
19119.cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
19120.cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
19121If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
19122qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
19123an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
19124expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
19125occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
19126&%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
19127any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
19128header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
19129
19130This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
19131ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
19132sense.
19133
19134When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
19135servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
19136making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
19137some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
19138name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
19139header rewriting.
19140
19141
19142.option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
19143.cindex "address" "copying routing"
19144Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
19145to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
19146options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19147default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19148servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19149any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19150
19151If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19152domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
19153local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19154lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
19155routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
19156message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
19157without processing them independently,
19158provided the following conditions are met:
19159
19160.ilist
19161No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
19162&%headers_remove%&.
19163.next
19164The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
19165the domain.
19166.endlist
19167
19168
19169
19170
19171.option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
19172.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19173When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
19174lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
19175applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
19176the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
19177domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
19178up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
19179&'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
19180actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
19181
19182Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
19183record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
19184local wildcard.
19185
19186
19187
19188.option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19189If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19190DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
19191&<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19192
19193
19194
19195
19196.option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
19197.cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
19198If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
19199added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
19200if
19201.code
19202widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
19203.endd
19204is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
19205&'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
19206&'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
19207and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
19208the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
19209when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
19210
19211
19212.section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
19213When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
19214of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
19215corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
19216is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
19217
19218These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
19219for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
19220such as that implied by
19221.code
19222domains = @mx_any
19223.endd
19224that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
19225entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
19226.ecindex IIDdnsrou1
19227.ecindex IIDdnsrou2
19228
19229
19230
19231
19232
19233
19234
19235
19236
19237. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19238. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19239
19240.chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
19241.cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
19242.cindex "domain literal" "routing"
19243.cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
19244This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
19245verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
19246generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
19247takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
19248router handles the address
19249.code
19250root@[192.168.1.1]
19251.endd
19252by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
19253consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
19254are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
19255.code
19256postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
19257.endd
19258Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
19259grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
19260
19261.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
19262If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
19263declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
19264&%self%& option determines what happens.
19265
19266The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
19267controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
19268also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
19269Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
19270
19271
19272
19273. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19274. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19275
19276.chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
19277.cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
19278.cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
19279The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
19280Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
19281not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
19282must set
19283.code
19284ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
19285.endd
19286in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
19287
19288The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
19289connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
19290a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
19291message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
19292this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
19293can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
19294must not be specified for it.
19295
19296.cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
19297.option hosts iplookup string unset
19298This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
19299names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
19300(or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
19301and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
19302happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
19303
19304
19305.option optional iplookup boolean false
19306If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
19307is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
19308delivery to the address is deferred.
19309
19310
19311.option port iplookup integer 0
19312.cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
19313This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
19314call.
19315
19316
19317.option protocol iplookup string udp
19318This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
19319protocols is to be used.
19320
19321
19322.option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
19323This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
19324default value is:
19325.code
19326$local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
19327.endd
19328The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
19329query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
19330
19331
19332.option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
19333If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
19334returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
19335string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
19336in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
19337&$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
19338whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
19339up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
19340
19341
19342.option response_pattern iplookup string unset
19343This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
19344returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
19345router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
19346response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
19347check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
19348address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
19349the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
19350following could be used:
19351.code
19352response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
19353reroute = $local_part@$1
19354.endd
19355
19356.option timeout iplookup time 5s
19357This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
19358machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
19359call. It does not apply to UDP.
19360
19361
19362
19363
19364. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19365. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19366
19367.chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
19368.scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
19369.scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
19370.cindex "domain" "manually routing"
19371The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
19372routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
19373route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
19374normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
19375route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
19376messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
19377
19378The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
19379it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
19380has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
19381include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
19382&"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
19383generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
19384being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
19385
19386.vindex "&$host$&"
19387In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
19388router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
19389an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
19390transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
19391with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
19392passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
19393host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
19394text string.
19395
19396The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
19397&%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
19398or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
19399any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
19400below, following the list of private options.
19401
19402
19403.section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
19404
19405.cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
19406The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
19407
19408.option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
19409See &%host_find_failed%&.
19410
19411.option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
19412This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
19413address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
19414of the following values:
19415.code
19416decline
19417defer
19418fail
19419freeze
19420ignore
19421pass
19422.endd
19423The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
19424error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
19425forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
19426&%pass_router%&),
19427.oindex "&%more%&"
19428overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
19429router only if &%more%& is true.
19430
19431The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
19432cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
19433controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
19434as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
19435
19436The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
19437state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
19438generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
19439
19440
19441.option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
19442.cindex "randomized host list"
19443.cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
19444If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
19445is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
19446overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
19447crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
19448same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
19449(even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
19450deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
19451
19452When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
19453into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
19454set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
19455item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
19456.code
19457route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
19458.endd
19459The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
19460randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
19461If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
19462randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
19463&%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
19464
19465
19466.option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
19467If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
19468Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
19469example:
19470.code
19471route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
19472.endd
19473If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
19474router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
19475deferred.
19476
19477
19478.option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
19479This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
19480unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
19481that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
19482
19483
19484.option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
19485.cindex "address" "copying routing"
19486Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
19487router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
19488router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19489default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19490servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19491any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19492
19493If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19494domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
19495local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19496lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
19497&(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
19498addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
19499same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
19500if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
19501
19502
19503
19504
19505.section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
19506The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
19507rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
19508entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
19509described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19510Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
19511.display
19512<&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
19513.endd
19514The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
19515no options:
19516.code
19517route_list = \
19518 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
19519 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19520.endd
19521The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
19522list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
19523usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
19524single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
19525pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
19526&<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
19527except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
19528That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
19529lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
19530in a &%route_list%&).
19531
19532The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
19533matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
19534then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
19535&%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
19536
19537
19538
19539.section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
19540The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
19541routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
19542hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
19543The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
19544Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
19545expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
19546like this:
19547.code
19548dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
19549thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19550.endd
19551This data can be accessed by setting
19552.code
19553route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
19554.endd
19555Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
19556decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
19557requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
19558possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
19559be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
19560
19561
19562
19563
19564.section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
19565A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
19566always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
19567declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
19568and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
19569in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
19570as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19571
19572If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
19573variables are set during its expansion:
19574
19575.ilist
19576.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19577If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
19578&$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
19579.code
19580route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
19581.endd
19582.next
19583&$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
19584.next
19585&$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
19586
19587.next
19588.vindex "&$value$&"
19589If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
19590looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
19591.code
19592route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
19593.endd
19594.endlist
19595
19596Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
19597semicolon is the default route list separator.
19598
19599
19600
19601.section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
19602Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
19603optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
19604is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
19605specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
19606by a colon. This leads to some complications:
19607
19608.ilist
19609Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
19610the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
19611be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
19612.code
19613route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
19614route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
19615.endd
19616.next
19617When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
19618colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
19619enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
19620number follows. For example:
19621.code
19622route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
19623.endd
19624.endlist
19625
19626.section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
19627When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
19628the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
19629delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
19630option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
19631transport.
19632
19633Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
19634hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
19635interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
19636records in the DNS. For example:
19637.code
19638route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
19639.endd
19640If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
19641example:
19642.code
19643route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
19644.endd
19645If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
19646randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
19647that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
19648be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
19649Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
19650happens is controlled by the
19651.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19652&%self%& option of the router.
19653
19654A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
19655hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
19656lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
19657below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
19658preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
19659randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
19660defined by MX preferences.
19661
19662If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
19663not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
19664preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
19665
19666If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
19667depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
19668is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
19669Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
19670
19671If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
19672most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
19673router.
19674
19675DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
19676failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
19677&%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
19678
19679The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
19680whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
19681
19682
19683
19684.section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
19685The options are a sequence of words, space-separated.
19686One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
19687&%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
19688other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
19689per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
19690routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
19691
19692.ilist
19693&%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
19694setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
19695.next
19696&%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
19697overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
19698.next
19699&%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
19700find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
19701also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
19702.next
19703&%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
19704no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
19705timeout), delivery is deferred.
19706.next
19707&%ipv4_only%&: in direct DNS lookups, look up only A records.
19708.next
19709&%ipv4_prefer%&: in direct DNS lookups, sort A records before AAAA records.
19710.endlist
19711
19712For example:
19713.code
19714route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
19715 domain2 host4:host5
19716.endd
19717If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
19718DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
19719result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
19720or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
19721call.
19722
19723&*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
19724called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
19725instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
19726lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
19727function called.
19728
19729&*Compatibility*&: From Exim 4.85 until fixed for 4.90, there was an
19730inadvertent constraint that a transport name as an option had to be the last
19731option specified.
19732
19733
19734
19735If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
19736&%host_find_failed%& option.
19737
19738.vindex "&$host$&"
19739When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
19740The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
19741
19742
19743
19744.section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
19745In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
19746transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
19747
19748.ilist
19749.cindex "smart host" "example router"
19750The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
19751&'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
19752named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
19753.code
19754domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
19755.endd
19756You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
19757your first router something like this:
19758.code
19759smart_route:
19760 driver = manualroute
19761 domains = !+local_domains
19762 transport = remote_smtp
19763 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
19764.endd
19765This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
19766&'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
19767they are tried in order
19768(but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
19769Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
19770.code
19771smart_route:
19772 driver = manualroute
19773 transport = remote_smtp
19774 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
19775.endd
19776There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
19777However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
19778example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
19779precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
19780always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
19781would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
19782always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
19783&%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
19784
19785.next
19786.cindex "mail hub example"
19787A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
19788records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
19789the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
19790machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
19791&(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
19792to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
19793using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
19794lookup is easier to manage.
19795
19796If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
19797to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
19798example:
19799.code
19800hub_route:
19801 driver = manualroute
19802 transport = remote_smtp
19803 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
19804.endd
19805This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
19806whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
19807if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
19808that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
19809domain can be used to find the host:
19810.code
19811through_firewall:
19812 driver = manualroute
19813 transport = remote_smtp
19814 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
19815.endd
19816The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
19817hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
19818data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
19819next router.
19820
19821.next
19822.cindex "batched SMTP output example"
19823.cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
19824You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
19825SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
19826storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
19827can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
19828.code
19829save_in_file:
19830 driver = manualroute
19831 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
19832 route_list = saved.domain.example
19833.endd
19834though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
19835several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
19836different transports can be listed in the routing information:
19837.code
19838save_in_file:
19839 driver = manualroute
19840 route_list = \
19841 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
19842 *.saved.domain2.example \
19843 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
19844 batch_pipe
19845.endd
19846.vindex "&$domain$&"
19847.vindex "&$host$&"
19848The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
19849doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
19850file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
19851the address if the lookup fails.
19852
19853.next
19854.cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
19855Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
19856&(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
19857one way it can be done:
19858.code
19859# Transport
19860uucp:
19861 driver = pipe
19862 user = nobody
19863 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
19864 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
19865 return_fail_output = true
19866
19867# Router
19868uucphost:
19869 transport = uucp
19870 driver = manualroute
19871 route_data = \
19872 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
19873.endd
19874The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
19875.code
19876darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
19877.endd
19878It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
19879makes clear the distinction between the domain name
19880&'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
19881.endlist
19882.ecindex IIDmanrou1
19883.ecindex IIDmanrou2
19884
19885
19886
19887
19888
19889
19890
19891
19892. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19893. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19894
19895.chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
19896.scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
19897.scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
19898.cindex "routing" "by external program"
19899The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
19900and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
19901mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
19902However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
19903&%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
19904be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
19905options:
19906.cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
19907
19908.option command queryprogram string&!! unset
19909This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
19910command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
19911expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
19912&<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
19913
19914
19915.option command_group queryprogram string unset
19916.cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
19917This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
19918address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
19919uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
19920gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
19921
19922
19923.option command_user queryprogram string unset
19924.cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
19925This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
19926command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
19927it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
19928using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
19929not set, a value for the gid also.
19930
19931&*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
19932root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
19933However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
19934usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
19935is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
19936the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
19937gid.
19938
19939
19940.option current_directory queryprogram string /
19941This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
19942before running the command.
19943
19944
19945.option timeout queryprogram time 1h
19946If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
19947is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
19948timeout.
19949
19950
19951The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
19952the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
19953containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
19954the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
19955field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
19956
19957.ilist
19958&'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
19959below).
19960.next
19961&'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
19962&%no_more%& is set.
19963.next
19964&'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
19965subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
19966of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
19967included in the SMTP response.
19968.next
19969&'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
19970subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
19971included in any SMTP response.
19972.next
19973&'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
19974.next
19975&'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
19976&%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
19977.next
19978&'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
19979new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
19980or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
19981.endlist
19982
19983When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
19984number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
19985the page):
19986.code
19987ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
19988LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
19989.endd
19990The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
19991is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
19992used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
19993an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
19994
19995The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
19996As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
19997in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
19998&`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
19999(see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
20000
20001If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
20002find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
20003anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
20004goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
20005result of the lookup is the result of that call.
20006
20007.vindex "&$address_data$&"
20008If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
20009variable. For example, this return line
20010.code
20011accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
20012.endd
20013routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
20014the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
20015.ecindex IIDquerou1
20016.ecindex IIDquerou2
20017
20018
20019
20020
20021. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20022. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20023
20024.chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
20025.scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
20026.scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
20027.cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
20028.cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
20029The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
20030common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
20031(usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
20032files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
20033redirected in several different ways:
20034
20035.ilist
20036It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
20037independently.
20038.next
20039It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
20040.next
20041It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
20042.next
20043It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
20044.next
20045It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
20046.next
20047It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
20048.next
20049It can be discarded.
20050.endlist
20051
20052The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
20053However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
20054files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
20055&%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
20056
20057If success DSNs have been requested
20058.cindex "DSN" "success"
20059.cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
20060redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
20061
20062
20063
20064.section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
20065The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
20066expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
20067contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
20068options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
20069aliases, in a configuration like this:
20070.code
20071system_aliases:
20072 driver = redirect
20073 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
20074.endd
20075If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
20076expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
20077expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
20078cause delivery to be deferred.
20079
20080A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
20081&_.forward_& files, like this:
20082.code
20083userforward:
20084 driver = redirect
20085 check_local_user
20086 file = $home/.forward
20087 no_verify
20088.endd
20089If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
20090empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
20091is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
20092yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
20093comments.
20094
20095
20096
20097.section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
20098.cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
20099It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
20100&_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
20101
20102.ilist
20103When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
20104running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
20105the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
20106practice the router may not be able to operate.
20107.next
20108However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
20109is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
20110local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
20111saves some resources.
20112.endlist
20113
20114
20115
20116
20117
20118
20119.section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
20120.cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20121.cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20122The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
20123can be interpreted in two different ways:
20124
20125.ilist
20126If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
20127&"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
20128&'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
20129respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
20130in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
20131document is intended for use by end users.
20132.next
20133Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
20134described in the next section.
20135.endlist
20136
20137When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
20138in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
20139generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
20140configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
20141for the &(appendfile)& transport.
20142
20143
20144
20145.section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
20146.cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
20147When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
20148comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
20149addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
20150&<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
20151disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
20152depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
20153commas or newlines.
20154If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
20155quotes.
20156
20157Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
20158also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
20159next newline character is ignored.
20160
20161If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
20162double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
20163(but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
20164&"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
20165removed.
20166
20167.vindex "&$local_part$&"
20168&*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
20169and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
20170of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
20171special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
20172&'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
20173setting:
20174.code
20175data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
20176.endd
20177
20178
20179.section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
20180.cindex "routing" "loops in"
20181.cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
20182.cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
20183A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
20184consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
20185automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
20186is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
20187Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
20188as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
20189complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
20190
20191.cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
20192Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
20193filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
20194mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
20195&'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
20196.code
20197cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
20198.endd
20199.cindex "backslash in alias file"
20200.cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
20201For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
20202preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
20203it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
20204synonymously.
20205
20206If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
202072822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
20208domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
20209addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
20210force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
20211
20212Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
20213Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
20214contains:
20215.code
20216Sam.Reman: spqr
20217.endd
20218Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
20219messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
20220this forward file:
20221.code
20222Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20223.endd
20224With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
20225&(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
20226second time round, because it has previously routed it,
20227and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
20228should really contain
20229.code
20230spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20231.endd
20232but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
20233below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
20234&(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
20235
20236
20237
20238.section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
20239In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
20240lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
20241
20242.ilist
20243.cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
20244.cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
20245An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
20246as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
20247command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
20248Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20249which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20250
20251Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
20252the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
20253the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
20254in double quotes, for example:
20255.code
20256"|/some/command ready,steady,go"
20257.endd
20258since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
20259quote just the command. An item such as
20260.code
20261|"/some/command ready,steady,go"
20262.endd
20263is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
20264
20265Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
20266of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
20267redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
20268quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
20269string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
20270are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
20271data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
20272transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
20273an &%accept%& router.
20274
20275.next
20276.cindex "file" "in redirection list"
20277.cindex "address redirection" "to file"
20278An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
20279parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
20280.code
20281/home/world/minbari
20282.endd
20283is treated as a file name, but
20284.code
20285/s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
20286.endd
20287is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
20288the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
20289forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
20290file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
20291
20292Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20293which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20294
20295.cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
20296However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
20297bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
20298instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
20299
20300.next
20301.cindex "included address list"
20302.cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
20303If an item is of the form
20304.code
20305:include:<path name>
20306.endd
20307a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
20308point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
20309out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
20310by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
20311item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
20312the alias name. This example is incorrect:
20313.code
20314list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
20315.endd
20316It must be given as
20317.code
20318list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
20319.endd
20320.next
20321.cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
20322.cindex "delivery" "discard"
20323.cindex "delivery" "blackhole"
20324.cindex "black hole"
20325.cindex "abandoning mail"
20326Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
20327&%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
20328the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
20329.code
20330:blackhole:
20331.endd
20332can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
20333done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
20334&_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
20335
20336&*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
20337delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
20338are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
20339database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
20340&_/dev/null_&.
20341
20342.next
20343.cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
20344.cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
20345.cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
20346.cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
20347.cindex "customizing" "failure message"
20348An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
20349redirection items of the form
20350.code
20351:defer:
20352:fail:
20353.endd
20354respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
20355to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
20356text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
20357associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
20358.code
20359X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
20360.endd
20361In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
20362of a
20363.cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
20364VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
20365default.
20366.cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
20367The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
20368the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
20369
20370.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20371By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
20372&':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
20373space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
20374followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
20375code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
20376incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
20377suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
20378&%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
20379ignored.
20380
20381.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
20382In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
20383default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
20384therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
20385
20386Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
20387not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
20388normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
20389as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
20390lookup and in &':include:'& files.
20391
20392During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
20393containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
20394whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
20395subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
20396deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
20397rules still apply.
20398
20399.next
20400.cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
20401Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
20402chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
20403for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
20404&':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
20405router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
20406results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
20407.endlist
20408
20409
20410.section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
20411.cindex "duplicate addresses"
20412.cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
20413.cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
20414Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
20415to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
20416routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
20417aliasing scheme of the type
20418.code
20419pipe: |/some/command $local_part
20420localpart1: pipe
20421localpart2: pipe
20422.endd
20423does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
20424when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
20425discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
20426such as
20427.code
20428localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
20429localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
20430.endd
20431does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
20432the pipes are distinct.
20433
20434
20435
20436.section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
20437.cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
20438.cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
20439When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
20440leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
20441afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
20442delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
20443members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
20444can be used to avoid this.
20445
20446
20447.section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
20448.cindex "address redirection" "errors"
20449If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
20450error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
20451for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
20452detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
20453deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
20454
20455
20456
20457.section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
20458
20459.cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
20460The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
20461
20462
20463.option allow_defer redirect boolean false
20464Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
20465data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
20466
20467
20468.option allow_fail redirect boolean false
20469.cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
20470If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
20471and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
20472
20473
20474.option allow_filter redirect boolean false
20475.cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
20476.cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
20477Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
20478&"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
20479are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
20480lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
20481
20482It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
20483the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
20484
20485
20486The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
20487&%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
20488&%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
20489files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
20490true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
20491
20492
20493
20494.option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
20495.cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
20496Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
20497This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
20498default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
20499let ordinary users do.
20500
20501
20502
20503.option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
20504This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
20505as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
20506Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
20507configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
20508for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
20509
20510When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
20511is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
20512the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
20513and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
20514domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
20515&_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
20516.code
20517\Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
20518.endd
20519Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
20520&"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
20521originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
20522(having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
20523&"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
20524&%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
20525file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
20526original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
20527
20528
20529.option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
20530When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
20531when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
20532&%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
20533&%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
20534deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
20535is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
20536&%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
20537
20538
20539
20540.option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
20541When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
20542this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
20543permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
20544option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
20545&%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
20546
20547
20548.option data redirect string&!! unset
20549This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
20550set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
20551list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
20552expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
20553has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
20554
20555When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
20556filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
20557terminated with newline characters. For example:
20558.code
20559data = #Exim filter\n\
20560 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
20561.endd
20562If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
20563you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
20564choice into a newline.
20565
20566
20567.option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
20568A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
20569ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20570specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20571configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
20572
20573
20574.option file redirect string&!! unset
20575This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
20576is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
20577use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
20578failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
20579must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
20580data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
20581entirely of comments), the router declines.
20582
20583.cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
20584If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
20585runs a check on the containing directory,
20586unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
20587If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
20588happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
20589is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
20590not, the router declines.
20591
20592
20593.option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
20594.vindex "&$address_file$&"
20595A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
20596ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20597specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20598configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
20599it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
20600
20601
20602.option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
20603When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
20604relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
20605relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
20606relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
20607
20608
20609.option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
20610.cindex "restricting access to features"
20611.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20612If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
20613redirection list.
20614
20615
20616.option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
20617.cindex "restricting access to features"
20618.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20619If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
20620&%allow_filter%& is true.
20621
20622
20623
20624
20625.option forbid_file redirect boolean false
20626.cindex "restricting access to features"
20627.cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
20628.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20629.cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
20630.cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
20631If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
20632specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
20633conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
20634set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
20635locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
20636
20637
20638.option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
20639.cindex "restricting access to features"
20640.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20641If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20642make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
20643functions.
20644
20645.option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
20646.cindex "restricting access to features"
20647.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20648.cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
20649If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20650make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
20651
20652.option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
20653.cindex "restricting access to features"
20654.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20655If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
20656permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
20657under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
20658&_.forward_& files).
20659
20660
20661.option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
20662.cindex "restricting access to features"
20663.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20664If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20665to make use of &%lookup%& items.
20666
20667
20668.option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
20669.cindex "restricting access to features"
20670.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20671This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
20672it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
20673of the embedded Perl support.
20674
20675
20676.option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
20677.cindex "restricting access to features"
20678.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20679If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20680to make use of &%readfile%& items.
20681
20682
20683.option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
20684.cindex "restricting access to features"
20685.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20686If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20687to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
20688
20689
20690.option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
20691.cindex "restricting access to features"
20692.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20693If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
20694message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
20695files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
20696&%one_time%& is set.
20697
20698
20699.option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
20700.cindex "restricting access to features"
20701.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20702If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20703to make use of &%run%& items.
20704
20705
20706.option forbid_include redirect boolean false
20707.cindex "restricting access to features"
20708.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20709If this option is true, items of the form
20710.code
20711:include:<path name>
20712.endd
20713are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
20714
20715
20716.option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
20717.cindex "restricting access to features"
20718.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20719.cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
20720If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
20721specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
20722forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
20723
20724
20725.option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
20726.cindex "restricting access to features"
20727.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20728If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
20729&%allow_filter%& is true.
20730
20731
20732.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20733.option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
20734If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
20735of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
20736the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
20737
20738
20739
20740
20741.option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
20742.cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
20743If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
20744generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
20745generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
20746bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
20747bounce may well quote the generated address.
20748
20749
20750.option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
20751.cindex "EACCES"
20752If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
20753EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
20754file did not exist.
20755
20756
20757.option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
20758.cindex "ENOTDIR"
20759If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
20760ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
20761router behaves as if the file did not exist.
20762
20763Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
20764router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
20765(the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
20766against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
20767is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
20768is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
20769a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
20770that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
20771
20772
20773
20774.option include_directory redirect string unset
20775If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
20776redirection list must start with this directory.
20777
20778
20779.option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
20780This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
20781&%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
20782
20783
20784.option one_time redirect boolean false
20785.cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
20786.cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
20787.cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
20788.cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
20789.cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
20790Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
20791files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
20792of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
20793is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
20794but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
20795message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
20796lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
20797before they subscribed.
20798
20799If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
20800deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
20801&"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
20802&"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
20803attempt.
20804
20805&*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
20806router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
20807reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
20808permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
20809
20810&*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
20811to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
20812and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
20813
20814&*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
20815&%one_time%&.
20816
20817The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
20818addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
20819addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
20820&%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
20821typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
20822expansion.
20823
20824
20825.option owners redirect "string list" unset
20826.cindex "ownership" "alias file"
20827.cindex "ownership" "forward file"
20828.cindex "alias file" "ownership"
20829.cindex "forward file" "ownership"
20830This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
20831This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
20832See &%check_owner%& above.
20833
20834
20835.option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
20836This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
20837The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
20838&%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
20839
20840
20841.option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
20842.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
20843A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
20844starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
20845transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
20846name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
20847When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
20848
20849
20850.option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
20851.vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
20852If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
20853generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
20854in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
20855expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
20856to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
20857&$qualify_recipient$&.
20858
20859This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
20860but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
20861not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
20862addresses.
20863
20864.option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
20865.cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
20866.cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
20867.cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
20868If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
20869set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
20870without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
20871address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
20872&%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
20873this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
20874
20875
20876.option repeat_use redirect boolean true
20877If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
20878any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
20879the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
20880only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
20881&%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
20882
20883
20884.option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
20885A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
20886&%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
20887by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
20888transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
20889are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
20890
20891
20892.option rewrite redirect boolean true
20893.cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
20894If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
20895subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
20896and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
20897
20898
20899.option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
20900The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
20901:subaddress part of an address.
20902
20903.option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
20904The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
20905of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
20906(including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
20907
20908
20909.option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
20910.cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
20911To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
20912&%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
20913(do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
20914&%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
20915needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
20916
20917
20918
20919.option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
20920.cindex "forward file" "broken"
20921.cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
20922.cindex "alias file" "broken"
20923.cindex "broken alias or forward files"
20924.cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
20925.cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
20926.cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
20927If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
20928non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
20929&%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
20930giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
20931are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
20932&%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
20933be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
20934&%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
20935
20936If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
20937errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
20938the following routers.
20939
20940If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
20941error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
20942taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
20943so it is passed to the following routers.
20944
20945.cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
20946Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
20947action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
20948&%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
20949
20950&%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
20951lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
20952option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
20953notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
20954.code
20955userforward:
20956 driver = redirect
20957 allow_filter
20958 check_local_user
20959 file = $home/.forward
20960 file_transport = address_file
20961 pipe_transport = address_pipe
20962 reply_transport = address_reply
20963 no_verify
20964 skip_syntax_errors
20965 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
20966 syntax_errors_text = \
20967 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
20968 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
20969 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
20970 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
20971 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
20972 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
20973 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
20974 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
20975 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
20976 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
20977.endd
20978You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
20979&`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
20980put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
20981.code
20982real_localuser:
20983 driver = accept
20984 check_local_user
20985 local_part_prefix = real-
20986 transport = local_delivery
20987.endd
20988For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
20989router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
20990.code
20991 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
20992 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
20993.endd
20994
20995
20996.option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
20997See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
20998
20999
21000.option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
21001See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
21002.ecindex IIDredrou1
21003.ecindex IIDredrou2
21004
21005
21006
21007
21008
21009
21010. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21011. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21012
21013.chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
21014 "Environment for local transports"
21015.scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
21016.scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment" "local transports"
21017.scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
21018Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
21019transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
21020in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
21021mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
21022
21023Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
21024some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
21025transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
21026&<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
21027
21028The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
21029different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
21030settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
21031or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
21032configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
21033
21034
21035
21036.section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
21037.cindex "concurrent deliveries"
21038.cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
21039If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
21040simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
21041the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
21042rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
21043time.
21044
21045However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
21046locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
21047.code
21048my_transport:
21049 driver = pipe
21050 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
21051.endd
21052This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
21053messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
21054&%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
21055file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
21056
21057
21058
21059
21060.section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
21061.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
21062.cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
21063All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
21064overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
21065set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
21066delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
21067group (set by the transport). For example:
21068.code
21069# Routers ...
21070# User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
21071local_users:
21072 driver = accept
21073 check_local_user
21074 transport = group_delivery
21075
21076# Transports ...
21077# This transport overrides the group
21078group_delivery:
21079 driver = appendfile
21080 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21081 group = mail
21082.endd
21083If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
21084address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
21085gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
21086set.
21087
21088.oindex "&%initgroups%&"
21089When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
21090function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
21091&%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
21092by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
21093for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
21094
21095.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
21096The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
21097is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
21098receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
21099original gid is also used.
21100
21101This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
21102following that is set is used:
21103
21104.ilist
21105A &%group%& setting of the transport;
21106.next
21107A &%group%& setting of the router;
21108.next
21109A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
21110&%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
21111.next
21112The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
21113.next
21114In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
21115the uid is the creator's uid;
21116.next
21117The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
21118.endlist
21119
21120If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
21121no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
21122This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
21123The first of the following that is set is used:
21124
21125.ilist
21126A &%user%& setting of the transport;
21127.next
21128In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
21129.next
21130A &%user%& setting of the router;
21131.next
21132A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
21133.next
21134The Exim uid.
21135.endlist
21136
21137Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
21138&%never_users%& list.
21139
21140
21141
21142
21143
21144.section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
21145.cindex "current directory for local transport"
21146.cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
21147.cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
21148.cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
21149Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
21150the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
21151However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
21152are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
21153for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21154
21155.ilist
21156The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
21157.next
21158The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
21159.next
21160The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
21161.next
21162The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
21163.endlist
21164
21165The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21166
21167.ilist
21168The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
21169.next
21170The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
21171.endlist
21172
21173
21174If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
21175value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
21176directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
21177
21178
21179
21180.section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
21181.vindex "&$domain$&"
21182.vindex "&$local_part$&"
21183.vindex "&$original_domain$&"
21184Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
21185variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
21186deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
21187at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
21188other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
21189never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
21190and &$original_domain$& is never set.
21191.ecindex IIDenvlotra1
21192.ecindex IIDenvlotra2
21193.ecindex IIDenvlotra3
21194
21195
21196
21197
21198
21199
21200
21201. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21202. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21203
21204.chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
21205.scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
21206.scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
21207.scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
21208The following generic options apply to all transports:
21209
21210
21211.option body_only transports boolean false
21212.cindex "transport" "body only"
21213.cindex "message" "transporting body only"
21214.cindex "body of message" "transporting"
21215If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
21216mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
21217or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
21218&%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
21219automatically suppress them.
21220
21221
21222.option current_directory transports string&!! unset
21223.cindex "transport" "current directory for"
21224This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
21225transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
21226If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
21227logged, and delivery is deferred.
21228
21229
21230.option disable_logging transports boolean false
21231If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
21232deliveries by the transport or for any
21233transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
21234what you are doing.
21235
21236
21237.option debug_print transports string&!! unset
21238.cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
21239If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
21240option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
21241transport is run.
21242If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
21243output, and Exim carries on processing.
21244This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
21245so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
21246option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
21247variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
21248one.
21249The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
21250transport and the router that called it.
21251
21252.option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
21253.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
21254If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
21255This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
21256header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
21257requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
21258safely be resent to other recipients.
21259
21260
21261.option driver transports string unset
21262This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
21263There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
21264
21265
21266.option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
21267.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21268If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
21269This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
21270delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
21271configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
21272address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
21273header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
21274its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
21275resent to other recipients.
21276
21277
21278.option event_action transports string&!! unset
21279.cindex events
21280This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
21281For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
21282
21283
21284.option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
21285.cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
21286This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
21287value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
21288&%user%& (see below).
21289
21290
21291.option headers_add transports list&!! unset
21292.cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
21293.cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
21294This option specifies a list of text headers,
21295newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way),
21296which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
21297portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
21298&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
21299routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21300is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21301errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21302
21303Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
21304for a transport; all listed headers are added.
21305
21306
21307.option headers_only transports boolean false
21308.cindex "transport" "header lines only"
21309.cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
21310.cindex "header lines" "transporting"
21311If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
21312exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
21313transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
21314checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
21315
21316
21317.option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
21318.cindex "header lines" "removing"
21319.cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
21320This option specifies a list of header names,
21321colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way);
21322these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
21323in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
21324routers.
21325Each list item is separately expanded.
21326If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21327is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21328errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21329
21330Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
21331for a transport; all listed headers are removed.
21332
21333&*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
21334items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
21335To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
21336
21337
21338
21339.option headers_rewrite transports string unset
21340.cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
21341.cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
21342This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
21343that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
21344option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
21345the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
21346message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
21347example,
21348.code
21349headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
21350 x@y w@z
21351.endd
21352changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
21353&'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
21354header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
21355only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
21356the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
21357filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
21358affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
21359envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
21360change envelope recipients at this time.
21361
21362
21363.option home_directory transports string&!! unset
21364.cindex "transport" "home directory for"
21365.vindex "&$home$&"
21366This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
21367overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
21368placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
21369used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
21370&%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
21371&%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
21372for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
21373deferred.
21374
21375
21376.option initgroups transports boolean false
21377.cindex "additional groups"
21378.cindex "groups" "additional"
21379.cindex "transport" "group; additional"
21380If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
21381transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
21382to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
21383
21384
21385.option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
21386.cindex limit "transport parallelism"
21387.cindex transport "parallel processes"
21388.cindex transport "concurrency limit"
21389.cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
21390If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
21391it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
21392The control does not apply to shadow transports.
21393
21394.cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
21395Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
21396incremented whenever a transport process is being created. The record
21397is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
21398Obviously there is scope for
21399records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
21400guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
21401
21402If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
21403relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
21404start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
21405may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
21406are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
21407
21408
21409.option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
21410.cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
21411.cindex "size" "of message, limit"
21412.cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
21413This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
21414expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
21415digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
21416including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
21417delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
21418message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
21419the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
21420ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
21421&%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
21422delivered.
21423
21424
21425
21426.option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
21427.cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
21428.cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
21429.cindex "local part" "prefix"
21430.cindex "local part" "suffix"
21431When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
21432affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
21433form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
21434that contains
21435.code
21436local_part_prefix = *-
21437.endd
21438routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
21439is delivered with
21440.code
21441RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
21442.endd
21443This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
21444recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
21445whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
21446deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
21447&(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
21448
21449
21450.option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
21451.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
21452When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
21453in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
21454is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
21455deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
21456part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
21457temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
21458deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
21459
21460However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
21461as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
21462(For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
21463this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
21464
21465For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
21466the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
21467on a remote transport in the current implementation.
21468
21469
21470.option return_path transports string&!! unset
21471.cindex "envelope sender"
21472.cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
21473.cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
21474If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
21475the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
21476that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
21477designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
21478SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
21479only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
21480header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
21481
21482&*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
21483&%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
21484
21485.vindex "&$return_path$&"
21486The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
21487either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
21488&%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
21489replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
21490option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
21491section &<<SECTverp>>&.
21492
21493&*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
21494remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
21495the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
21496This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
21497&%errors_to%& in a router.
21498
21499
21500
21501.option return_path_add transports boolean false
21502.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
21503If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
21504Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
21505mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
21506have easy access to it.
21507
21508RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
21509the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
21510header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
21511option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
21512incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
21513recipients.
21514
21515
21516.option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
21517See &%shadow_transport%& below.
21518
21519
21520.option shadow_transport transports string unset
21521.cindex "shadow transport"
21522.cindex "transport" "shadow"
21523A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
21524another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
21525
21526Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
21527&%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
21528string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
21529passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
21530expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
21531cause a log line to be written.
21532
21533The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
21534subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
21535provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
21536is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
21537ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
21538of the form
21539.code
21540ST=<shadow transport name>
21541.endd
21542If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
21543parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
21544purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
21545provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
21546headers that some sites insist on.
21547
21548
21549.option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
21550.cindex "transport" "filter"
21551.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21552This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
21553at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
21554individual users or via a system filter.
21555If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
21556
21557When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
21558&%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
21559the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
21560input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
21561command must be specified as an absolute path.
21562
21563The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
21564terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
21565SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
21566lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
21567settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
21568&(pipe)& transports.
21569
21570The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
21571standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
21572destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
21573filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
21574are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
21575
21576The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
21577care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
21578test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
21579SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
21580
21581.cindex "content scanning" "per user"
21582A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
21583at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
21584message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
21585a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
21586not possible to discard a message at this stage.
21587
21588.cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
21589A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
21590being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
21591support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
21592at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
21593more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
21594the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
21595additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
21596
21597.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21598The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
21599the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
21600parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
21601Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
21602section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
21603to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
21604of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
21605an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
21606&(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
21607
21608.vindex "&$host$&"
21609.vindex "&$host_address$&"
21610The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
21611transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
21612which the message is being sent. For example:
21613.code
21614transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
21615 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
21616.endd
21617
21618Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
21619generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
21620command is split up &'before'& expansion.
21621.ilist
21622If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
21623part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
21624expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
21625example:
21626.code
21627transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
21628.endd
21629This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
21630&(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
21631stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
21632the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
21633&`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
21634Exim tried to expand the first one.
21635.next
21636Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
21637expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
21638arguments. Consider this example:
21639.code
21640transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21641 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21642.endd
21643The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
21644if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
21645.code
21646transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21647 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21648.endd
21649.endlist
21650
21651The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
21652For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
21653normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
21654A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
21655serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
21656the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
21657bounced from a transport filter.
21658
21659If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
21660passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
21661message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
21662
21663
21664.option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
21665.cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
21666When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
21667that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
21668temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
21669&(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
21670way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
21671error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
21672becomes a temporary error.
21673
21674
21675.option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
21676.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
21677.cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
21678This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
21679run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
21680given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
21681associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
21682option is not set.
21683
21684For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
21685specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
21686&%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
21687
21688.cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
21689For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
21690sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
21691to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
21692retry data.
21693.ecindex IIDgenoptra1
21694.ecindex IIDgenoptra2
21695.ecindex IIDgenoptra3
21696
21697
21698
21699
21700
21701
21702. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21703. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21704
21705.chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
21706 "Address batching"
21707.cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
21708The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
21709one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
21710remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
21711normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
21712transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
21713copy of the message is delivered each time.
21714
21715.cindex "batched local delivery"
21716.oindex "&%batch_max%&"
21717.oindex "&%batch_id%&"
21718In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
21719local transport, for example:
21720
21721.ilist
21722In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
21723delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
21724recipients saves space.
21725.next
21726In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
21727a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
21728.next
21729In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
21730to a scanner program or
21731to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
21732acceptable.
21733.endlist
21734
21735These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
21736(&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
21737repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
21738
21739The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
21740delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
21741(no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
21742&%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
21743(that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
21744to certain conditions:
21745
21746.ilist
21747.vindex "&$local_part$&"
21748If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
21749batching is possible.
21750.next
21751.vindex "&$domain$&"
21752If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
21753addresses with the same domain are batched.
21754.next
21755.cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
21756If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
21757addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
21758customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
21759including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
21760from taking place.
21761.next
21762Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
21763delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
21764group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
21765be the same.
21766.endlist
21767
21768In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
21769both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
21770is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
21771course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
21772option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
21773&"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
21774&%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
21775.code
21776check_string = "."
21777escape_string = ".."
21778.endd
21779when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
21780given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
21781&%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
21782
21783.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21784If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
21785&'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
21786that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
21787transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
21788addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
21789
21790.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
21791.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21792If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
21793transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
21794the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
21795of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
21796argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
21797delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
21798are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
21799
21800
21801
21802
21803. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21804. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21805
21806.chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
21807.scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
21808.scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
21809.cindex "directory creation"
21810.cindex "creating directories"
21811The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
21812file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
21813files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
21814format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
21815University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
21816being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
21817to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
21818delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
21819supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
21820directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
21821
21822The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
21823default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
21824SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
21825included.
21826
21827.cindex "quota" "system"
21828Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
21829also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
21830system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
21831
21832If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
21833partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
21834modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
21835creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
21836
21837Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
21838file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
21839private options.
21840
21841The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
21842users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
21843putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
21844&"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
21845option).
21846
21847
21848
21849.section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
21850The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
21851the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
21852the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
21853normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
21854
21855.vindex "&$address_file$&"
21856.vindex "&$local_part$&"
21857However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
21858directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
21859forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
21860user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
21861the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
21862name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
21863operation. There are two cases:
21864
21865.ilist
21866If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
21867must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
21868common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
21869different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
21870default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
21871name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
21872&%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
21873.next
21874If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
21875used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
21876contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
21877.endlist
21878
21879
21880.cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
21881.cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
21882As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
21883have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
21884form:
21885.code
21886save folder23
21887.endd
21888or Sieve filter commands of the form:
21889.code
21890require "fileinto";
21891fileinto "folder23";
21892.endd
21893In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
21894must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
21895case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
21896is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
21897way of handling this requirement:
21898.code
21899file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
21900 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
21901 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
21902 {$address_file} \
21903 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
21904 }} \
21905 }
21906.endd
21907With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
21908location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
21909&_mail_& directory within the home directory.
21910
21911&*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
21912&_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
21913the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
21914you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
21915&%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
21916path to the transport.
21917
21918&*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
21919the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
21920
21921
21922
21923
21924.section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
21925.cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
21926
21927
21928
21929.option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
21930.cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
21931.cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
21932.cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
21933Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
21934regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
21935delivery is deferred.
21936
21937
21938.option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
21939.cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
21940.cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
21941By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
21942that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
21943are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
21944what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
21945are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
21946
21947
21948.option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
21949See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21950However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
21951happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
21952file.
21953
21954
21955.option batch_max appendfile integer 1
21956See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
21957
21958
21959.option check_group appendfile boolean false
21960When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
21961option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
21962delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
21963file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
21964
21965
21966.option check_owner appendfile boolean true
21967When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
21968is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
21969process is running.
21970
21971
21972.option check_string appendfile string "see below"
21973.cindex "&""From""& line"
21974As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
21975matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
21976replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
21977a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
21978contains is significant.
21979
21980If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
21981are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
21982configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
21983&">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
21984&%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
21985
21986The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
21987suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
21988&"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
21989if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
21990.cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
21991.cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
21992.code
21993check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21994escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
21995message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21996message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
21997.endd
21998.option create_directory appendfile boolean true
21999.cindex "directory creation"
22000When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
22001directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
22002is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
22003
22004The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
22005operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
22006example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
22007is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
22008in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
22009
22010
22011
22012.option create_file appendfile string anywhere
22013This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
22014by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
22015directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
22016delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
22017beneath.
22018
22019The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
22020&"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
22021set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
22022given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
22023names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
22024by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
22025&%file_must_exist%&.
22026
22027
22028.option directory appendfile string&!! unset
22029This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
22030or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
22031redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
22032
22033When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
22034into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
22035appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
22036(see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
22037&<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
22038
22039
22040.option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
22041.cindex "base62"
22042.vindex "&$inode$&"
22043When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
22044&%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
22045whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
22046.code
22047q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
22048.endd
22049This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
22050inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
22051option.
22052
22053
22054.option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
22055If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
22056&%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
22057
22058
22059.option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
22060See &%check_string%& above.
22061
22062
22063.option file appendfile string&!! unset
22064This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
22065&%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
22066of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
22067specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
22068&%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
22069&%file%&.
22070
22071.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22072.cindex "locking files"
22073.cindex "lock files"
22074If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
22075mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
22076
22077The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
22078path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
22079examples:
22080.code
22081file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
22082file = /home/$local_part/inbox
22083file = $home/inbox
22084.endd
22085.cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
22086In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
22087is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
22088create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
22089deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
22090run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
22091
22092
22093
22094.option file_format appendfile string unset
22095.cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
22096This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
22097before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
22098start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
22099colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
22100second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
22101string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
22102transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
22103this added to it:
22104.code
22105file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
22106 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
22107.endd
22108Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
22109a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
22110to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
22111to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
22112is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
22113match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
22114delivery is deferred.
22115
22116
22117.option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
22118If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
22119A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
22120If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
22121
22122
22123.option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
22124.cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22125.cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
22126.cindex "locking files"
22127By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
22128when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
22129sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
22130Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
22131for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
22132deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
22133mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
22134misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
22135
22136On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
22137not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
22138is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
22139and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
22140
22141If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
22142timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
22143retries is
22144.code
22145(lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
22146.endd
22147rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
22148which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
22149&%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
22150
22151You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
22152local deliveries because of errors of the form
22153.code
22154failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
22155.endd
22156
22157.option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
22158This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
22159&%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
22160&%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
22161
22162
22163.option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
22164This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
22165for details of locking.
22166
22167
22168.option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
22169This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
22170is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
22171
22172
22173.option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22174This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
22175used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
22176
22177
22178.option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
22179.cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22180When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
22181exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
22182accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
22183
22184
22185.option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
22186.cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22187.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22188If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22189number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
22190followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
22191external source that maintains the data.
22192
22193
22194.option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
22195.cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22196.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22197If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22198size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
22199This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
22200maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
22201it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
22202
22203
22204
22205.option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
22206.cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
22207If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
22208file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
22209transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
22210&(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
22211&%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
22212directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
22213SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
22214&<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22215
22216
22217.option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
22218.cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
22219.cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
22220This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
22221a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
22222directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
22223calculation. The default value is:
22224.code
22225maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
22226.endd
22227This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
22228(directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
22229&_Trash_&
22230folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
22231.code
22232maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
22233.endd
22234This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
22235directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
22236calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
22237directly into that directory.
22238
22239
22240.option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
22241This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
22242&"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22243
22244
22245.option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
22246This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
22247section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22248
22249
22250.option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
22251.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22252The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
22253If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
22254creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
22255quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
22256value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
22257&<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22258
22259.option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
22260.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
22261.cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
22262The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
22263effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
22264matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
22265containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
22266delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
22267&_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
22268See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
22269
22270
22271.option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
22272.cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
22273If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
22274new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
22275SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
22276below for further details.
22277
22278
22279.option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
22280This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22281section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22282
22283
22284.option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
22285This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22286section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22287
22288
22289.option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
22290.cindex "locking files"
22291.cindex "file" "locking"
22292.cindex "file" "MBX format"
22293.cindex "MBX format, specifying"
22294This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22295set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
22296the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
22297traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
22298IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
22299
22300&*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
22301automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
22302empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
22303combination:
22304.code
22305mbx_format = true
22306message_prefix =
22307message_suffix =
22308.endd
22309If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
22310&%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
22311is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
22312&%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
22313interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
22314should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
22315going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
22316mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
22317
22318If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
22319the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
22320(this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
22321append messages to it.
22322
22323
22324.option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22325.cindex "&""From""& line"
22326The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22327The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22328in which case it is:
22329.code
22330message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
22331 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
22332.endd
22333&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22334&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22335
22336.option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22337The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22338The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22339in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
22340setting
22341.code
22342message_suffix =
22343.endd
22344&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22345&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22346
22347.option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22348If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
22349has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
22350permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
22351if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
22352a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
22353value, and this option is ignored.
22354
22355
22356.option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
22357This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
22358mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
22359true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
22360continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
22361
22362
22363.option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
22364If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
22365successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
22366on users about incoming mail.
22367
22368
22369.option quota appendfile string&!! unset
22370.cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
22371This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
22372or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
22373is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
22374all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
22375individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
22376&%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
22377have no shell access to their mailboxes).
22378
22379As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
22380multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
22381For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
22382
22383A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
22384may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
22385If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
22386become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
22387Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
22388the obvious value which users understand most easily.
22389
22390The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
22391(decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
22392for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, optionally followed by a slash
22393and further option modifiers. If Exim is running on a system with
22394large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
22395be handled.
22396
22397The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22398quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22399
22400&*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
22401
22402The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
22403the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
22404be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
22405fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
22406system quota failures.
22407
22408By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
22409mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
22410last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
22411during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
22412refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
22413message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
22414changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
22415for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
22416continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
22417delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
22418
22419
22420.option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
22421This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
22422into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
22423called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
22424delivery directory.
22425
22426
22427.option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
22428This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
22429number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
22430can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
22431failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
22432&"no quota"&.
22433
22434The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22435quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22436
22437.option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
22438See &%quota%& above.
22439
22440
22441.option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
22442This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
22443for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
22444these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
22445If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
22446captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
22447file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
22448
22449This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
22450&-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
22451facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
22452the file length to the file name. For example:
22453.code
22454maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
22455quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
22456.endd
22457An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
22458number of lines in the message.
22459
22460The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
22461file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
22462sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
22463
22464Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
22465
22466
22467.option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
22468See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
22469&%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
22470.code
22471quota_warn_message = "\
22472 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
22473 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
22474 This message is automatically created \
22475 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
22476 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
22477 a warning threshold that is\n\
22478 set by the system administrator.\n"
22479.endd
22480
22481
22482.option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
22483.cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
22484.cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
22485.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22486This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
22487resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
22488size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
22489threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
22490may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
22491sign. For example:
22492.code
22493quota = 10M
22494quota_warn_threshold = 75%
22495.endd
22496If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
22497percent sign is ignored.
22498
22499The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
22500and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
22501warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
22502the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
22503can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
22504&'From:'& line, the default is:
22505.code
22506From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
22507.endd
22508.oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
22509If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
22510option.
22511
22512The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
22513are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
22514percentage.
22515
22516
22517.option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
22518.cindex "envelope sender"
22519If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
22520format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
22521you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
22522so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
22523for details of batch SMTP.
22524
22525
22526.option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
22527.cindex "carriage return"
22528.cindex "linefeed"
22529This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
22530(carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
22531of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
22532of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
22533
22534&*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
22535(which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
22536in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
22537carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
22538have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
22539changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
22540
22541
22542.option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22543This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
22544exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
22545&%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
22546that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22547&%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
22548
22549
22550.option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
22551This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
22552the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
22553&[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
22554each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
22555
22556This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
22557&[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
22558where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
22559both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
22560
22561.cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
22562Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
22563have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
22564&[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
22565the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
22566error.
22567
22568&*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
22569is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
22570
22571
22572.option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
22573If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
22574appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
22575&[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
22576sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
22577&[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
22578delivering over NFS from more than one host.
22579
22580.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22581In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
22582necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
22583achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
22584file corruption.
22585
22586The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
22587It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
22588except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
22589
22590
22591.option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22592This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22593set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
22594locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
22595of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
22596are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
22597the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
22598rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
22599does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
22600
22601You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22602&%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
22603MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
22604without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
22605
22606
22607
22608
22609.section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
22610.cindex "appending to a file"
22611.cindex "file" "appending"
22612Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
22613
22614.ilist
22615If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
22616return is given.
22617
22618.next
22619.cindex "directory creation"
22620If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
22621&%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
22622&%directory_mode%& option.
22623
22624.next
22625If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
22626indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
22627transport.
22628
22629.next
22630.cindex "file" "locking"
22631.cindex "locking files"
22632.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22633If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
22634reliably over NFS, as follows:
22635
22636.olist
22637Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
22638current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
22639as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
22640.next
22641Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
22642.next
22643If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
22644Unlink the hitching post name.
22645.next
22646Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
22647then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
22648of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
22649restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
22650.next
22651If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
22652up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
22653mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
22654lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
22655existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
22656it before trying again.
22657.endlist olist
22658
22659.next
22660A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
22661so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
22662than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
22663
22664.next
22665.cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
22666.cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
22667If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
22668&%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
22669checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
22670is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
22671ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
22672directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
22673idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
22674checked.
22675
22676.next
22677If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
22678and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
22679different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
22680delivery is deferred.
22681
22682.next
22683If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
22684If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
22685is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
22686permissions.
22687
22688.next
22689The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
22690If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
22691hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
22692
22693.next
22694If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
22695changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
22696have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
22697
22698.next
22699If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
22700option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
22701directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
22702open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
22703except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
22704set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
22705the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
22706that prevents link following.
22707
22708.next
22709.cindex "loop" "while file testing"
22710If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
22711existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
22712being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
22713after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
22714
22715.next
22716If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
22717
22718.next
22719.cindex "file" "locking"
22720.cindex "locking files"
22721Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
22722are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
22723&%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
22724However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
22725file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
22726.code
22727/tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
22728.endd
22729using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
22730the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
22731the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
22732
22733If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
22734depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
22735&%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
22736
22737If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
22738&%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
22739to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
22740delivery is deferred.
22741
22742If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
22743&[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
22744waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
22745immediately. It retries up to
22746.code
22747(lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
22748.endd
22749times (rounded up).
22750.endlist
22751
22752At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
22753and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
22754
22755
22756.section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
22757.cindex "delivery" "to single file"
22758.cindex "&""From""& line"
22759When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
22760delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
22761activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
22762&%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
22763router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
22764configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
22765ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
22766
22767No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
22768locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
22769separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
22770of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
22771newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
22772&%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
22773any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
22774
22775If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
22776the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
22777different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
22778deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
22779
22780
22781.cindex "maildir format"
22782.cindex "mailstore format"
22783There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
22784done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
22785&%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
22786formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
22787SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
22788
22789.cindex "directory creation"
22790In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
22791sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
22792option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
22793constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
22794the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
22795&%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
22796deferred.
22797
22798
22799
22800.section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
22801.cindex "maildir format" "description of"
22802If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
22803it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
22804directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
22805directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
22806&_new_& subdirectory.
22807
22808In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
22809<&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
22810Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
22811before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
22812file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
22813opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
22814Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
22815
22816Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
22817called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
22818do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
22819path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
22820&%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
22821contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
22822&_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
22823&_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
22824
22825These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
22826and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
22827folders. Consider this example:
22828.code
22829maildir_format = true
22830directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
22831 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
22832 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
22833maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
22834.endd
22835If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
22836delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
22837the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
22838not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
22839&_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
22840&_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
22841
22842However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
22843delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
22844does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
22845&_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
22846directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
22847
22848&*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
22849not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
22850&_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
22851
22852.cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22853.cindex "maildir++"
22854If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
22855&%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
22856the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
22857Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
22858down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
22859the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
22860amount of space used.
22861
22862One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
22863computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
22864checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
22865needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
22866use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
22867of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
22868
22869
22870
22871
22872.section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
22873If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
22874When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
22875tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
22876name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
22877the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
22878
22879
22880.vindex "&$message_size$&"
22881Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
22882&%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
22883happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
22884variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
22885forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
22886be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
22887Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
22888empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
22889colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
22890maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
22891backwards compatibility).
22892
22893For one common implementation, you might set:
22894.code
22895maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
22896.endd
22897but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
22898
22899It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
22900as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
22901&[stat()]& each message file.
22902
22903
22904.section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
22905.cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
22906.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22907If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
22908storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
22909within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
22910creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
22911the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
22912to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
22913
22914The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
22915messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
22916in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
22917value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
22918is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
22919need to know the quota.
22920
22921If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
22922file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
22923
22924A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
22925maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
22926See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
22927details.
22928
22929
22930.section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
22931.cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
22932If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
22933files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
22934message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
22935this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
22936contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
22937itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
22938
22939During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
22940&_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
22941&_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
22942mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
22943file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
22944the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
22945
22946The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
22947option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
22948the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
22949There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
22950greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
22951appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
22952
22953If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
22954failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
22955configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
22956&$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
22957
22958
22959.section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
22960If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
22961file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
22962messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
22963section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
22964.code
22965directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
22966.endd
22967might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
22968then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
22969expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
22970.ecindex IIDapptra1
22971.ecindex IIDapptra2
22972
22973
22974
22975
22976
22977
22978. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22979. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22980
22981.chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
22982.scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
22983.scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
22984The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
22985the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
22986automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
22987&'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
22988to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
22989
22990If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
22991&%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
22992delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
22993that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
22994another router can set up a normal message delivery.
22995
22996
22997The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
22998&"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
22999directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
23000message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
23001empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
23002
23003The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
23004by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
23005passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
23006transport is run as a consequence of a
23007&%mail%&
23008or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
23009supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
23010that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
23011case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
23012is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
23013&%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
23014
23015&(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
23016command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
23017gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
23018&<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
23019
23020There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
23021that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
23022&(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
23023address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
23024separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
23025the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
23026message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
23027
23028Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
23029message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
23030immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
23031the transport defers.
23032Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
23033controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
23034
23035If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
23036&%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
23037of the original message that is included in the generated message when
23038&%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
23039
23040.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23041If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
23042the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
23043as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
23044is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
23045problems. They are just discarded.
23046
23047
23048
23049.section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
23050.cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
23051
23052.option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
23053This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
23054message when the message is specified by the transport.
23055
23056
23057.option cc autoreply string&!! unset
23058This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
23059when the message is specified by the transport.
23060
23061
23062.option file autoreply string&!! unset
23063The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
23064is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
23065string comes first.
23066
23067
23068.option file_expand autoreply boolean false
23069If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
23070subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
23071
23072
23073.option file_optional autoreply boolean false
23074If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
23075option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
23076
23077
23078.option from autoreply string&!! unset
23079This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
23080specified by the transport.
23081
23082
23083.option headers autoreply string&!! unset
23084This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
23085when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
23086&"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
23087
23088
23089.option log autoreply string&!! unset
23090This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
23091the message is specified by the transport.
23092
23093
23094.option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
23095If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
23096used.
23097
23098
23099.option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
23100If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
23101item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
23102discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
23103generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
23104
23105
23106
23107.option once autoreply string&!! unset
23108This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
23109recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
23110This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
23111
23112If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
23113By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
23114is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
23115However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
23116message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
23117this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
23118prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
23119infinity.
23120
23121If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
23122and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
23123greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
23124Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
23125regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
23126
23127In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
23128which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
23129be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
23130means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
23131unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
23132file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
23133
23134
23135.option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
23136See &%once%& above.
23137
23138
23139.option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
23140See &%once%& above.
23141After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
23142
23143
23144.option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
23145This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
23146specified by the transport.
23147
23148
23149.option return_message autoreply boolean false
23150If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
23151message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
23152configuration option.
23153
23154
23155.option subject autoreply string&!! unset
23156This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
23157specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
23158automatic responses. For example:
23159.code
23160subject = Re: $h_subject:
23161.endd
23162There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
23163subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
23164bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
23165non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
23166small.
23167
23168
23169
23170.option text autoreply string&!! unset
23171This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
23172message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
23173the text comes first.
23174
23175
23176.option to autoreply string&!! unset
23177This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
23178when the message is specified by the transport.
23179.ecindex IIDauttra1
23180.ecindex IIDauttra2
23181
23182
23183
23184
23185. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23186. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23187
23188.chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
23189.cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
23190.cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
23191.cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
23192.cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
23193The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
23194specified command
23195or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
23196This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
23197transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
23198implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
23199to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
23200has it commented out. You need to ensure that
23201.code
23202TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
23203.endd
23204.cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
23205is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
23206included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
23207as follows:
23208
23209.option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
23210See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23211
23212
23213.option batch_max lmtp integer 1
23214This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23215Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
23216good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
23217batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23218
23219
23220.option command lmtp string&!! unset
23221This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
23222is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
23223arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
23224number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
23225is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
23226LMTP protocol.
23227
23228.option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
23229.cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23230If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
23231commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
23232in its response to the LHLO command.
23233
23234.option socket lmtp string&!! unset
23235This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
23236be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
23237delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
23238
23239
23240.option timeout lmtp time 5m
23241The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
23242respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
23243is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
23244LMTP transport:
23245.code
23246lmtp:
23247 driver = lmtp
23248 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
23249 batch_max = 20
23250 user = exim
23251.endd
23252This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
23253necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
23254
23255
23256
23257. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23258. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23259
23260.chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
23261.scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
23262.scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
23263The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
23264running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
23265pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
23266(such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
23267their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
23268following ways:
23269
23270.ilist
23271.vindex "&$local_part$&"
23272A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
23273transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
23274contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
23275is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
23276.next
23277.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23278If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
23279transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
23280more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
23281(because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
23282(described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
23283that are routed to the transport.
23284.next
23285.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
23286A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
23287alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
23288pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
23289&%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
23290(&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
23291this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
23292.endlist
23293
23294
23295The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
23296deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
23297implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
23298
23299In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
23300&_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
23301other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
23302transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
23303directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
23304details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
23305for a discussion of local delivery batching.
23306
23307
23308.section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
23309If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
23310delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
23311any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
23312write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
23313Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
23314of "1" to enforce serialization.
23315
23316
23317
23318
23319.section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
23320.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
23321If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
23322have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
23323the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
23324in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
23325later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
23326logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
23327&"local delivery failed"&.
23328
23329If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
23330the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
23331will be sent as normal.
23332
23333If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
23334script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
23335value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
23336apply in this case.
23337
23338If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
23339return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
23340asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
23341a non-existent command may be the problem.
23342
23343The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
23344set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
23345error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
23346return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
23347included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
23348similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
23349failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
23350&%temp_errors%&.
23351
23352
23353
23354.section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
23355.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
23356The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
23357by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
23358&%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
23359run.
23360
23361.cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
23362Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
23363double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
23364way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
23365
23366String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
23367traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
23368expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
23369For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
23370quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
23371.code
23372command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
23373.endd
23374will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
23375arguments. You have to write
23376.code
23377command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
23378.endd
23379to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
23380argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
23381result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
23382interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
23383generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
23384expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
23385example:
23386.code
23387command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
23388.endd
23389
23390.cindex "transport" "filter"
23391.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23392.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23393Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
23394&`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
23395place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
23396transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
23397inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
23398avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
23399&(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
23400
23401If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, Special handling takes place
23402for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
23403is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
23404argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
23405&'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
23406the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
23407should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
23408run while preserving the argument vector separation.
23409
23410After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
23411in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
23412message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
23413standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
23414read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
23415may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
23416control what is done with it.
23417
23418Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
23419in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
23420taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
23421explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
23422where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
23423under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
23424an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
23425works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
23426as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
23427&%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
23428with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
23429
23430
23431
23432.section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
23433.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23434.cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23435The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
23436This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
23437the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
23438environment. The environment for the &(pipe)& transport is not subject
23439to the &%add_environment%& and &%keep_environment%& main config options.
23440.display
23441&`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
23442&`HOME `& the home directory, if set
23443&`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
23444&`LOCAL_PART `& see below
23445&`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
23446&`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
23447&`LOGNAME `& see below
23448&`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
23449&`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
23450&`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
23451&`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
23452&`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
23453&`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
23454&`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
23455&`USER `& see below
23456.endd
23457When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
23458router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
23459called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
23460the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
23461removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
23462LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
23463same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
23464
23465.cindex "HOST"
23466HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
23467associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
23468pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
23469the router.
23470
23471.cindex "HOME"
23472If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
23473for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
23474by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
23475user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
23476
23477
23478.section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
23479.cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
23480
23481
23482
23483.option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
23484.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
23485The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23486permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
23487permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
23488paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
23489&%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
23490in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
23491the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
23492&%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
23493otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
23494example, if
23495.code
23496allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
23497.endd
23498and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
23499&_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
23500&%use_shell%& is set.
23501
23502
23503.option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
23504See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23505
23506
23507.option batch_max pipe integer 1
23508This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23509See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23510
23511
23512.option check_string pipe string unset
23513As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
23514&%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
23515by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
23516&%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
23517any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
23518of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
23519the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
23520ignored.
23521
23522
23523.option command pipe string&!! unset
23524This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
23525obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
23526set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
23527the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
23528Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
23529&<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
23530
23531
23532.option environment pipe string&!! unset
23533.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23534.cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23535This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
23536command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
23537a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23538environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
23539
23540
23541.option escape_string pipe string unset
23542See &%check_string%& above.
23543
23544
23545.option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
23546.cindex "exec failure"
23547.cindex "failure of exec"
23548.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
23549Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
23550any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
23551is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
23552frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
23553
23554
23555.option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
23556.cindex "signal exit"
23557.cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
23558Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
23559a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
23560frozen in Exim's queue instead.
23561
23562
23563.option force_command pipe boolean false
23564.cindex "force command"
23565.cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
23566Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
23567the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
23568is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
23569useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
23570command. For example:
23571.code
23572command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
23573force_command
23574.endd
23575
23576Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
23577&%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
23578separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
23579
23580
23581.option ignore_status pipe boolean false
23582If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
23583run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
23584Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
23585from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
23586&%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
23587
23588&*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
23589See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
23590
23591
23592.option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
23593.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
23594If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
23595one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
23596and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
23597written to the main log.
23598
23599
23600.option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
23601If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
23602stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
23603the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
23604failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
23605option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
23606be set.
23607
23608
23609.option log_output pipe boolean false
23610If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
23611stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
23612the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
23613exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
23614
23615
23616.option max_output pipe integer 20K
23617This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
23618standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
23619process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
23620catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
23621the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
23622&%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
23623exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
23624
23625
23626.option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
23627The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
23628The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
23629.code
23630message_prefix = \
23631 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
23632 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
23633.endd
23634.cindex "Cyrus"
23635.cindex "&%tmail%&"
23636.cindex "&""From""& line"
23637This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
23638However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
23639or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
23640setting
23641.code
23642message_prefix =
23643.endd
23644&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23645&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
23646
23647
23648.option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
23649The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
23650The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
23651The suffix can be suppressed by setting
23652.code
23653message_suffix =
23654.endd
23655&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23656&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
23657
23658
23659.option path pipe string&!! "/bin:/usr/bin"
23660This option is expanded and
23661specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
23662variable of the subprocess.
23663If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
23664sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
23665apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
23666
23667
23668.option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
23669Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
23670a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
23671during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
23672It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
23673for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
23674resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
23675installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
23676of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
23677
23678
23679.option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
23680.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
23681If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
23682process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
23683to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
23684&%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
23685accept the message is used.
23686
23687
23688.option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
23689When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
23690contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
23691in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
23692command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
23693handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
23694
23695
23696.option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
23697If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
23698return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
23699is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
23700However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
23701message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
23702&%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
23703
23704
23705
23706.option return_output pipe boolean false
23707If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
23708deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
23709is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
23710However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
23711output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
23712option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
23713of them may be set.
23714
23715
23716
23717.option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
23718.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
23719This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
23720asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
23721and &%return_output%& is not set,
23722and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
23723temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
23724numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
23725codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
23726defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
23727compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
23728and 73, respectively.
23729
23730
23731.option timeout pipe time 1h
23732If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
23733causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
23734specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
23735command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
23736and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
23737if one of the processes starts a new process group.
23738
23739.option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
23740A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
23741runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
23742treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
23743is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
23744delivery to be deferred.
23745
23746.option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
23747This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
23748
23749
23750.option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
23751.cindex "envelope sender"
23752If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
23753SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
23754commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
23755you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
23756&<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
23757
23758.option use_classresources pipe boolean false
23759.cindex "class resources (BSD)"
23760This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
23761BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
23762resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
23763limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
23764class database.
23765
23766
23767.option use_crlf pipe boolean false
23768.cindex "carriage return"
23769.cindex "linefeed"
23770This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
23771(carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
23772of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
23773of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
23774
23775The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
23776written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
23777are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
23778&%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
23779values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
23780
23781
23782.option use_shell pipe boolean false
23783.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23784If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
23785instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
23786&<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
23787where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
23788modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
23789&`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
23790command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
23791its &%-c%& option.
23792
23793
23794
23795.section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
23796.cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
23797.cindex "&'procmail'&"
23798.cindex "external local delivery"
23799.cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
23800.cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
23801The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
23802delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
23803this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
23804uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
23805by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
23806necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
23807appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
23808configuration for &%procmail%&:
23809.code
23810# transport
23811procmail_pipe:
23812 driver = pipe
23813 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
23814 return_path_add
23815 delivery_date_add
23816 envelope_to_add
23817 check_string = "From "
23818 escape_string = ">From "
23819 umask = 077
23820 user = $local_part
23821 group = mail
23822
23823# router
23824procmail:
23825 driver = accept
23826 check_local_user
23827 transport = procmail_pipe
23828.endd
23829In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
23830&'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
23831or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
23832user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
23833&%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
23834home directory is the user's home directory by default.
23835
23836&*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
23837.code
23838IFS=" "
23839.endd
23840as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
23841use a shell to run pipe commands.
23842
23843.cindex "Cyrus"
23844The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
23845deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
23846.code
23847# transport
23848local_delivery_cyrus:
23849 driver = pipe
23850 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
23851 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
23852 user = cyrus
23853 group = mail
23854 return_output
23855 log_output
23856 message_prefix =
23857 message_suffix =
23858
23859# router
23860local_user_cyrus:
23861 driver = accept
23862 check_local_user
23863 local_part_suffix = .*
23864 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
23865.endd
23866Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
23867&%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
23868sender.
23869.ecindex IIDpiptra1
23870.ecindex IIDpiptra2
23871
23872
23873. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23874. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23875
23876.chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
23877.scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
23878.scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
23879The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
23880or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
23881that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
23882explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
23883&<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
23884
23885
23886.section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
23887The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
23888two ways:
23889
23890.ilist
23891If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
23892routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
23893that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
23894the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
23895does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
23896value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
23897section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
23898.next
23899.cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
23900When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
23901looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
23902connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
23903for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
23904process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
23905process.
23906.endlist
23907
23908
23909For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
23910incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
23911no further messages are sent over that connection.
23912
23913
23914
23915.section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
23916.vindex "&$host$&"
23917.vindex "&$host_address$&"
23918At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
23919&$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
23920passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
23921specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
23922&$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
23923that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
23924&%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
23925
23926
23927.section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
23928.vindex &$tls_bits$&
23929.vindex &$tls_cipher$&
23930.vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
23931.vindex &$tls_sni$&
23932At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
23933&$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
23934are the values that were set when the message was received.
23935These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
23936SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
23937variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
23938appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
23939are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
23940&%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
23941
23942These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
23943and will be removed in a future release.
23944
23945
23946.section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
23947.cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
23948The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
23949
23950
23951.option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
23952.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
23953When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
23954is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
23955runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
23956reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
23957setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
23958problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
23959
23960.option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
23961.cindex "local host" "sending to"
23962.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
23963When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
23964to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
23965deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
23966the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
23967configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
23968configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
23969
23970
23971.option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
23972.cindex "Cyrus"
23973When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
23974is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
23975overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
23976forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
23977to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
23978ignored.
23979
23980The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
23981started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
23982&$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
23983particular connection.
23984
23985If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
23986&%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
23987deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
23988unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
23989
23990This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
23991deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
23992&"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
23993.code
23994authenticated_sender = $local_part
23995.endd
23996This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
23997allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
23998
23999Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
24000domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
24001value.
24002
24003
24004.option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
24005If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
24006is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
24007authenticated as a client.
24008
24009
24010.option command_timeout smtp time 5m
24011This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
24012sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
24013remote host. Its value must not be zero.
24014
24015
24016.option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
24017This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
24018to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
24019several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
24020less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
24021systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
24022option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
24023
24024
24025.option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
24026.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
24027.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
24028.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24029This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
24030over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
24031For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
24032option.
24033
24034
24035.option dane_require_tls_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
24036.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers for DANE"
24037.cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
24038.cindex DANE "TLS ciphers"
24039This option may be used to override &%tls_require_ciphers%& for connections
24040where DANE has been determined to be in effect.
24041If not set, then &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used.
24042Normal SMTP delivery is not able to make strong demands of TLS cipher
24043configuration, because delivery will fall back to plaintext. Once DANE has
24044been determined to be in effect, there is no plaintext fallback and making the
24045TLS cipherlist configuration stronger will increase security, rather than
24046counter-intuitively decreasing it.
24047If the option expands to be empty or is forced to fail, then it will
24048be treated as unset and &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used instead.
24049
24050
24051.option data_timeout smtp time 5m
24052This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
24053the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
24054of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
24055
24056
24057.option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
24058.option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
24059.option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
24060.option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
24061.option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
24062.option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
24063.option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
24064.option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "per RFC"
24065.option dkim_timestamps smtp string&!! unset
24066DKIM signing options. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24067
24068
24069.option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
24070This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
24071domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
24072cutoff times.
24073
24074In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
24075them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
24076Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
24077retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
24078a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
24079unhappy at this prospect, so...
24080
24081If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
24082addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
24083IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
24084none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
24085delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
24086addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
24087continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
24088&%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
24089to them.
24090
24091
24092.option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
24093If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
24094and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
24095the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
24096in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
24097
24098
24099.option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
24100If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
24101&%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
24102See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
24103details.
24104
24105
24106.option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
24107.cindex "MX record" "security"
24108.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24109.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24110.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24111DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
24112the dnssec request bit set.
24113This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
24114
24115
24116
24117.option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
24118.cindex "MX record" "security"
24119.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24120.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24121.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24122DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
24123the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
24124(AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
24125This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
24126
24127
24128
24129.option dscp smtp string&!! unset
24130.cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
24131This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
24132of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
24133The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
24134Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
24135&`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
24136
24137The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
24138(for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
24139that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
24140equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
24141Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
24142
24143
24144.option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
24145.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24146String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
24147colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
24148port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
24149&<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24150item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24151in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
24152
24153Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
24154addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
24155&%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
24156not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
24157&%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
24158However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
24159
24160If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
24161the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
24162transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
24163address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
24164list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
24165
24166Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
24167re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
24168addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
24169copy of the message is sent.
24170
24171The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
24172&%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
24173both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
24174from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
24175fails"& facility.
24176
24177
24178.option final_timeout smtp time 10m
24179This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
24180line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
24181zero.
24182
24183.option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
24184If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
24185being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
24186(or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
24187instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
24188it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
24189
24190.option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
24191This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
24192server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
24193implementations of TLS.
24194
24195.option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
24196.cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
24197.cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
24198.cindex "LHLO argument setting"
24199The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
24200been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
24201command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
24202option is:
24203.code
24204$primary_hostname
24205.endd
24206During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
24207the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
24208&$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
24209used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
24210servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
24211that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
24212interface address, you could use this:
24213.code
24214helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
24215 {$primary_hostname}}
24216.endd
24217The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
24218callouts.
24219
24220.option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
24221Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
24222finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
24223&(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
24224email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
24225all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
24226
24227The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
24228processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
24229&%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
24230&%hosts_override%& is set.
24231
24232The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
24233list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
24234separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
24235&<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24236item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24237in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
24238of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
24239
24240If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
24241the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
24242well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
24243address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
24244&[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
24245&%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
24246that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
24247address are used.
24248
24249During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
24250unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
24251
24252
24253.option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24254.cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
24255.cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
24256.cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
24257.cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24258This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
24259example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
24260matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
24261start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
24262facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
24263
24264
24265.option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
24266.cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24267Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
24268that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
24269
24270
24271.option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24272.cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24273Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24274matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24275
24276.option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24277.cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24278Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
24279or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
24280to any host that matches this list.
24281
24282
24283.option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
24284.cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24285.cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
24286.cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
24287.cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
24288This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
24289delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
24290&<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
24291
24292
24293.option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
24294This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
24295tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
24296why it exists.
24297
24298
24299
24300.option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24301.cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24302.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24303.cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24304For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
24305been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24306message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
24307explanation of when this might be needed.
24308
24309.option hosts_noproxy_tls smtp "host list&!!" *
24310.cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24311.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24312.cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24313For any host that matches this list, a TLS session which has
24314been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24315message on the same session.
24316
24317The traditional implementation closes down TLS and re-starts it in the new
24318process, on the same open TCP connection, for each successive message
24319sent. If permitted by this option a pipe to to the new process is set up
24320instead, and the original process maintains the TLS connection and proxies
24321the SMTP connection from and to the new process and any subsequents.
24322The new process has no access to TLS information, so cannot include it in
24323logging.
24324
24325
24326
24327.option hosts_override smtp boolean false
24328If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
24329attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
24330&%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
24331&%fallback_hosts%&.
24332
24333
24334.option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
24335.cindex "randomized host list"
24336.cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
24337.cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
24338If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
24339&%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
24340were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
24341router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
24342is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
24343list can be used to do crude load sharing.
24344
24345When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
24346order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
24347behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
24348&`+`& in the host list. For example:
24349.code
24350hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
24351.endd
24352The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
24353randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
24354If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
24355
24356.option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24357.cindex "authentication" "required by client"
24358This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
24359before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
24360servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
24361authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
24362temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
24363hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
24364&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24365
24366
24367.option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
24368.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24369Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
24370TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24371&%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24372
24373.option hosts_require_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
24374.cindex DANE "transport options"
24375.cindex DANE "requiring for certain servers"
24376If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
24377TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
24378and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made.
24379There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24380See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24381
24382.option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24383.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24384Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
24385TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24386&%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24387
24388.option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24389.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24390Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24391matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24392&*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
24393incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
24394
24395.option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24396.cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
24397This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24398authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
24399connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
24400unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
24401&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24402
24403.option hosts_try_chunking smtp "host list&!!" *
24404.cindex CHUNKING "enabling, in client"
24405.cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
24406.cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
24407This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24408CHUNKING support, Exim will attempt to use BDAT commands rather than DATA.
24409BDAT will not be used in conjunction with a transport filter.
24410
24411.option hosts_try_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
24412.cindex DANE "transport options"
24413.cindex DANE "attempting for certain servers"
24414If built with DANE support, Exim will lookup a
24415TLSA record for any host matching the list.
24416If found and verified by DNSSEC,
24417a DANE-verified TLS connection is made to that host;
24418there will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24419See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24420
24421.option hosts_try_fastopen smtp "host list&!!" unset
24422.cindex "fast open, TCP" "enabling, in client"
24423.cindex "TCP Fast Open" "enabling, in client"
24424.cindex "RFC 7413" "TCP Fast Open"
24425This option provides a list of servers to which, provided
24426the facility is supported by this system, Exim will attempt to
24427perform a TCP Fast Open.
24428No data is sent on the SYN segment but, if the remote server also
24429supports the facility, it can send its SMTP banner immediately after
24430the SYN,ACK segment. This can save up to one round-trip time.
24431
24432The facility is only active for previously-contacted servers,
24433as the initiator must present a cookie in the SYN segment.
24434
24435On (at least some) current Linux distributions the facility must be enabled
24436in the kernel by the sysadmin before the support is usable.
24437There is no option for control of the server side; if the system supports
24438it it is always enabled. Note that lengthy operations in the connect ACL,
24439such as DNSBL lookups, will still delay the emission of the SMTP banner.
24440
24441.option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
24442.cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
24443This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24444PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
24445for multi-recipient messages.
24446The option can usually be left as default.
24447
24448.option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
24449.cindex "bind IP address"
24450.cindex "IP address" "binding"
24451.vindex "&$host$&"
24452.vindex "&$host_address$&"
24453This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
24454call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
24455&`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
24456message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
24457&$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
24458outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
24459interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
24460unknown.
24461
24462During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
24463&$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
24464during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
24465string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
24466string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
24467separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
24468.code
24469interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
24470.endd
24471The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
24472connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
24473&%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
24474interface to use if the host has more than one.
24475
24476
24477.option keepalive smtp boolean true
24478.cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
24479This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
24480connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
24481periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
24482of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
24483or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
24484that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
24485that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
24486TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
24487unreachable hosts.
24488
24489
24490.option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
24491.cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
24492If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
24493string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
24494has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
24495
24496.option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
24497.cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
24498This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
24499SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
24500so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
24501permits this.
24502
24503
24504.option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
24505.vindex "&$domain$&"
24506When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
24507addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
24508to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
24509handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
24510&$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
24511is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
24512
24513It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
24514&$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
24515&$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
24516
24517.option port smtp string&!! "see below"
24518.cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
24519.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
24520This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
24521&*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
24522received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
24523The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
24524variable that contains an outgoing port.
24525
24526If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
24527otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
24528normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
24529&"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
24530is deferred.
24531
24532
24533
24534.option protocol smtp string smtp
24535.cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
24536.cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
24537.cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
24538.vindex "&$port$&"
24539If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
24540the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
24541protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
24542deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
24543over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
24544
24545If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
24546changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
24547connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
24548The Internet standards bodies strongly discourage use of this mode.
24549
24550
24551.option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
24552Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
24553constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
24554means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
24555tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
24556addresses is not affected.
24557
24558However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
24559each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
24560the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
24561Exim to use only the host name.
24562Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
24563
24564
24565.option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
24566.cindex "serializing connections"
24567.cindex "host" "serializing connections"
24568Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
24569host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
24570the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
24571slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
24572Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
24573&%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
24574
24575.cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
24576Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
24577written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
24578is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
24579records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
24580guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
24581
24582If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
24583relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
24584start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
24585may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
24586are used for ETRN serialization.
24587
24588See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
24589
24590
24591.option size_addition smtp integer 1024
24592.cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
24593.cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
24594.cindex "size" "of message"
24595.cindex "transport" "filter"
24596.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
24597If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
24598MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
24599an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
24600sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
24601configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
24602this if a lot of text is added to messages.
24603
24604Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
24605the use of the SIZE option altogether.
24606
24607
24608.option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
24609.cindex proxy SOCKS
24610This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
24611transport. For details see section &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
24612
24613
24614.option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
24615.cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
24616.cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
24617.vindex "&$host$&"
24618.vindex "&$host_address$&"
24619The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
24620client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
24621connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
24622address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
24623details of TLS.
24624
24625&*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
24626certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
24627name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
24628assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
24629client.
24630
24631
24632.option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
24633.cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
24634.cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
24635This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
24636be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
24637
24638
24639.option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
24640.cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
24641When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
24642key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
24643for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
24644If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
24645will fail.
24646
24647Only supported when using GnuTLS.
24648
24649
24650.option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
24651.cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
24652.vindex "&$host$&"
24653.vindex "&$host_address$&"
24654The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
24655client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
24656connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
24657&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24658expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
24659result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
24660the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24661
24662
24663.option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
24664.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
24665.cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
24666.vindex "&$host$&"
24667.vindex "&$host_address$&"
24668The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
24669when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
24670the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
24671&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24672expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
24673is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
24674&<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
24675ciphers is a preference order.
24676
24677
24678
24679.option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
24680.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
24681.vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
24682If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
24683TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
24684the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
24685certificate and private key for the session.
24686
24687See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
24688
24689Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
24690TLS extensions.
24691
24692
24693
24694
24695.option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
24696.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
24697When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
24698setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
24699to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
24700current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
24701option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
24702response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
24703TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
24704unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
24705in clear.
24706
24707
24708.option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
24709.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24710.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24711This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
24712certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
24713The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
24714Note that unless the host is in this list
24715TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
24716when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
24717The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
24718certificate verification succeeds.
24719
24720
24721.option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
24722.cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
24723.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24724This option give a list of hosts for which,
24725while verifying the server certificate,
24726checks will be included on the host name
24727(note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
24728versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
24729limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
24730
24731There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
24732
24733
24734.option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
24735.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24736.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24737.vindex "&$host$&"
24738.vindex "&$host_address$&"
24739The value of this option must be either the
24740word "system"
24741or the absolute path to
24742a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
24743for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
24744
24745The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
24746This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
24747is taken as empty and an explicit location
24748must be specified.
24749
24750The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
24751preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
24752
24753With OpenSSL the certificates specified
24754explicitly
24755either by file or directory
24756are added to those given by the system default location.
24757
24758The values of &$host$& and
24759&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24760expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24761
24762For back-compatibility,
24763if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
24764(a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
24765and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
24766
24767
24768.option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
24769.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24770.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24771This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
24772certificate verification must succeed.
24773The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
24774If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
24775operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
24776
24777.new
24778.option utf8_downconvert smtp integer!! unset
24779.cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
24780.cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
24781If built with internationalization support,
24782this option controls conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
24783to a-label form.
24784For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
24785.wen
24786
24787
24788
24789
24790.section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
24791 "SECTvalhosmax"
24792.cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24793.cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
24794There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
24795tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
24796&%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
24797
24798
24799The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
24800for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
24801option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
24802multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
24803retrying.
24804
24805Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
24806multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
24807created as a result of routing one of these domains.
24808
24809Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
24810several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
24811problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
24812&%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
24813delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
24814
24815Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
24816arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
24817limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
24818some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
24819&%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
24820that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
24821see below for an exception).
24822
24823Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
24824list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
24825If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
24826but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
24827that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
24828
24829Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
24830higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
24831hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
24832which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
24833tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
24834reached their retry times.
24835
24836However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
24837large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
24838Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
24839of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
24840time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
24841without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
24842all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
24843there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
24844the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
24845every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
24846reached.
24847
24848The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
24849particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
24850out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
24851reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
24852been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
24853take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
24854
24855The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
24856Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
24857and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
24858possible IP addresses have been tried.
24859.ecindex IIDsmttra1
24860.ecindex IIDsmttra2
24861
24862
24863
24864
24865
24866. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24867. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24868
24869.chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
24870.scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
24871There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
24872addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
24873(referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
24874abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
24875
24876Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
24877messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
24878&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
24879appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
24880locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
24881unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
24882lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
24883
24884One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
24885when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
24886such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
24887do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
24888
24889
24890.section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
24891This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
24892main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
24893&%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
24894
24895Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
24896Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
24897facility; you do not have to use it.
24898
24899The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
24900configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
24901addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
24902address to which it applies.
24903
24904Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
24905the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
24906rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
24907those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
24908by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
24909are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
24910rules.
24911
24912Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
24913applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
24914well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
24915headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
24916
24917
24918In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
24919legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
24920in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
24921used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
24922Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
24923discouraged.
24924
24925There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
24926illustrated by these examples:
24927
24928.ilist
24929The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
24930exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
24931gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
24932&'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
24933.next
24934A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
24935&'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
24936.endlist
24937
24938
24939
24940.section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
24941.cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
24942.cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
24943Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
24944message's processing.
24945
24946.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24947At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
24948by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
24949ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
24950is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
24951rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
24952rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
24953RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
24954rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
24955
24956.vindex "&$domain$&"
24957.vindex "&$local_part$&"
24958Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
24959may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
24960rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
24961from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
24962for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
24963value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
24964as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
24965SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
24966
24967As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
24968recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
24969the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
24970any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
24971.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
24972before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
24973
24974When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
24975rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
24976redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
24977
24978.cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
24979.cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
24980.cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
24981At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
24982specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
24983This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
24984section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
24985header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
24986applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
24987
24988The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
24989transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
24990transport time.
24991
24992
24993
24994
24995.section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
24996.cindex "rewriting" "testing"
24997.cindex "testing" "rewriting"
24998Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
24999configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
25000&%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
250012822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
25002transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
25003appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
25004envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
25005.code
25006exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
25007.endd
25008might produce the output
25009.code
25010sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25011from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25012to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25013cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25014bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25015reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25016env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25017env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25018.endd
25019which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
25020the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
25021present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
25022set for a particular transport.
25023
25024
25025.section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
25026.cindex "rewriting" "rules"
25027The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
25028rules in the form
25029.display
25030<&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
25031.endd
25032Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
25033transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
25034takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
25035any colons must be doubled, of course).
25036
25037The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
25038Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
25039case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
25040characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
25041ignored.
25042
25043For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
25044order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
25045replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
25046
25047The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
25048releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
25049received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
25050lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
25051address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
25052(or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
25053that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
25054
25055.vindex "&$domain$&"
25056.vindex "&$local_part$&"
25057The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
25058string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
25059rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
25060.code
25061*@* ${lookup ...
25062.endd
25063where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
25064refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25065
25066
25067.section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
25068.cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
25069.cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
25070The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
25071address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
25072single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
25073against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
25074you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
25075facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
25076
25077Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
25078case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
25079can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
25080
25081.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
25082After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
25083depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
25084replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
25085refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
25086numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
25087of pattern they are set as follows:
25088
25089.ilist
25090If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
25091refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
25092the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
25093pattern
25094.code
25095*queen@*.fict.example
25096.endd
25097is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
25098.code
25099$0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
25100$1 = hearts-
25101$2 = wonderland
25102.endd
25103Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
25104does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
25105
25106.next
25107If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
25108of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
25109for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
25110rewriting rule of the form
25111.display
25112&`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
25113.endd
25114and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
25115.code
25116$1 = foo
25117$2 = bar
25118$3 = baz.example
25119.endd
25120If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
25121wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
25122&$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
25123partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
25124whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
25125.endlist
25126
25127
25128.section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
25129.cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
25130If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
25131match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
25132rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
25133.code
25134hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
25135.endd
25136specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
25137&'From:'& headers.
25138
25139.vindex "&$domain$&"
25140.vindex "&$local_part$&"
25141If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
25142yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
25143&$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25144Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
25145cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
25146matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
25147the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
25148current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
25149expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
25150entry written to the panic log.
25151
25152
25153
25154.section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
25155There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
25156
25157.ilist
25158Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
25159c, f, h, r, s, t.
25160.next
25161A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
25162.next
25163Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
25164.endlist
25165
25166For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
25167E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
25168
25169
25170
25171.section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
25172 "SECID154"
25173.cindex "rewriting" "flags"
25174If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
25175&<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
25176and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
25177transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
25178rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
25179.display
25180&`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
25181&`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
25182&`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
25183&`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
25184&`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
25185&`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
25186&`h`& rewrite all headers
25187&`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
25188&`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
25189&`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
25190.endd
25191"All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
25192individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
25193other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
25194
25195You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
25196restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
25197
25198
25199.section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
25200.cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
25201.cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
25202.cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
25203The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
25204SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
25205before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
25206required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
25207data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
25208
25209.vindex "&$domain$&"
25210.vindex "&$local_part$&"
25211This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
25212compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
25213input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
25214the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
25215expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
25216original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
25217
25218
25219.section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
25220There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
25221take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
25222correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
25223
25224.ilist
25225If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
25226unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
25227absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
25228.next
25229If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
25230even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
25231expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
25232(does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
25233.next
25234The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
25235address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
25236rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
25237.next
25238.cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
25239When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
25240to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
25241left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
25242.code
25243From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
25244.endd
25245into
25246.code
25247From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
25248.endd
25249.cindex "RFC 2047"
25250Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
25251done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
25252causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
25253replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
252542822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
25255brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
25256(except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
25257is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
25258
25259When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
25260rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
25261.endlist
25262
25263
25264.section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
25265Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
25266.code
25267*@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
25268*@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
25269 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
25270.endd
25271Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
25272the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
25273has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
25274consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
25275present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
25276explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
25277at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
25278error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
25279
25280The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
25281domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
25282.code
25283root@*.hitch.fict.example *
25284.endd
25285were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
25286local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
25287
25288Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
25289&${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
25290messages that originate outside the local host:
25291.code
25292*@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
25293 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
25294.endd
25295The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
25296space.
25297
25298.cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
25299.cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
25300Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
25301an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
25302the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
25303remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
25304sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
25305components. For example, the rule
25306.code
25307\N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
25308.endd
25309rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
25310&'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
25311a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
25312method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
25313to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
25314use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
25315can be done on the rewritten addresses.
25316.ecindex IIDaddrew
25317
25318
25319
25320
25321
25322. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25323. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25324
25325.chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
25326.scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
25327.scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
25328The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
25329retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
25330be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
25331empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
25332errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
25333general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
25334line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
25335address, domain and error.
25336
25337The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
25338host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
25339Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
25340address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
25341been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
25342tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
25343log selector is set, the message
25344.cindex "retry" "time not reached"
25345&"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
25346skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
25347the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
25348
25349Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
25350in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
25351actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
25352failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
25353the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
25354added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
25355same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
25356domain are maintained independently.
25357
25358When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
25359receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
25360always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
25361behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
25362quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
25363suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
25364subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
25365the local address is reached.
25366
25367.section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
25368If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
25369whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
25370files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
25371always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
25372
25373The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
25374rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
25375record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
25376timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
25377and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
25378messages that it should now be retaining.
25379
25380
25381
25382.section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
25383.cindex "retry" "rules"
25384Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
25385separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
25386addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
25387enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
25388in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
25389present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
25390message's sender, respectively.
25391
25392
25393The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
25394&<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
25395which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
25396has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
25397list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
25398which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
25399example,
25400.code
25401lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25402.endd
25403provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
25404whereas
25405.code
25406alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25407.endd
25408applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
25409In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
25410part.
25411
25412.cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
25413&*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
25414must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
25415expressions work in address lists.
25416.display
25417&`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
25418&`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
25419.endd
25420
25421
25422.section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
25423When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
25424example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
25425against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
25426router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
25427regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
25428A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
25429&"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
25430&%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
25431
25432Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
25433failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
25434configuration is tested against the complete address only if
25435&%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
25436local transports).
25437
25438.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
25439However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
25440suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
25441whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
25442rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
25443failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
25444recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
25445reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
25446&%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
25447lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
25448commands.
25449
25450
25451
25452.section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
25453 "SECID160"
25454For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
25455example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
25456twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
25457&"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
25458the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
25459suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
25460.code
25461a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
25462 MX 6 p.q.r.example
25463 MX 7 m.n.o.example
25464.endd
25465and the retry rules are
25466.code
25467p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
25468a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
25469.endd
25470and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
25471first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
25472rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
25473to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
25474tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
25475first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
25476
25477In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
25478first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
25479&'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
25480routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
25481
25482&*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
25483However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
25484host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
25485.code
25486route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
25487.endd
25488then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
25489textual form of the IP address.
25490
25491.section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
25492.cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
25493The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
25494asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
25495
25496.vlist
25497.vitem &%auth_failed%&
25498Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
25499&%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
25500
25501.vitem &%data_4xx%&
25502A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
25503after the command, or after sending the message's data.
25504
25505.vitem &%mail_4xx%&
25506A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
25507
25508.vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
25509A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
25510.endlist
25511
25512For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
25513as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
25514recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
25515and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
25516retry rule of this form:
25517.code
25518the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
25519.endd
25520These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
25521LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
25522
25523.vlist
25524.vitem &%lost_connection%&
25525A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
25526legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
25527for the same host, it indicates something odd.
25528
25529.vitem &%lookup%&
25530A DNS lookup for a host failed.
25531Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
25532its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
25533Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
25534its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
25535
25536.vitem &%refused_MX%&
25537A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
25538
25539.vitem &%refused_A%&
25540A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
25541
25542.vitem &%refused%&
25543A connection was refused.
25544
25545.vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
25546A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
25547
25548.vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
25549A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
25550
25551.vitem &%timeout_connect%&
25552A connection attempt timed out.
25553
25554.vitem &%timeout_MX%&
25555There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
25556obtained from an MX record.
25557
25558.vitem &%timeout_A%&
25559There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
25560obtained from an MX record.
25561
25562.vitem &%timeout%&
25563There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
25564
25565.vitem &%tls_required%&
25566The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
25567&(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
25568to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
25569
25570.vitem &%quota%&
25571A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
25572transport.
25573
25574.vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
25575.cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
25576.cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
25577A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
25578transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
25579&'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
25580for four days.
25581.endlist
25582
25583.cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
25584The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
25585timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
25586it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
25587However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
25588heuristic rules:
25589
25590.ilist
25591If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
25592used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
25593quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
25594.next
25595.cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
25596For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
25597subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
25598the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
25599change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
25600MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
25601time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
25602.next
25603For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
25604obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
25605.endlist
25606
25607The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
25608mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
25609when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
25610error).
25611
25612
25613
25614.section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
25615.cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
25616You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
25617specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
25618apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
25619form:
25620.display
25621&`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
25622.endd
25623The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
25624.code
25625* rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
25626.endd
25627matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
25628host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
25629For example:
25630.code
25631a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
25632.endd
25633&*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
25634(which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
25635only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
25636its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
25637all messages, not just those with specific senders.
25638
25639When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
25640&%-f%& command line option, like this:
25641.code
25642exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
25643.endd
25644If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
25645list is never matched.
25646
25647
25648
25649
25650
25651.section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
25652.cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
25653The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
25654sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
25655.display
25656<&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
25657.endd
25658The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
25659time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
25660arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
25661time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
25662relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
25663
25664.cindex "retry" "algorithms"
25665.cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
25666.cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
25667.cindex "retry" "random intervals"
25668The available algorithms are:
25669
25670.ilist
25671&'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
25672the interval.
25673.next
25674&'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
25675specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
25676is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
25677.next
25678&'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
25679retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
25680maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
25681the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
25682rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
25683members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
25684queue processing times.
25685.endlist
25686
25687When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
25688order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
25689used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
25690case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
25691current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
25692computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
25693interval is found. The main configuration variable
25694.cindex "limit" "retry interval"
25695.cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
25696.oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
25697&%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
25698cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
25699
25700A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
25701host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
25702basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
25703for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
25704generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
25705time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
25706time.
25707
25708.cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
25709Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
25710run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
25711starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
25712new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
25713If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
25714occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
25715messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
25716processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
25717your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
25718number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
25719sending everything to a smart host, for example).
25720
25721The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
25722&'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
25723&<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
25724&'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
25725are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
25726deliveries that have been deferred.
25727
25728
25729.section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
25730Here are some example retry rules:
25731.code
25732alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
25733wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
25734wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
25735lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25736* refused_A F,2h,20m;
25737* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
25738.endd
25739The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
25740&'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
25741mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
25742hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
25743parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
25744effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
25745fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
25746days.
25747
25748The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
25749happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
25750intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
25751first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
25752so on (this is a rather extreme example).
25753
25754The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
25755They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
25756all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
25757were not obtained from an MX record.
25758
25759The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
25760first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
25761not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
25762hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
257631.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
25764
25765
25766
25767.section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
25768.cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
25769.oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
25770.cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
25771.cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
25772Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
25773consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
25774set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
25775been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
25776arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
25777failing for the first time.
25778
25779This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
25780backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
25781Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
25782down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
25783
25784If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
25785every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
25786message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
25787
25788
25789
25790
25791.section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
25792.cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
25793.cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
25794Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
25795that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
25796default retry rule:
25797.code
25798* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
25799.endd
25800the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
25801long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
25802failure for the recipient address that counts.
25803
25804When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
25805addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
25806causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
25807In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
25808time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
25809
25810For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
25811messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
25812post-cutoff retry time is not used.
25813
25814If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
25815.oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
25816&%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
25817default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
25818reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
25819attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
25820those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
25821the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
25822
25823In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
25824for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
25825times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
25826behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
25827to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
25828notice.
25829
25830If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
25831addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
25832addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
25833no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
25834words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
25835addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
25836If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
25837&%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
25838deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
25839true.
25840
25841.section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
25842.cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
25843Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
25844intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
25845its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
25846because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
25847host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
25848failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
25849reached.
25850
25851Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
25852applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
25853Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
25854examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
25855commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
25856time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
25857is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
25858time out the address.
25859
25860The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
25861the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
25862given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
25863time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
25864not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
25865considered immediately.
25866.ecindex IIDretconf1
25867.ecindex IIDregconf2
25868
25869
25870
25871
25872
25873
25874. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25875. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25876
25877.chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
25878.scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
25879.scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
25880The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
25881with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
25882described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
25883to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
25884permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
25885transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
25886other.
25887
25888.cindex "AUTH" "description of"
25889Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
25890
25891.ilist
25892The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
25893the client's EHLO command.
25894.next
25895The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
25896may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
25897.next
25898The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
25899appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
25900just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
25901any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
25902with the AUTH command.
25903.next
25904The server either accepts or denies authentication.
25905.next
25906If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
25907option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
25908mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
25909connection.
25910.next
25911If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
25912authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
25913unauthenticated connection.
25914.endlist
25915
25916If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
25917mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
25918SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
25919includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
25920.display
25921&`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
25922&`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
25923&`Connected to server.example.`&
25924&`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
25925&`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
25926&*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
25927&`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
25928&`250-SIZE 52428800`&
25929&`250-PIPELINING`&
25930&`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
25931&`250 HELP`&
25932.endd
25933The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
25934authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
25935mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
25936routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
25937controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
25938included by setting
25939.code
25940AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
25941AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
25942AUTH_DOVECOT=yes
25943AUTH_GSASL=yes
25944AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
25945AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
25946AUTH_SPA=yes
25947AUTH_TLS=yes
25948.endd
25949in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
25950authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
25951the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
25952The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
25953work via a socket interface.
25954The fourth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
25955provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
25956The fifth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
25957supporting setting a server keytab.
25958The sixth can be configured to support
25959the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
25960not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The seventh authenticator
25961supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
25962The eighth is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
25963instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
25964
25965The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
25966section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
25967authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
25968authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
25969is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
25970messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
25971options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
25972
25973To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
25974&%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
25975either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
25976functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
25977to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
25978both sets of options, is required. For example:
25979.code
25980cram:
25981 driver = cram_md5
25982 public_name = CRAM-MD5
25983 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
25984 client_name = ph10
25985 client_secret = secret2
25986.endd
25987The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
25988&%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
25989
25990Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
25991The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
25992authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
25993in Exim.
25994
25995&*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
25996per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
25997account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
25998authenticating data.
25999
26000Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
26001&'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
26002and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
26003Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
26004used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
26005second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
26006user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
26007configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
26008&'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
26009as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
26010choose to honour.
26011
26012A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
26013to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
26014mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
26015typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
26016
26017
26018
26019.section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
26020.cindex "authentication" "generic options"
26021.cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
26022
26023.option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26024When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
26025&%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
26026used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
26027encrypted by a setting such as:
26028.code
26029client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
26030.endd
26031
26032
26033.option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
26034When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
26035result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
26036Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
26037
26038
26039.option driver authenticators string unset
26040This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
26041authenticators is to be used.
26042
26043
26044.option public_name authenticators string unset
26045This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
26046implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
26047contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
26048but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
26049defaults to the driver's instance name.
26050
26051
26052.option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26053When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
26054is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
26055mechanism is not advertised.
26056If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
26057forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
26058See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
26059
26060
26061.option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26062This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
26063is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
26064for details.
26065
26066For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
26067mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
26068
26069For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
26070authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
26071authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
26072authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
26073to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
26074error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
26075string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26076expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
26077other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
26078the error text.
26079
26080
26081.option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
26082If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
26083command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
26084output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
26085out the values of variables.
26086If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
26087output, and Exim carries on processing.
26088
26089
26090.option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
26091.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26092When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
26093expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
26094messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
26095lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
26096configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
26097refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
26098If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
26099
26100
26101.option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26102This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
26103as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
26104driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
26105as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
26106remembered for later use.
26107How it is used is described in the following section.
26108
26109
26110
26111
26112
26113.section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
26114.cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
26115.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26116When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
26117the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
26118message:
26119
26120.ilist
26121If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
26122than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
26123.next
26124If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
26125.next
26126.vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
26127If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
26128running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
26129from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
26130&$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
26131return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
26132given for the MAIL command.
26133.next
26134If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
26135is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
26136authenticated.
26137.next
26138If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
26139the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
26140&%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
26141valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
26142fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
26143&$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
26144the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
26145message.
26146.endlist
26147
26148
26149When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
26150hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
26151&$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
26152process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
26153
26154.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
26155Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
26156MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
26157therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
26158value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
26159ACL is run.
26160
26161
26162
26163.section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
26164.cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
26165When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
26166authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
26167conditions:
26168
26169.ilist
26170The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
26171.next
26172It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
26173yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
26174.endlist
26175
26176The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
26177the mechanisms are advertised.
26178
26179Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
26180provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
26181even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
26182set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
26183You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
26184For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
26185that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
26186.code
26187auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
26188.endd
26189so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
26190
26191The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
26192authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
26193advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
26194such as:
26195.code
26196server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
26197.endd
26198.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
26199If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
26200yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
26201
26202When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
26203immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
26204command. This is the case if
26205
26206.ilist
26207The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
26208.next
26209No authenticators are configured with server options; or
26210.next
26211Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
26212server authenticators.
26213.endlist
26214
26215
26216Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
26217to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
26218AUTH is accepted from any client host.
26219
26220If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
26221server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
26222that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
26223the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
26224fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
26225rejected with a 504 error.
26226
26227.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
26228.vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
26229When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
26230&$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
26231or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
26232public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
26233client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
26234no successful authentication.
26235
26236.cindex authentication "expansion item"
26237Successful authentication sets up information used by the
26238&$authresults$& expansion item.
26239
26240
26241
26242
26243.section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
26244.cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
26245.cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
26246.cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
26247Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
26248configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
26249encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
26250script:
26251.code
26252use MIME::Base64;
26253printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
26254.endd
26255.cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
26256This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
26257interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
26258some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
26259command line to run this script on such data might be
26260.code
26261encode '\0user\0password'
26262.endd
26263Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
26264backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
26265whose code value is zero.
26266
26267&*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
26268digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
26269you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
26270interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
26271
26272&*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
26273specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
26274example, a command such as
26275.code
26276encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
26277.endd
26278gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
26279
26280If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
26281base64-encoded strings is to run the command
26282.code
26283echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
26284.endd
26285The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
26286in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
26287output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
26288should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
26289
26290
26291
26292.section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
26293.cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
26294The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
26295&%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
26296announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
26297of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
26298
26299.ilist
26300For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
26301they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
26302mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
26303of the authenticator.
26304.next
26305.vindex "&$host$&"
26306.vindex "&$host_address$&"
26307When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
26308variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
26309that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
26310any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
26311Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
26312delivery to be deferred.
26313.next
26314If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
26315Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
26316try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
26317usual way.
26318.next
26319If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
26320carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
26321possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
26322no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
26323what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
26324&%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
26325delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
26326turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
26327deliver the message unauthenticated.
26328.endlist
26329
26330Note that the hostlist test for whether to do authentication can be
26331confused if name-IP lookups change between the time the peer is decided
26332upon and the time that the transport runs. For example, with a manualroute
26333router given a host name, and with DNS "round-robin" used by that name: if
26334the local resolver cache times out between the router and the transport
26335running, the transport may get an IP for the name for its authentication
26336check which does not match the connection peer IP.
26337No authentication will then be done, despite the names being identical.
26338
26339For such cases use a separate transport which always authenticates.
26340
26341.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26342When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
26343parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
26344the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
26345is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
26346incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
26347allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
26348to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
26349&%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
26350&%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
26351the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
26352.ecindex IIDauthconf1
26353.ecindex IIDauthconf2
26354
26355
26356
26357
26358
26359
26360. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26361. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26362
26363.chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
26364.scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
26365.scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
26366The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
26367LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
26368plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
26369security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
26370(see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
26371use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
26372connections as you do for login accounts.
26373
26374.section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
26375.cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
26376When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
26377
26378.option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26379This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
26380configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
26381
26382.option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
26383The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
26384prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
26385given.
26386
26387.section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
26388.cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26389.cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26390.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
26391 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26392.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26393.cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26394
26395When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
26396expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
26397response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
26398values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
26399a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
26400are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
26401(neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
26402
26403For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
26404the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
26405variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
26406string expansions that also use them for other things.
26407
26408If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
26409supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
26410data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
26411
26412.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26413Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
26414&%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
26415authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
26416to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
26417&"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26418expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
26419generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
26420For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
26421string as the error text
26422
26423&*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
26424password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
26425There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
26426
26427
26428
26429.section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
26430.cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
26431.cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
26432.cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26433The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
26434sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
26435separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
26436subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
26437
26438The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
26439Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
26440configured as follows:
26441.code
26442fixed_plain:
26443 driver = plaintext
26444 public_name = PLAIN
26445 server_prompts = :
26446 server_condition = \
26447 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
26448 server_set_id = $auth2
26449.endd
26450Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
26451are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
26452password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
26453or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
26454
26455The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
26456the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
26457AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
26458authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
26459.code
26460250-AUTH PLAIN
26461.endd
26462and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
26463.code
26464AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
26465.endd
26466As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
26467data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
26468.code
26469AUTH PLAIN
26470.endd
26471to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
26472prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
26473
26474The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
26475when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
26476represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
26477is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
26478second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
26479
26480Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
26481realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
26482authenticating clients it could make sense.
26483
26484A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
26485&$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
26486comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
26487this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
26488This is an incorrect example:
26489.code
26490server_condition = \
26491 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
26492.endd
26493The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
26494which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
26495incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
26496non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
26497strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
26498the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
26499name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
26500.code
26501server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
26502 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
26503.endd
26504In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
26505fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
26506used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
26507always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
26508writing the test makes the logic clearer.
26509
26510
26511.section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
26512.cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
26513.cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
26514The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
26515in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
26516user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
26517plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
26518.code
26519fixed_login:
26520 driver = plaintext
26521 public_name = LOGIN
26522 server_prompts = User Name : Password
26523 server_condition = \
26524 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
26525 server_set_id = $auth1
26526.endd
26527Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
26528with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
26529if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
26530strings are used to obtain two data items.
26531
26532Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
26533example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
26534&"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
26535strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
26536name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
26537.code
26538login:
26539 driver = plaintext
26540 public_name = LOGIN
26541 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
26542 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
26543 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
26544 ldapauth{\
26545 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
26546 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
26547 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
26548 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
26549.endd
26550We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
26551does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
26552operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
26553&%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
26554correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
26555the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
26556uninterpreted string.
26557
26558
26559.section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
26560A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
26561interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
26562traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
26563Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
26564&<<SECTexpcond>>&.
26565
26566
26567
26568
26569.section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
26570.cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
26571The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
26572
26573.option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
26574If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
26575authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
26576the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
26577usual.
26578
26579.option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
26580The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
26581string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
26582string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
26583to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
26584most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
26585with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
26586way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
26587(with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
26588so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
26589&%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
26590&$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
26591
26592&*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
26593splitting takes priority and happens first.
26594
26595Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
26596the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
26597there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
26598NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
26599the string.
26600
26601This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
26602authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
26603.code
26604fixed_plain:
26605 driver = plaintext
26606 public_name = PLAIN
26607 client_send = ^username^mysecret
26608.endd
26609The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
26610command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
26611that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
26612.code
26613fixed_login:
26614 driver = plaintext
26615 public_name = LOGIN
26616 client_send = : username : mysecret
26617.endd
26618The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
26619the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
26620prompts.
26621.ecindex IIDplaiauth1
26622.ecindex IIDplaiauth2
26623
26624
26625
26626
26627. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26628. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26629
26630.chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
26631.scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
26632.scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
26633.cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
26634.cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
26635The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
26636sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
26637name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
26638string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
26639is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
26640secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
26641available in plain text at either end.
26642
26643
26644.section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
26645.cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
26646This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
26647authenticator as a server:
26648
26649.option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
26650.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
26651When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
26652the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
26653obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
26654that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
26655string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
26656fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
26657returned to the client.
26658
26659For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
26660in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
26661deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
26662numeric variables for other things.
26663
26664For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
26665client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
26666user name, authentication fails.
26667.code
26668fixed_cram:
26669 driver = cram_md5
26670 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26671 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
26672 server_set_id = $auth1
26673.endd
26674.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26675If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
26676name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
26677secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
26678.code
26679lookup_cram:
26680 driver = cram_md5
26681 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26682 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
26683 {$value}fail}
26684 server_set_id = $auth1
26685.endd
26686Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
26687because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
26688
26689As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
26690using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
26691lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
26692realm, with:
26693.code
26694cyrusless_crammd5:
26695 driver = cram_md5
26696 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26697 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
26698 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26699 server_set_id = $auth1
26700.endd
26701
26702.section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
26703.cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
26704When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
26705
26706
26707
26708.option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
26709This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
26710computing the response to the server's challenge.
26711
26712
26713.option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
26714This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
26715expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
26716
26717
26718.vindex "&$host$&"
26719.vindex "&$host_address$&"
26720Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
26721to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
26722expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
26723prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
26724authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
26725send the message to the current server.
26726
26727A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
26728strings, is:
26729.code
26730fixed_cram:
26731 driver = cram_md5
26732 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26733 client_name = ph10
26734 client_secret = secret
26735.endd
26736.ecindex IIDcramauth1
26737.ecindex IIDcramauth2
26738
26739
26740
26741. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26742. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26743
26744.chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
26745.scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
26746.scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
26747.cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
26748.cindex "Kerberos"
26749The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick while
26750at A L Digital Ltd.
26751
26752The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
26753library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
26754Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
26755including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
26756directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
26757
26758The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
26759the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
26760then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
26761name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
26762
26763Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
26764or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
26765user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
26766by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
26767depending on the driver you are using.
26768
26769The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
26770be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
26771Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
26772changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
26773layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
26774implementation.
26775
26776For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
26777may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
26778variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
26779Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
26780With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
26781environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
26782is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
26783the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
26784
26785
26786.section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
26787The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
26788(on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
26789previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
26790use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
26791confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
26792things.
26793
26794
26795.option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
26796This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
26797library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
26798SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
26799
26800
26801.option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
26802This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
26803default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
26804you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
26805example:
26806.code
26807sasl:
26808 driver = cyrus_sasl
26809 public_name = X-ANYTHING
26810 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
26811 server_set_id = $auth1
26812.endd
26813
26814.option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
26815This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
26816
26817
26818.option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
26819This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
26820
26821
26822For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
26823private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
26824the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
26825PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
26826.code
26827sasl_cram_md5:
26828 driver = cyrus_sasl
26829 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26830 server_set_id = $auth1
26831
26832sasl_plain:
26833 driver = cyrus_sasl
26834 public_name = PLAIN
26835 server_set_id = $auth2
26836.endd
26837Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
26838not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
26839but it is present in many binary distributions.
26840.ecindex IIDcyrauth1
26841.ecindex IIDcyrauth2
26842
26843
26844
26845
26846. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26847. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26848.chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
26849.scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
26850.scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
26851This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
26852Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
26853Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
26854If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
26855to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
26856authenticator only. There is only one option:
26857
26858.option server_socket dovecot string unset
26859
26860This option must specify the UNIX socket that is the interface to Dovecot
26861authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
26862mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
26863authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
26864.code
26865dovecot_plain:
26866 driver = dovecot
26867 public_name = PLAIN
26868 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
26869 server_set_id = $auth1
26870
26871dovecot_ntlm:
26872 driver = dovecot
26873 public_name = NTLM
26874 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
26875 server_set_id = $auth1
26876.endd
26877If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
26878&$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
26879option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
26880connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
26881option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
26882who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
26883.ecindex IIDdcotauth1
26884.ecindex IIDdcotauth2
26885
26886
26887. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26888. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26889.chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
26890.scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
26891.scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
26892.cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
26893.cindex "authentication" "SASL"
26894.cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
26895.cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
26896.cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
26897.cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
26898.cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
26899.cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
26900.cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
26901The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
26902library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
26903and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
26904scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
26905made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
26906without code changes in Exim.
26907
26908
26909.option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
26910Do not set this true without consulting a cryptographic engineer.
26911
26912Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
26913of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
26914authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
26915ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
26916context.
26917
26918This should have meant that certificate identity and verification becomes a
26919non-issue, as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and
26920server to see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
26921
26922This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
26923only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
26924writing, that's the SCRAM family.
26925
26926This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
26927this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
26928of Exim might have switched the default to be true.
26929
26930However, Channel Binding in TLS has proven to be broken in current versions.
26931Do not plan to rely upon this feature for security, ever, without consulting
26932with a subject matter expert (a cryptographic engineer).
26933
26934
26935.option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
26936This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
26937library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
26938Some mechanisms will use this data.
26939
26940
26941.option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
26942This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
26943default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
26944you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
26945example:
26946.code
26947sasl:
26948 driver = gsasl
26949 public_name = X-ANYTHING
26950 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
26951 server_set_id = $auth1
26952.endd
26953
26954
26955.option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
26956Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
26957that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
26958the password itself.
26959
26960The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
26961In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
26962The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
26963if available, else the empty string.
26964The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
26965else the empty string.
26966
26967A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
26968
26969If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
26970option to be simply "true".
26971
26972
26973.option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
26974This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
26975Some mechanisms will use this data.
26976
26977
26978.option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
26979This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26980&$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26981(This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26982
26983
26984.option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
26985This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
26986&$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
26987(This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
26988
26989
26990.option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
26991This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
26992Some mechanisms will use this data.
26993
26994
26995.section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
26996.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26997These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
26998They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
26999
27000Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
27001meanings for these variables:
27002
27003.ilist
27004.vindex "&$auth1$&"
27005&$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
27006.next
27007.vindex "&$auth2$&"
27008&$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
27009.next
27010.vindex "&$auth3$&"
27011&$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
27012.endlist
27013
27014On a per-mechanism basis:
27015
27016.ilist
27017.cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
27018EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
27019the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27020.next
27021.cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
27022ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
27023the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27024.next
27025.cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
27026GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
27027&$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
27028the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27029.endlist
27030
27031An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
27032identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
27033email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
27034
27035
27036An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
27037and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
27038.code
27039gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
27040 driver = gsasl
27041 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27042 server_realm = imap.example.org
27043 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
27044 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
27045 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
27046 server_condition = yes
27047.endd
27048
27049
27050. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27051. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27052
27053.chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
27054.scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
27055.scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
27056.cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
27057.cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
27058The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
27059Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
27060reliably.
27061
27062.option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
27063This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
27064for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
27065identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
27066
27067.option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
27068If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
27069&_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
27070The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
27071
27072.option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
27073This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
27074&%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
27075from the keytab.
27076
27077
27078.section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
27079Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
27080to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
27081not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
27082
27083The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
27084Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
27085Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
27086role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
27087
27088.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27089.ilist
27090.vindex "&$auth1$&"
27091&$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
27092.next
27093.vindex "&$auth2$&"
27094&$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
27095authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
27096GSS Display Name.
27097.endlist
27098
27099
27100. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27101. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27102
27103.chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
27104.scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
27105.scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
27106.cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
27107.cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
27108.cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
27109.cindex "NTLM authentication"
27110The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
27111Password Authentication'& mechanism,
27112which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
27113this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
27114taken from the Samba project (&url(https://www.samba.org/)). The code for the
27115server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
27116follows:
27117
27118.ilist
27119After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
27120authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
27121.next
27122The server sends back a challenge.
27123.next
27124The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
27125and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
27126.endlist
27127
27128Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
27129
27130
27131
27132.section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
27133.cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
27134The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
27135
27136.option server_password spa string&!! unset
27137.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
27138This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
27139authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
27140compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
27141&$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
27142it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
27143for other things. For example:
27144.code
27145spa:
27146 driver = spa
27147 public_name = NTLM
27148 server_password = \
27149 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
27150.endd
27151If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27152failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27153
27154
27155
27156
27157
27158.section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
27159.cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
27160The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
27161
27162
27163
27164.option client_domain spa string&!! unset
27165This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
27166
27167
27168.option client_password spa string&!! unset
27169This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
27170
27171
27172.option client_username spa string&!! unset
27173This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
27174configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
27175&'msn.com'&:
27176.code
27177msn:
27178 driver = spa
27179 public_name = MSN
27180 client_username = msn/msn_username
27181 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
27182 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
27183.endd
27184.ecindex IIDspaauth1
27185.ecindex IIDspaauth2
27186
27187
27188
27189
27190
27191. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27192. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27193
27194.chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
27195.scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
27196.scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
27197.cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
27198.cindex "authentication" "X509"
27199.cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
27200The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
27201authentication based on client certificates.
27202
27203It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
27204advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
27205It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
27206the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
27207by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
27208the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
27209
27210The client must present a verifiable certificate,
27211for which it must have been requested via the
27212&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
27213(see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27214
27215If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
27216run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
27217and can authenticate the connection.
27218If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
27219
27220A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
27221
27222
27223.cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
27224The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
27225
27226.option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
27227.cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
27228This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
27229the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
27230If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27231failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27232
27233.option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
27234.option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
27235As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
27236
27237&%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
27238
27239
27240Example:
27241.code
27242tls:
27243 driver = tls
27244 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
27245 {$tls_in_peercert}}
27246 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth1} \
27247 {!= {0} \
27248 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
27249 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
27250 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
27251 } } } }
27252 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
27253.endd
27254This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
27255of your configured trust-anchors
27256(which usually means the full set of public CAs)
27257and which has a SAN with a good account name.
27258Note that the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
27259whereas a plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
27260
27261. An alternative might use
27262. .code
27263. server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
27264. .endd
27265. to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
27266. (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
27267. This would help for per-device use.
27268.
27269. However, for the future we really need support for checking a
27270. user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
27271
27272.ecindex IIDtlsauth1
27273.ecindex IIDtlsauth2
27274
27275
27276Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
27277the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
27278a connect- or helo-ACL.
27279
27280
27281
27282. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27283. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27284
27285.chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
27286 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
27287.scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
27288.scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
27289.cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
27290.cindex "OpenSSL"
27291.cindex "GnuTLS"
27292Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
27293Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
27294GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
27295cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
27296order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
27297version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
27298You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
27299level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
27300certificates are used.
27301
27302RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
27303connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
27304server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
27305mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
27306between them is encrypted.
27307
27308Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
27309and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
27310certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
27311possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
27312encryption state.
27313
27314&*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
27315disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
27316in order to get TLS to work.
27317
27318
27319
27320.section "Support for the &""submissions""& (aka &""ssmtp""& and &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
27321 "SECID284"
27322.cindex "submissions protocol"
27323.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
27324.cindex "smtps protocol"
27325.cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
27326.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
27327.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
27328The history of port numbers for TLS in SMTP is a little messy and has been
27329contentious. As of RFC 8314, the common practice of using the historically
27330allocated port 465 for "email submission but with TLS immediately upon connect
27331instead of using STARTTLS" is officially blessed by the IETF, and recommended
27332by them in preference to STARTTLS.
27333
27334The name originally assigned to the port was &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, but as
27335clarity emerged over the dual roles of SMTP, for MX delivery and Email
27336Submission, nomenclature has shifted. The modern name is now &"submissions"&.
27337
27338This approach was, for a while, officially abandoned when encrypted SMTP was
27339standardized, but many clients kept using it, even as the TCP port number was
27340reassigned for other use.
27341Thus you may encounter guidance claiming that you shouldn't enable use of
27342this port.
27343In practice, a number of mail-clients have only ever supported submissions,
27344not submission with STARTTLS upgrade.
27345Ideally, offer both submission (587) and submissions (465) service.
27346
27347Exim supports TLS-on-connect by means of the &%tls_on_connect_ports%&
27348global option. Its value must be a list of port numbers;
27349the most common use is expected to be:
27350.code
27351tls_on_connect_ports = 465
27352.endd
27353The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
27354via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
27355the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
27356the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
27357an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
27358defined elsewhere.
27359
27360There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
27361&%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the TLS-only behaviour for all ports.
27362
27363
27364
27365
27366
27367
27368.section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
27369.cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
27370The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
27371followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
27372to use GnuTLS, you need to set
27373.code
27374USE_GNUTLS=yes
27375.endd
27376in Local/Makefile, in addition to
27377.code
27378SUPPORT_TLS=yes
27379.endd
27380You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
27381include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
27382
27383There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
27384
27385.ilist
27386The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
27387cannot be the path of a directory
27388for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
27389(for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
27390.next
27391The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
27392.next
27393.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
27394.vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
27395Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
27396separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
27397affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
27398.next
27399OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
27400DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
27401RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
27402in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
27403for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
27404to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
27405&%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
27406option).
27407.next
27408The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
27409sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
27410.next
27411The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
27412When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
27413(If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
27414let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
27415.next
27416With GnuTLS, if an explicit list is used for the &%tls_privatekey%& main option
27417main option, it must be ordered to match the &%tls_certificate%& list.
27418.next
27419Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
27420This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
27421explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
27422implementation, then patches are welcome.
27423.endlist
27424
27425
27426.section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
27427This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
27428an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
27429but not the chosen filename.
27430By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
27431See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
27432
27433GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
27434to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
27435Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
27436&_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
27437of bits requested.
27438The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
27439its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
27440parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
27441that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
27442renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
27443this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
27444place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
27445
27446For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
27447recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
27448If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
27449are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
27450not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
27451
27452Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
27453values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
27454parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
27455If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
27456until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
27457a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
27458
27459The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
27460in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
27461generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
27462
27463To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
27464and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
27465&(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
27466renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
27467.code
27468# ls
27469[ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
27470# rm -f new-params
27471# touch new-params
27472# chown exim:exim new-params
27473# chmod 0600 new-params
27474# certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
27475# openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
27476[ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
27477 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
27478 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
27479# chmod 0400 new-params
27480# mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
27481.endd
27482If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
27483stalling is removed.
27484
27485The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
27486Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
27487the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
27488a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
27489and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
27490failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
27491of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
27492which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
27493GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
27494to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
27495limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
27496
27497The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
27498value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
27499&%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
275002432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
27501
27502In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
27503increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
27504bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
27505procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
27506the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
27507
27508
27509.section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
27510.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
27511.oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
27512There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
27513suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
27514.new
27515are acceptable for TLS versions prior to 1.3.
27516.wen
27517The list is colon separated and may contain names like
27518DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
27519directly to this function call.
27520Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
27521&'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
27522The following quotation from the OpenSSL
27523documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
27524
27525.ilist
27526It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
27527.next
27528It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
27529or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
27530ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
27531SSL v3 algorithms.
27532.next
27533Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
27534the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
27535SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
27536algorithms.
27537.endlist
27538
27539Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
27540&`-`& or &`+`&.
27541.ilist
27542If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
27543ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
27544stated.
27545.next
27546If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
27547of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
27548.next
27549If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
27550option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
27551.endlist
27552
27553If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
27554a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
27555includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
27556not be moved to the end of the list.
27557.endlist
27558
27559The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
27560string:
27561.code
27562# note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
27563$ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
27564.endd
27565
27566This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
27567there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
27568submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
27569choice of clients used:
27570.code
27571# OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
27572tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
27573 {DEFAULT}\
27574 {HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1}}
27575.endd
27576
27577This example will prefer ECDSA-authenticated ciphers over RSA ones:
27578.code
27579tls_require_ciphers = ECDSA:RSA:!COMPLEMENTOFDEFAULT
27580.endd
27581
27582.new
27583For TLS version 1.3 the control available is less fine-grained
27584and Exim does not provide access to it at present.
27585The value of the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is ignored when
27586TLS version 1.3 is negotiated.
27587
27588As of writing the library default cipher suite list for TLSv1.3 is
27589.code
27590TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
27591.endd
27592.wen
27593
27594
27595.section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
27596 "SECTreqciphgnu"
27597.cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
27598.cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
27599.cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
27600.cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
27601.cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
27602.cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
27603.oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
27604The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
27605as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
27606ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
27607
27608The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
27609and controls both protocols and ciphers.
27610
27611The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
27612controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
27613&(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
27614the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
27615the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
27616aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
27617
27618Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
27619"Priority strings". This is online as
27620&url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
27621but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
27622installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
27623then the example code
27624&url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string)
27625on that site can be used to test a given string.
27626
27627For example:
27628.code
27629# Disable older versions of protocols
27630tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
27631.endd
27632
27633Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
27634additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
27635"&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
27636
27637This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
27638there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
27639by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
27640where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
27641used:
27642.code
27643# GnuTLS variant
27644tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
27645 {NORMAL:%COMPAT}\
27646 {SECURE128}}
27647.endd
27648
27649
27650.section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
27651.cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
27652When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
27653the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
27654but not to any others. The default value of this option is *, which means
27655that STARTTLS is always advertised. Set it to blank to never advertise;
27656this is reasonable for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
27657
27658If STARTTLS is to be used you
27659need to set some other options in order to make TLS available.
27660
27661If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
27662problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
27663persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
27664with the error
27665.code
27666554 Security failure
27667.endd
27668If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
27669rejected with a 554 error code.
27670
27671To enable TLS operations on a server, the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option
27672must be set to match some hosts. The default is * which matches all hosts.
27673
27674If this is all you do, TLS encryption will be enabled but not authentication -
27675meaning that the peer has no assurance it is actually you he is talking to.
27676You gain protection from a passive sniffer listening on the wire but not
27677from someone able to intercept the communication.
27678
27679Further protection requires some further configuration at the server end.
27680
27681To make TLS work you need to set, in the server,
27682.code
27683tls_certificate = /some/file/name
27684tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
27685.endd
27686These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
27687the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
27688contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
27689that goes with it. These files need to be
27690PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
27691always be given as full path names.
27692The key must not be password-protected.
27693They can be the same file if both the
27694certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
27695set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
27696is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
27697certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
27698the server's certificate.
27699
27700For dual-stack (eg. RSA and ECDSA) configurations, these options can be
27701colon-separated lists of file paths. Ciphers using given authentication
27702algorithms require the presence of a suitable certificate to supply the
27703public-key. The server selects among the certificates to present to the
27704client depending on the selected cipher, hence the priority ordering for
27705ciphers will affect which certificate is used.
27706
27707If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
27708source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
27709few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
27710
27711&*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
27712they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
27713Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
27714transport.
27715
27716With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
27717require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
27718this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
27719.code
27720tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
27721.endd
27722is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
27723with the parameters contained in the file.
27724Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
27725available:
27726.code
27727tls_dhparam = none
27728.endd
27729This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
27730DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
27731used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
27732documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
27733
27734See the command
27735.code
27736openssl dhparam
27737.endd
27738for a way of generating file data.
27739
27740The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
27741host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
27742for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
27743in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
27744forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
27745
27746.cindex "cipher" "logging"
27747.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
27748.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
27749The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
27750an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
27751incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
27752also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
27753&"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
27754condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
27755
27756Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
27757can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
27758cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
27759example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
27760contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
27761documentation for more details.
27762
27763For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
27764(again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
27765
27766
27767.section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
27768.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
27769.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
27770If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
27771session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
27772&%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
27773apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
27774Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
27775contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
27776expected certificates.
27777These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
27778an explicit file or,
27779depending on library version, a directory, identified by
27780&%tls_verify_certificates%&.
27781
27782A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
27783directory is used
27784(OpenSSL only),
27785each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
27786of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
27787certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
27788.code
27789openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
27790.endd
27791where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
27792
27793The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
27794what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
27795does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
27796&%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
27797attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
27798dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
27799session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
27800fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
27801example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
27802relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
27803
27804.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
27805When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
27806the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
27807&$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
27808
27809.cindex "log" "distinguished name"
27810Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
27811&'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
27812&"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
27813&%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
27814certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
27815
27816
27817.section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
27818.cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
27819.cindex "revocation list"
27820.cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
27821.cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
27822Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
27823certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
27824server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
27825an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
27826of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
27827CRL in PEM format.
27828The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
27829file from every certificate authority they know of.
27830
27831The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
27832Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
27833against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
27834usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
27835private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
27836is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
27837
27838The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
27839comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
27840connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
27841re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
27842
27843The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
27844issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
27845the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
27846negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
27847CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
27848resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
27849starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
27850proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
27851
27852Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
27853or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
27854support for OCSP stapling is included.
27855
27856There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
27857The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
27858an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
27859option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
27860contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
27861
27862Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
27863proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
27864Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
27865contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
27866on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
27867next connection.
27868
27869When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
27870in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
27871ignored.
27872
27873For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
27874also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
27875certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
27876of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
27877intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
27878file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
27879
27880Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
27881not any of the chain from CA to it.
27882
27883There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
27884
27885.code
27886 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
27887 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
27888 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
27889
27890 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
27891 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
27892 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
27893.endd
27894
27895
27896
27897
27898.section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
27899.cindex "cipher" "logging"
27900.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
27901.cindex "log" "distinguished name"
27902.cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
27903The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
27904deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
27905server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
27906within the &(smtp)& transport.
27907
27908It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
27909transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
27910server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
27911this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
27912transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
27913
27914If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
27915to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
27916&%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
27917those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
27918set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
27919usual way.
27920
27921When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
27922the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
27923a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
27924session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
27925&%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
27926delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
27927it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
27928STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
27929negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
27930unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
27931unencrypted.
27932
27933The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
27934transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
27935if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
27936&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
27937
27938If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
27939specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
27940These may be
27941the system default set (depending on library version),
27942a file,
27943or (depending on library version) a directory.
27944The client verifies the server's certificate
27945against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
27946in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
27947Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
27948&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
27949
27950The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
27951certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
27952or need not succeed respectively.
27953
27954The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
27955&%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
27956is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
27957value is empty.
27958&%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
27959a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
27960value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
27961otherwise.
27962
27963The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
27964&%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
27965for OCSP to be relevant.
27966
27967If
27968&%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
27969list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
27970the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
27971alternative hosts, if any.
27972
27973 &*Note*&:
27974These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
27975is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
27976by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
27977client.
27978
27979.vindex "&$host$&"
27980.vindex "&$host_address$&"
27981All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
27982&$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
27983which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
27984behave as if the relevant option were unset.
27985
27986.vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
27987.vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
27988.vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
27989.vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
27990Before an SMTP connection is established, the
27991&$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
27992variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
27993that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
27994successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
27995outgoing connection.
27996
27997
27998
27999.section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
28000.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
28001.vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
28002.oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
28003With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
28004information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
28005extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
28006&"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
28007client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
28008within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
28009for this session.
28010
28011This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
28012which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
28013address.
28014
28015With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
28016against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
28017provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
28018be of limited use in that environment.
28019
28020With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
28021connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
28022choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
28023wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
28024different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
28025
28026The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
28027if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
28028nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
28029only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
28030for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
28031
28032Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
28033received from a client.
28034It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
28035
28036If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
28037option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
28038during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
28039
28040.ilist
28041&%tls_certificate%&
28042.next
28043&%tls_crl%&
28044.next
28045&%tls_privatekey%&
28046.next
28047&%tls_verify_certificates%&
28048.next
28049&%tls_ocsp_file%&
28050.endlist
28051
28052Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
28053attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
28054can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_in_sni$& is
28055arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
28056Further, the initial certificate is loaded before SNI is arrived, so
28057an expansion for &%tls_certificate%& must have a default which is used
28058when &$tls_in_sni$& is empty.
28059
28060The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
28061are re-expanded.
28062
28063When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
28064for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
28065enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
28066see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
28067
28068When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
280690.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
28070built, then you have SNI support).
28071
28072
28073
28074.section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
28075 "SECTmulmessam"
28076.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
28077.cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
28078Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
28079an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
28080one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
28081of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
28082connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
28083to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, for sending using TLS Exim
28084starts an additional proxy process for handling the encryption, piping the
28085unencrypted data stream from and to the delivery processes.
28086
28087An older mode of operation can be enabled on a per-host basis by the
28088&%hosts_noproxy_tls%& option on the &(smtp)& transport. If the host matches
28089this list the proxy process described above is not used; instead Exim
28090shuts down an existing TLS session being run by the delivery process
28091before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
28092try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
28093if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
28094
28095The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
28096after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
28097just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
28098reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
28099successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
28100SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
28101should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
28102subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
28103and delay other deliveries to that host.
28104
28105To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
28106closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
28107closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
28108information is recorded.
28109
28110There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
28111&(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
28112connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
28113
28114
28115
28116
28117.section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
28118.cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
28119In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
28120certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities.
28121This is a large topic and an introductory guide is unsuitable for the Exim
28122reference manual, so instead we provide pointers to existing documentation.
28123
28124The Apache web-server was for a long time the canonical guide, so their
28125documentation is a good place to start; their SSL module's Introduction
28126document is currently at
28127.display
28128.url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_intro.html)
28129.endd
28130and their FAQ is at
28131.display
28132&url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_faq.html)
28133.endd
28134
28135Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
281360-201-61598-3) in 2001, contains both introductory and more in-depth
28137descriptions.
28138More recently Ivan Ristić's book &'Bulletproof SSL and TLS'&,
28139published by Feisty Duck (ISBN 978-1907117046) in 2013 is good.
28140Ivan is the author of the popular TLS testing tools at
28141&url(https://www.ssllabs.com/).
28142
28143
28144.section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
28145The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
28146certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
28147sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
28148not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
28149First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
28150certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
28151intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
28152certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
28153The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
28154validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
28155root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
28156install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
28157
28158Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
28159even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
28160server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
28161diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
28162
28163
28164
28165.section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
28166.cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
28167You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
28168with OpenSSL, like this:
28169. ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
28170. ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
28171.code
28172openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
28173 -days 9999 -nodes
28174.endd
28175&_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
28176delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
28177specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
28178important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
28179that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
28180prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
28181this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
28182
28183. ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
28184. ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
28185. ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
28186. ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
28187. ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
28188. ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
28189. ==== -pdp, 2012
28190NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
28191epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
28192the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
28193the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
28194of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
28195writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
28196progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
28197be a sensible resolution).
28198
28199A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
28200may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
28201encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
28202
28203However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
28204user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
28205certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
28206must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
28207authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
28208signed with that self-signed certificate.
28209
28210For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
28211user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
28212Open-source PKI book, available online at
28213&url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/ospkibook/).
28214.ecindex IIDencsmtp1
28215.ecindex IIDencsmtp2
28216
28217
28218
28219.section DANE "SECDANE"
28220.cindex DANE
28221DNS-based Authentication of Named Entities, as applied to SMTP over TLS, provides assurance to a client that
28222it is actually talking to the server it wants to rather than some attacker operating a Man In The Middle (MITM)
28223operation. The latter can terminate the TLS connection you make, and make another one to the server (so both
28224you and the server still think you have an encrypted connection) and, if one of the "well known" set of
28225Certificate Authorities has been suborned - something which *has* been seen already (2014), a verifiable
28226certificate (if you're using normal root CAs, eg. the Mozilla set, as your trust anchors).
28227
28228What DANE does is replace the CAs with the DNS as the trust anchor. The assurance is limited to a) the possibility
28229that the DNS has been suborned, b) mistakes made by the admins of the target server. The attack surface presented
28230by (a) is thought to be smaller than that of the set of root CAs.
28231
28232It also allows the server to declare (implicitly) that connections to it should use TLS. An MITM could simply
28233fail to pass on a server's STARTTLS.
28234
28235DANE scales better than having to maintain (and side-channel communicate) copies of server certificates
28236for every possible target server. It also scales (slightly) better than having to maintain on an SMTP
28237client a copy of the standard CAs bundle. It also means not having to pay a CA for certificates.
28238
28239DANE requires a server operator to do three things: 1) run DNSSEC. This provides assurance to clients
28240that DNS lookups they do for the server have not been tampered with. The domain MX record applying
28241to this server, its A record, its TLSA record and any associated CNAME records must all be covered by
28242DNSSEC.
282432) add TLSA DNS records. These say what the server certificate for a TLS connection should be.
282443) offer a server certificate, or certificate chain, in TLS connections which is is anchored by one of the TLSA records.
28245
28246There are no changes to Exim specific to server-side operation of DANE.
28247Support for client-side operation of DANE can be included at compile time by defining SUPPORT_DANE=yes
28248in &_Local/Makefile_&.
28249If it has been included, the macro "_HAVE_DANE" will be defined.
28250
28251The TLSA record for the server may have "certificate usage" of DANE-TA(2) or DANE-EE(3).
28252These are the "Trust Anchor" and "End Entity" variants.
28253The latter specifies the End Entity directly, i.e. the certificate involved is that of the server
28254(and if only DANE-EE is used then it should be the sole one transmitted during the TLS handshake);
28255this is appropriate for a single system, using a self-signed certificate.
28256DANE-TA usage is effectively declaring a specific CA to be used; this might be a private CA or a public,
28257well-known one.
28258A private CA at simplest is just a self-signed certificate (with certain
28259attributes) which is used to sign cerver certificates, but running one securely
28260does require careful arrangement.
28261With DANE-TA, as implemented in Exim and commonly in other MTAs,
28262the server TLS handshake must transmit the entire certificate chain from CA to server-certificate.
28263DANE-TA is commonly used for several services and/or servers, each having a TLSA query-domain CNAME record,
28264all of which point to a single TLSA record.
28265DANE-TA and DANE-EE can both be used together.
28266
28267.new
28268Our recommendation is to use DANE with a certificate from a public CA,
28269because this enables a variety of strategies for remote clients to verify
28270your certificate.
28271You can then publish information both via DANE and another technology,
28272"MTA-STS", described below.
28273
28274When you use DANE-TA to publish trust anchor information, you ask entities
28275outside your administrative control to trust the Certificate Authority for
28276connections to you.
28277If using a private CA then you should expect others to still apply the
28278technical criteria they'd use for a public CA to your certificates.
28279In particular, you should probably try to follow current best practices for CA
28280operation around hash algorithms and key sizes.
28281Do not expect other organizations to lower their security expectations just
28282because a particular profile might be reasonable for your own internal use.
28283
28284When this text was last updated, this in practice means to avoid use of SHA-1
28285and MD5; if using RSA to use key sizes of at least 2048 bits (and no larger
28286than 4096, for interoperability); to use keyUsage fields correctly; to use
28287random serial numbers.
28288The list of requirements is subject to change as best practices evolve.
28289If you're not already using a private CA, or it doesn't meet these
28290requirements, then we encourage you to avoid all these issues and use a public
28291CA such as &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt) instead.
28292.wen
28293
28294The TLSA record should have a Selector field of SPKI(1) and a Matching Type field of SHA2-512(2).
28295
28296At the time of writing, &url(https://www.huque.com/bin/gen_tlsa)
28297is useful for quickly generating TLSA records; and commands like
28298
28299.code
28300 openssl x509 -in -pubkey -noout <certificate.pem \
28301 | openssl rsa -outform der -pubin 2>/dev/null \
28302 | openssl sha512 \
28303 | awk '{print $2}'
28304.endd
28305
28306are workable for 4th-field hashes.
28307
28308For use with the DANE-TA model, server certificates must have a correct name (SubjectName or SubjectAltName).
28309
28310.new
28311The Certificate issued by the CA published in the DANE-TA model should be
28312issued using a strong hash algorithm.
28313Exim, and importantly various other MTAs sending to you, will not
28314re-enable hash algorithms which have been disabled by default in TLS
28315libraries.
28316This means no MD5 and no SHA-1. SHA2-256 is the minimum for reliable
28317interoperability (and probably the maximum too, in 2018).
28318.wen
28319
28320The use of OCSP-stapling should be considered, allowing for fast revocation of certificates (which would otherwise
28321be limited by the DNS TTL on the TLSA records). However, this is likely to only be usable with DANE-TA. NOTE: the
28322default of requesting OCSP for all hosts is modified iff DANE is in use, to:
28323
28324.code
28325 hosts_request_ocsp = ${if or { {= {0}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} \
28326 {= {4}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} } \
28327 {*}{}}
28328.endd
28329
28330The (new) variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& is a bitfield with numbered bits set for TLSA record usage codes.
28331The zero above means DANE was not in use, the four means that only DANE-TA usage TLSA records were
28332found. If the definition of &%hosts_request_ocsp%& includes the
28333string "tls_out_tlsa_usage", they are re-expanded in time to
28334control the OCSP request.
28335
28336This modification of hosts_request_ocsp is only done if it has the default value of "*". Admins who change it, and
28337those who use &%hosts_require_ocsp%&, should consider the interaction with DANE in their OCSP settings.
28338
28339
28340For client-side DANE there are three new smtp transport options, &%hosts_try_dane%&, &%hosts_require_dane%&
28341and &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%&.
28342The require variant will result in failure if the target host is not DNSSEC-secured.
28343
28344DANE will only be usable if the target host has DNSSEC-secured MX, A and TLSA records.
28345
28346A TLSA lookup will be done if either of the above options match and the host-lookup succeeded using dnssec.
28347If a TLSA lookup is done and succeeds, a DANE-verified TLS connection
28348will be required for the host. If it does not, the host will not
28349be used; there is no fallback to non-DANE or non-TLS.
28350
28351If DANE is requested and usable, then the TLS cipher list configuration
28352prefers to use the option &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%& and falls
28353back to &%tls_require_ciphers%& only if that is unset.
28354This lets you configure "decent crypto" for DANE and "better than nothing
28355crypto" as the default. Note though that while GnuTLS lets the string control
28356which versions of TLS/SSL will be negotiated, OpenSSL does not and you're
28357limited to ciphersuite constraints.
28358
28359If DANE is requested and useable (see above) the following transport options are ignored:
28360.code
28361 hosts_require_tls
28362 tls_verify_hosts
28363 tls_try_verify_hosts
28364 tls_verify_certificates
28365 tls_crl
28366 tls_verify_cert_hostnames
28367.endd
28368
28369If DANE is not usable, whether requested or not, and CA-anchored
28370verification evaluation is wanted, the above variables should be set appropriately.
28371
28372Currently the &%dnssec_request_domains%& must be active and &%dnssec_require_domains%& is ignored.
28373
28374If verification was successful using DANE then the "CV" item in the delivery log line will show as "CV=dane".
28375
28376There is a new variable &$tls_out_dane$& which will have "yes" if
28377verification succeeded using DANE and "no" otherwise (only useful
28378in combination with events; see &<<CHAPevents>>&),
28379and a new variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& (detailed above).
28380
28381.cindex DANE reporting
28382An event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "dane:fail" will be raised on failures
28383to achieve DANE-verified connection, if one was either requested and offered, or
28384required. This is intended to support TLS-reporting as defined in
28385&url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-ietf-uta-smtp-tlsrpt-17).
28386The &$event_data$& will be one of the Result Types defined in
28387Section 4.3 of that document.
28388
28389Under GnuTLS, DANE is only supported from version 3.0.0 onwards.
28390
28391DANE is specified in published RFCs and decouples certificate authority trust
28392selection from a "race to the bottom" of "you must trust everything for mail
28393to get through". There is an alternative technology called MTA-STS, which
28394instead publishes MX trust anchor information on an HTTPS website. At the
28395time this text was last updated, MTA-STS was still a draft, not yet an RFC.
28396Exim has no support for MTA-STS as a client, but Exim mail server operators
28397can choose to publish information describing their TLS configuration using
28398MTA-STS to let those clients who do use that protocol derive trust
28399information.
28400
28401The MTA-STS design requires a certificate from a public Certificate Authority
28402which is recognized by clients sending to you.
28403That selection of which CAs are trusted by others is outside your control.
28404
28405The most interoperable course of action is probably to use
28406&url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt), with automated certificate
28407renewal; to publish the anchor information in DNSSEC-secured DNS via TLSA
28408records for DANE clients (such as Exim and Postfix) and to publish anchor
28409information for MTA-STS as well. This is what is done for the &'exim.org'&
28410domain itself (with caveats around occasionally broken MTA-STS because of
28411incompatible specification changes prior to reaching RFC status).
28412
28413
28414
28415. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28416. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28417
28418.chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
28419.scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
28420.cindex "control of incoming mail"
28421.cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
28422.cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
28423Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
28424configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
28425name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
28426one very small ACL:
28427.code
28428begin acl
28429small_acl:
28430 accept hosts = one.host.only
28431.endd
28432You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
28433which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
28434
28435The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
28436certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
28437when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
28438option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
28439in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
28440local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
28441a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
28442&<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
28443
28444
28445.section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
28446The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
28447configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
28448
28449
28450.section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
28451.cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
28452In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
28453options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
28454.cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
28455.cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
28456.cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
28457.cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
28458.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
28459.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
28460.cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
28461.cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
28462.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
28463.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
28464.cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
28465.cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
28466.cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
28467.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
28468.cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
28469.cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
28470
28471.table2 140pt
28472.irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
28473.irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
28474.irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
28475.irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
28476.irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
28477.irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
28478.irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
28479.irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
28480.irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
28481.irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
28482.irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
28483.irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
28484.irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
28485.irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
28486.irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
28487.irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
28488.irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
28489.irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
28490.irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
28491.irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
28492.endtable
28493
28494For example, if you set
28495.code
28496acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
28497.endd
28498the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
28499in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
28500done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
28501sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
28502command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
28503trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
28504testing as possible at RCPT time.
28505
28506
28507.section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
28508.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
28509The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
28510apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
28511really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
28512the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
28513relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
28514are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
28515&$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
28516&$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
28517in any of these ACLs.
28518
28519The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
28520non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
28521analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
28522batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
28523result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
28524really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
28525on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
28526controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
28527.code
28528control = suppress_local_fixups
28529.endd
28530This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
28531run, it is too late.
28532
28533The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28534content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28535
28536The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
28537kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
28538temporary error for these kinds of message.
28539
28540
28541.section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
28542.cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
28543.oindex &%smtp_banner%&
28544The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
28545session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
28546an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
28547accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
28548the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
28549&%smtp_banner%& option.
28550
28551
28552.section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
28553.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
28554.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
28555The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
28556EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
28557&%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
28558Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
28559session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
28560setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
28561
28562Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
28563mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
28564&$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
28565
28566If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
28567modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
28568at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
28569affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
28570an EHLO response.
28571
28572
28573.section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
28574.cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
28575Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
28576command, with two responses being sent to the client.
28577When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
28578is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
28579the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
28580response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
28581added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
28582are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
28583
28584You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
28585in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
28586tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
28587received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
28588the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
28589associated with the DATA command.
28590
28591.cindex CHUNKING "BDAT command"
28592.cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
28593.cindex "RFC 3030" CHUNKING
28594If CHUNKING was advertised and a BDAT command sequence is received,
28595the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL is not run.
28596. XXX why not? It should be possible, for the first BDAT.
28597The &%acl_smtp_data%& is run after the last BDAT command and all of
28598the data specified is received.
28599
28600For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
28601error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
28602MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
28603before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
28604and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
28605your resources.
28606
28607The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
28608the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
28609the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
28610and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
28611
28612.section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
28613The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
28614enabled (which is the default).
28615
28616The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
28617received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
28618otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
28619
28620This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
28621
28622For details on the operation of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
28623
28624
28625.section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
28626The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28627content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28628
28629This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
28630
28631
28632.section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
28633.cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
28634.oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
28635The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
28636with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
28637It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
28638client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
28639has been accepted.
28640
28641The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
28642has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
28643with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
28644The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
28645The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
28646can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
28647for some or all recipients.
28648
28649PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
28650one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
28651content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
28652.cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
28653for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
28654is &"yes"&.
28655Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
28656ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
28657will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
28658
28659See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
28660and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
28661
28662This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
28663If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
28664the feature was not requested by the client.
28665
28666.section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
28667.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
28668The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
28669does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
28670does not in fact control any access.
28671For this reason, it may only accept
28672or warn as its final result.
28673
28674This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
28675session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
28676messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
28677more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
28678
28679&*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
28680the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
28681
28682You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
28683&%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
28684response to QUIT.
28685
28686This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
28687failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
28688because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
28689client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
28690connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
28691
28692
28693.section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
28694.vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
28695The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
28696an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
28697trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
28698because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
28699situation even worse.
28700
28701Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
28702logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
28703modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
28704and &%warn%&.
28705
28706.vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
28707When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
28708to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
28709connection. The possible values are:
28710.table2
28711.irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
28712.irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
28713.irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
28714.irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
28715.irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
28716.irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
28717.irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
28718.irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
28719.irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
28720.irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
28721.endtable
28722In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
28723Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
28724With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
28725overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
28726&%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
28727used.
28728
28729
28730.section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
28731.cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
28732The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
28733you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
28734.code
28735acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
28736 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
28737.endd
28738In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
28739providing an RFC 4409 message &"submission"& service on port 587 and
28740an RFC 8314 &"submissions"& service on port 465. You can use a string
28741expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
28742more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
28743
28744The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
28745configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
28746string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
28747
28748.ilist
28749If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
28750contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
28751Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
28752lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
28753If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
28754causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
28755.code
28756acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
28757 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
28758 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
28759.endd
28760This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
28761back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
28762file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
28763can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
28764.next
28765If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
28766Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
28767matches the string.
28768.next
28769If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
28770the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
28771want to have something like
28772.code
28773acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
28774.endd
28775in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
28776newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
28777.endlist
28778
28779
28780
28781
28782.section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
28783.cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
28784Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
28785section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
28786&"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
28787database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
28788return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
28789&"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
28790This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
28791
28792For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
28793&"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
28794submitters of non-SMTP messages.
28795
28796
28797ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
28798has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
28799individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
28800blackholing facility. Use it with care.
28801
28802If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
28803ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
28804RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
28805recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
28806run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
28807remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
28808&%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
28809
28810If the ACL for VRFY returns &"accept"&, a recipient verify (without callout)
28811is done on the address and the result determines the SMTP response.
28812
28813
28814.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
28815The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
28816recipients; it may create new recipients.
28817
28818
28819
28820.section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
28821.cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
28822The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
28823all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
28824not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
28825reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
28826
28827For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
28828these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
28829used to accept or reject anything.
28830
28831For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
28832&%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
28833&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
28834when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
28835
28836For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
28837&%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
28838This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
28839messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
28840configuration file.
28841
28842
28843
28844
28845.section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
28846.cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
28847.vindex &$domain$&
28848.vindex &$local_part$&
28849.vindex &$sender_address$&
28850.vindex &$sender_host_address$&
28851.vindex &$smtp_command$&
28852When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
28853that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
28854&$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
28855statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
28856&$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
28857is available in &$smtp_command$&.
28858
28859When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
28860contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
28861set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
28862how it is used.
28863
28864.vindex "&$message_size$&"
28865The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
28866the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
28867that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
28868the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
28869received).
28870
28871.vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
28872.vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
28873The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
28874The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
28875accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
28876of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
28877&$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
28878&$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
28879
28880
28881
28882
28883
28884.section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
28885.cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
28886.vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
28887.vindex &$smtp_command$&
28888When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
28889the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
28890and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
28891These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
28892here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
28893encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
28894does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
28895unencrypted connections.
28896.code
28897acl_check_auth:
28898 accept encrypted = *
28899 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
28900 {CRAM-MD5}}
28901 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
28902.endd
28903(Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
28904that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
28905encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
28906option to do this.)
28907
28908
28909
28910.section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
28911.cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
28912.cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
28913An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
28914with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
28915Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
28916set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
28917
28918If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
28919used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
28920provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
28921example:
28922.code
28923deny dnslists = list1.example
28924 dnslists = list2.example
28925.endd
28926If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
28927the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
28928happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
28929all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
28930test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
28931
28932
28933.section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
28934The ACL verbs are as follows:
28935
28936.ilist
28937.cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
28938&%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
28939of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
28940appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
28941is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
28942after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
28943check a RCPT command:
28944.code
28945accept domains = +local_domains
28946 endpass
28947 verify = recipient
28948.endd
28949If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
28950passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
28951the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
28952fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
28953&%endpass%&.
28954
28955The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
28956use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
28957that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
28958configuration.
28959
28960.cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
28961If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
28962depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
28963(when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
28964statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
28965SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
28966.display
28967&`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
28968&` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
28969.endd
28970You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
28971response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
28972same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
28973
28974If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
28975an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
28976for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
28977of &%endpass%&.
28978
28979
28980.next
28981.cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
28982&%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
28983an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
28984&%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
28985temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
28986&(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
28987be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
28988
28989
28990.next
28991.cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
28992&%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
28993the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
28994example,
28995.code
28996deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
28997.endd
28998rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
28999
29000
29001.next
29002.cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
29003&%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
29004&"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
29005that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
29006the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
29007recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
29008recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
29009message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
29010do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
29011
29012If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
29013its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
29014The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
29015
29016
29017.next
29018.cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
29019&%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
29020forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
29021.code
29022drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
29023 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
29024.endd
29025There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
29026The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
29027
29028.next
29029.cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
29030&%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
29031statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
29032example, when checking a RCPT command,
29033.code
29034require message = Sender did not verify
29035 verify = sender
29036.endd
29037passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
29038verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
29039&%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
29040discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
29041
29042.next
29043.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
29044&%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
29045&%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
29046to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
29047written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
29048message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
29049duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
29050
29051If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
29052and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
29053&%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
29054first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
29055&<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
29056
29057If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
29058some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
29059This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
29060is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
29061conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
29062is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
29063onwards.
29064
29065
29066.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29067When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
29068text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
29069want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
29070.code
29071warn !verify = sender
29072 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
29073.endd
29074.endlist
29075
29076At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
29077
29078As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
29079written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
29080subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
29081continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
29082mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
29083
29084
29085
29086.section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
29087.cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
29088There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
29089can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
29090of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
29091transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
29092variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
29093an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
29094alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
29095the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
29096.ilist
29097The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
29098throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
29099while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
29100on the same SMTP connection.
29101.next
29102The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
29103while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
29104reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
29105.endlist
29106
29107When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
29108preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
29109time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
29110.code
29111accept hosts = whatever
29112 set acl_m4 = some value
29113accept authenticated = *
29114 set acl_c_auth = yes
29115.endd
29116&*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
29117be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
29118&%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
29119
29120.oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
29121What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
29122referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
29123false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
29124error is generated.
29125
29126Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
29127their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
29128
29129
29130.section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
29131.cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
29132.cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
29133An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
29134.code
29135deny domains = *.dom.example
29136 !verify = recipient
29137.endd
29138causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
29139&'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
29140negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
29141two statements are equivalent:
29142.code
29143deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
29144deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
29145.endd
29146However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
29147side negation of the whole condition is possible.
29148
29149The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
29150of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
29151condition is true. Consider these two statements:
29152.code
29153accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
29154 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
29155accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
29156 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
29157.endd
29158Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
29159the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
29160different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
29161condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
29162therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
29163the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
29164and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
29165
29166ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
29167specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
29168others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
29169warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
29170message is handled.
29171
29172The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
29173processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
29174modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
29175consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
29176.code
29177require message = Can't verify sender
29178 verify = sender
29179 message = Can't verify recipient
29180 verify = recipient
29181 message = This message cannot be used
29182.endd
29183If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
29184&"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
29185so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
29186recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
29187verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
29188because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
29189
29190For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
29191modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
29192happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
29193the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
29194.code
29195deny hosts = ...
29196 !senders = *@my.domain.example
29197 message = Invalid sender from client host
29198.endd
29199The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
29200by which time Exim has set up the message.
29201
29202
29203
29204.section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
29205.cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
29206The ACL modifiers are as follows:
29207
29208.vlist
29209.vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29210This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
29211incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
29212accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
29213
29214.vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29215.cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
29216.cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
29217This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
29218continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
29219the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
29220update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
29221write rather ugly lines like this:
29222.display
29223&`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
29224.endd
29225Instead, all you need is
29226.display
29227&`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
29228.endd
29229
29230.vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29231.cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
29232This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
29233incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
29234lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
29235lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
29236controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
29237even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
29238
29239As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
29240separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
29241in several different ways. For example:
29242
29243. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
29244. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
29245. ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
29246. ==== way.
29247
29248.ilist
29249It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
29250.code
29251 accept ...some conditions
29252 control = queue_only
29253.endd
29254In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
29255other words, when the conditions are all true.
29256
29257.next
29258It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
29259.code
29260 accept ...some conditions...
29261 control = queue_only
29262 ...some more conditions...
29263.endd
29264If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
29265statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
29266In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
29267to be relevant.
29268
29269.next
29270It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
29271decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
29272example:
29273.code
29274 warn ...some conditions...
29275 control = freeze
29276 accept ...
29277.endd
29278This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
29279&%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
29280log entry.
29281
29282.next
29283If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
29284&%require%& verb. For example:
29285.code
29286 require control = no_multiline_responses
29287.endd
29288.endlist
29289
29290.vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
29291.cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
29292.oindex "&%-bh%&"
29293This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
29294the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
29295&%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
29296output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
29297happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
29298output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
29299
29300Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
29301example:
29302.code
29303deny ...some conditions...
29304 delay = 30s
29305.endd
29306The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
29307&"deny"&. Compare this with:
29308.code
29309deny delay = 30s
29310 ...some conditions...
29311.endd
29312which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
29313can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
29314.code
29315warn ...some conditions...
29316 delay = 2m
29317 control = freeze
29318accept ...
29319.endd
29320
29321If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
29322responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
29323they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
29324delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
29325appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
29326unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
29327using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
29328
29329
29330.vitem &*endpass*&
29331.cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
29332This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
29333&%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
29334failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
29335failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
29336confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
29337&"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
29338
29339
29340.vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29341.cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
29342This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
29343ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
29344.code
29345require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
29346 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
29347.endd
29348&%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
29349example:
29350.display
29351&`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
29352&` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
29353.endd
29354When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
29355that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
29356recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
29357message.
29358
29359The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
29360the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
29361denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
29362available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
29363variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
29364&%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
29365ignored.
29366
29367.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29368If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
29369verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
29370error message.
29371
29372If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
29373the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
29374more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
29375actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
29376of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
29377is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
29378
29379If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
29380example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
29381the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
29382logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
29383both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
29384logging rejections.
29385
29386
29387.vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
29388.cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
29389.cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
29390This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
29391about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
29392be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
29393may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
29394ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
29395.display
29396&`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
29397&` log_reject_target =`&
29398.endd
29399This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
29400permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
29401current ACL.
29402
29403
29404.vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29405.cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
29406.cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
29407This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
29408processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
29409&%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
29410access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
29411ACLs. For example:
29412.display
29413&`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
29414&` control = freeze`&
29415&` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
29416.endd
29417By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
29418with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
29419another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
29420example:
29421.code
29422logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
29423logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
29424.endd
29425
29426
29427.vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29428.cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
29429This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
29430message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
29431or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
29432there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
29433&%accept%& for details.)
29434
29435The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
29436to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
29437generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
29438&%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
29439the &%hosts%& condition fails:
29440.code
29441require message = Host not recognized
29442 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
29443.endd
29444(Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
29445processed.)
29446
29447.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
29448.oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
29449For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
29450of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
29451is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
29452is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
29453overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
29454accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
29455truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
29456EHLO options.
29457
29458When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
29459consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
29460of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
29461.code
29462deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
29463 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
29464.endd
29465The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
29466by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
29467access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
294682&'xx'&.
29469
29470Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
29471the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
29472
29473The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
29474literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
29475anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
29476response.
29477
29478.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29479For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
29480stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
29481
29482If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
29483specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
29484However, the original message is available in the variable
29485&$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
29486wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
29487routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
29488use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
29489
29490For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
29491is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
29492modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
29493all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
29494&%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
29495&%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
29496effect.
29497
29498
29499.vitem &*queue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29500.cindex "&%queue%& ACL modifier"
29501.cindex "named queues" "selecting in ACL"
29502This modifier specifies the use of a named queue for spool files
29503for the message.
29504It can only be used before the message is received (i.e. not in
29505the DATA ACL).
29506This could be used, for example, for known high-volume burst sources
29507of traffic, or for quarantine of messages.
29508Separate queue-runner processes will be needed for named queues.
29509If the text after expansion is empty, the default queue is used.
29510
29511
29512.vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29513This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
29514 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
29515the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
29516
29517
29518.vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
29519.cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
29520This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
29521&<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
29522
29523
29524.vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
29525.cindex "UDP communications"
29526This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
29527collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
29528the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
29529of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
29530server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
29531separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
29532example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
29533when:
29534.code
29535udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
29536 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
29537.endd
29538.endlist
29539
29540
29541
29542
29543.section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
29544.cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
29545The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
29546
29547.vlist
29548.vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
29549This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
29550has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
29551apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
29552HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
29553really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
29554not work without it. For example:
29555.code
29556warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
29557 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
29558.endd
29559Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
29560the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
29561matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
29562mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
29563by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
29564
29565
29566.vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
29567 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
29568.cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
29569.cindex "case of local parts"
29570.vindex "&$local_part$&"
29571These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
29572(that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
29573are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
29574any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
29575for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
29576is encountered.
29577
29578These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
29579local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
29580in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
29581handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
29582configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
29583
29584This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
29585containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
29586spam score:
29587.code
29588warn control = caseful_local_part
29589 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
29590 $acl_m4 + \
29591 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
29592 }
29593 control = caselower_local_part
29594.endd
29595Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
29596is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
29597
29598
29599.vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery/*&<&'options'&>
29600.cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
29601.cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
29602This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
29603
29604The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
29605If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
29606and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
29607is used for all recipients of the message,
29608then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
29609and data is copied from one to the other.
29610
29611An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
29612for a mail will be quietly ignored.
29613If a recipient-verify callout
29614(with use_sender)
29615connection is subsequently
29616requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
29617any subsequent recipients and the data,
29618otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
29619
29620Note that routers are used in verify mode,
29621and cannot depend on content of received headers.
29622Note also that headers cannot be
29623modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
29624Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
29625The &'Received-By:'& header is generated as soon as the body reception starts,
29626rather than the traditional time after the full message is received;
29627this will affect the timestamp.
29628
29629All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
29630rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
29631the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
29632Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
29633message body.
29634
29635Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
29636of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
29637before the entire message has been received from the source.
29638It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR
29639or CHUNKING
29640options in use.
29641
29642Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
29643a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
29644If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
29645the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
29646before the acceptance "<=" line.
29647
29648If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
29649usual fashion.
29650This behaviour can be adjusted by appending the option &*defer=*&<&'value'&>
29651to the control; the default value is &"spool"& and the alternate value
29652&"pass"& copies an SMTP defer response from the target back to the initiator
29653and does not queue the message.
29654Note that this is independent of any recipient verify conditions in the ACL.
29655
29656Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
29657(possibly faked)
29658sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
29659
29660
29661.vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
29662.cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
29663.cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
29664This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
29665with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile in the usual logs directory,
29666by default called &'debuglog'&.
29667The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
29668may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
29669the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
29670option.
29671Logging started this way may be stopped, and the file removed,
29672with the &'kill'& option.
29673Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
29674contexts):
29675.code
29676 control = debug
29677 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
29678 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
29679 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
29680 control = debug/kill
29681.endd
29682
29683
29684.vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
29685.cindex "disable DKIM verify"
29686.cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
29687This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
29688the operation and configuration of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
29689
29690
29691.vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
29692.cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
29693.cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
29694This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
29695connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
29696strings or to numeric value.
29697The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
29698Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
29699&`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
29700
29701The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
29702(for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
29703that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
29704equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
29705Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
29706
29707
29708.vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
29709 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
29710.cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
29711.cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
29712These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
29713is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
29714state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
29715in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
29716
29717The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
29718connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
29719messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
29720&%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
29721before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
29722synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
29723work with.
29724
29725
29726.vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
29727.cindex "fake defer"
29728.cindex "defer, fake"
29729This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
29730except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
29731550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
29732messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
29733use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
29734
29735.vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
29736.cindex "fake rejection"
29737.cindex "rejection, fake"
29738This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
29739words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
29740message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
29741However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
29742only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
29743the same SMTP connection.
29744
29745The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
29746message is supplied, the following is used:
29747.code
29748550-Your message has been rejected but is being
29749550-kept for evaluation.
29750550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
29751550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
29752.endd
29753This facility should be used with extreme caution.
29754
29755.vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
29756.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
29757This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
29758other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
29759it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
29760current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
29761SMTP connection.
29762
29763This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
29764&%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
29765is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
29766are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
29767
29768.vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
29769.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
29770Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
29771avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
29772use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
29773disables such output flushing.
29774
29775.vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
29776.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
29777Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
29778avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
29779use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
29780that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
29781
29782.vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
29783This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
29784extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
29785of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
29786or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
29787needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
29788only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
29789the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
29790to be useful in production.
29791
29792.vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
29793.cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
29794This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
29795It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
29796SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
29797
29798If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
29799suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
29800one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
29801(&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
29802responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
29803sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
29804
29805.ilist
29806Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
29807sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
29808verification failed"&) is sent.
29809.next
29810If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
29811line is output.
29812.endlist
29813
29814The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
29815calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
29816
29817.vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
29818.cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
29819This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
29820the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
29821response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
29822controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
29823&%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
29824
29825.vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
29826.oindex "&%queue_only%&"
29827.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
29828This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
29829other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
29830it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
29831runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
29832effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
29833to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
29834same SMTP connection.
29835
29836.vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
29837.cindex "message" "submission"
29838.cindex "submission mode"
29839This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
29840latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
29841the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
29842operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
29843necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
29844This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
29845late (the message has already been created).
29846
29847Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
29848messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
29849submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
29850The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
29851that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
29852
29853.vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
29854.cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
29855This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
29856complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
29857normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
29858
29859.ilist
29860Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
29861dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
29862.next
29863No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
29864.next
29865There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
29866.endlist ilist
29867
29868This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
29869passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
29870used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
29871and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
29872data is read.
29873
29874&*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
29875that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
29876
29877.vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
29878This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
29879to a-label form.
29880For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
29881.endlist vlist
29882
29883
29884.section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
29885All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
29886
29887.ilist
29888Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
29889.next
29890Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
29891&`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
29892.next
29893Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
29894.next
29895Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
29896.endlist
29897
29898
29899
29900.section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
29901.cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
29902.cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
29903.cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
29904The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
29905to an incoming message, as in this example:
29906.code
29907warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
29908 dialup.mail-abuse.org
29909 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
29910.endd
29911The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
29912MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
29913receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
29914&%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
29915any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
29916RCPT ACL).
29917
29918Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
29919DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
29920
29921Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
29922the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
29923contains one or more newlines that
29924are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
29925lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
29926front of any line that is not a valid header line.
29927
29928Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
29929They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
29930However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
29931is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
29932during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
29933with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
29934lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
29935In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
29936non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
29937message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
29938are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
29939
29940.cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
29941Header lines are not visible in string expansions
29942of message headers
29943until they are added to the
29944message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
29945ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
29946header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
29947ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
29948passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
29949this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
29950&<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
29951
29952The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
29953
29954The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
29955processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
29956.display
29957&`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
29958&` `&<&'some condition'&>
29959
29960&`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
29961&` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
29962.endd
29963In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
29964condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
29965condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
29966ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
29967honoured.
29968
29969.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
29970For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
29971&%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
29972effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
29973them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
29974usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
29975are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
29976specifications.
29977
29978By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
29979header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
29980be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
29981after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
29982that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
29983
29984This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
29985&":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
29986header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
29987to be a header name first.) For example:
29988.code
29989warn add_header = \
29990 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
29991.endd
29992If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
29993each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
29994you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
29995up in reverse order.
29996
29997&*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
29998added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
29999system filter or in a router or transport.
30000
30001
30002
30003.section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
30004.cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
30005.cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
30006.cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
30007The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
30008from an incoming message, as in this example:
30009.code
30010warn message = Remove internal headers
30011 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
30012.endd
30013The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
30014MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
30015receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
30016&%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
30017with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
30018any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
30019
30020Headers will not be removed from the message if the modifier is used in
30021DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
30022
30023More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
30024list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
30025not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
30026create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
30027are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
30028.code
30029warn hosts = +internal_hosts
30030 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
30031warn message = Remove internal headers
30032 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
30033.endd
30034Header names for removal are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
30035Matching header lines are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
30036If multiple header lines match, all are removed.
30037There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor in removing
30038a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
30039during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
30040if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
30041accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
30042all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
30043ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
30044would have been removed.
30045
30046.cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
30047Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
30048is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
30049not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
30050removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
30051this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
30052passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
30053you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
30054&<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
30055
30056The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
30057processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
30058.display
30059&`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
30060&` `&<&'some condition'&>
30061
30062&`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
30063&` remove_header = X-Internal`&
30064.endd
30065In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
30066condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
30067condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
30068same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
30069are honoured.
30070
30071&*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
30072present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
30073in a system filter or in a router or transport.
30074
30075
30076
30077
30078.section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
30079.cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
30080Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
30081compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
30082for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
30083content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30084
30085Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
30086senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
30087result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
30088done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
30089can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
30090same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
30091The conditions are as follows:
30092
30093
30094.vlist
30095.vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
30096.cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
30097.cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
30098.cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
30099.cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
30100The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
30101&%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
30102&"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
30103false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
30104condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
30105condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
30106ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
30107
30108If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
30109can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
30110and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
30111Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
30112The name and values are expanded separately.
30113Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
30114will act as argument separators.
30115
30116If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
30117the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
30118&%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
30119conditions are tested.
30120
30121ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
30122loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
30123circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
30124for different local users or different local domains.
30125
30126.vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
30127.cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
30128.cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
30129.cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
30130If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
30131the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
30132authentication by any authenticator, you can set
30133.code
30134authenticated = *
30135.endd
30136
30137.vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
30138.cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
30139.cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
30140.cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
30141.cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
30142This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
30143expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
30144&"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
30145number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
30146any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
30147&"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
30148ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
30149negative.
30150
30151.vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
30152.cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
30153This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30154content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
30155&%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
30156If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
30157problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
30158chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30159
30160.vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
30161.cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
30162.cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
30163.cindex "black list (DNS)"
30164.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
30165This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
30166&"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
30167use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
30168different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
30169&<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
30170
30171.vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
30172.cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
30173.cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
30174.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
30175.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
30176This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
30177of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
30178enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
30179lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
30180&%domains%& test.
30181
30182&*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
30183use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
30184
30185
30186.vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
30187.cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
30188.cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
30189.cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
30190If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
30191name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
30192encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
30193.code
30194encrypted = *
30195.endd
30196
30197
30198.vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
30199.cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
30200.cindex "host" "ACL checking"
30201.cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
30202This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
30203name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
30204you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
30205.code
30206accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
30207.endd
30208The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
30209the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
30210and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
30211
30212The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
30213Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
30214but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
30215find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
30216opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
30217found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
30218
30219If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
30220address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
30221.code
30222accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
30223accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
30224.endd
30225The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
30226is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
30227statement can then check the IP address.
30228
30229.vindex "&$host_data$&"
30230If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
30231of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
30232allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
30233.code
30234deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
30235message = $host_data
30236.endd
30237which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
30238
30239.vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
30240.cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
30241.cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
30242.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
30243.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
30244This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
30245part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
30246enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
30247result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
30248the next &%local_parts%& test.
30249
30250.vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
30251.cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
30252.cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
30253.cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
30254This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30255content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
30256viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30257
30258.vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
30259.cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
30260.cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
30261This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30262content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
30263&%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
30264with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
30265&<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30266
30267.vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
30268.cindex "rate limiting"
30269This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
30270messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
30271
30272.vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
30273.cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
30274.cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
30275.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
30276This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
30277recipient address against a list of recipients.
30278
30279.vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
30280.cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
30281.cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
30282This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30283content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
30284non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
30285any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30286
30287.vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
30288.cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
30289.cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
30290.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
30291.vindex "&$domain$&"
30292.vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
30293This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
30294domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
30295&$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
30296of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
30297lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
30298RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
30299influence the sender checking.
30300
30301&*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
30302relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
30303
30304.vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
30305.cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
30306.cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
30307.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
30308This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
30309for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
30310.code
30311senders = :
30312.endd
30313&*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
30314relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
30315
30316.vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
30317.cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
30318.cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
30319This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30320content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
30321SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30322
30323.vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
30324.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30325.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
30326.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
30327.cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
30328.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
30329This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
30330certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
30331server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
30332or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
30333
30334.vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
30335.cindex "CSA verification"
30336This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
30337send email. Details of how this works are given in section
30338&<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
30339
30340.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
30341.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30342.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
30343.cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
30344.cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
30345This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30346received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30347&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
30348there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
30349allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
30350
30351Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
30352problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
30353detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
30354
30355.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
30356.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30357.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
30358.cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
30359.cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
30360.cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
30361This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30362received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30363&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
30364of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
30365is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
30366However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
30367that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
30368to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
30369might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
30370
30371Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
30372section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
30373&<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
30374condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
30375.code
30376deny senders = :
30377 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
30378 !verify = header_sender
30379.endd
30380
30381.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
30382.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30383.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
30384.cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
30385.cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
30386This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30387received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30388&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
30389lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
30390and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
30391Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
30392permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
30393&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
30394appropriate.
30395
30396Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
30397ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
30398.code
30399To: @
30400.endd
30401and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
30402common as they used to be.
30403
30404.vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
30405.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30406.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
30407.cindex "HELO" "verifying"
30408.cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
30409.cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
30410.cindex "verifying" "HELO"
30411This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
30412client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
30413attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
30414condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
30415&%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
30416independently of this condition.
30417
30418For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
30419option), this condition is always true.
30420
30421
30422.vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
30423.cindex "verifying" "not blind"
30424.cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
30425This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
30426Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
30427&'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
30428case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
30429&'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
30430used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
30431
30432There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
30433recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
30434
30435
30436.vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
30437.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30438.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
30439.cindex "recipient" "verifying"
30440.cindex "verifying" "recipient"
30441.vindex "&$address_data$&"
30442This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
30443recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
30444&<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
30445of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
30446This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
30447verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
30448address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
30449value for the child address.
30450
30451.vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
30452.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30453.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
30454.cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
30455This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
30456address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
30457was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
30458Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
30459one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
30460original IP address.
30461
30462There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
30463DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
30464
30465If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
30466is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
30467
30468.vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
30469.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30470.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
30471.cindex "sender" "verifying"
30472.cindex "verifying" "sender"
30473This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
30474message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
30475the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
30476condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
30477
30478.vindex "&$address_data$&"
30479.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
30480If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
30481value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
30482value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
30483statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
30484want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
30485
30486Details of verification are given later, starting at section
30487&<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
30488to avoid doing it more than once per message.
30489
30490.vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
30491.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30492This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
30493verified as a sender.
30494
30495Note that '/' is legal in local-parts; if the address may have such
30496(eg. is generated from the received message)
30497they must be protected from the options parsing by doubling:
30498.code
30499verify = sender=${sg{${address:$h_sender:}}{/}{//}}
30500.endd
30501.endlist
30502
30503
30504
30505.section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
30506.cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
30507.cindex "black list (DNS)"
30508.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
30509In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
30510is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
30511address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
30512domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
30513special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
30514address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
30515.code
30516deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
30517 dialups.mail-abuse.org
30518.endd
30519the following records are looked up:
30520.code
3052143.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
3052243.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
30523.endd
30524As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
30525Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
30526to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
30527use two separate conditions:
30528.code
30529deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30530 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
30531.endd
30532If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
30533behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
30534record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
30535processed.
30536
30537This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
30538(which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
30539blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
30540following special items in the list:
30541.display
30542&`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
30543&`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
30544&`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
30545.endd
30546.cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
30547.cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
30548.cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
30549Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
30550.code
30551deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
30552.endd
30553Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
30554warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
30555.code
30556deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30557warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
30558 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
30559.endd
30560.cindex caching "of dns lookup"
30561.cindex DNS TTL
30562DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
30563(but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
30564so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
30565connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
30566Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
30567connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
30568
30569There are a number of DNS lists to choose from, some commercial, some free,
30570or free for small deployments. An overview can be found at
30571&url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Comparison_of_DNS_blacklists).
30572
30573
30574
30575.section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
30576.cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
30577By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
30578of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
30579after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
30580.code
30581deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
30582.endd
30583This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
30584use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
30585MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
30586&<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
30587
30588
30589
30590
30591.section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
30592.cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
30593There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
30594addresses. No reversing of components is used
30595with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
30596listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
30597.code
30598deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
30599 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
30600.endd
30601This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
30602RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
30603example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
30604up by this example is
30605.code
30606tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
30607.endd
30608A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
30609addresses. For example:
30610.code
30611deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30612 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
30613.endd
30614The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
30615name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
30616
30617
30618
30619
30620.section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
30621.cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
30622The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
30623names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
30624name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
30625As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
30626this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
30627either to double the separators like this:
30628.code
30629dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
30630.endd
30631or to change the separator character, like this:
30632.code
30633dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
30634.endd
30635If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
30636blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
30637occurs. Consider this condition:
30638.code
30639dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
30640.endd
30641The DNS lookups that occur are:
30642.code
306432.1.168.192.black.list.tld
30644a.domain.black.list.tld
30645.endd
30646Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
30647address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
30648are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
30649or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
30650only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
30651successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
30652error for a previous item.
30653
30654The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
30655syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
30656.code
30657dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
30658dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
30659.endd
30660However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
30661is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
30662.code
30663deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
30664 $sender_address_domain \
30665 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
30666 see $dnslist_text.
30667 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
30668 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
30669 $sender_address_domain} }} }
30670.endd
30671Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
30672multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
30673and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
30674of expanding the condition might be something like this:
30675.code
30676dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
30677.endd
30678Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
30679domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
30680
30681The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
30682&$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
30683
30684
30685
30686
30687.section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
30688.cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
30689DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
30690just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
30691RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
30692The values used on the RBL+ list are:
30693.display
30694127.1.0.1 RBL
30695127.1.0.2 DUL
30696127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
30697127.1.0.4 RSS
30698127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
30699127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
30700127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
30701.endd
30702Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
30703different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
30704see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
30705
30706
30707.section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
30708.cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
30709.cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
30710.vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
30711.vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
30712.vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
30713.vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
30714When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
30715the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
30716&`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
30717(for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
30718the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
30719&$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
30720cases, for example:
30721.code
30722deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
30723.endd
30724the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
30725&$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
30726For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
30727might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
30728.code
30729deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
30730.endd
30731If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
30732&`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
30733
30734If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
30735addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
30736The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
30737record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
30738very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
30739information.
30740
30741You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
30742&-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
30743expanded until after it has failed. For example:
30744.code
30745deny hosts = !+local_networks
30746 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
30747 at $dnslist_domain
30748 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
30749.endd
30750
30751
30752
30753.section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
30754.cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
30755You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
30756in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
30757For example,
30758.code
30759deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
30760.endd
30761rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
30762any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
30763that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
30764describes how multiple records are handled.
30765
30766More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
30767separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
30768&%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
30769.code
30770deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30771.endd
30772If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
30773addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
30774first. For example:
30775.code
30776deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
30777 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
30778.endd
30779
30780If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
30781listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
30782In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
30783true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
30784tested. For example:
30785.code
30786dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
30787.endd
30788matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
30789want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
30790being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
30791.code
30792dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
30793.endd
30794matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
30795an odd number.
30796
30797
30798
30799.section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
30800You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
30801condition. Whereas
30802.code
30803deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30804.endd
30805means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
30806IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
30807.code
30808deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30809.endd
30810means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
30811IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
30812words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
30813the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
30814
30815&*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
30816host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
30817
30818If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
30819previous example is precisely equivalent to
30820.code
30821deny dnslists = a.b.c
30822 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
30823.endd
30824However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
30825Consider this example:
30826.code
30827deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30828 list.dsbl.org : \
30829 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
30830 relays.ordb.org
30831.endd
30832Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
30833.code
30834deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30835 list.dsbl.org
30836deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
30837 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
30838deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
30839.endd
30840which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
30841
30842
30843
30844
30845.section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
30846A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
30847thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
30848is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
30849the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
30850the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
30851.code
30852dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
30853.endd
30854What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
30855127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
30856condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
30857because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
30858affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
30859additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
30860
30861.ilist
30862If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
30863IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
30864condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
30865.next
30866If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
30867looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
30868changed to:
30869.code
30870dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
30871.endd
30872and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
30873false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
30874.code
30875dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
30876.endd
30877for the condition to be true.
30878.endlist
30879
30880When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
30881the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
30882.ilist
30883If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
30884addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
30885.code
30886dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
30887.endd
30888If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
30889false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
30890.next
30891If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
30892looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
30893.code
30894dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
30895.endd
30896If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
30897true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
30898.code
30899dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
30900.endd
30901for the condition to be false.
30902.endlist
30903When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
30904between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
30905
30906
30907
30908
30909.section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
30910.cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
30911When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
30912the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
30913the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
30914address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
30915only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
30916can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
30917in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
30918lists.
30919
30920A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
30921two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
30922do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
30923If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
30924restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
30925a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
30926domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
30927.code
30928deny message = \
30929 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
30930 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
30931 dnslists = \
30932 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
30933 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
30934.endd
30935For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
30936&'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
30937match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
30938value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
30939record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
30940The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
30941
30942If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
30943given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
30944the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
30945.code
30946deny dnslists = \
30947 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
30948 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
30949 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
30950 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
30951.endd
30952In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
30953values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
30954done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
30955
30956
30957
30958.section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
30959.cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
30960.cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
30961If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
30962nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
309633ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
30964.code
309651.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
30966 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30967.endd
30968(split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
30969lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
30970IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
30971.code
30972*.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
30973.endd
30974is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
30975Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
30976
30977You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
30978&%condition%& condition, as in this example:
30979.code
30980deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
30981 dnslists = some.list.example
30982.endd
30983
30984If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
30985address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
30986(DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
30987.code
30988 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
30989.endd
30990
30991.section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
30992.cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
30993.cindex "limiting client sending rates"
30994.oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
30995The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
30996which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
30997&%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
30998commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
30999works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
31000host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
31001.display
31002&`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
31003.endd
31004If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
31005period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
31006
31007As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
31008&$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
31009configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
31010of &'p'&.
31011
31012The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
31013time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
31014means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
31015parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
31016send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
31017in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
31018constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
31019changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
31020both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
31021
31022There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
31023log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
31024when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
31025instructions when it is run with no arguments.
31026
31027The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
31028sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
31029retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
31030which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
31031By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
31032of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
31033user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
31034&$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
31035example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
31036authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
31037
31038The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
31039rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
31040&`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
31041ACL.
31042
31043Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
31044specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example messages or recipients
31045or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
31046&%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
31047using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
31048separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
31049
31050Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
31051any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
31052stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
31053remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
31054remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
31055behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
31056the &%count=%& option.
31057
31058
31059.section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
31060.cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
31061The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
31062normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
31063&%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
31064
31065The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
31066the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
31067&%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
31068&%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
31069
31070The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
31071the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
31072in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
31073used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
31074in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
31075follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
31076in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
31077
31078The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
31079accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
31080&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
31081&%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
31082ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
31083in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
31084recipients as a large high-speed burst.
31085
31086The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
31087number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
31088last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
31089recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
31090&%acl_smtp_rcpt%&.
31091
31092The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
31093condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
31094command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
31095multiple different commands.
31096
31097The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
31098measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
31099&`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
31100increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
31101other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
31102
31103The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
31104
31105
31106.section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
31107.cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
31108You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
31109control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
31110mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
31111
31112If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
31113previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
31114
31115For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
31116it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
31117can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
31118in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
31119new rate.
31120.code
31121acl_check_connect:
31122 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
31123 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
31124 (max $sender_rate_limit)
31125# ...
31126acl_check_mail:
31127 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
31128 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
31129 (max $sender_rate_limit)
31130.endd
31131
31132If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
31133processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
31134it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
31135in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
31136same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
31137multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
31138checks.
31139
31140The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
31141use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
31142update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
31143&%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
31144next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
31145
31146
31147.section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
31148.cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
31149If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
31150engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
31151&%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
31152counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
31153rest of the ACL.
31154
31155The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
31156updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
31157client's average rate of successfully sent email,
31158.new
31159up to the given limit.
31160This is appropriate if the countermeasure when the condition is true
31161consists of refusing the message, and
31162is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
31163If the action when true is anything more complex then this option is
31164likely not what is wanted.
31165.wen
31166
31167The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
31168updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
31169of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
31170actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
31171counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
31172pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
31173again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
31174attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
31175.code
31176 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
31177.endd
31178
31179
31180.section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
31181.cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
31182The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
31183rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
31184mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
31185sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
31186&`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
31187measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
31188options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
31189
31190For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
31191has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
31192rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
31193per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
31194go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
31195recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
31196
31197When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
31198&%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
31199rate.
31200
31201The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
31202other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
31203unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
31204required increases with larger limits.
31205
31206The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
31207will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
31208the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
31209the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
31210events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
31211times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
31212throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
31213limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
31214are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
31215as intended.
31216
31217
31218.section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
31219Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
31220when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
31221(for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
31222policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
31223message. For example:
31224.code
31225# Log all senders' rates
31226warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
31227 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
31228
31229# Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
31230# at the decimal point.
31231warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
31232 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
31233 $sender_rate_limit }s
31234
31235# Keep authenticated users under control
31236deny authenticated = *
31237 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
31238
31239# System-wide rate limit
31240defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
31241 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
31242
31243# Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
31244# set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
31245defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
31246 messages per $sender_rate_period
31247 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
31248 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
31249 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
31250.endd
31251&*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
31252especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
31253bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
31254making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
31255RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
31256this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
31257hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
31258
31259
31260
31261.section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
31262.cindex "verifying address" "options for"
31263.cindex "policy control" "address verification"
31264Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
31265&<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
31266&<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
31267The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
31268verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
31269other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
31270.code
31271verify = sender/callout
31272verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
31273.endd
31274The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
31275address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
31276difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
31277be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
31278(see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
31279The available options are as follows:
31280
31281.ilist
31282If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
31283remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
31284check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
31285.next
31286If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
31287normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
31288options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
31289verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
31290.next
31291The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
31292discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
31293.next
31294The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
31295immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
31296generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
31297discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
31298.endlist
31299
31300.cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
31301.vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
31302.vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
31303.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
31304After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
31305error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
31306coding like this:
31307.code
31308warn !verify = sender
31309 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
31310.endd
31311If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
31312denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
31313verification failure.
31314
31315In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
31316appropriate) contains one of the following words:
31317
31318.ilist
31319&%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
31320was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
31321.next
31322&%route%&: Routing failed.
31323.next
31324&%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
31325occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
31326connection, HELO, or MAIL).
31327.next
31328&%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
31329.next
31330&%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
31331.endlist
31332
31333The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
31334rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
31335
31336.new
31337The above variables may also be set after a &*successful*&
31338address verification to:
31339
31340.ilist
31341&%random%&: A random local-part callout succeeded
31342.endlist
31343.wen
31344
31345
31346
31347
31348.section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
31349.cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
31350.cindex "callout" "verification"
31351.cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
31352For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
31353checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
31354the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
31355&'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
31356a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
31357address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
31358sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
31359deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
31360sender's domain.
31361
31362Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
31363request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
31364described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
31365lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
31366cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
31367caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
31368
31369Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
31370the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
31371callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
31372callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
31373on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
31374
31375If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
31376second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
31377one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
31378&(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
31379router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
31380&%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
31381&%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
31382supplies a host list.
31383Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
31384
31385The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
31386remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
31387specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
31388specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
31389specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
31390the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
31391&$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
31392
31393For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
31394test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
31395following SMTP commands are sent:
31396.display
31397&`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
31398&`MAIL FROM:<>`&
31399&`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
31400&`QUIT`&
31401.endd
31402LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
31403set to &"lmtp"&.
31404
31405The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
31406settings.
31407
31408A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
31409for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
31410the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
31411that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
31412do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
31413&%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
31414
31415If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
31416succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
31417Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
31418hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
31419&%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
31420
31421.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
31422A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
31423output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
31424clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
31425disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
31426
31427
31428
31429
31430.section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
31431.cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
31432The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
31433optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
31434.code
31435verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
31436.endd
31437The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
31438separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
31439deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
31440
31441
31442.vlist
31443.vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
31444.cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
31445This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
31446For example:
31447.code
31448verify = sender/callout=5s
31449.endd
31450The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
31451remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
31452the &%connect%& parameter.
31453
31454
31455.vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
31456.cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
31457This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
31458for making the SMTP connection. For example:
31459.code
31460verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
31461.endd
31462If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
31463
31464.vitem &*defer_ok*&
31465.cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
31466When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
31467of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
31468updated in this circumstance.
31469
31470.vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
31471.cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
31472This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
31473&'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
31474accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
31475unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
31476
31477
31478.vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
31479.cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
31480When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
31481verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
31482sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
31483whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
31484MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
31485as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
31486(empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
31487address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
31488.code
31489require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
31490.endd
31491This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
31492
31493
31494.vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
31495.cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
31496This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
31497For example:
31498.code
31499verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
31500.endd
31501This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
31502commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
31503be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
31504very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
31505(for example, when network connections are timing out).
31506
31507
31508.vitem &*no_cache*&
31509.cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
31510.cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
31511When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
31512
31513.vitem &*postmaster*&
31514.cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
31515When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
31516check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
31517rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
31518the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
31519used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
31520made, until the cache record expires.
31521
31522.vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
31523The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
31524You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
31525For example:
31526.code
31527require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
31528.endd
31529If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
31530one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
31531.code
31532require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
31533.endd
31534&*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
31535account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
31536a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
31537postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
31538
31539
31540.vitem &*random*&
31541.cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
31542When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
31543check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
31544really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
31545&%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
31546.code
31547$primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
31548.endd
31549The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
31550parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
31551specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
31552a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
31553succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
31554
31555.vitem &*use_postmaster*&
31556.cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
31557This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31558.code
31559deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
31560.endd
31561.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
31562It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
31563performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
31564that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
31565domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
31566
31567.vitem &*use_sender*&
31568This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31569.code
31570require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
31571.endd
31572It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
31573command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
31574need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
31575sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
31576usefulness of callout caching.
31577
31578.vitem &*hold*&
31579This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31580.code
31581require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender,hold
31582.endd
31583It causes the connection to be held open and used for any further recipients
31584and for eventual delivery (should that be done quickly).
31585Doing this saves on TCP and SMTP startup costs, and TLS costs also
31586when that is used for the connections.
31587The advantage is only gained if there are no callout cache hits
31588(which could be enforced by the no_cache option),
31589if the use_sender option is used,
31590if neither the random nor the use_postmaster option is used,
31591and if no other callouts intervene.
31592.endlist
31593
31594If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
31595command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
31596&%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
31597usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
31598that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
31599Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
31600these circumstances.
31601
31602However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
31603host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
31604callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
31605sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
31606callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
31607own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
31608is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
31609
31610Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
31611caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
31612by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
31613actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
31614
31615
31616
31617
31618.section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
31619.cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
31620.cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
31621.cindex "caching" "callout"
31622Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
31623used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
31624option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
31625different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
31626a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
31627entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
31628
31629When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
31630the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
31631is not available.
31632
31633The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
31634independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
31635(default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
31636
31637If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
31638commands up to and including
31639.code
31640MAIL FROM:<>
31641.endd
31642(but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
31643any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
31644domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
31645making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
31646separate expiry times for domain cache records:
31647&%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
31648&%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
31649
31650Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
31651cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
31652Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
31653ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
31654will eventually be noticed.
31655
31656The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
31657being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
31658behaviour will be the same.
31659
31660
31661
31662.section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
31663.cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
31664See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
31665verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
31666failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
31667relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
31668you might see:
31669.code
31670MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
31671250 OK
31672RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
31673550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
31674550-Called: 192.168.34.43
31675550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
31676550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
31677550 Sender verification failed
31678.endd
31679If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
31680only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
31681out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
31682&`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
31683example:
31684.code
31685verify = sender/no_details
31686.endd
31687
31688.section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
31689.cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
31690.cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
31691A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
31692during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
31693or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
31694it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
31695
31696.ilist
31697When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
31698continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
31699verification also fails.
31700.next
31701When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
31702verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
31703.endlist
31704
31705This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
31706way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
31707example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
31708.code
31709A.Wol: aw123
31710aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
31711.endd
31712work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
31713redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
31714mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
31715verification to succeed.
31716
31717It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
31718redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
31719generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
31720option. For example:
31721.code
31722require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
31723.endd
31724In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
31725the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
31726
31727When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
31728redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
31729also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
31730address and a report is output for each of them.
31731
31732
31733
31734.section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
31735.cindex "CSA" "verifying"
31736Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
31737which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
31738special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
31739domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
31740Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
31741.code
31742verify = csa
31743.endd
31744This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
31745valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
31746succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
31747&$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
31748&"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
31749be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
31750
31751The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
31752detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
31753looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
31754address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
31755
31756.ilist
31757The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
31758.next
31759The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
31760.next
31761The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
31762(for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
31763.next
31764The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
31765that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
31766.endlist
31767
31768The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
31769use for the DNS query. The default is:
31770.code
31771verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
31772.endd
31773This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
31774is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
31775address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
31776the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
31777meaningful to say:
31778.code
31779verify = csa/$sender_host_address
31780.endd
31781In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
31782This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
31783&%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
31784
31785If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
31786is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
31787making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
31788using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
31789default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
31790default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
31791(&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
31792of legitimate HELO domains.
31793
31794The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
31795direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
31796search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
31797addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
31798lookup such as:
31799.code
31800${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
31801.endd
31802has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
31803The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
31804authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
31805
31806
31807
31808
31809.section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
31810.cindex "BATV, verifying"
31811Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
31812of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
31813Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
31814recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
31815bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
31816spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
31817
31818There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
31819&"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
31820the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
31821address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
31822item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
31823The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
31824&<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
31825The validity period on signed addresses is seven days.
31826
31827As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
31828database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
31829like this:
31830.code
31831PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
31832 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
31833 }{$value}}
31834.endd
31835Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
31836list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
31837use this:
31838.code
31839# Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
31840deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
31841 senders = :
31842 recipients = +batv_senders
31843
31844# Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
31845deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
31846 senders = :
31847 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
31848 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
31849 !condition = $prvscheck_result
31850.endd
31851The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
31852to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
31853send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
31854recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
31855the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
31856
31857A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
31858&%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
31859prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
31860the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
31861the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
31862timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
31863of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
31864
31865There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
31866you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
31867deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
31868router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
31869.code
31870batv_redirect:
31871 driver = redirect
31872 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
31873.endd
31874This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
31875of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
31876address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
31877local addresses.
31878
31879To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
31880can be used:
31881.code
31882external_smtp_batv:
31883 driver = smtp
31884 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
31885 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
31886 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
31887 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
31888 {$value}fail}}}
31889.endd
31890If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
31891
31892
31893
31894.section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
31895.cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
31896.cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
31897.cindex "policy control" "relay control"
31898An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
31899delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
31900within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
31901passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
31902.cindex "&""percent hack""&"
31903but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
31904
31905Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
31906A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
31907relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
31908a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
31909with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
31910same host is fulfilling both functions,
31911. ///
31912. as illustrated in the diagram below,
31913. ///
31914but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
31915not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
31916system to arbitrary domains.
31917
31918
31919You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
31920runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
31921Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
31922example, suppose you want to do the following:
31923
31924.ilist
31925Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
31926locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
31927&'my.dom2.example'&.
31928.next
31929Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
31930These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
31931.next
31932Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
31933Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
31934.endlist
31935
31936
31937In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
31938.code
31939domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
31940domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
31941hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
31942.endd
31943Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
31944command:
31945.code
31946acl_check_rcpt:
31947 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
31948 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
31949.endd
31950The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
31951the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
31952statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
31953hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
31954than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
31955default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
31956in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
31957
31958
31959
31960.section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
31961.cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
31962You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
31963that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
31964the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
31965.ecindex IIDacl
31966
31967
31968
31969. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31970. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31971
31972.chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
31973.scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
31974The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
31975as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
31976was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
31977maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
31978specification.
31979
31980It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
31981&[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
31982scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
31983messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
31984chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
31985
31986If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
31987Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
31988&_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
31989
31990.ilist
31991Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
31992for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
31993.next
31994Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
31995&%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
31996run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
31997.next
31998An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
31999of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
32000.next
32001Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
32002conditions.
32003.next
32004Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
32005.endlist
32006
32007Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
32008added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
32009changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
32010EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
32011this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
32012&_doc/experimental.txt_&.
32013
32014All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
32015temporarily created in a file called:
32016.display
32017<&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
32018.endd
32019The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
32020expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
32021first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
32022scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
32023removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
32024.code
32025control = no_mbox_unspool
32026.endd
32027has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
32028same directory by default.
32029
32030
32031
32032.section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
32033.cindex "virus scanning"
32034.cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
32035.cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
32036The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
32037It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
32038specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
32039in memory and thus are much faster.
32040
32041A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
32042if it expires then a defer action is taken.
32043
32044.oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
32045You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
32046to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
32047are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
32048.display
32049&`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
32050.endd
32051If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
32052.code
32053av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
32054.endd
32055If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
32056before use.
32057The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
32058The following scanner types are supported in this release,
32059though individual ones can be included or not at build time:
32060
32061.vlist
32062.vitem &%avast%&
32063.cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
32064This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
32065Security (currently at version 2.2.0).
32066You can get a trial version at &url(https://www.avast.com) or for Linux
32067at &url(https://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
32068This scanner type takes one option,
32069which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
32070or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
32071The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
32072single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
32073A list of options may follow. These options are interpreted on the
32074Exim's side of the malware scanner, or are given on separate lines to
32075the daemon as options before the main scan command.
32076
32077.cindex &`pass_unscanned`& "avast"
32078If &`pass_unscanned`&
32079is set, any files the Avast scanner can't scan (e.g.
32080decompression bombs, or invalid archives) are considered clean. Use with
32081care.
32082
32083For example:
32084.code
32085av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
32086av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:pass_unscanned:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
32087av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
32088.endd
32089If you omit the argument, the default path
32090&_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
32091is used.
32092If you use a remote host,
32093you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
32094as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
32095For information about available commands and their options you may use
32096.code
32097$ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
32098 FLAGS
32099 SENSITIVITY
32100 PACK
32101.endd
32102
32103If the scanner returns a temporary failure (e.g. license issues, or
32104permission problems), the message is deferred and a paniclog entry is
32105written. The usual &`defer_ok`& option is available.
32106
32107.vitem &%aveserver%&
32108.cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
32109This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
32110at &url(https://www.kaspersky.com/). This scanner type takes one option,
32111which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
32112example:
32113.code
32114av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
32115.endd
32116
32117
32118.vitem &%clamd%&
32119.cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
32120This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
32121&url(https://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
32122unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
32123in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
32124
32125The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
32126a UNIX socket specification,
32127a TCP socket specification,
32128or a (global) option.
32129
32130A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
32131For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
32132for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
32133and the second a port number,
32134Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
32135These per-server options are supported:
32136.code
32137retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
32138.endd
32139
32140The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
32141a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
32142
32143If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
32144
32145Examples:
32146.code
32147av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
32148av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
32149av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
32150av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
32151av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
32152.endd
32153If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
32154&`local`&
32155option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
32156to be scanned, which should normally result in less I/O happening and be
32157more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
32158Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
32159
32160The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
32161randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
32162that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
32163socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
32164unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
32165When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
32166not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
32167selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
32168email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
32169.code
321702013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
32171 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
32172 (Connection refused)
32173.endd
32174
32175If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
32176contributing the code for this scanner.
32177
32178.vitem &%cmdline%&
32179.cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
32180This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
32181used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
32182type takes 3 mandatory options:
32183
32184.olist
32185The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
32186and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
32187
32188.next
32189A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
32190virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
32191absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
32192the &"trigger"& expression.
32193
32194.next
32195Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
32196match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
32197&"name"& expression.
32198.endlist olist
32199
32200For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
32201.code
32202Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
32203.endd
32204For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
32205name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
32206for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
32207configuration setting:
32208.code
32209av_scanner = cmdline:\
32210 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
32211 found in file:'(.+)'
32212.endd
32213.vitem &%drweb%&
32214.cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
32215The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(https://www.sald.ru/)) interface
32216takes one option,
32217either a full path to a UNIX socket,
32218or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
32219The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
32220single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
32221For example:
32222.code
32223av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
32224av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
32225.endd
32226If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
32227is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
32228
32229.vitem &%f-protd%&
32230.cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
32231The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
32232One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
32233(or port-range).
32234For example:
32235.code
32236av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
32237.endd
32238If you omit the argument, the default values shown above are used.
32239
32240.vitem &%f-prot6d%&
32241.cindex "virus scanners" "f-prot6d"
32242The f-prot6d scanner is accessed using the FPSCAND protocol over TCP.
32243One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number.
32244For example:
32245.code
32246av_scanner = f-prot6d:localhost 10200
32247.endd
32248If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
32249
32250.vitem &%fsecure%&
32251.cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
32252The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(https://www.f-secure.com/)) takes one
32253argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
32254.code
32255av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
32256.endd
32257If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
32258Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
32259
32260.vitem &%kavdaemon%&
32261.cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
32262This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
32263Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
32264scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
32265For example:
32266.code
32267av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
32268.endd
32269The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
32270
32271.vitem &%mksd%&
32272.cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
32273This was a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users,
32274though some documentation was available in English.
32275The history can be shown at &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Mks_vir)
32276and this appears to be a candidate for removal from Exim, unless
32277we are informed of other virus scanners which use the same protocol
32278to integrate.
32279The only option for this scanner type is
32280the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
32281provided that mksd has
32282been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
32283.code
32284av_scanner = mksd:2
32285.endd
32286You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
32287
32288.vitem &%sock%&
32289.cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
32290This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
32291running on the local machine.
32292There are four options:
32293an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
32294a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
32295the path to the mail file to be scanned),
32296an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
32297and an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
32298For example:
32299.code
32300av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)$
32301.endd
32302Note that surrounding whitespace is stripped from each option, meaning
32303there is no way to specify a trailing newline.
32304The socket specifier and both regular-expressions are required.
32305Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_& (note this does have a trailing newline);
32306specify an empty element to get this.
32307
32308.vitem &%sophie%&
32309.cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
32310Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
32311You can get Sophie at &url(http://sophie.sourceforge.net/). The only option
32312for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
32313client communication. For example:
32314.code
32315av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
32316.endd
32317The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
32318the option.
32319.endlist
32320
32321When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
32322the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
32323ACL.
32324
32325The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
32326makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
32327The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
32328for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
32329However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
32330which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
32331message.
32332
32333The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
32334use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
32335The first element can then be one of
32336
32337.ilist
32338&"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
32339The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
32340recommended usage.
32341.next
32342&"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
32343the condition fails immediately.
32344.next
32345A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
32346condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
32347expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
32348Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
32349unless the separator is changed (in the usual way).
32350.endlist
32351
32352You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
32353messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
32354Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
32355
32356You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
32357specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
32358For example:
32359.code
32360malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
32361.endd
32362A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
32363
32364.vindex "&$callout_address$&"
32365When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
32366is set to record the actual address used.
32367
32368.vindex "&$malware_name$&"
32369When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
32370&$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
32371&%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
32372logging data.
32373
32374Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
32375imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
32376
32377Here is a very simple scanning example:
32378.code
32379deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32380 malware = *
32381.endd
32382The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
32383.code
32384deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32385 malware = */defer_ok
32386.endd
32387The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
32388aveserver. It assumes you have set:
32389.code
32390av_scanner = $acl_m0
32391.endd
32392in the main Exim configuration.
32393.code
32394deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32395 set acl_m0 = sophie
32396 malware = *
32397
32398deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32399 set acl_m0 = aveserver
32400 malware = *
32401.endd
32402
32403
32404.section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
32405.cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
32406.cindex "spam scanning"
32407.cindex "SpamAssassin"
32408.cindex "Rspamd"
32409The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
32410score and a report for the message.
32411Support is also provided for Rspamd.
32412
32413For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
32414Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
32415&url(https://spamassassin.apache.org/) and &url(https://www.rspamd.com/)
32416
32417SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
32418.code
32419perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
32420.endd
32421SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
32422documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
32423nicely, however.
32424
32425.oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
32426By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
32427intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
32428&%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
32429you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
32430configuration as follows (example):
32431.code
32432spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
32433.endd
32434The SpamAssassin protocol relies on a TCP half-close from the client.
32435If your SpamAssassin client side is running a Linux system with an
32436iptables firewall, consider setting
32437&%net.netfilter.nf_conntrack_tcp_timeout_close_wait%& to at least the
32438timeout, Exim uses when waiting for a response from the SpamAssassin
32439server (currently defaulting to 120s). With a lower value the Linux
32440connection tracking may consider your half-closed connection as dead too
32441soon.
32442
32443
32444To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
32445on TCP port 11333)
32446you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
32447.code
32448spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
32449.endd
32450
32451As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
32452sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
32453file name instead of an address/port pair:
32454.code
32455spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
32456.endd
32457You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
32458reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
32459&%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
32460option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way):
32461.code
32462spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
32463 192.168.2.11 783 : \
32464 192.168.2.12 783
32465.endd
32466Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
32467When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
32468servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
32469condition defers.
32470
32471Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
32472Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
32473and changeable in the usual way; take care to not double the separator.
32474
32475For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
32476subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
32477and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
32478In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
32479
32480Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
32481are options.
32482The supported options are:
32483.code
32484pri=<priority> Selection priority
32485weight=<value> Selection bias
32486time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
32487retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
32488tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
32489variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
32490.endd
32491
32492The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
32493higher values being tried first.
32494The default priority is 1.
32495
32496The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
32497Within a priority set
32498servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
32499The default value for selection bias is 1.
32500
32501Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
32502in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
32503Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
32504characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
32505
32506Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
32507are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
32508
32509The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
32510The default value is two minutes.
32511
32512The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
32513a failed connect is made.
32514The default is to not retry.
32515
32516The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
32517a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
32518used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
32519expansion.
32520
32521.vindex "&$callout_address$&"
32522When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
32523is set to record the actual address used.
32524
32525.section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
32526Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
32527.code
32528deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
32529 spam = joe
32530.endd
32531The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
32532relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
32533to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
32534default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
32535Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
32536right-hand side.
32537
32538The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
32539principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
32540have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
32541&%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
32542read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
32543are not set.
32544Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
32545(e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
32546after the first),
32547or the use of PRDR,
32548.cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
32549are needed to use this feature.
32550
32551The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
32552you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
32553&"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
32554
32555
32556Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
32557large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
32558are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
32559example:
32560.code
32561deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
32562 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
32563 spam = nobody
32564.endd
32565
32566The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
32567SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
32568&%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
32569it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
32570
32571.cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
32572When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
32573variables.
32574Except for &$spam_report$&,
32575these variables are saved with the received message so are
32576available for use at delivery time.
32577
32578.vlist
32579.vitem &$spam_score$&
32580The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
32581for inclusion in log or reject messages.
32582
32583.vitem &$spam_score_int$&
32584The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
32585example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
32586because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
32587The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
32588
32589.vitem &$spam_bar$&
32590A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
32591integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
32592&$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
32593headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
32594spam bar is 50 characters.
32595
32596.vitem &$spam_report$&
32597A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
32598message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
32599This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
32600Beware that SpamAssassin may return non-ASCII characters, especially
32601when running in country-specific locales, which are not legal
32602unencoded in headers.
32603
32604.vitem &$spam_action$&
32605For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
32606spam score versus threshold.
32607For Rspamd, the recommended action.
32608
32609.endlist
32610
32611The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
32612spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
32613does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
32614
32615The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
32616the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
32617failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
32618statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
32619spam condition, like this:
32620.code
32621deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
32622 spam = joe/defer_ok
32623.endd
32624This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
32625
32626Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
32627condition:
32628.code
32629# put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
32630warn spam = nobody:true
32631 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
32632 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
32633
32634# add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
32635# is over threshold
32636warn spam = nobody
32637 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
32638
32639# reject spam at high scores (> 12)
32640deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
32641 spam = nobody:true
32642 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
32643.endd
32644
32645
32646
32647.section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
32648.cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
32649.cindex "MIME content scanning"
32650.oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
32651.oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
32652The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
32653each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
32654of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
32655specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
32656options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
32657cases.
32658
32659These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
32660ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
32661the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
32662message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
32663ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
32664result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
32665&%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
32666
32667You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
32668only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
32669condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
32670&%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
32671&<<SECTscanregex>>&).
32672
32673At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
32674information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
32675of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
32676parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
32677part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
32678syntax is:
32679.display
32680&`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
32681.endd
32682The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
32683the value can be:
32684
32685.olist
32686&"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
32687.next
32688The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
32689&"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
32690a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
32691full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
32692.next
32693A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
32694directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
32695is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
32696the full path and file name.
32697.next
32698If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
32699filename, and the default path is then used.
32700.endlist
32701The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
32702errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
32703a file with its original, proposed filename using
32704.code
32705decode = $mime_filename
32706.endd
32707However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
32708anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
32709automatically unlinked.
32710
32711For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
32712content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
32713as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
32714variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
32715before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
32716
32717The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
32718used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
32719respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
32720
32721.cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
32722The following list describes all expansion variables that are
32723available in the MIME ACL:
32724
32725.vlist
32726.vitem &$mime_boundary$&
32727If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
32728have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
32729has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
32730contains the empty string.
32731
32732.vitem &$mime_charset$&
32733This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
32734&'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
32735.code
32736us-ascii
32737gb2312 (Chinese)
32738iso-8859-1
32739.endd
32740Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
32741case-insensitively.
32742
32743.vitem &$mime_content_description$&
32744This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
32745header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
32746implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
32747only used for display purposes.
32748
32749.vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
32750This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
32751header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
32752
32753.vitem &$mime_content_id$&
32754This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
32755This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
32756
32757.vitem &$mime_content_size$&
32758This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
32759successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
32760size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
32761has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
32762
32763.vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
32764This variable contains the normalized content of the
32765&'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
32766type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
32767
32768.vitem &$mime_content_type$&
32769If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
32770value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
32771are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
32772.code
32773text/plain
32774text/html
32775application/octet-stream
32776image/jpeg
32777audio/midi
32778.endd
32779If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
32780empty string.
32781
32782.vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
32783This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
32784successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
32785containing the decoded data.
32786.endlist
32787
32788.cindex "RFC 2047"
32789.vlist
32790.vitem &$mime_filename$&
32791This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
32792proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
32793&'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
32794RFC2047
32795or RFC2231
32796decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
32797 If no filename was
32798found, this variable contains the empty string.
32799
32800.vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
32801This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
32802attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
32803content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
32804
32805The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
32806cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
32807follows:
32808
32809.olist
32810The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
32811
32812.next
32813If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
32814so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
32815
32816.next
32817If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
32818and the rest are attachments.
32819
32820.next
32821All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
32822.endlist olist
32823
32824As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
32825alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
32826coverletter mail attached to non-HTML coverletter mail will also be allowed:
32827.code
32828deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
32829!condition = $mime_is_rfc822
32830condition = $mime_is_coverletter
32831condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
32832.endd
32833.vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
32834This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
32835&"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
32836Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
32837want to carry out specific actions on them.
32838
32839.vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
32840This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
32841checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
32842decoding is fully recursive.
32843
32844.vitem &$mime_part_count$&
32845This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
32846starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
32847counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
32848&$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
32849complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
32850parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
32851.endlist
32852
32853
32854
32855.section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
32856.cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
32857.cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
32858You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
32859the message, or on individual MIME parts.
32860
32861The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
32862matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
32863MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
32864linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
32865have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
32866
32867The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
32868to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
32869part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
32870is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
32871and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
3287232K characters are checked.
32873
32874The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
32875literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
32876expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
32877with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
32878Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
32879.code
32880deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
32881 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
32882.endd
32883The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
32884&$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
32885matching regular expression.
32886The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
32887are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
32888
32889&*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
32890CPU-intensive.
32891
32892.ecindex IIDcosca
32893
32894
32895
32896
32897. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32898. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32899
32900.chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
32901 "Local scan function"
32902.scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
32903.cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
32904.cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
32905In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
32906want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
32907
32908The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
32909passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
32910a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
32911condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
32912non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
32913
32914To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
32915possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
32916in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
32917can of course use a little C stub to call it.
32918
32919The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
32920when Exim is just about to accept the message.
32921It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
32922well as messages arriving via SMTP.
32923
32924Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
32925option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
32926Zero means &"no timeout"&.
32927Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
32928before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
32929are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
32930incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
32931For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
32932code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
32933
32934
32935
32936.section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
32937.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
32938To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
32939function is before building Exim, by setting
32940.new
32941both HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN and
32942.wen
32943LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
32944&_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
32945directory, so you might set
32946.code
32947HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN=yes
32948LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
32949.endd
32950for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
32951Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
32952be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
32953function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
32954commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
32955_src/local_scan.c_.
32956
32957If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
32958for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
32959.code
32960LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
32961.endd
32962in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
32963
32964
32965
32966
32967.section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
32968.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
32969You must include this line near the start of your code:
32970.code
32971#include "local_scan.h"
32972.endd
32973This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
32974prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
32975almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
32976for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
32977It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
32978strings and pointers to character strings:
32979.code
32980#define CS (char *)
32981#define CCS (const char *)
32982#define CSS (char **)
32983#define US (unsigned char *)
32984#define CUS (const unsigned char *)
32985#define USS (unsigned char **)
32986.endd
32987The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
32988.code
32989extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
32990.endd
32991The arguments are as follows:
32992
32993.ilist
32994&%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
32995(the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
32996recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
32997
32998The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
32999character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
33000id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
33001macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
33002case this changes in some future version.
33003.next
33004&%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
33005string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
33006.endlist
33007
33008The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
33009
33010.vlist
33011.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
33012.vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
33013The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
33014the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
33015newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
33016maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
33017
33018.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
33019This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
33020queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
33021
33022.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
33023This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
33024queued without immediate delivery.
33025
33026.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
33027The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
33028passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
33029they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
33030&`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
33031used.
33032
33033.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
33034The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
33035message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
33036problem"& is used.
33037
33038.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
33039This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
33040message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
33041&%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
33042&%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
33043&%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
33044same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
33045
33046.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
33047This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
33048LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
33049.endlist
33050
33051If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
33052reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
33053&%-oe%& command line options.
33054
33055
33056
33057.section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
33058.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
33059It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
33060that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
33061want to do this, you must have the line
33062.code
33063LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
33064.endd
33065in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
33066&_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
33067file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
33068to define them.
33069
33070The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
33071&`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
33072and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
33073alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
33074variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
33075entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
33076.code
33077static int my_integer_option = 42;
33078static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
33079
33080optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
33081 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
33082 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
33083};
33084
33085int local_scan_options_count =
33086 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
33087.endd
33088The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
33089configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
33090.code
33091begin local_scan
33092my_integer = 99
33093my_string = some string of text...
33094.endd
33095The available types of option data are as follows:
33096
33097.vlist
33098.vitem &*opt_bool*&
33099This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
33100variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
33101that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
33102whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
33103TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
33104values.)
33105
33106.vitem &*opt_fixed*&
33107This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
33108The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
33109multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
33110
33111.vitem &*opt_int*&
33112This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
33113&`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
33114Exim.
33115
33116.vitem &*opt_mkint*&
33117This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
33118&%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
33119printed with the suffix K or M.
33120
33121.vitem &*opt_octint*&
33122This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
33123octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
33124always output in octal.
33125
33126.vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
33127This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
33128variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
33129
33130.vitem &*opt_time*&
33131This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
33132type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
33133.endlist
33134
33135If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
33136out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
33137
33138
33139
33140.section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
33141.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
33142The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
33143are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
33144Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
33145including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
33146C variables are as follows:
33147
33148.vlist
33149.vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
33150This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
33151It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
33152
33153.vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
33154This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
33155It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
33156
33157.vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
33158This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
33159is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
33160&[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
33161
33162.ilist
33163The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
33164testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
33165other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
33166
33167.next
33168The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
33169by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
33170of debugging bits.
33171.endlist ilist
33172
33173Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
33174selected, you should use code like this:
33175.code
33176if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
33177 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
33178.endd
33179.vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
33180After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
33181variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
33182
33183.vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
33184A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
33185discussed below.
33186
33187.vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
33188A pointer to the last of the header lines.
33189
33190.vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
33191The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
33192
33193.vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
33194This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
33195&%-bh%& command line option.
33196
33197.vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
33198The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
33199is NULL for locally submitted messages.
33200
33201.vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
33202The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
33203command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
33204specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
33205
33206.vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
33207This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
33208&$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
33209
33210.vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
33211The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
33212
33213.vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
33214The number of accepted recipients.
33215
33216.vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
33217.cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
33218.cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
33219The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
33220&%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
33221can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
33222below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
33223adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
33224&%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
33225value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
33226blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
33227and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
33228
33229.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
33230The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
33231
33232.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
33233The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
33234locally-submitted messages.
33235
33236.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
33237The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
33238was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
33239
33240.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
33241The name of the sending host, if known.
33242
33243.vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
33244The port on the sending host.
33245
33246.vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
33247This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
33248
33249.vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
33250This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
33251
33252.vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
33253The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
33254requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
33255.endlist
33256
33257
33258.section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
33259The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
33260You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
33261(see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
33262their type to *.
33263
33264
33265.vlist
33266.vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
33267A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
33268
33269.vitem &*int&~type*&
33270A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
33271characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
33272Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
33273with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
33274rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
33275lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
33276
33277.vitem &*int&~slen*&
33278The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
33279internal newlines.
33280
33281.vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
33282A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
33283a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
33284.endlist
33285
33286
33287
33288.section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
33289The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
33290
33291.vlist
33292.vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
33293This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
33294
33295.vitem &*int&~pno*&
33296This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
33297the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
33298and must always contain -1 at this stage.
33299
33300.vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
33301If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
33302recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
33303envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
33304router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
33305an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
33306&%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
33307is NULL for all recipients.
33308.endlist
33309
33310
33311
33312.section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
33313.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
33314The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
33315These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
33316release:
33317
33318.vlist
33319.vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
33320 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
33321
33322This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
33323&%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
33324be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
33325for the process in &%newumask%&.
33326
33327Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
33328and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
33329standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
33330descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
33331argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
33332
33333The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
33334
33335.vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
33336This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
33337seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
33338return value is as follows:
33339
33340.ilist
33341>= 0
33342
33343The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
33344ending status.
33345
33346.next
33347< 0 and > &--256
33348
33349The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
33350signal number.
33351
33352.next
33353&--256
33354
33355The process timed out.
33356.next
33357&--257
33358
33359The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
33360.endlist
33361
33362.vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
33363This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
33364Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
33365want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
33366forks a subprocess that is running
33367.code
33368exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
33369.endd
33370and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
33371that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
33372of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
33373recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
33374
33375When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
33376finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
33377fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
33378addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
33379
33380
33381.vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
33382 *sender_authentication)*&
33383This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
33384that it runs is:
33385.display
33386&`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
33387.endd
33388The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
33389
33390
33391.vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
33392This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
33393output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
33394calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
33395conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
33396.code
33397if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
33398 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
33399.endd
33400
33401.vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
33402This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
33403expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
33404The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
33405expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
33406the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
33407block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
33408&<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
33409
33410.vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
33411This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
33412existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
33413character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
33414substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
33415if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
33416
33417.vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
33418 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
33419This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
33420chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
33421
33422If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
33423&%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
33424NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
33425matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
33426&%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
33427found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
33428marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
33429option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
33430top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
33431headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
33432.code
33433header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
33434 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
33435.endd
33436Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
33437there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
33438
33439
33440.vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
33441This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
33442occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
33443particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
33444match the specification, the function does nothing.
33445
33446
33447.vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
33448 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
33449This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
33450a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
33451colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
33452&"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
33453.code
33454if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
33455.endd
33456.vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
33457.cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
33458This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
33459The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
33460back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
33461zero-terminated.
33462
33463.vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
33464This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
33465zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
33466to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
33467string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
33468yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
33469easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
33470added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
33471
33472.vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
33473This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
33474matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
33475.display
33476&`OK `& match succeeded
33477&`FAIL `& match failed
33478&`DEFER `& match deferred
33479.endd
33480DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
33481inability to contact a database.
33482
33483.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
33484 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
33485This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
33486controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
33487&'lss_match_domain()'&.
33488
33489.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
33490 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
33491This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
33492controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
33493matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
33494
33495.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
33496 uschar&~*list)*&"
33497This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
33498expected to be
33499.code
33500lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
33501.endd
33502.vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
33503An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
33504is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
33505looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
33506values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
33507returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
33508failed.
33509
33510.vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
33511 *format,&~...)*&"
33512This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
33513is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
33514&`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
33515them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
33516arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
33517contain any newlines, not even at the end.
33518
33519
33520.vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
33521This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
33522is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
33523with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
33524
33525This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
33526described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
33527the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
33528value afterwards. For example:
33529.code
33530 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
33531 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
33532 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
33533.endd
33534
33535.vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
33536This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
33537recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
33538matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
33539address.
33540.endlist
33541
33542
33543.cindex "RFC 2047"
33544.vlist
33545.vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
33546 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
33547This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
33548these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
33549from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
33550a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
33551made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
33552binary string is returned with an error message.
33553
33554The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
33555maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
33556encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
33557
33558.cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
33559.cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
33560If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
33561contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
33562not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
33563
33564The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
33565&%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
33566which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
33567
33568If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
33569argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
33570set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
33571returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
33572with translation.
33573
33574
33575.vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
33576This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
33577below.
33578
33579.vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
33580The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
33581output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
33582stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
33583SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
33584is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
33585opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
33586test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
33587is involved.
33588
33589If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
33590output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
33591
33592Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
33593must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
33594LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
33595LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
33596initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
33597to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
33598that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
33599.code
33600smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
33601return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
33602.endd
33603Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
33604the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
33605&'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
33606multiple output lines.
33607
33608The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
33609does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
33610the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
33611detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
33612you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
33613dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
33614arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
33615is an error.
33616
33617.vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
33618This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
33619chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
33620runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
33621
33622.vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
33623This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
33624permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
33625
33626.vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
33627See below.
33628
33629.vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
33630See below.
33631
33632.vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
33633These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
33634The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
33635number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
33636and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
33637pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
33638more discussion.
33639.endlist
33640
33641
33642
33643.section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
33644.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
33645No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
33646The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
33647recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
33648to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
33649message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
33650terminates.
33651
33652Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
33653data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
33654connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
33655one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
33656
33657If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
33658in the same SMTP connection, you should set
33659.code
33660store_pool = POOL_PERM
33661.endd
33662before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
33663restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
33664the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
33665set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
33666
33667The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
33668&'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
33669There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
33670block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
33671&%store_pool%&.
33672.ecindex IIDlosca
33673
33674
33675
33676
33677. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33678. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33679
33680.chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
33681.scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
33682.scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
33683.scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
33684The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
33685that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
33686also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
33687they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
33688
33689The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
33690is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
33691It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
33692commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
33693The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
33694
33695The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
33696is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
33697the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
33698If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
33699of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
33700prevent it happening on retries.
33701
33702.vindex "&$domain$&"
33703.vindex "&$local_part$&"
33704&*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
33705specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
33706&$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
33707you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
33708independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
33709described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
33710
33711
33712.section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
33713.cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
33714.cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
33715The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
33716setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
33717other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
33718&%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
33719.code
33720system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
33721system_filter_user = exim
33722.endd
33723If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
33724&%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
33725specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
33726&%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
33727&%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
33728by the &%reply%& command.
33729
33730
33731.section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
33732You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
33733filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
33734are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
33735
33736If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
33737you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
33738
33739
33740
33741.section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
33742The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
33743files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
33744mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
33745available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
33746If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
33747they cause errors.
33748
33749.cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
33750There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
33751files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
33752is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
33753&%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
33754subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
33755manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
33756
33757&*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
33758specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
33759succeed, it will not be tried again.
33760If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
33761arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
33762
33763When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
33764&$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
33765users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
33766to which users' filter files can refer.
33767
33768
33769
33770.section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
33771.vindex "&$recipients$&"
33772The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
33773of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
33774filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
33775
33776
33777
33778.section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
33779.cindex "freezing messages"
33780.cindex "message" "freezing"
33781.cindex "message" "forced failure"
33782.cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
33783.cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
33784.cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
33785There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
33786always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
33787filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
33788for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
33789word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
33790.code
33791fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
33792.endd
33793The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
33794
33795The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
33796message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
33797and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
33798delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
33799that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
33800run.
33801
33802The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
33803not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
33804filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
33805is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
33806
33807.cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
33808.cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
33809The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
33810well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
33811up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
33812log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
33813two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
33814strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
33815message. For example:
33816.code
33817fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
33818 because it contains attachments that we are \
33819 not prepared to receive."
33820.endd
33821
33822.cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
33823Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
33824the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
33825the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
33826command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
33827Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
33828use, for example
33829.code
33830if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
33831then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
33832.endd
33833though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
33834alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
33835generated by the filter.
33836
33837The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
33838&%defer%&,
33839&%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
33840set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
33841as
33842.code
33843mail ...
33844freeze
33845.endd
33846to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
33847failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
33848take place.
33849
33850
33851
33852.section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
33853.cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
33854.cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
33855.cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
33856Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
33857.code
33858headers add <string>
33859headers remove <string>
33860.endd
33861The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
33862added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
33863filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
33864space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
33865forced to fail, the command has no effect.
33866
33867You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
33868continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
33869including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
33870example:
33871.code
33872headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
33873 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
33874 X-header-2: ...."
33875.endd
33876Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
33877be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
33878space after input continuations is ignored.
33879
33880The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
33881This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
33882those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
33883&'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
33884header with the same name, they are all removed.
33885
33886The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
33887of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
33888from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
33889modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
33890Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
33891used for all recipients of the message.
33892
33893During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
33894header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
33895that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
33896routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
33897routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
33898until the message is actually being written (see section
33899&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
33900
33901If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
33902added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
33903present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
33904present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
33905message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
33906conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
33907modified more than once.
33908
33909Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
33910use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
33911For example:
33912.code
33913headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
33914headers remove "Subject"
33915headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
33916headers remove "Old-Subject"
33917.endd
33918
33919
33920
33921.section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
33922.cindex "envelope sender"
33923In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
33924.code
33925errors_to <some address>
33926.endd
33927in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
33928delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
33929user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
33930might use
33931.code
33932unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
33933.endd
33934to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
33935address if its delivery failed.
33936
33937
33938
33939.section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
33940.vindex "&$domain$&"
33941.vindex "&$local_part$&"
33942In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
33943delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
33944operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
33945such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
33946filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
33947which implements such a filter:
33948.code
33949central_filter:
33950 check_local_user
33951 driver = redirect
33952 domains = +local_domains
33953 file = /central/filters/$local_part
33954 no_verify
33955 allow_filter
33956 allow_freeze
33957.endd
33958The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
33959&%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
33960the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
33961use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
33962
33963Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
33964specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
33965its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
33966address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
33967normal way.
33968.ecindex IIDsysfil1
33969.ecindex IIDsysfil2
33970.ecindex IIDsysfil3
33971
33972
33973
33974
33975
33976
33977. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33978. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33979
33980.chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
33981.scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
33982Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
33983all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
33984these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
33985this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
33986removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
33987before it is placed on Exim's queue.
33988
33989Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
33990&"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
33991that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
33992its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
33993set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
33994
33995&*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
33996or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
33997loopback interface specially in any way.
33998
33999If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
34000that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
34001
34002
34003
34004
34005.section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
34006.cindex "message" "submission"
34007.cindex "submission mode"
34008Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
34009&%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
34010received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
34011state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
34012.code
34013control = submission
34014.endd
34015in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
34016&<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
34017a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
34018known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
34019example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
34020interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
34021.code
34022warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
34023 control = submission
34024.endd
34025.cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
34026There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
34027is used to separate options. For example:
34028.code
34029control = submission/sender_retain
34030.endd
34031Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
34032true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
34033of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
34034the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
34035authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
34036&'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
34037attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
34038
34039When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
34040domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
34041example:
34042.code
34043control = submission/domain=some.domain
34044.endd
34045The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
34046&<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
34047that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
34048&'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
34049.code
34050accept authenticated = *
34051 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
34052 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
34053 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
34054.endd
34055Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
34056option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
34057the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
34058.code
34059bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
34060.endd
34061then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
34062line would be:
34063.code
34064Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
34065.endd
34066.cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
34067By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
34068used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
34069specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
34070
34071&*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
34072ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
34073untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
34074specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
34075does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
34076spoof another's address.
34077
34078.section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
34079.cindex "line endings"
34080.cindex "carriage return"
34081.cindex "linefeed"
34082RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
34083linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
34084SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
34085conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
34086use CRLF or just CR.
34087
34088Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
34089using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
34090receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
34091Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
34092MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
34093has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
34094that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
34095other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
34096follows:
34097
34098.ilist
34099LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
34100.next
34101CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
34102is ignored.
34103.next
34104The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
34105nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
34106terminator.
34107.next
34108If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
34109the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
34110is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
34111people trying to play silly games.
34112.next
34113If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
34114bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
34115line.
34116.endlist
34117
34118
34119
34120
34121
34122.section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
34123.cindex "unqualified addresses"
34124.cindex "address" "qualification"
34125By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
34126host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
34127SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
34128messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
34129requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
34130
34131Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
34132sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
34133&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
34134cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
34135value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
34136
34137.oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
34138.oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
34139Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
34140that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
34141line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
34142are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
34143other words, such qualification is also controlled by
34144&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
34145
34146
34147
34148
34149.section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
34150.cindex "&""From""& line"
34151.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
34152.cindex "sender" "address"
34153.oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
34154.oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
34155.cindex "envelope sender"
34156.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
34157Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
34158with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
34159&"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
34160.code
34161From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
34162From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
34163.endd
34164This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
34165Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
34166via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
34167such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
34168&%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
34169and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
34170regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
34171default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
34172that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
34173
34174.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
34175When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
34176a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
34177contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
34178then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
34179qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
34180the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
34181
34182If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
34183sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
34184that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
34185
34186Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
34187treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
34188as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
34189incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
34190
34191
34192
34193.section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
34194.cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
34195.cindex "header lines" "Resent-"
34196RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
34197&`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
34198recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
34199&'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
34200&'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
34201
34202.blockquote
34203&'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
34204processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
34205.endblockquote
34206
34207This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
34208address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
34209follows:
34210
34211.ilist
34212A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
34213is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
34214.next
34215If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
34216&%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
34217&'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
34218.next
34219For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
34220also removed.
34221.next
34222For a locally-submitted message,
34223if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
34224&'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
34225the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
34226included in log lines in this case.
34227.next
34228The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
34229&%Resent-%& header lines are present.
34230.endlist
34231
34232
34233
34234
34235.section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
34236Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
34237includes the header line:
34238.code
34239Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
34240.endd
34241
34242.section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
34243.cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
34244If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
34245message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
34246extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
34247existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
34248
34249
34250.section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
34251.cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
34252.cindex "header lines" "Date:"
34253If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
34254Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
34255&%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
34256
34257.section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
34258.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
34259.oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
34260&'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
34261set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
34262the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
34263in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
34264set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
34265messages.
34266
34267
34268.section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
34269.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
34270.cindex "header lines" "Envelope-to:"
34271.oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
34272&'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
34273Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
34274generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
34275messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
34276(the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
34277messages.
34278
34279
34280.section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
34281.cindex "&'From:'& header line"
34282.cindex "header lines" "From:"
34283.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
34284.cindex "message" "submission"
34285.cindex "submission mode"
34286If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
34287adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
34288
34289.ilist
34290The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
34291message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
34292.next
34293.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
34294The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
34295.olist
34296.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
34297If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
34298&$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
34299.next
34300If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
34301part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
34302.next
34303If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
34304&$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
34305.endlist
34306.endlist
34307
34308A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
34309
34310If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
34311line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
34312containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
34313are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
34314They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
34315&%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
34316&%qualify_domain%&.
34317
34318For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
34319&'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
34320user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
34321name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
34322
34323
34324.section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
34325.cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
34326.cindex "header lines" "Message-ID:"
34327.cindex "message" "submission"
34328.oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
34329If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
34330&'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
34331&%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
34332to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
34333creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
34334message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
34335followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
34336in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
34337&%message_id_header_domain%& options.
34338
34339
34340.section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
34341.cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
34342.cindex "header lines" "Received:"
34343A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
34344contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
34345Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
34346
34347The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
34348have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
34349line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
34350that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
34351
34352Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
34353changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
34354-H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
34355
34356
34357.section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
34358.cindex "&'References:'& header line"
34359.cindex "header lines" "References:"
34360Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
34361header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
34362section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
34363header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
34364responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
34365processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
34366than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
34367incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
3436811 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
34369
34370
34371
34372.section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
34373.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
34374.cindex "header lines" "Return-path:"
34375.oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
34376&'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
34377it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
34378transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
34379transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
34380default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
34381
34382
34383
34384.section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
34385.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
34386.cindex "message" "submission"
34387.cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
34388For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
34389existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
34390these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
34391&%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
34392control setting.
34393
34394When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
34395&%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
34396control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
34397&'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
34398that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
34399&%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
34400be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
34401appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
34402line is added to the message.
34403
34404If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
34405the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
34406&%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
34407options true at the same time.
34408
34409.cindex "submission mode"
34410By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
34411received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
34412a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
34413not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
34414
34415.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
34416First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
34417authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
34418created as follows:
34419
34420.ilist
34421.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
34422If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
34423&$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
34424.next
34425If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
34426is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
34427.next
34428If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
34429&$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
34430.endlist
34431
34432This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
34433are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
34434added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
34435by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
34436
34437.cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
34438&*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
34439the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
34440except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
34441
34442
34443
34444.section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
34445 "SECTheadersaddrem"
34446.cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
34447.cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
34448When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
34449specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
34450process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
34451modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
34452as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
34453
34454In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
34455specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
34456addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
34457changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
34458transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
34459they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
34460
34461&*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
34462the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
34463expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
34464
34465For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
34466option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
34467newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
34468.code
34469headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
34470 X-added-second: another added header line
34471.endd
34472Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
34473
34474Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
34475specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
34476Each header-line is separately expanded.
34477
34478The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
34479list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
34480often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
34481not part of the names. For example:
34482.code
34483headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
34484.endd
34485
34486Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
34487specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
34488Each item is separately expanded.
34489Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
34490form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
34491will act as list separators.
34492
34493When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
34494items are expanded at routing time,
34495and then associated with all addresses that are
34496accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
34497an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
34498forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
34499
34500.oindex "&%unseen%&"
34501However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
34502the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
34503&"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
34504
34505Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
34506settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
34507dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
34508requirements.
34509
34510The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
34511with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
34512these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
34513recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
34514consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
34515names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
34516instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
34517
34518After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
34519lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
34520the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
34521header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
34522
34523This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
34524the following consequences:
34525
34526.ilist
34527The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
34528remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
34529to it, at all times.
34530.next
34531Header lines that are added by a router's
34532&%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
34533expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
34534.next
34535Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
34536in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
34537.next
34538Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
34539a later router or by a transport.
34540.next
34541An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
34542removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
34543.code
34544headers_remove = subject
34545headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
34546.endd
34547.endlist
34548
34549&*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
34550for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
34551
34552
34553
34554
34555
34556.section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
34557.cindex "address" "constructed"
34558.cindex "constructed address"
34559When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
34560the form
34561.display
34562<&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
34563.endd
34564For example:
34565.code
34566Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
34567.endd
34568The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
34569otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
34570&"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
34571ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
34572upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
34573&%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
34574The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
34575there is no password file entry.
34576
34577.cindex "RFC 2047"
34578In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
34579parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
34580characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
34581including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
34582&%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
34583characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
34584&%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
34585is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
34586
34587
34588
34589.section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
34590.cindex "case of local parts"
34591.cindex "local part" "case of"
34592RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
34593be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
34594addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
34595because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
34596routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
34597original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
34598router option.
34599
34600.cindex "mixed-case login names"
34601If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
34602assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
34603your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
34604correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
34605.code
34606correct_case:
34607 driver = redirect
34608 domains = +local_domains
34609 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
34610 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
34611 @$domain
34612.endd
34613For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
34614(&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
34615up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
34616on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
34617local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
34618
34619
34620
34621.section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
34622.cindex "dot" "in local part"
34623.cindex "local part" "dots in"
34624RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
34625part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
34626middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
34627empty components for compatibility.
34628
34629
34630
34631.section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
34632.cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
34633Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
34634happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
34635in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
34636&'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
34637
34638Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
34639in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
34640routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
34641example, a header such as
34642.code
34643To: hare@teaparty
34644.endd
34645might get rewritten as
34646.code
34647To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
34648.endd
34649Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
34650does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
34651been routed.
34652
34653Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
34654addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
34655result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
34656deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
34657immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
34658routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
34659.ecindex IIDmesproc
34660
34661
34662
34663. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34664. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34665
34666.chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
34667.scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
34668.scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
34669Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
34670LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
34671closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
34672processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
34673
34674.ilist
34675SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
34676.next
34677SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
34678.next
34679Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
34680.endlist
34681
34682For mail delivery, the following are available:
34683
34684.ilist
34685SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
34686.next
34687LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
34688&"lmtp"&);
34689.next
34690LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
34691transport);
34692.next
34693Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
34694the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
34695.endlist
34696
34697&'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
34698stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
34699used to contain the envelope information.
34700
34701
34702
34703.section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
34704.cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
34705.cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
34706.cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
34707.cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
34708.cindex "EHLO"
34709.cindex "HELO"
34710.cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
34711Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
34712The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
34713processing is the same in both cases.
34714
34715If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
34716parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
34717command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
34718&%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
34719such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
34720.cindex "transport" "filter"
34721.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
34722transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
34723suppressed.
34724
34725If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
34726pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
34727required for the transaction.
34728
34729If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
34730was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
34731server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
34732Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
34733is called for verification.
34734
34735If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
34736the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
34737in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
34738
34739.cindex "carriage return"
34740.cindex "linefeed"
34741Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
34742LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
34743order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
34744line terminator.
34745
34746If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
34747characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
34748same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
34749even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
34750of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
34751they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
34752each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
34753in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
34754significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
34755
34756When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
34757message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
34758records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
34759particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
34760
34761.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
34762Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
34763a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
34764See the next section for more detail about error handling.
34765
34766.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
34767.cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
34768When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
34769looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
34770messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
34771creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
34772a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
34773so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
34774does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
34775turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
34776
34777The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
34778limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
34779
34780.cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
34781The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
34782identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
34783square bracket of the IP address.
34784
34785
34786
34787
34788.section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
34789.cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
34790.cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
34791.cindex "host" "error"
34792Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
34793message errors, and recipient errors.
34794
34795.vlist
34796.vitem "&*Host errors*&"
34797A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
34798particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
34799
34800.ilist
34801Connection refused or timed out,
34802.next
34803Any error response code on connection,
34804.next
34805Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
34806.next
34807Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
34808.next
34809I/O errors at any time,
34810.next
34811Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
34812the &"."& at the end of the data.
34813.endlist ilist
34814
34815For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
34816EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
34817error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
34818host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
34819the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
34820alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
34821host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
34822made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
34823
34824.vitem "&*Message errors*&"
34825.cindex "message" "error"
34826A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
34827particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
34828message errors are:
34829
34830.ilist
34831Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
34832the data,
34833.next
34834Timeout after MAIL,
34835.next
34836Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
34837timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
34838connection at any other time.
34839.endlist ilist
34840
34841For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
34842to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
34843temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
34844addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
34845a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
34846message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
34847that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
34848time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
34849affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
34850it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
34851
34852If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
34853to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
34854over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
34855response to MAIL.
34856
34857.vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
34858.cindex "recipient" "error"
34859A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
34860recipient errors are:
34861
34862.ilist
34863Any error response to RCPT,
34864.next
34865Timeout after RCPT.
34866.endlist
34867
34868For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
34869recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
34870sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
34871address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
34872used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
34873routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
34874operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
34875to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
34876if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
34877(&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
34878have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
34879the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
34880the retry clock is reset.
34881
34882The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
34883host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
34884other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
34885in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
34886proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
34887than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
34888if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
34889through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
34890recipient's retry time.
34891.endlist
34892
34893In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
34894current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
34895tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
34896own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
34897until the next delivery attempt.
34898
34899Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
34900MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
34901would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
34902host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
34903What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
34904is created.
34905
34906The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
34907these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
34908procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
34909response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
34910it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
34911message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
34912helpful to treat this case as a message error.
34913
34914Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
34915host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
34916or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
34917the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
34918then to be treated as a host error.
34919
34920There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
34921terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
34922reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
34923should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
34924host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
34925
34926
34927
34928
34929.section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
34930.cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
34931.cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
34932.cindex "inetd"
34933.cindex "daemon"
34934Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
34935listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
34936&_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
34937.code
34938smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
34939.endd
34940Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
34941agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
34942a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
34943the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
34944with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
34945stream and exits with an error code.
34946
34947By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
34948disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
34949unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
34950&%smtp_connection%& log selector.
34951
34952.cindex "carriage return"
34953.cindex "linefeed"
34954Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
34955LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
34956order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
34957line terminator.
34958Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
34959sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
34960sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
34961
34962.cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
34963.cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
34964One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
34965HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
34966commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
34967the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
34968Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
34969match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
34970
34971.cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
34972.cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
34973The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
34974a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
34975&%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
34976false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
34977&%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
34978value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
34979message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
34980
34981When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
34982its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
34983logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
34984
34985The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
34986prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
34987number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
34988&%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
34989rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
34990
34991The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
34992subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
34993for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
34994things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
34995processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
34996sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
34997it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
34998
34999When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
35000and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
35001high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
35002&%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
35003applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
35004
35005Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
35006can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
35007&%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
35008number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
35009SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
35010&%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
35011subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
35012a delivery process.
35013
35014The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
35015&%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
35016started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
35017handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
35018however, available with &'inetd'&.
35019
35020Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
35021are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
35022to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
35023section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
35024
35025Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
35026MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
35027&%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
35028
35029
35030
35031.section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
35032.cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
35033If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
35034commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
35035the error response to the last command. The default value for
35036&%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
35037abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
35038circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
35039
35040
35041.section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
35042.cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
35043.cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
35044A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
35045something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
35046address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
35047sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
35048&%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
35049drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
35050default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
35051broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
35052
35053
35054
35055.section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
35056.cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
35057The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
35058DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
35059many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
35060denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
35061client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
35062defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
35063
35064When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
35065allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
35066but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
35067or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
35068starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
35069counted.
35070
35071The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
35072STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
35073RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
35074
35075You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
35076&%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
35077&%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
35078the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
35079specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
35080
35081
35082
35083
35084.section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
35085When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
35086runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
35087appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
35088
35089.cindex "VRFY" "processing"
35090When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
35091setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
35092(with a 252 SMTP response code)
35093in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
35094When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
35095called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
35096SMTP response codes.
35097
35098.cindex "EXPN" "processing"
35099If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
35100When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
35101EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
35102than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
35103as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
35104of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
35105VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
35106RCPT failures.
35107
35108
35109
35110.section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
35111.cindex "ETRN" "processing"
35112RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
35113overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
35114disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
35115the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
35116should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
35117
35118The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
35119delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
35120the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
35121text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
35122specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
35123the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
35124argument. For example,
35125.code
35126ETRN #brigadoon
35127.endd
35128runs the command
35129.code
35130exim -R brigadoon
35131.endd
35132which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
35133containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
35134default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
35135for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
35136a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
35137
35138.cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
35139Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
35140record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
35141the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
35142the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
35143a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
35144left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
35145Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
35146
35147.oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
35148For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
35149used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
35150whatever the form of its argument. For
35151example:
35152.code
35153smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
35154 $sender_host_address
35155.endd
35156.vindex "&$domain$&"
35157The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
35158expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
35159and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
35160wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
35161under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
35162for it to change them before running the command.
35163
35164
35165
35166.section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
35167.cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
35168Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
35169standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
35170line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
35171&%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
35172messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
35173sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
35174an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
35175identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
35176runs for RCPT commands:
35177.code
35178accept hosts = :
35179.endd
35180This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
35181
35182
35183
35184.section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
35185.cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
35186.cindex "batched SMTP output"
35187Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
35188batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
35189be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
35190delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
35191envelope along with the message.
35192
35193The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
35194MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
35195the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
35196HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
35197can be used to specify it.
35198
35199Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
35200one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
35201to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
35202this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
35203chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
35204
35205.vindex "&$host$&"
35206When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
35207sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
35208transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
35209router:
35210.code
35211begin routers
35212route_append:
35213 driver = manualroute
35214 transport = smtp_appendfile
35215 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
35216
35217begin transports
35218smtp_appendfile:
35219 driver = appendfile
35220 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
35221 batch_max = 1000
35222 use_bsmtp
35223 user = exim
35224.endd
35225This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
35226format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
35227message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
35228
35229
35230
35231.section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
35232.cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
35233.cindex "batched SMTP input"
35234The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
35235reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
35236is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
35237sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
35238rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
35239and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
35240as NOOP; QUIT quits.
35241
35242Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
35243ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
35244
35245If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
35246the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
35247standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
35248make some use of automatically, for example:
35249.code
35250554 Unexpected end of file
35251Transaction started in line 10
35252Error detected in line 14
35253.endd
35254It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
35255file, for example:
35256.code
35257An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
35258The error message was:
35259
35260501 '>' missing at end of address
35261
35262The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
35263The error was detected in line 12.
35264The SMTP command at fault was:
35265
35266rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
35267
352681 previous message was successfully processed.
35269The rest of the batch was abandoned.
35270.endd
35271The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
35272messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
35273accepted.
35274.ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
35275.ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
35276
35277
35278
35279. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35280. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35281
35282.chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
35283 "Customizing messages"
35284When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
35285configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
35286to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
35287the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
35288string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
35289
35290The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
35291cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
35292option. Exim also adds the line
35293.code
35294Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
35295.endd
35296to all warning and bounce messages,
35297
35298
35299.section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
35300.cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
35301.cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
35302If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
35303message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
35304delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
35305&%bounce_message_file%& is set.
35306
35307When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
35308constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
35309separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
35310opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
35311logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
35312item.
35313
35314.vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
35315.vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
35316Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
35317expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
35318the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
35319&$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
35320option, rounded to a whole number.
35321
35322The items must appear in the file in the following order:
35323
35324.ilist
35325The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
35326&'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
35327.next
35328The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
35329failing addresses with their error messages.
35330.next
35331The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
35332returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
35333.next
35334The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
35335The fields exist for back-compatibility
35336.endlist
35337
35338The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
35339following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
35340other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
35341.code
35342Subject: Mail delivery failed
35343 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
35344 {: returning message to sender}}
35345****
35346This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
35347
35348A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
35349 {that you sent }{sent by
35350
35351<$sender_address>
35352
35353}}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
35354This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
35355****
35356The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
35357****
35358------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
35359 ------
35360****
35361------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
35362 only the first
35363------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
35364****
35365.endd
35366.section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
35367.cindex "customizing" "warning message"
35368.cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
35369The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
35370warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
35371text sections:
35372
35373.ilist
35374The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
35375&'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
35376.next
35377The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
35378the delayed addresses.
35379.next
35380The third item then ends the message.
35381.endlist
35382
35383The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
35384have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
35385.code
35386Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
35387 $warn_message_delay
35388****
35389This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
35390
35391A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
35392{that you sent }{sent by
35393
35394<$sender_address>
35395
35396}}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
35397more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
35398
35399The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
35400The subject of the message is: $h_subject
35401The date of the message is: $h_date
35402
35403The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
35404****
35405No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
35406continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
35407intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
35408mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
35409the message will be returned to you.
35410.endd
35411.vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
35412.vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
35413However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
35414appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
35415&$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
35416minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
35417of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
35418multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
35419handled them.
35420
35421
35422
35423
35424. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35425. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35426
35427.chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
35428This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
35429common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
35430
35431
35432
35433.section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
35434.cindex "smart host" "example router"
35435If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
35436should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
35437routing explicitly:
35438.code
35439send_to_smart_host:
35440 driver = manualroute
35441 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
35442 transport = remote_smtp
35443.endd
35444You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
35445If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
35446receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
35447synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
35448&<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
35449
35450
35451
35452
35453.section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
35454.cindex "mailing lists"
35455Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
35456requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
35457Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
35458
35459The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
35460is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
35461independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
35462lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
35463.code
35464lists:
35465 driver = redirect
35466 domains = lists.example
35467 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
35468 forbid_pipe
35469 forbid_file
35470 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
35471 no_more
35472.endd
35473This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
35474in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
35475such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
35476routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
35477
35478The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
35479expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
35480a mailing list.
35481
35482.oindex "&%errors_to%&"
35483The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
35484taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
35485original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
35486the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
35487
35488For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
35489&'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
35490&_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
35491&'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
35492There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
35493the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
35494such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
35495or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
35496&%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
35497
35498
35499
35500.section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
35501.cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
35502If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
35503delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
35504list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
35505list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
35506addresses are not rigorously checked.
35507
35508If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
35509entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
35510&%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
35511whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
35512&%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
35513
35514
35515
35516.section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
35517.cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
35518Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
35519in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
35520recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
35521cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
35522delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
35523account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
35524the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
35525message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
35526
35527If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
35528on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
35529router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
35530&"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
35531&"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
35532subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
35533failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
35534pre-existing messages.
35535
35536The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
35537addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
35538addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
35539&%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
35540one level of expansion anyway.
35541
35542
35543
35544.section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
35545.cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
35546The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
35547send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
35548from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
35549&%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
35550
35551The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
35552of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
35553.code
35554lists_request:
35555 driver = redirect
35556 domains = lists.example
35557 local_part_suffix = -request
35558 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
35559 no_more
35560
35561lists_post:
35562 driver = redirect
35563 domains = lists.example
35564 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
35565 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
35566 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
35567 forbid_pipe
35568 forbid_file
35569 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
35570 no_more
35571
35572lists_closed:
35573 driver = redirect
35574 domains = lists.example
35575 allow_fail
35576 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
35577.endd
35578All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
35579they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
35580&%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
35581mailing list.
35582
35583The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
35584checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
35585checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
35586necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
35587because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
35588not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
35589means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
35590&%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
35591&"unrouteable address"& error.
35592
35593The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
35594a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
35595the address, giving a suitable error message.
35596
35597
35598
35599
35600.section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
35601.cindex "VERP"
35602.cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
35603.cindex "envelope sender"
35604Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(https://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
35605are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
35606address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
35607the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
35608if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
35609original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
35610
35611.oindex &%errors_to%&
35612.oindex &%return_path%&
35613Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
35614facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
35615list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
35616these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
35617host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
35618of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
35619of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
35620.code
35621verp_smtp:
35622 driver = smtp
35623 max_rcpt = 1
35624 return_path = \
35625 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
35626 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
35627.endd
35628This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
35629SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
35630&"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
35631local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
35632example, that a message whose return path has been set to
35633&'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
35634&'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
35635rewritten as
35636.code
35637somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
35638.endd
35639.vindex "&$local_part$&"
35640For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
35641have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
35642achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
35643might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
35644&$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
35645
35646Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
35647probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
35648extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
35649can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
35650.code
35651dnslookup:
35652 driver = dnslookup
35653 domains = ! +local_domains
35654 transport = \
35655 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
35656 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
35657 no_more
35658.endd
35659If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
35660of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
35661routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
35662errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
35663address.
35664
35665On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
35666&(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
35667SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
35668and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
35669of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
35670.code
35671verp_dnslookup:
35672 driver = dnslookup
35673 domains = ! +local_domains
35674 transport = remote_smtp
35675 errors_to = \
35676 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
35677 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
35678 no_more
35679.endd
35680Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
35681configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
35682Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
35683router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
35684them.
35685
35686The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
35687message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
35688host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
35689a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
35690a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
35691than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
35692used).
35693
35694
35695
35696
35697
35698
35699.section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
35700.cindex "virtual domains"
35701.cindex "domain" "virtual"
35702The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
35703meanings:
35704
35705.ilist
35706A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
35707aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
35708top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
35709.next
35710One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
35711with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
35712have login accounts on that host.
35713.endlist
35714
35715The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
35716the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
35717aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
35718virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
35719whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
35720to a router of this form:
35721.code
35722virtual:
35723 driver = redirect
35724 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
35725 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
35726 no_more
35727.endd
35728The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
35729is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
35730domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
35731part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
35732setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
35733string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
35734
35735This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
35736follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
35737can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
35738a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
35739
35740The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
35741way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
35742valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
35743.code
35744my_domains:
35745 driver = accept
35746 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
35747 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
35748 transport = my_mailboxes
35749.endd
35750The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
35751can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
35752file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
35753option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
35754because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
35755follows:
35756.code
35757my_mailboxes:
35758 driver = appendfile
35759 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
35760 user = mail
35761.endd
35762This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
35763required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
35764
35765The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
35766requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
35767up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
35768information about the domains.
35769
35770
35771
35772.section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
35773.cindex "multiple mailboxes"
35774.cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
35775.cindex "local part" "prefix"
35776.cindex "local part" "suffix"
35777Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
35778incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
35779allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
35780identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
35781parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
35782&%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
35783example, consider this router:
35784.code
35785userforward:
35786 driver = redirect
35787 check_local_user
35788 file = $home/.forward
35789 local_part_suffix = -*
35790 local_part_suffix_optional
35791 allow_filter
35792.endd
35793.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
35794It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
35795&'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
35796cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
35797.code
35798if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
35799save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
35800endif
35801.endd
35802If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
35803fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
35804&%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
35805control over which suffixes are valid.
35806
35807Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
35808&_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
35809another MTA:
35810.code
35811userforward:
35812 driver = redirect
35813 check_local_user
35814 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
35815 local_part_suffix = -*
35816 local_part_suffix_optional
35817 allow_filter
35818.endd
35819If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
35820example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
35821does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
35822subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
35823&_.forward_& file to use as a default.
35824
35825
35826
35827.section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
35828.cindex "vacation processing"
35829The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
35830a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
35831(see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
35832This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
35833that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
35834
35835.ilist
35836A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
35837can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
35838alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
35839&_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
35840.code
35841spqr, vacation-spqr
35842.endd
35843.next
35844The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
35845vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
35846user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
35847ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
35848to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
35849message.
35850.endlist
35851
35852Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
35853use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
35854
35855
35856
35857.section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
35858.cindex "message" "copying every"
35859Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
35860be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
35861command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
35862each day's messages.
35863
35864There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
35865messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
35866delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
35867notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
35868
35869
35870
35871.section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
35872.cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
35873It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
35874Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
35875arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
35876permanently connected.
35877
35878Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
35879particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
35880Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
35881
35882
35883.section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
35884It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
35885host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
35886approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
35887being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
35888some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
35889to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
35890resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
35891
35892A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
35893intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
35894into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
35895format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
35896destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
35897in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
35898if required.
35899
35900On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
35901you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
35902intermittent host. For example:
35903.code
35904cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
35905.endd
35906This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
35907which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
35908online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
35909options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
35910causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
35911connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
35912immediately.
35913
35914If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
35915issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
35916mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
35917used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
35918avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
35919Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
35920arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
35921
35922
35923
35924.section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
35925The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
35926increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
35927connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
35928delivered immediately.
35929
35930.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
35931.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
35932.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
35933Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
35934not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
35935possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
35936each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
35937avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
35938&%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
35939first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
35940normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
35941destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
35942single SMTP connection.
35943
35944
35945
35946. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35947. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35948
35949.chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
35950 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
35951.cindex "client, non-queueing"
35952.cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
35953On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
35954email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
35955configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
35956However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
35957configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
35958&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
35959messages this way.
35960
35961If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
35962run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
35963any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
35964continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
35965email is not desirable.
35966
35967There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
35968&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
35969any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
35970host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
35971informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
35972to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
35973to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
35974
35975There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
35976that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
35977ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
35978before sending a message to the smart host.
35979
35980Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
35981tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
35982overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
35983
35984.oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
35985There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
35986Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
35987assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
35988just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
35989compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
35990router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
35991
35992When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
35993following ways:
35994
35995.ilist
35996A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
35997In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
35998.next
35999Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
36000assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
36001&%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
36002does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
36003successful, a zero return code is given.
36004.next
36005Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
36006be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
36007the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
36008must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
36009deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
36010are.
36011.next
36012If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
36013failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
36014successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
36015.next
36016Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
36017is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
36018smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
36019the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
36020there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
36021.next
36022If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
36023connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
36024failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
36025.next
36026When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
36027(as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
36028value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
36029are ever generated.
36030.next
36031No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
36032.next
36033A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
36034true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
36035&%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
36036.endlist
36037
36038The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
36039the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
36040deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
36041privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
36042to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
36043the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
36044
36045
36046
36047
36048. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36049. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36050
36051.chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
36052.scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
36053.cindex "log" "types of"
36054Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
36055and the panic log:
36056
36057.ilist
36058.cindex "main log"
36059The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
36060line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
36061down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
36062out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
36063them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
36064they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
36065analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
36066&<<SECTmailstat>>&).
36067.next
36068.cindex "reject log"
36069The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
36070of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
36071The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
36072the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
36073is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
36074lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
36075reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
36076host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
36077can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
36078false.
36079.next
36080.cindex "panic log"
36081.cindex "system log"
36082When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
36083error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
36084are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
36085other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
36086therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
36087regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
36088panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
36089is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
36090message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
36091.endlist
36092
36093Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
36094example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
36095In the log file, this would be all on one line:
36096.code
360972001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
36098 by QUIT
36099.endd
36100By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
36101ways of changing this:
36102
36103.ilist
36104You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
36105you set
36106.code
36107timezone = UTC
36108.endd
36109the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
36110.next
36111If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
36112example:
36113.code
361142003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
36115.endd
36116.endlist
36117
36118.cindex "log" "process ids in"
36119.cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
36120Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
36121request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
36122&<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
36123brackets, immediately after the time and date.
36124
36125
36126
36127
36128.section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
36129.cindex "log" "destination"
36130.cindex "log" "to file"
36131.cindex "log" "to syslog"
36132.cindex "syslog"
36133The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
36134should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
36135are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
36136arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
36137It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
36138need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
36139Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
36140
36141The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
36142&_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
36143configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
36144references to the host name:
36145.code
36146log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
36147.endd
36148It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
36149rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
36150start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
36151before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
36152configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
36153log at all.
36154
36155The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
36156list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
36157facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
36158colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
36159otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
36160point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
36161implying the use of a default path.
36162
36163When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
36164LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
36165&"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
36166mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
36167files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
36168equivalent to the setting:
36169.code
36170log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
36171.endd
36172If you do not specify anything at build time or run time,
36173or if you unset the option at run time (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
36174that is where the logs are written.
36175
36176A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log file names
36177are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
36178
36179Here are some examples of possible settings:
36180.display
36181&`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
36182&`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
36183&`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
36184&`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
36185.endd
36186If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
36187error is logged.
36188
36189
36190
36191.section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
36192.cindex "log" "cycling local files"
36193.cindex "cycling logs"
36194.cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
36195.cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
36196Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
36197log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
36198provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
36199main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
36200keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
36201
36202An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
36203and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
36204example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
36205message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
36206that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
36207something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
36208ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
36209&[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
36210does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
36211tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
36212for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
36213renamed.
36214
36215
36216
36217.section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
36218.cindex "log" "datestamped files"
36219Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
36220periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
36221for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
36222&_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
36223the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
36224point where the datestamp is required. For example:
36225.code
36226log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
36227log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
36228log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
36229log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
36230.endd
36231As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
36232examples of names generated by the above examples:
36233.code
36234/var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
36235/var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
36236/var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
36237/var/log/exim/main.200212
36238.endd
36239When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
36240files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
36241will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
36242run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
36243
36244The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
36245is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
36246When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
36247the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
36248non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
36249character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
36250log names:
36251.code
36252/var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
36253/var/log/exim-panic.log
36254/var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
36255/var/log/exim/panic
36256.endd
36257
36258
36259.section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
36260.cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
36261The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
36262except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
36263Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
36264that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
36265&"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
36266by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
36267&%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
36268SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
36269&_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
36270LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
36271the time and host name to each line.
36272The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
36273
36274.ilist
36275&'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
36276.next
36277&'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
36278.next
36279&'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
36280.endlist
36281
36282Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
36283written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
36284these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
36285by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
36286
36287Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
36288entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
36289these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
36290calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
36291870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
36292additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
36293replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
36294RFC 3164, you should set
36295.code
36296SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
36297.endd
36298in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
36299lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
36300
36301To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
36302entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
36303where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
36304components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
36305because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
36306delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
36307870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
36308&'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
36309name, and pid as added by syslog:
36310.code
36311[1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
36312[2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
36313[3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
36314[4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
36315[5/5] mple>)
36316.endd
36317The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
36318(LOG_NOTICE):
36319.code
36320[1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
36321[2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
36322[3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
36323[4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
36324[5\18] .example>)
36325[6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
36326[7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
36327[8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
36328[9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
36329[10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
36330[11\18] 09:43 +0100
36331[12\18] F From: <>
36332[13\18] Subject: this is a test header
36333[18\18] X-something: this is another header
36334[15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
36335[16\18] le>
36336[17\18] B Bcc:
36337[18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
36338.endd
36339Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
36340without modification.
36341
36342If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
36343display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
36344the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
36345where it is.
36346
36347
36348
36349.section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
36350One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
36351successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
36352picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
36353timestamp. The flags are:
36354.display
36355&`<=`& message arrival
36356&`(=`& message fakereject
36357&`=>`& normal message delivery
36358&`->`& additional address in same delivery
36359&`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
36360&`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
36361&`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
36362&`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
36363.endd
36364
36365
36366.section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
36367.cindex "log" "reception line"
36368The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
36369message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
36370several lines in order to fit it on the page:
36371.code
363722002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
36373 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
36374 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
36375.endd
36376The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
36377bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
36378generated, this is followed by an item of the form
36379.code
36380R=<message id>
36381.endd
36382which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
36383
36384.cindex "HELO"
36385.cindex "EHLO"
36386For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
36387record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
36388received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
36389host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
36390above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
36391&%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
36392by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
36393verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
36394EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
36395name in parentheses.
36396
36397Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
36398without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
36399the log containing text like these examples:
36400.code
36401H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
36402H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
36403.endd
36404This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
36405on.
36406
36407For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
36408the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
36409of Exim.
36410
36411.cindex "authentication" "logging"
36412.cindex "AUTH" "logging"
36413For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
36414message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
36415of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
36416extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
36417session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
36418suite that was used.
36419
36420.cindex log protocol
36421The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
36422hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
36423value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
36424there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
36425was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
36426&%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
36427authenticator name.
36428
36429.cindex "size" "of message"
36430The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
36431received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
36432headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
36433message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
36434other).
36435
36436The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
36437data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
36438
36439
36440
36441.section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
36442.cindex "log" "delivery line"
36443The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
36444delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
36445deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
36446to fit it on the page:
36447.code
364482002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
36449 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
364502002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
36451 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
36452 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
36453.endd
36454For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
36455after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
36456intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
36457last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
36458fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
36459
36460If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
36461followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
36462If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
36463option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
36464
36465If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
36466for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
36467.display
36468&`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
36469.endd
36470If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
36471parentheses afterwards.
36472
36473.cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
36474When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
36475SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
36476flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
36477down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
36478lines for the second and subsequent messages.
36479When two or more messages are delivered down a single TLS connection, the
36480DNS and some TLS-related information logged for the first message delivered
36481will not be present in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
36482TLS cipher information is still available.
36483
36484.cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
36485.cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
36486When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
36487line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
36488rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
36489
36490The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
36491&"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
36492
36493The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
36494data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
36495
36496
36497.section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
36498.cindex "discarded messages"
36499.cindex "message" "discarded"
36500.cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
36501When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
36502obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
36503.code
365042002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
36505 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
36506.endd
36507is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
36508because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
36509.code
365101999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
36511 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
36512.endd
36513
36514
36515.section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
36516When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
36517.code
365182002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
36519 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
36520.endd
36521In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
36522last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
36523written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
36524.code
365252002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
36526 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
36527.endd
36528When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
36529a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
36530appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
36531
36532
36533
36534.section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
36535.cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
36536If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
36537following form is logged:
36538.code
365391995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
36540 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
36541.endd
36542If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
36543the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
36544.code
365452002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
36546 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
36547 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
36548 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
36549 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
36550.endd
36551The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
36552used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
36553disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
36554flagged with &`**`&.
36555
36556
36557
36558.section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
36559.cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
36560If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
36561used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
36562&"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
36563
36564
36565
36566.section "Completion" "SECID257"
36567A line of the form
36568.code
365692002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
36570.endd
36571is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
36572at the end of its processing.
36573
36574
36575
36576
36577.section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
36578.cindex "log" "summary of fields"
36579A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
36580the following table:
36581.display
36582&`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
36583&`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
36584&` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
36585&`CV `& certificate verification status
36586&`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
36587&`DKIM`& domain verified in incoming message
36588&`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
36589&`DS `& DNSSEC secured lookups
36590&`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
36591&`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
36592&`H `& host name and IP address
36593&`I `& local interface used
36594&`id `& message id for incoming message
36595&`K `& CHUNKING extension used
36596&`L `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: PIPELINING extension used
36597&`M8S `& 8BITMIME status for incoming message
36598&`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
36599&` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
36600&`PRDR`& PRDR extension used
36601&`PRX `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: proxy address
36602&`Q `& alternate queue name
36603&`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
36604&` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
36605&`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
36606&` `& on &`=>`& &`>>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
36607&`RT `& on &`<=`& lines: time taken for reception
36608&`S `& size of message in bytes
36609&`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
36610&`ST `& shadow transport name
36611&`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
36612&`TFO `& connection took advantage of TCP Fast Open
36613&` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
36614&`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
36615&`X `& TLS cipher suite
36616.endd
36617
36618
36619.section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
36620Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
36621self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
36622
36623.ilist
36624.cindex "retry" "time not reached"
36625&'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
36626during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
36627This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
36628during the first delivery attempt.
36629.next
36630&'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
36631temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
36632for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
36633.next
36634.cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
36635&'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
36636some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
36637common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
36638&'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
36639doing.
36640.next
36641.cindex "error" "ignored"
36642&'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
36643message:
36644.olist
36645Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
36646&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
36647.next
36648A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
36649failed. The delivery was discarded.
36650.next
36651A delivery set up by a router configured with
36652. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
36653. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
36654.code
36655 errors_to = <>
36656.endd
36657failed. The delivery was discarded.
36658.endlist olist
36659.next
36660.cindex DKIM "log line"
36661&'DKIM: d='&&~&~Verbose results of a DKIM verification attempt, if enabled for
36662logging and the message has a DKIM signature header.
36663.endlist ilist
36664
36665
36666
36667
36668
36669.section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
36670.cindex "log" "selectors"
36671By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
36672default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
36673&%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
36674example:
36675.code
36676log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
36677.endd
36678The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
36679selection marked by asterisks:
36680.display
36681&` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
36682&`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
36683&` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
36684&` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
36685&` arguments `& command line arguments
36686&`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
36687&`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
36688&` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
36689&` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
36690&`*dkim `& DKIM verified domain on <= lines
36691&` dkim_verbose `& separate full DKIM verification result line, per signature
36692&`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
36693&` dnssec `& DNSSEC secured lookups
36694&`*etrn `& ETRN commands
36695&`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
36696&` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
36697&` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
36698&` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
36699&`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
36700&` millisec `& millisecond timestamps and RT,QT,DT,D times
36701&` outgoing_interface `& local interface on => lines
36702&` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
36703&`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
36704&` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
36705&` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
36706&` pid `& Exim process id
36707&` pipelining `& PIPELINING use, on <= and => lines
36708&` proxy `& proxy address on <= and => lines
36709&` receive_time `& time taken to receive message
36710&` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
36711&` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
36712&`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
36713&`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
36714&` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
36715&` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
36716&`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
36717&`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
36718&`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
36719&`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
36720&` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
36721&` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
36722&` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
36723&` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
36724&` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
36725&` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
36726&` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
36727&`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
36728&`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
36729&` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
36730&` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
36731&` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
36732
36733&` all `& all of the above
36734.endd
36735See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
36736section &<<SECID99>>&
36737
36738More details on each of these items follows:
36739
36740.ilist
36741.cindex "8BITMIME"
36742.cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
36743&%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
36744which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
36745that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
36746&`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
36747&`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
36748.next
36749.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
36750&%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
36751its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
36752this log selector is set.
36753.next
36754.cindex "log" "rewriting"
36755.cindex "rewriting" "logging"
36756&%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
36757rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
36758such users cannot access the log).
36759.next
36760.cindex "log" "full parentage"
36761&%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
36762delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
36763parentheses between them.
36764.next
36765.cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
36766.cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
36767&%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
36768to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
36769feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
36770&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
36771privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
36772that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
36773are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
36774because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
36775only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
36776between the caller and Exim.
36777.next
36778.cindex "log" "connection rejections"
36779&%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
36780connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
36781.next
36782.cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
36783.cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
36784&%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
36785started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
36786messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
36787process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
36788.next
36789.cindex "log" "delivery duration"
36790&%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
36791perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
36792If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
36793precision, eg. &`DT=0.304s`&.
36794.next
36795.cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
36796.cindex "size" "of message"
36797&%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
36798the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
36799.next
36800.cindex log "DKIM verification"
36801.cindex DKIM "verification logging"
36802&%dkim%&: For message acceptance log lines, when an DKIM signature in the header
36803verifies successfully a tag of DKIM is added, with one of the verified domains.
36804.next
36805.cindex log "DKIM verification"
36806.cindex DKIM "verification logging"
36807&%dkim_verbose%&: A log entry is written for each attempted DKIM verification.
36808.next
36809.cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
36810.cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
36811.cindex "black list (DNS)"
36812&%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
36813DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
36814.next
36815.cindex log dnssec
36816.cindex dnssec logging
36817&%dnssec%&: For message acceptance and (attempted) delivery log lines, when
36818dns lookups gave secure results a tag of DS is added.
36819For acceptance this covers the reverse and forward lookups for host name verification.
36820It does not cover helo-name verification.
36821For delivery this covers the SRV, MX, A and/or AAAA lookups.
36822.next
36823.cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
36824.cindex "ETRN" "logging"
36825&%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
36826is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
36827command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
36828selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
36829.next
36830.cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
36831&%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
36832any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
36833log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
36834routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
36835.next
36836.cindex "log" "ident timeout"
36837.cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
36838&%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
36839client's ident port times out.
36840.next
36841.cindex "log" "incoming interface"
36842.cindex "log" "local interface"
36843.cindex "log" "local address and port"
36844.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
36845.cindex "interface" "logging"
36846&%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
36847to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
36848followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
36849added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, to
36850rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing &"=>"& and &"->"& lines.
36851The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
36852.next
36853.cindex log "incoming proxy address"
36854.cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
36855.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
36856&%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
36857of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
36858on a proxied connection
36859or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection.
36860See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
36861.next
36862.cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
36863.cindex "port" "logging remote"
36864.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
36865.vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
36866.vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
36867&%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
36868added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
36869in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
36870changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
36871&$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
36872important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
36873.next
36874.cindex "log" "dropped connection"
36875&%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
36876connection is unexpectedly dropped.
36877.next
36878.cindex "log" "millisecond timestamps"
36879.cindex millisecond logging
36880.cindex timestamps "millisecond, in logs"
36881&%millisec%&: Timestamps have a period and three decimal places of finer granularity
36882appended to the seconds value.
36883.next
36884.cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
36885.cindex "log" "local interface"
36886.cindex "log" "local address and port"
36887.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
36888.cindex "interface" "logging"
36889&%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
36890interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
36891followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
36892off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
36893.next
36894.cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
36895.cindex "port" "logging outgoing remote"
36896.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging outgoing remote port"
36897&%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
36898containing => tags) following the IP address.
36899The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
36900&%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
36901This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
36902configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
36903local port is a random ephemeral port.
36904.next
36905.cindex "log" "process ids in"
36906.cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
36907&%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
36908immediately after the time and date.
36909.next
36910.new
36911.cindex log pipelining
36912.cindex pipelining "logging outgoing"
36913&%pipelining%&: A field is added to delivery and accept
36914log lines when the ESMTP PIPELINING extension was used.
36915The field is a single "L".
36916On accept lines, where PIPELINING was offered but not used by the client,
36917the field has a minus appended.
36918.next
36919.cindex "log" "queue run"
36920.cindex "queue runner" "logging"
36921&%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
36922.next
36923.cindex "log" "queue time"
36924&%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
36925local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
36926&`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
36927includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
36928This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
36929delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
36930message has been successfully received.
36931If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
36932precision, eg. &`QT=1.578s`&.
36933.next
36934&%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
36935the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
36936example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
36937message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
36938.next
36939.cindex "log" "receive duration"
36940&%receive_time%&: For each message, the amount of real time it has taken to
36941perform the reception is logged as RT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`RT=1s`&.
36942If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
36943precision, eg. &`RT=0.204s`&.
36944.next
36945.cindex "log" "recipients"
36946&%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
36947as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
36948that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
36949addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
36950has taken place.
36951Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
36952in the list.
36953.next
36954.cindex "log" "sender reception"
36955&%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
36956the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
36957&"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
36958.next
36959.cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
36960&%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
36961rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
36962log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
36963rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
36964.next
36965.cindex "log" "retry defer"
36966&%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
36967retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
36968message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
36969attempt.
36970.next
36971.cindex "log" "return path"
36972&%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
36973the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
36974This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
36975or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
36976.next
36977.cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
36978&%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
36979and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
36980This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
36981necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
36982.next
36983.cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
36984&%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
36985gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
36986the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
36987detail is lost.
36988.next
36989.cindex "log" "size rejection"
36990&%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
36991it is too big.
36992.next
36993.cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
36994.cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
36995&%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
36996queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
36997it.
36998.cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
36999The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
37000.next
37001.cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
37002.cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
37003.cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
37004&%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
37005outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
37006A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
37007response.
37008.next
37009.cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
37010.cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
37011&%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
37012established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
37013&%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
37014only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
37015processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
37016dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
37017not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
37018of connections unless this selector is enabled.
37019
37020For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
37021included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
37022reset if the daemon is restarted.
37023Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
37024subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
37025whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
37026match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
37027logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
37028.next
37029.cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
37030.cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
37031&%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
37032RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
37033and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
37034line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
37035.next
37036.cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
37037.cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
37038&%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
37039connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
37040the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
37041does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
37042an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
37043already have their own log lines.
37044
37045The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
37046way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
37047If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
37048an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
37049DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
37050the same logging options.
37051
37052Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
37053is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
37054.code
37055C=EHLO,QUIT
37056.endd
37057shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
37058than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
37059the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
37060setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
37061have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
37062.next
37063&%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
37064colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
37065log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
37066was accepted or used.
37067.next
37068.cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
37069.cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
37070&%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
37071encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
37072because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
37073been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
37074it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
37075received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
37076.next
37077.cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
37078.cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
37079.cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
37080.cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
37081.cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
37082&%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
37083encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
37084external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
37085using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
37086.next
37087.cindex "log" "subject"
37088.cindex "subject, logging"
37089&%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
37090preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
37091Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
37092specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
37093unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
37094.next
37095.cindex "log" "certificate verification"
37096.cindex log DANE
37097.cindex DANE logging
37098&%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
37099when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
37100verified
37101using a CA trust anchor,
37102&`CA=dane`& if using a DNS trust anchor,
37103and &`CV=no`& if not.
37104.next
37105.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
37106.cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
37107&%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
37108connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
37109.next
37110.cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
37111.cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
37112&%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
37113connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
37114added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
37115.next
37116.cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
37117.cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
37118&%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
37119the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
37120added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
37121.next
37122.cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
37123&%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
37124result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
37125.endlist
37126
37127
37128.section "Message log" "SECID260"
37129.cindex "message" "log file for"
37130.cindex "log" "message log; description of"
37131.cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
37132.oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
37133In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
37134that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
37135they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
37136message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
37137makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
37138to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
37139is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
37140only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
37141
37142On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
37143per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
37144&%message_logs%& option false.
37145.ecindex IIDloggen
37146
37147
37148
37149
37150. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37151. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37152
37153.chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
37154.scindex IIDutils "utilities"
37155A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
37156described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
37157the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
37158
37159.itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
37160.irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
37161 "list what Exim processes are doing"
37162.irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
37163.irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
37164.irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
37165.irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
37166 various criteria"
37167.irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
37168.irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
37169 "extract statistics from the log"
37170.irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
37171 "check address acceptance from given IP"
37172.irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
37173.irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
37174.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
37175.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
37176.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
37177.irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
37178.endtable
37179
37180Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
37181&'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
37182&url(https://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
37183
37184
37185
37186
37187.section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
37188.cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
37189.cindex "process, querying"
37190.cindex "SIGUSR1"
37191On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
37192(most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
37193a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
37194Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
37195processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
37196second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
37197order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
37198send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
37199
37200&*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
37201use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
37202script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
37203
37204
37205Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
37206varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
37207but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
37208system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
37209it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
37210options:
37211.display
37212&`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
37213&`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
37214&`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
37215&`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
37216.endd
37217An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
37218.code
37219164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
3722010483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
3722110492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
37222 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
3722310592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
3722410628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
37225.endd
37226The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
37227been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
37228
37229
37230
37231.section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
37232.cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
37233.cindex "queue" "grepping"
37234This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
37235.code
37236exim -bpu
37237.endd
37238or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
37239.code
37240exim -bp
37241.endd
37242The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
37243contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
37244
37245to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
37246that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
37247
37248.vlist
37249.vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
37250Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
37251tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
37252.code
37253exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
37254.endd
37255.vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
37256Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
37257tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
37258
37259.vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
37260Match against the size field.
37261
37262.vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
37263Match messages that are younger than the given time.
37264
37265.vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
37266Match messages that are older than the given time.
37267
37268.vitem &*-z*&
37269Match only frozen messages.
37270
37271.vitem &*-x*&
37272Match only non-frozen messages.
37273.endlist
37274
37275The following options control the format of the output:
37276
37277.vlist
37278.vitem &*-c*&
37279Display only the count of matching messages.
37280
37281.vitem &*-l*&
37282Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
37283the default.
37284
37285.vitem &*-i*&
37286Display message ids only.
37287
37288.vitem &*-b*&
37289Brief format &-- one line per message.
37290
37291.vitem &*-R*&
37292Display messages in reverse order.
37293
37294.vitem &*-a*&
37295Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
37296.endlist
37297
37298There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
37299
37300
37301
37302.section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
37303.cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
37304.cindex "queue" "summary"
37305The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
37306-bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
37307running a command such as
37308.code
37309exim -bp | exiqsumm
37310.endd
37311The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
37312it, as in the following example:
37313.code
373143 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
37315.endd
37316Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
37317volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
37318been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
37319number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
37320
37321A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
37322domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
37323the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
37324respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
37325domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
37326separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
37327sender.
37328
37329The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
37330this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
37331generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
37332option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
37333level"& addresses).
37334
37335
37336
37337
37338.section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
37339 "SECTextspeinf"
37340.cindex "&'exigrep'&"
37341.cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
37342The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
37343files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
37344extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
37345match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
37346given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
37347The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
37348If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
37349included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
37350.display
37351&`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
37352.endd
37353If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
37354
37355The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
37356condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
37357they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
37358
37359By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
37360makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
37361large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
37362option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
37363case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
37364
37365The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
37366pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
37367regular expression.
37368
37369The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
37370if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
37371
37372The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
37373that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
37374normally.
37375
37376Example of &%-M%&:
37377user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
37378&'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
37379displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
37380the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
37381when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
37382&"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
37383search term.
37384
37385If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
37386ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
37387whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
37388If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
37389autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
37390
37391
37392.section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
37393.cindex "&'exipick'&"
37394John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
37395lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
37396of &'exipick'&'s facilities, run &'exipick'& with
37397the &%--help%& option.
37398
37399
37400.section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
37401.cindex "log" "cycling local files"
37402.cindex "cycling logs"
37403.cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
37404The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
37405&'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
37406you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
37407&<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
37408for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
37409There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
37410.ilist
37411&%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
37412default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
37413.next
37414&%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
37415&%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
37416overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
37417configuration.
37418.endlist
37419
37420Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
37421the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
37422run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
37423&_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
37424&%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
37425logs are handled similarly.
37426
37427If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
37428&_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
37429to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
37430any existing log files.
37431
37432If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
37433the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
37434using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
37435setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
37436root &%crontab%& entry of the form
37437.code
374381 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
37439.endd
37440assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
37441&'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
37442
37443
37444
37445.section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
37446.cindex "statistics"
37447.cindex "&'eximstats'&"
37448A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
37449information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
37450. --- 2018-09-07: LogReport's Lire appears to be dead; website is a Yahoo Japan
37451. --- 404 error and everything else points to that.
37452
37453The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
37454latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
37455lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
37456various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
37457list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
37458.code
37459eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
37460.endd
37461By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
37462messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
37463both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
37464are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
37465addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
37466options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
37467also produced per user.
37468
37469The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
37470histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
37471hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
37472example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
37473as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
37474
37475Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
37476have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
37477messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
37478and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
37479recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
37480an entirely separate message.
37481
37482&'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
37483of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
37484each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
37485not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
37486least one address that failed.
37487
37488The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
37489or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
37490transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
37491(default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
37492a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
37493senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
37494and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
37495
37496The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
37497came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
37498without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
37499
37500There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
37501outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
37502by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
37503.code
37504perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
37505.endd
37506
37507.section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
37508.cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
37509.cindex "policy control" "checking access"
37510.cindex "checking access"
37511The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
37512debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
37513policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
37514familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
37515sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
37516access?"& without bothering with any further details.
37517
37518The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
37519two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
37520.code
37521exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
37522.endd
37523The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
37524given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
37525connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
37526is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
37527.code
37528Rejected:
37529550 Relay not permitted
37530.endd
37531When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
37532for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
37533options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
37534that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
37535you can use:
37536.code
37537exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
37538 -f himself@there.example
37539.endd
37540Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
37541mandatory arguments.
37542
37543Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
37544while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
37545&%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
37546
37547
37548
37549.section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
37550.cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
37551.cindex "building DBM files"
37552.cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
37553.cindex "lower casing"
37554.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
37555The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
37556the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
37557&<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
37558names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
37559can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
37560
37561A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
37562the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
37563&'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
37564strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
37565files.
37566
37567The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
37568single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
37569It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
37570well.
37571
37572.cindex "USE_DB"
37573If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
37574configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
37575names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
37576a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
37577.code
37578exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
37579.endd
37580reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
37581&_/etc/aliases.db_&.
37582
37583In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
37584Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
37585environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
37586&'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
37587when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
37588recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
37589
37590If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
37591finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
37592option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
37593this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
37594&%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
37595There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
37596&%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
37597return code is 2.
37598
37599
37600
37601
37602.section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
37603.cindex "retry" "times"
37604.cindex "&'exinext'&"
37605A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
37606fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
37607complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
37608information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
37609is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
37610output. For example:
37611.code
37612$ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
37613kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
37614 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
37615 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
37616 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
37617roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
37618 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
37619 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
37620 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
37621 past final cutoff time
37622.endd
37623You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
37624will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
37625A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
37626message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
37627suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
37628&'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
37629run very often.
37630
37631The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
37632of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
37633passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
37634configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
37635file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
37636environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
37637
37638
37639
37640.section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
37641.cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
37642.cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
37643Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
37644uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
37645arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
37646second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
37647
37648.ilist
37649&'retry'&: the database of retry information
37650.next
37651&'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
37652for remote hosts
37653.next
37654&'callout'&: the callout cache
37655.next
37656&'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
37657.next
37658&'misc'&: other hints data
37659.endlist
37660
37661The &'misc'& database is used for
37662
37663.ilist
37664Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
37665.next
37666Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
37667&(smtp)& transport)
37668.next
37669Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
37670in a transport)
37671.endlist
37672
37673
37674
37675.section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
37676.cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
37677The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
37678&'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
37679spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
37680.code
37681exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
37682.endd
37683Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
37684.code
37685T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
3768631-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
37687.endd
37688The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
37689of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
37690transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
37691a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
37692address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
37693transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
37694to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
37695and a textual description of the error.
37696
37697The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
37698the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
37699ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
37700exceeded.
37701
37702Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
37703consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
37704waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
37705one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
37706may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
37707may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
37708cross-references.
37709
37710
37711
37712.section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
37713.cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
37714The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
37715database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
37716days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
37717updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
37718since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
37719for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
37720updated sufficiently often.
37721
37722The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
37723followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
37724the retry database:
37725.code
37726exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
37727.endd
37728Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
37729message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
37730they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
37731are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
37732types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
37733message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
37734queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
37735&'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
37736For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
37737removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
37738whenever it removes information from the database.
37739
37740Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
37741needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
37742down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
37743first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
37744records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
37745
37746It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
37747hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
37748a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
37749work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
37750but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
37751After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
37752point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
37753tidied.
37754
37755&*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
37756databases is likely to keep on increasing.
37757
37758
37759
37760
37761.section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
37762.cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
37763The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
37764Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
37765getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
37766is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
37767key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
37768displayed.
37769
37770If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
37771except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
37772out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
37773data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
37774by new data, for example:
37775.code
37776> 4 951102:1000
37777.endd
37778resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
37779sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
37780used as optional separators.
37781
37782
37783
37784
37785.section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
37786.cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
37787.cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
37788.cindex "locking mailboxes"
37789The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
37790Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
37791&'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
37792a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
37793the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
37794argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
37795second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
37796is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
37797is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
37798
37799.vlist
37800.vitem &%-fcntl%&
37801Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
37802
37803.vitem &%-flock%&
37804Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
37805supports it.
37806
37807.vitem &%-interval%&
37808This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
37809interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
37810
37811.vitem &%-lockfile%&
37812Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
37813
37814.vitem &%-mbx%&
37815Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
37816
37817.vitem &%-q%&
37818Suppress verification output.
37819
37820.vitem &%-retries%&
37821This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
37822the lock (default 10).
37823
37824.vitem &%-restore_time%&
37825This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
37826locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
37827example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
37828subsequently sees.
37829
37830.vitem &%-timeout%&
37831This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
37832timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
37833default), a non-blocking call is used.
37834
37835.vitem &%-v%&
37836Generate verbose output.
37837.endlist
37838
37839If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
37840default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
37841mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
37842&%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
37843requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
37844file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
37845more than 30 minutes old.
37846
37847The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
37848&%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
37849to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
37850&_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
37851number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
37852can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
37853
37854The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
37855&%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
37856suppresses all output except error messages.
37857
37858A command such as
37859.code
37860exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
37861.endd
37862runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
37863.display
37864&`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
37865<&'some commands'&>
37866&`End`&
37867.endd
37868runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
37869suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
37870such as
37871.code
37872exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
37873 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
37874.endd
37875Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
37876second argument &-- hence the quotes.
37877.ecindex IIDutils
37878
37879
37880. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37881. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37882
37883.chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
37884.scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
37885.cindex "X-windows"
37886.cindex "&'eximon'&"
37887.cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
37888.cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
37889The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
37890about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
37891perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
37892such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
37893monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
37894
37895
37896
37897.section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
37898The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
37899script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
37900binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
37901be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
37902&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
37903parameters are for.
37904
37905The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
37906a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
37907preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
37908.code
37909EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
37910.endd
37911(in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
37912the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
37913overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
37914&'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
37915syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
37916
37917X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
37918way. For example, a resource setting of the form
37919.code
37920Eximon*background: gray94
37921.endd
37922changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
37923stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
37924black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
37925data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
37926&"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
37927For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
37928reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
37929.code
37930xrdb -merge <<End
37931Eximon*highlight: gray
37932End
37933.endd
37934.cindex "admin user"
37935In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
37936&'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
37937
37938The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
37939contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
37940if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
37941binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
37942versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
37943
37944The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
37945more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
37946main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
37947delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
37948different parts of the display.
37949
37950
37951
37952
37953.section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
37954.cindex "stripchart"
37955The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
37956be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
37957&_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
37958configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
37959it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
37960hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
37961received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
37962period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
37963parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
37964
37965The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
37966displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
37967title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
37968For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
37969
37970It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
37971a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
37972to a single partition.
37973
37974.cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
37975This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
37976the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
37977this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
37978100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
37979SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
37980&_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
37981
37982
37983
37984
37985.section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
37986.cindex "size" "of monitor window"
37987.cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
37988.cindex "window size"
37989Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
37990to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
37991shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
37992stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
37993the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
37994in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
37995
37996When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
37997currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
37998size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
37999remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
38000
38001The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
38002stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
38003the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
38004The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
38005&'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
38006the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38007
38008Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
38009built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
38010START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38011
38012
38013
38014.section "The log display" "SECID267"
38015.cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
38016The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
38017the main log is maintained.
38018To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
38019removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
38020The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
38021syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
38022to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
38023
38024The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
38025move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
38026scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
38027LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
38028to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
38029much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
38030a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
38031only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
38032available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
38033normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
38034configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38035
38036Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
38037and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
38038respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
38039It cannot go further back up the log.
38040
38041The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
38042normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
38043by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
38044by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
38045back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
38046the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
38047
38048Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
38049There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
38050the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
38051happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
38052&"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
38053^C is typed the search is cancelled.
38054
38055The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
38056widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
38057&"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
38058eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
38059However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
38060provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
38061come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
38062unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
38063on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
38064window.
38065
38066
38067
38068.section "The queue display" "SECID268"
38069.cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
38070The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
38071are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
38072as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
38073parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
38074at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
38075the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
38076there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
38077to force an update of the queue display at any time.
38078
38079When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
38080and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
38081with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
38082pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
38083type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
38084such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
38085of the texts, the message is not displayed.
38086
38087If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
38088are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
38089example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
38090&'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
38091has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
38092cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
38093a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
38094
38095While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
38096else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
38097queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
38098pressing the &"Hide"& button.
38099
38100The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
38101time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
38102message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
38103a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
38104recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
38105listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
38106an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
38107not shown.
38108
38109.cindex "frozen messages" "display"
38110If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
38111
38112The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
38113of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
38114The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
38115available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
38116display is updated.
38117
38118
38119
38120.section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
38121.cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
38122If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
38123pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
38124line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
38125any selected text.
38126
38127If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
38128MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
38129set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
38130value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
38131run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
38132.code
38133EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
38134.endd
38135The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
38136follows:
38137
38138.ilist
38139&'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
38140in a new text window.
38141.next
38142&'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
38143information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
38144&<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
38145.next
38146&'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
38147displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
38148amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
38149option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
38150.next
38151&'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
38152delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
38153frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
38154a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
38155up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
38156.next
38157&'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
38158that the message be frozen.
38159.next
38160.cindex "thawing messages"
38161.cindex "unfreezing messages"
38162.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
38163&'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
38164that the message be thawed.
38165.next
38166.cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
38167&'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
38168that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
38169for any remaining undelivered addresses.
38170.next
38171&'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
38172that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
38173message.
38174.next
38175&'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
38176be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
38177is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
38178Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
38179causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
38180additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
38181which case no action is taken.
38182.next
38183&'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
38184can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
38185is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
38186Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
38187causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
38188recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
38189case no action is taken.
38190.next
38191&'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
38192mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
38193.next
38194&'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
38195sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
38196&%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
38197in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
38198bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
38199not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
38200the address is qualified with that domain.
38201.endlist
38202
38203When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
38204other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
38205particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
38206output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
38207from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
38208&_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
38209if no output is generated.
38210
38211The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
38212thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
38213&_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
38214force an update of the display after one of these actions.
38215
38216In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
38217cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
38218and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
38219.ecindex IIDeximon
38220
38221
38222
38223
38224
38225. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38226. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38227
38228.chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
38229.scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
38230This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
38231which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
38232
38233For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
38234Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
38235existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
38236chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
38237security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
38238its security as compared with other MTAs.
38239
38240What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
38241have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
38242absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
38243as soon as possible.
38244
38245
38246.section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
38247.cindex "security" "build-time features"
38248There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
38249to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
38250Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
38251penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
38252
38253.ilist
38254ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
38255start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
38256names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
38257value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
38258&_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
38259default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
38260
38261If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
38262which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
38263into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
38264configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
38265.next
38266
38267If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
38268or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
38269file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
38270the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
38271root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
38272right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
38273reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
38274it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
38275privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
38276separate commands.
38277
38278.next
38279The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
38280with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
38281CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
38282requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
38283the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
38284but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
38285previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
38286.next
38287If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
38288is disabled.
38289.next
38290FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
38291never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
38292option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
38293to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
38294is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
38295.endlist
38296
38297
38298
38299.section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
38300.cindex "setuid"
38301.cindex "root privilege"
38302The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
38303privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
38304example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
38305may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
38306discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
38307is required for two things:
38308
38309.ilist
38310To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
38311the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
38312not required.
38313.next
38314To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
38315perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
38316configuration.
38317.endlist
38318
38319It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
38320receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
38321obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
38322For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
38323&_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
38324group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
38325is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
38326&'mail'& or another user name altogether.
38327
38328Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
38329abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
38330&[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
38331
38332After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
38333uid and gid in the following cases:
38334
38335.ilist
38336.oindex "&%-C%&"
38337.oindex "&%-D%&"
38338If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
38339the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
38340calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
38341the calling process.
38342However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
38343option may not be used at all.
38344If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
38345can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
38346user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
38347.next
38348.oindex "&%-be%&"
38349.oindex "&%-bf%&"
38350.oindex "&%-bF%&"
38351If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
38352(&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
38353calling process.
38354.next
38355If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
38356process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
38357uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
38358runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
38359testing address verification
38360.oindex "&%-bv%&"
38361.oindex "&%-bh%&"
38362(the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
38363option).
38364.next
38365For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
38366remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
38367.endlist
38368
38369The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
38370
38371.ilist
38372A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
38373user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
38374function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
38375will be used during message reception.
38376.next
38377A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
38378job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
38379.next
38380A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
38381but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
38382subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
38383deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
38384remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
38385subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
38386while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
38387generating bounce and warning messages.
38388
38389While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
38390process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
38391this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
38392gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
38393.next
38394A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
38395the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
38396.endlist
38397
38398
38399
38400
38401.section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
38402.cindex "privilege, running without"
38403.cindex "unprivileged running"
38404.cindex "root privilege" "running without"
38405Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
38406operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
38407by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
38408gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
38409(and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
38410routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
38411to any other uid.
38412
38413.cindex SIGHUP
38414.cindex "daemon" "restarting"
38415Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
38416that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
38417correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
38418
38419An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
38420to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
38421process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
38422when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
38423SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
38424
38425It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
38426stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
38427been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
38428effect.
38429
38430If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
38431set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
38432to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
38433
38434In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
38435those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
38436Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
38437that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
38438discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
38439have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
38440number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
38441address this problem at this time.
38442
38443For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
38444is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
38445&%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
38446be used in the most straightforward way.
38447
38448If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
38449number of restrictions on what you can do:
38450
38451.ilist
38452You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
38453&%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
38454normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
38455work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
38456explicit specification of another user causes an error.
38457.next
38458Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
38459not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
38460.next
38461Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
38462the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
38463and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
38464enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
38465.next
38466Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
38467some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
38468
38469.olist
38470They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
38471implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
38472mode of the mailbox files themselves.
38473.next
38474You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
38475owned by the Exim user.
38476.next
38477You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
38478on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
38479mailboxes need to be created manually.
38480.endlist olist
38481.endlist ilist
38482
38483
38484These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
38485However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
38486gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
38487gives more security at essentially no cost.
38488
38489If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
38490&<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
38491
38492
38493
38494
38495.section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
38496Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
38497are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
38498
38499
38500
38501.section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
38502.cindex "security" "local commands"
38503.cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
38504There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
38505commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
38506configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
38507run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
38508
38509.ilist
38510Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
38511injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
38512be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
38513allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
38514has &%use_shell%& enabled.
38515.next
38516A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
38517&%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
38518&_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
38519hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
38520NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
38521forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
38522need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
38523.next
38524The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
38525administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
38526Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
38527.next
38528Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
38529taint checking might apply to their usage.
38530.next
38531Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
38532administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
38533instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
38534.next
38535Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
38536Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
38537each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
38538of opaque strings.
38539The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
38540real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
38541injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
38542Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
38543.endlist
38544
38545
38546
38547
38548.section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
38549.cindex "security" "data sources"
38550.cindex "security" "regular expressions"
38551.cindex "regular expressions" "security"
38552.cindex "PCRE" "security"
38553If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
38554are some issues to be aware of:
38555
38556.ilist
38557Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
38558.next
38559Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
38560.next
38561Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
38562data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
38563"backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
38564expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
38565when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
38566possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
38567data.
38568.next
38569It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
38570&%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
38571items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
38572.next
38573Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
38574expected to yield one result.
38575.endlist
38576
38577
38578
38579
38580.section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
38581.cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
38582.cindex "IP source routing"
38583Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
38584some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
38585IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
38586IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
38587
38588
38589
38590.section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
38591Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
38592be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
38593
38594
38595
38596
38597.section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
38598.cindex "trusted users"
38599.cindex "admin user"
38600.cindex "privileged user"
38601.cindex "user" "trusted"
38602.cindex "user" "admin"
38603Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
38604able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
38605addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
38606local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
38607permit a remote host to be specified.
38608
38609.oindex "&%-f%&"
38610However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
38611in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
38612message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
38613but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
38614permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
38615the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
38616
38617Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
38618other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
38619the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
38620as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
38621group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
38622
38623Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
38624can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
38625them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
38626the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
38627includes the contents of files on the spool.
38628
38629.oindex "&%-M%&"
38630.oindex "&%-q%&"
38631By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
38632delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
38633restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
38634Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
38635queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
38636setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
38637
38638Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
38639the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
38640the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
38641group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
38642the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
38643unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
38644files.
38645
38646By default, regular users are trusted to perform basic testing and
38647introspection commands, as themselves. This setting can be tightened by
38648setting the &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& option.
38649This affects most of the checking options,
38650such as &%-be%& and anything else &%-b*%&.
38651
38652
38653.section "Spool files" "SECID275"
38654.cindex "spool directory" "files"
38655Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
38656set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
38657&_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
38658any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
38659
38660
38661
38662.section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
38663Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
38664of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
38665with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
38666to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
38667this.
38668
38669
38670
38671.section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
38672The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
38673are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
38674Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
38675converted output.
38676
38677
38678
38679.section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
38680Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
38681to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
38682does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
38683arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
38684
38685
38686
38687.section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
38688Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
38689defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
38690loading it.
38691
38692
38693.section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
38694.cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
38695A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
38696&'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
38697The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
38698that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
38699conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
38700
38701The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
38702the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
38703string.
38704
38705
38706
38707.section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
38708Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
38709formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
38710the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
38711
38712
38713
38714.section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
38715These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
38716enough to hold the result.
38717.ecindex IIDsecurcon
38718
38719
38720
38721
38722. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38723. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38724
38725.chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
38726.scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
38727.scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
38728.scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
38729.cindex "spool files" "editing"
38730A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
38731followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
38732the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
38733kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
38734two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
38735is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
38736themselves are recoverable.
38737
38738.new
38739The file formats may be changed, or new formats added, at any release.
38740Spool files are not intended as an interface to other programs
38741and should not be used as such.
38742.wen
38743
38744Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
38745need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
38746on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
38747
38748.ilist
38749You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
38750fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
38751which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
38752place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
38753lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
38754.next
38755.vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
38756If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
38757&$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect and can
38758cause incomplete transmission of messages or undeliverable messages.
38759.next
38760If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
38761.next
38762If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
38763signature.
38764.endlist
38765All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
38766
38767Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
38768its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
38769files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
38770the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
38771the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
38772is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
38773file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
38774-J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
38775attempt.
38776
38777Files whose names end with -K or .eml may also be seen in the spool.
38778These are temporaries used for DKIM or malware processing, when that is used.
38779They should be tidied up by normal operations; any old ones are probably
38780relics of crashes and can be removed.
38781
38782.section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
38783.cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
38784.cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
38785The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
38786process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
38787gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
38788message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
38789normally the Exim user.
38790
38791The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
38792transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
38793empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
38794in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
38795created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
38796&%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
38797leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
38798&"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
38799
38800The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
38801was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
38802start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
38803warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
38804
38805There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
38806order, and are omitted when not relevant:
38807
38808.vlist
38809.vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
38810This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
38811&%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
38812recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
38813this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
38814identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
38815the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
38816the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
38817the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
38818newlines.
38819
38820.vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
38821A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
38822defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
38823The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
38824starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
38825character. It may contain internal newlines.
38826
38827.vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
38828A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
38829Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
38830length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
38831starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
38832character. It may contain internal newlines.
38833
38834.vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
38835This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
38836&$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
38837
38838.vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
38839This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
38840lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
38841transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
38842messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
38843
38844.vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
38845This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
38846(to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
38847time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
38848hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
38849
38850.vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
38851The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
38852&-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
38853
38854.vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
38855The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
38856&$authenticated_sender$& variable.
38857
38858.vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
38859This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is
38860present unless &%-spool_file_wireformat%& is.
38861
38862.vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
38863This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
38864present if the number is greater than zero.
38865
38866.vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
38867This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
38868file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
38869
38870.vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
38871.cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
38872The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
38873
38874.vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
38875This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
38876command.
38877
38878.vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
38879This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
38880the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
38881messages.
38882
38883.vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
38884If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
38885the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
38886&$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
38887
38888.vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
38889This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
38890address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
38891
38892.vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
38893.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
38894.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
38895This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
38896if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
38897received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
38898
38899.vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
38900For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
38901unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
38902ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
38903supplied by the remote host, if any.
38904
38905.vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
38906This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
38907which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
38908generated messages.
38909
38910.vitem &%-local%&
38911The message is from a local sender.
38912
38913.vitem &%-localerror%&
38914The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
38915
38916.vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
38917This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
38918when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
38919variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
38920
38921.vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
38922The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
38923Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
38924
38925.vitem &%-N%&
38926A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
38927actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
38928&%-N%& is assumed.
38929
38930.vitem &%-received_protocol%&
38931This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
38932the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
38933
38934.vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
38935The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
38936to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
38937
38938.vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
38939If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
38940of &$spam_score_int$&.
38941
38942.vitem &%-spool_file_wireformat%&
38943The -D file for this message is in wire-format (for ESMTP CHUNKING)
38944rather than Unix-format.
38945The line-ending is CRLF rather than newline.
38946There is still, however, no leading-dot-stuffing.
38947
38948.vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
38949A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
38950certificate was verified by the server.
38951
38952.vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
38953When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
38954name of the cipher suite that was used.
38955
38956.vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
38957When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
38958was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
38959certificate.
38960.endlist
38961
38962Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
38963is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
38964line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
38965is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
38966the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
38967balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
38968to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
38969original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
38970addresses are complete.
38971
38972If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
38973the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
38974Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
38975tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
38976right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
38977follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
38978.code
38979YY darcy@austen.fict.example
38980NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
38981NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38982.endd
38983After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
38984This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
38985recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
38986delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
38987example:
38988.code
389894
38990editor@thesaurus.ref.example
38991darcy@austen.fict.example
38992rdo@foundation
38993alice@wonderland.fict.example
38994.endd
38995However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
38996result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
38997line is of the following form:
38998.display
38999<&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
39000 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
39001.endd
39002The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
39003the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
39004fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
39005original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
39006envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
39007length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
39008characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
39009that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
39010
39011
39012A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
39013which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
39014when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
39015character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
39016embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
39017following:
39018
39019.table2 50pt
39020.row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
39021.row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
39022.row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
39023.row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
39024.row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
39025.row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
39026.row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
39027.row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
39028.row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
39029.row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
39030.endtable
39031
39032Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
39033purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
39034typical set of headers:
39035.code
39036111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
39037id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
39038049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
39039038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
39040042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
39041049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
39042099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
39043darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39044104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
39045darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39046038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
39047.endd
39048The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
39049&'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
39050unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
39051.ecindex IIDforspo1
39052.ecindex IIDforspo2
39053.ecindex IIDforspo3
39054
39055.section "Format of the -D file" "SECID282a"
39056The data file is traditionally in Unix-standard format: lines are ended with
39057an ASCII newline character.
39058However, when the &%spool_wireformat%& main option is used some -D files
39059can have an alternate format.
39060This is flagged by a &%-spool_file_wireformat%& line in the corresponding -H file.
39061The -D file lines (not including the first name-component line) are
39062suitable for direct copying to the wire when transmitting using the
39063ESMTP CHUNKING option, meaning lower processing overhead.
39064Lines are terminated with an ASCII CRLF pair.
39065There is no dot-stuffing (and no dot-termination).
39066
39067. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39068. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39069
39070.chapter "DKIM and SPF" "CHAPdkim" &&&
39071 "DKIM and SPF Support"
39072.cindex "DKIM"
39073
39074.section "DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" SECDKIM
39075
39076DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
39077linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
39078be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
39079DKIM is documented in RFC 6376.
39080
39081As DKIM relies on the message being unchanged in transit, messages handled
39082by a mailing-list (which traditionally adds to the message) will not match
39083any original DKIM signature.
39084
39085DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
39086It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
39087
39088Exim's DKIM implementation allows for
39089.olist
39090Signing outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
39091It can co-exist with all other Exim features
39092(including transport filters)
39093except cutthrough delivery.
39094.next
39095Verifying signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
39096ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
39097different signature contexts.
39098.endlist
39099
39100In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
39101default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
39102Exim's standard controls.
39103
39104Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
39105on by default for logging (in the <= line) purposes.
39106
39107Additional log detail can be enabled using the &%dkim_verbose%& log_selector.
39108When set, for each signature in incoming email,
39109exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
39110signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
39111.code
391122009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
39113 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
39114 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
39115 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
39116.endd
39117
39118You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
39119or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
39120control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
39121where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
39122senders).
39123
39124
39125.section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECDKIMSIGN"
39126.cindex "DKIM" "signing"
39127
39128For signing to be usable you must have published a DKIM record in DNS.
39129Note that RFC 8301 says:
39130.code
39131rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
39132
39133Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
39134Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
39135.endd
39136
39137Note also that the key content (the 'p=' field)
39138in the DNS record is different between RSA and EC keys;
39139for the former it is the base64 of the ASN.1 for the RSA public key
39140(equivalent to the private-key .pem with the header/trailer stripped)
39141but for EC keys it is the base64 of the pure key; no ASN.1 wrapping.
39142
39143Signing is enabled by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
39144These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
39145
39146.option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
39147The domain(s) you want to sign with.
39148After expansion, this can be a list.
39149Each element in turn is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable
39150while expanding the remaining signing options.
39151If it is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done,
39152and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
39153
39154.option dkim_selector smtp string list&!! unset
39155This sets the key selector string.
39156After expansion, which can use &$dkim_domain$&, this can be a list.
39157Each element in turn is put in the expansion
39158variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
39159option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
39160If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done for this domain,
39161and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
39162
39163.option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
39164This sets the private key to use.
39165You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
39166&%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
39167The result can either
39168.ilist
39169be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor (.pem file), including line breaks
39170.next
39171with GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
39172be a valid Ed25519 private key (same format as above)
39173.next
39174start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
39175the private key
39176.next
39177be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
39178be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
39179is set.
39180.endlist
39181
39182To generate keys under OpenSSL:
39183.code
39184openssl genrsa -out dkim_rsa.private 2048
39185openssl rsa -in dkim_rsa.private -out /dev/stdout -pubout -outform PEM
39186.endd
39187Take the base-64 lines from the output of the second command, concatenated,
39188for the DNS TXT record.
39189See section 3.6 of RFC6376 for the record specification.
39190
39191Under GnuTLS:
39192.code
39193certtool --generate-privkey --rsa --bits=2048 --password='' -8 --outfile=dkim_rsa.private
39194certtool --load-privkey=dkim_rsa.private --pubkey-info
39195.endd
39196
39197Note that RFC 8301 says:
39198.code
39199Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
39200Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
39201.endd
39202
39203Support for EC keys is being developed under
39204&url(https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-dcrup-dkim-crypto/).
39205They are considerably smaller than RSA keys for equivalent protection.
39206As they are a recent development, users should consider dual-signing
39207(by setting a list of selectors, and an expansion for this option)
39208for some transition period.
39209The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
39210for EC keys.
39211
39212OpenSSL 1.1.1 and GnuTLS 3.6.0 can create Ed25519 private keys:
39213.code
39214openssl genpkey -algorithm ed25519 -out dkim_ed25519.private
39215certtool --generate-privkey --key-type=ed25519 --outfile=dkim_ed25519.private
39216.endd
39217
39218To produce the required public key value for a DNS record:
39219.code
39220openssl pkey -outform DER -pubout -in dkim_ed25519.private | tail -c +13 | base64
39221certtool --load_privkey=dkim_ed25519.private --pubkey_info --outder | tail -c +13 | base64
39222.endd
39223
39224Note that the format
39225of Ed25519 keys in DNS has not yet been decided; this release supports
39226both of the leading candidates at this time, a future release will
39227probably drop support for whichever proposal loses.
39228
39229.option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
39230Can be set to any one of the supported hash methods, which are:
39231.ilist
39232&`sha1`& &-- should not be used, is old and insecure
39233.next
39234&`sha256`& &-- the default
39235.next
39236&`sha512`& &-- possibly more secure but less well supported
39237.endlist
39238
39239Note that RFC 8301 says:
39240.code
39241rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
39242.endd
39243
39244.option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
39245If set after expansion, the value is used to set an "i=" tag in
39246the signing header. The DKIM standards restrict the permissible
39247syntax of this optional tag to a mail address, with possibly-empty
39248local part, an @, and a domain identical to or subdomain of the "d="
39249tag value. Note that Exim does not check the value.
39250
39251.option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
39252This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
39253The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
39254The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
39255only supports signing with the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
39256
39257.option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
39258This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
39259should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
39260either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
39261unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
39262variables here.
39263
39264.option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "see below"
39265If set, this option must expand to a colon-separated
39266list of header names.
39267Headers with these names, or the absence or such a header, will be included
39268in the message signature.
39269When unspecified, the header names listed in RFC4871 will be used,
39270whether or not each header is present in the message.
39271The default list is available for the expansion in the macro
39272"_DKIM_SIGN_HEADERS".
39273
39274If a name is repeated, multiple headers by that name (or the absence thereof)
39275will be signed. The textually later headers in the headers part of the
39276message are signed first, if there are multiples.
39277
39278A name can be prefixed with either an '=' or a '+' character.
39279If an '=' prefix is used, all headers that are present with this name
39280will be signed.
39281If a '+' prefix if used, all headers that are present with this name
39282will be signed, and one signature added for a missing header with the
39283name will be appended.
39284
39285.new
39286.option dkim_timestamps smtp integer&!! unset
39287This option controls the inclusion of timestamp information in the signature.
39288If not set, no such information will be included.
39289Otherwise, must be an unsigned number giving an offset in seconds from the current time
39290for the expiry tag
39291(eg. 1209600 for two weeks);
39292both creation (t=) and expiry (x=) tags will be included.
39293
39294RFC 6376 lists these tags as RECOMMENDED.
39295.wen
39296
39297
39298.section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECDKIMVFY"
39299.cindex "DKIM" "verification"
39300
39301.new
39302Verification of DKIM signatures in SMTP incoming email is done for all
39303messages for which an ACL control &%dkim_disable_verify%& has not been set.
39304.cindex authentication "expansion item"
39305Performing verification sets up information used by the
39306&$authresults$& expansion item.
39307.wen
39308
39309.new The results of that verification are then made available to the
39310&%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL, &new(which can examine and modify them).
39311By default, this ACL is called once for each
39312syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
39313A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
39314If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
39315If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message, that is
39316summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
39317
39318To evaluate the &new(verification result) in the ACL
39319a large number of expansion variables
39320containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
39321runtime of the ACL.
39322
39323Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
39324more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
39325&%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
39326&%$dkim_signers%& exist.
39327
39328The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
39329list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
39330called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
39331the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
39332list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
39333&%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
39334it defaults as:
39335.code
39336dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
39337.endd
39338This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
39339DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
39340call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
39341.code
39342dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
39343.endd
39344This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
39345and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
39346You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
39347.code
39348dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
39349.endd
39350
39351If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
39352&%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
39353
39354If multiple signatures match a domain (or identity), the ACL is called once
39355for each matching signature.
39356
39357
39358Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
39359available (from most to least important):
39360
39361
39362.vlist
39363.vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
39364The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
39365an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
39366&%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
39367
39368.vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
39369Within the DKIM ACL,
39370a string describing the general status of the signature. One of
39371.ilist
39372&%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
39373identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
39374.next
39375&%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
39376More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
39377.next
39378&%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
39379available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
39380.next
39381&%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
39382.endlist
39383
39384This variable can be overwritten using an ACL 'set' modifier.
39385This might, for instance, be done to enforce a policy restriction on
39386hash-method or key-size:
39387.code
39388 warn condition = ${if eq {$dkim_verify_status}{pass}}
39389 condition = ${if eq {${length_3:$dkim_algo}}{rsa}}
39390 condition = ${if or {{eq {$dkim_algo}{rsa-sha1}} \
39391 {< {$dkim_key_length}{1024}}}}
39392 logwrite = NOTE: forcing DKIM verify fail (was pass)
39393 set dkim_verify_status = fail
39394 set dkim_verify_reason = hash too weak or key too short
39395.endd
39396
39397So long as a DKIM ACL is defined (it need do no more than accept),
39398after all the DKIM ACL runs have completed, the value becomes a
39399colon-separated list of the values after each run.
39400This is maintained for the mime, prdr and data ACLs.
39401
39402.vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
39403A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
39404"fail" or "invalid". One of
39405.ilist
39406&%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
39407key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
39408.next
39409&%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
39410record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
39411.next
39412&%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
39413body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
39414means that the message body was modified in transit.
39415.next
39416&%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
39417could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
39418re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
39419DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
39420.endlist
39421
39422This variable can be overwritten, with any value, using an ACL 'set' modifier.
39423
39424.vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
39425The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
39426an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
39427reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
39428
39429.vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
39430The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
39431if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
39432identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
39433
39434.vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
39435The key record selector string.
39436
39437.vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
39438The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
39439If running under GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
39440may also be 'ed25519-sha256'.
39441The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
39442for EC keys.
39443
39444Note that RFC 8301 says:
39445.code
39446rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
39447
39448DKIM signatures identified as having been signed with historic
39449algorithms (currently, rsa-sha1) have permanently failed evaluation
39450.endd
39451
39452To enforce this you must have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
39453and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above.
39454
39455.vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
39456The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
39457
39458.vitem &%$dkim_canon_headers%&
39459The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
39460
39461.vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
39462A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
39463(copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
39464Note that RFC6376 requires that verification fail if the From: header is
39465not included in the signature. Exim does not enforce this; sites wishing
39466strict enforcement should code the check explicitly.
39467
39468.vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
39469The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
39470limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
39471that this variable always expands to an integer value.
39472.new
39473&*Note:*& The presence of the signature tag specifying a signing body length
39474is one possible route to spoofing of valid DKIM signatures.
39475A paranoid implementation might wish to regard signature where this variable
39476shows less than the "no limit" return as being invalid.
39477.wen
39478
39479.vitem &%$dkim_created%&
39480UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
39481When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
39482
39483.vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
39484UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
39485signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
39486signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
39487integer size comparisons against this value.
39488Note that Exim does not check this value.
39489
39490.vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
39491A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
39492
39493.vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
39494"1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
39495
39496.vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
39497"1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
39498
39499.vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
39500Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
39501in the key record.
39502
39503.vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
39504Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
39505in the key record.
39506
39507.vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
39508Notes from the key record (tag n=).
39509
39510.vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
39511Number of bits in the key.
39512
39513Note that RFC 8301 says:
39514.code
39515Verifiers MUST NOT consider signatures using RSA keys of
39516less than 1024 bits as valid signatures.
39517.endd
39518
39519To enforce this you must have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
39520and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above.
39521As EC keys are much smaller, the check should only do this for RSA keys.
39522
39523.endlist
39524
39525In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
39526
39527.vlist
39528.vitem &%dkim_signers%&
39529ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
39530for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
39531(reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
39532verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
39533
39534.code
39535# Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no gmail signature
39536warn log_message = GMail sender without gmail.com DKIM signature
39537 sender_domains = gmail.com
39538 dkim_signers = gmail.com
39539 dkim_status = none
39540.endd
39541
39542Note that the above does not check for a total lack of DKIM signing;
39543for that check for empty &$h_DKIM-Signature:$& in the data ACL.
39544
39545.vitem &%dkim_status%&
39546ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
39547results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
39548to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
39549
39550.code
39551deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
39552 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
39553 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
39554 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
39555.endd
39556
39557The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
39558see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
39559for more information of what they mean.
39560.endlist
39561
39562
39563
39564
39565.section "SPF (Sender Policy Framework)" SECSPF
39566.cindex SPF verification
39567
39568SPF is a mechanism whereby a domain may assert which IP addresses may transmit
39569messages with its domain in the envelope from, documented by RFC 7208.
39570For more information on SPF see &url(http://www.openspf.org).
39571. --- 2018-09-07: still not https
39572
39573Messages sent by a system not authorised will fail checking of such assertions.
39574This includes retransmissions done by traditional forwarders.
39575
39576SPF verification support is built into Exim if SUPPORT_SPF=yes is set in
39577&_Local/Makefile_&. The support uses the &_libspf2_& library
39578&url(https://www.libspf2.org/).
39579There is no Exim involvement in the transmission of messages;
39580publishing certain DNS records is all that is required.
39581
39582For verification, an ACL condition and an expansion lookup are provided.
39583.cindex authentication "expansion item"
39584Performing verification sets up information used by the
39585&$authresults$& expansion item.
39586
39587
39588.cindex SPF "ACL condition"
39589.cindex ACL "spf condition"
39590The ACL condition "spf" can be used at or after the MAIL ACL.
39591It takes as an argument a list of strings giving the outcome of the SPF check,
39592and will succeed for any matching outcome.
39593Valid strings are:
39594.vlist
39595.vitem &%pass%&
39596The SPF check passed, the sending host is positively verified by SPF.
39597
39598.vitem &%fail%&
39599The SPF check failed, the sending host is NOT allowed to send mail for the
39600domain in the envelope-from address.
39601
39602.vitem &%softfail%&
39603The SPF check failed, but the queried domain can't absolutely confirm that this
39604is a forgery.
39605
39606.vitem &%none%&
39607The queried domain does not publish SPF records.
39608
39609.vitem &%neutral%&
39610The SPF check returned a "neutral" state. This means the queried domain has
39611published a SPF record, but wants to allow outside servers to send mail under
39612its domain as well. This should be treated like "none".
39613
39614.vitem &%permerror%&
39615This indicates a syntax error in the SPF record of the queried domain.
39616You may deny messages when this occurs.
39617
39618.vitem &%temperror%&
39619This indicates a temporary error during all processing, including Exim's
39620SPF processing. You may defer messages when this occurs.
39621.endlist
39622
39623You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert
39624its meaning, for example "!fail" will match all results but
39625"fail". The string list is evaluated left-to-right, in a
39626short-circuit fashion.
39627
39628Example:
39629.code
39630deny spf = fail
39631 message = $sender_host_address is not allowed to send mail from \
39632 ${if def:sender_address_domain \
39633 {$sender_address_domain}{$sender_helo_name}}. \
39634 Please see http://www.openspf.org/Why?scope=\
39635 ${if def:sender_address_domain {mfrom}{helo}};\
39636 identity=${if def:sender_address_domain \
39637 {$sender_address}{$sender_helo_name}};\
39638 ip=$sender_host_address
39639.endd
39640
39641When the spf condition has run, it sets up several expansion
39642variables:
39643
39644.cindex SPF "verification variables"
39645.vlist
39646.vitem &$spf_header_comment$&
39647.vindex &$spf_header_comment$&
39648 This contains a human-readable string describing the outcome
39649 of the SPF check. You can add it to a custom header or use
39650 it for logging purposes.
39651
39652.vitem &$spf_received$&
39653.vindex &$spf_received$&
39654 This contains a complete Received-SPF: header that can be
39655 added to the message. Please note that according to the SPF
39656 draft, this header must be added at the top of the header
39657 list. Please see section 10 on how you can do this.
39658
39659 Note: in case of "Best-guess" (see below), the convention is
39660 to put this string in a header called X-SPF-Guess: instead.
39661
39662.vitem &$spf_result$&
39663.vindex &$spf_result$&
39664 This contains the outcome of the SPF check in string form,
39665 one of pass, fail, softfail, none, neutral, permerror or
39666 temperror.
39667
39668.vitem &$spf_result_guessed$&
39669.vindex &$spf_result_guessed$&
39670 This boolean is true only if a best-guess operation was used
39671 and required in order to obtain a result.
39672
39673.vitem &$spf_smtp_comment$&
39674.vindex &$spf_smtp_comment$&
39675 This contains a string that can be used in a SMTP response
39676 to the calling party. Useful for "fail".
39677.endlist
39678
39679
39680.cindex SPF "ACL condition"
39681.cindex ACL "spf_guess condition"
39682.cindex SPF "best guess"
39683In addition to SPF, you can also perform checks for so-called
39684"Best-guess". Strictly speaking, "Best-guess" is not standard
39685SPF, but it is supported by the same framework that enables SPF
39686capability.
39687Refer to &url(http://www.openspf.org/FAQ/Best_guess_record)
39688for a description of what it means.
39689. --- 2018-09-07: still not https:
39690
39691To access this feature, simply use the spf_guess condition in place
39692of the spf one. For example:
39693
39694.code
39695deny spf_guess = fail
39696 message = $sender_host_address doesn't look trustworthy to me
39697.endd
39698
39699In case you decide to reject messages based on this check, you
39700should note that although it uses the same framework, "Best-guess"
39701is not SPF, and therefore you should not mention SPF at all in your
39702reject message.
39703
39704When the spf_guess condition has run, it sets up the same expansion
39705variables as when spf condition is run, described above.
39706
39707Additionally, since Best-guess is not standardized, you may redefine
39708what "Best-guess" means to you by redefining the main configuration
39709&%spf_guess%& option.
39710For example, the following:
39711
39712.code
39713spf_guess = v=spf1 a/16 mx/16 ptr ?all
39714.endd
39715
39716would relax host matching rules to a broader network range.
39717
39718
39719.cindex SPF "lookup expansion"
39720.cindex lookup spf
39721A lookup expansion is also available. It takes an email
39722address as the key and an IP address as the database:
39723
39724.code
39725 ${lookup {username@domain} spf {ip.ip.ip.ip}}
39726.endd
39727
39728The lookup will return the same result strings as can appear in
39729&$spf_result$& (pass,fail,softfail,neutral,none,err_perm,err_temp).
39730Currently, only IPv4 addresses are supported.
39731
39732
39733
39734
39735. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39736. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39737
39738.chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
39739 "Proxy support"
39740.cindex "proxy support"
39741.cindex "proxy" "access via"
39742
39743A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
39744Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
39745
39746
39747.section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
39748.cindex proxy inbound
39749.cindex proxy "server side"
39750.cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
39751.cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
39752
39753Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
39754that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
39755To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
39756in Local/Makefile.
39757
39758It was built on the HAProxy specification, found at
39759&url(https://www.haproxy.org/download/1.8/doc/proxy-protocol.txt).
39760
39761The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
39762such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
39763to distribute load.
39764Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
39765the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
39766There is no logging if a host passes or
39767fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
39768recorded in an ACL (example is below).
39769
39770Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
39771main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
39772hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
39773Exim supports both version 1 and version 2 of the Proxy Protocol and
39774automatically determines which version is in use.
39775
39776The Proxy Protocol header is the first data received on a TCP connection
39777and is inserted before any TLS-on-connect handshake from the client; Exim
39778negotiates TLS between Exim-as-server and the remote client, not between
39779Exim and the proxy server.
39780
39781The following expansion variables are usable
39782(&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
39783of the proxy):
39784.display
39785&'proxy_external_address '& IP of host being proxied or IP of remote interface of proxy
39786&'proxy_external_port '& Port of host being proxied or Port on remote interface of proxy
39787&'proxy_local_address '& IP of proxy server inbound or IP of local interface of proxy
39788&'proxy_local_port '& Port of proxy server inbound or Port on local interface of proxy
39789&'proxy_session '& boolean: SMTP connection via proxy
39790.endd
39791If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_external_address$& is empty
39792there was a protocol error.
39793
39794Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
39795per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
39796evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
39797handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
39798With the option set so high, you lose the ability
39799to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
39800In order to prevent your server from overload, you
39801need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
39802A possible solution is:
39803.display
39804 # Set max number of connections per host
39805 LIMIT = 5
39806 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
39807 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
39808
39809 defer message = Too many connections from this IP right now
39810 ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
39811.endd
39812
39813
39814
39815.section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
39816.cindex proxy outbound
39817.cindex proxy "client side"
39818.cindex proxy SOCKS
39819.cindex SOCKS proxy
39820Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
39821using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by RFC1928).
39822The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
39823Local/Makefile.
39824
39825Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
39826on an smtp transport.
39827The option value is expanded and should then be a list
39828(colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
39829Each proxy specifier is a list
39830(space-separated by default) where the initial element
39831is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
39832
39833Options are a string <name>=<value>.
39834The list of options is in the following table:
39835.display
39836&'auth '& authentication method
39837&'name '& authentication username
39838&'pass '& authentication password
39839&'port '& tcp port
39840&'tmo '& connection timeout
39841&'pri '& priority
39842&'weight '& selection bias
39843.endd
39844
39845More details on each of these options follows:
39846
39847.ilist
39848.cindex authentication "to proxy"
39849.cindex proxy authentication
39850&%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
39851Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per RFC 1929
39852for access to the proxy.
39853Default is &"none"&.
39854.next
39855&%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
39856Default is empty.
39857.next
39858&%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
39859Default is empty.
39860.next
39861&%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
39862Default is 1080.
39863.next
39864&%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
39865Default is 5.
39866.next
39867&%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
39868higher values being tried first.
39869The default priority is 1.
39870.next
39871&%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
39872Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
39873weighted by this value.
39874The default value for selection bias is 1.
39875.endlist
39876
39877Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
39878and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
39879overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
39880
39881.section Logging SECTproxyLog
39882To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
39883add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
39884This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
39885
39886. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39887. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39888
39889.chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
39890 "Internationalisation""
39891.cindex internationalisation "email address"
39892.cindex EAI
39893.cindex i18n
39894.cindex utf8 "mail name handling"
39895
39896Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
39897To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
39898Standards supported are RFCs 2060, 5890, 6530 and 6533.
39899
39900If Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N_2008 (in addition to SUPPORT_I18N, not
39901instead of it) then IDNA2008 is supported; this adds an extra library
39902requirement, upon libidn2.
39903
39904.section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
39905.cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
39906The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
39907a host list. If this matches the sending host and
39908accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
39909SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
39910
39911If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
39912international handling for the message is enabled and
39913the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
39914
39915The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
39916message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
39917whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
39918when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
39919
39920Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
39921UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
39922require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
39923the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
39924
39925HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
39926components expanded to a-label form,
39927and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
39928form of the name.
39929
39930.cindex log protocol
39931.cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
39932.cindex i18n logging
39933Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
39934prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
39935
39936The following expansion operators can be used:
39937.code
39938${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
39939${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
39940${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
39941${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
39942.endd
39943
39944.cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
39945.cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
39946The RCPT ACL
39947may use the following modifier:
39948.display
39949control = utf8_downconvert
39950control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
39951.endd
39952This sets a flag requiring that addresses are converted to
39953a-label form before smtp delivery, for use in a
39954Message Submission Agent context.
39955If a value is appended it may be:
39956.display
39957&`1 `& (default) mandatory downconversion
39958&`0 `& no downconversion
39959&`-1 `& if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host
39960.endd
39961
39962If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
39963is initially set to -1.
39964
39965.new
39966The smtp transport has an option &%utf8_downconvert%&.
39967If set it must expand to one of the three values described above,
39968and it overrides any previously set value.
39969.wen
39970
39971
39972There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
39973Configurations supporting these should inspect
39974&$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
39975
39976There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
39977Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
39978for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
39979
39980There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
39981and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
39982
39983
39984
39985.section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
39986To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
39987the following expansion operator can be used:
39988.code
39989${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
39990.endd
39991
39992The string is converted from the charset specified by
39993the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
39994or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
39995to the
39996modified UTF-7 encoding specified by RFC 2060,
39997with the following exception: All occurrences of <sep>
39998(which has to be a single character)
39999are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
40000<sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
40001
40002The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
40003The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
40004
40005This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
40006by many other IMAP servers.
40007
40008Examples:
40009.display
40010&`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
40011&`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
40012&`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
40013.endd
40014
40015Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
40016must be representable in UTF-16.
40017
40018
40019. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40020. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40021
40022.chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
40023 "Events"
40024.cindex events
40025
40026The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
40027of points. It was originally invented to give a way to do customised logging
40028actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
40029processing actions.
40030
40031Most installations will never need to use Events.
40032The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
40033in &_Local/Makefile_&.
40034
40035There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
40036The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
40037a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
40038
40039Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
40040An example might look like:
40041.cindex logging custom
40042.code
40043event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
40044{${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
40045 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
40046 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
40047 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
40048 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
40049 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
40050 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
40051 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
40052} {}}
40053.endd
40054
40055Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
40056The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
40057expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
40058
40059The current list of events is:
40060.display
40061&`dane:fail after transport `& per connection
40062&`msg:complete after main `& per message
40063&`msg:delivery after transport `& per recipient
40064&`msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport `& per recipient per host
40065&`msg:rcpt:defer after transport `& per recipient
40066&`msg:host:defer after transport `& per attempt
40067&`msg:fail:delivery after transport `& per recipient
40068&`msg:fail:internal after main `& per recipient
40069&`tcp:connect before transport `& per connection
40070&`tcp:close after transport `& per connection
40071&`tls:cert before both `& per certificate in verification chain
40072&`smtp:connect after transport `& per connection
40073.endd
40074New event types may be added in future.
40075
40076The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
40077event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
40078or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
40079
40080The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
40081before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
40082can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
40083
40084The third column in the table above says what section of the configuration
40085should define the event action.
40086
40087An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
40088with the event type:
40089.display
40090&`dane:fail `& failure reason
40091&`msg:delivery `& smtp confirmation message
40092&`msg:rcpt:host:defer `& error string
40093&`msg:rcpt:defer `& error string
40094&`msg:host:defer `& error string
40095&`tls:cert `& verification chain depth
40096&`smtp:connect `& smtp banner
40097.endd
40098
40099The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
40100
40101For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&
40102however due to the multiple contexts that Exim operates in during
40103the course of its processing:
40104.ilist
40105variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
40106transport call
40107.next
40108acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
40109and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
40110.endlist
40111Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
40112a useful way of writing to the main log.
40113
40114The expansion of the event_action option should normally
40115return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
40116following will be forced:
40117.display
40118&`tcp:connect `& do not connect
40119&`tls:cert `& refuse verification
40120&`smtp:connect `& close connection
40121.endd
40122All other message types ignore the result string, and
40123no other use is made of it.
40124
40125For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
40126then the address and port variables will be that of the proxy and not
40127the target system.
40128
40129For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
40130chain element received on the connection.
40131For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
40132loaded locally.
40133
40134. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40135. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40136
40137.chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
40138 "Adding drivers or lookups"
40139.cindex "adding drivers"
40140.cindex "new drivers, adding"
40141.cindex "drivers" "adding new"
40142The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
40143authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
40144
40145.olist
40146Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
40147existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
40148.next
40149Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
40150.display
40151<&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
40152.endd
40153where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
40154code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
40155should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
40156.next
40157Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
40158.code
40159#define <type>_NEWDRIVER
40160.endd
40161.next
40162Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
40163and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
40164.next
40165Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
40166near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
40167Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
40168As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
40169simple form that most lookups have.
40170.next
40171Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
40172&_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
40173driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
40174.next
40175Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
40176&_src_&.
40177.next
40178Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
40179as for other drivers and lookups.
40180.endlist
40181
40182Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
40183proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
40184occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
40185options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
40186searched using a binary chop procedure.
40187
40188There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
40189the interface that is expected.
40190
40191
40192
40193
40194. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40195. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40196
40197. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40198. These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
40199. Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
40200. PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
40201. processors.
40202. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40203
40204.literal xml
40205<?sdop
40206 format="newpage"
40207 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
40208 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
40209?>
40210.literal off
40211
40212.makeindex "Options index" "option"
40213.makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
40214.makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
40215
40216
40217. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40218. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////